英语的课件
发表时间:2024-04-27英语的课件。
教案课件是老师需要精心准备的,这就需要我们老师自己抽时间去完成。教师要严格按照教案要求进行教学从而增强教学效力。希望这份“英语的课件”能够达到您的预期,此文一读相信您会拥有新的认知深度!
英语的课件 篇1
大家上午好,今天我要向大家介绍的课是普通高中课程标准实验教科书英语必修2第4单元Wildlif Protection 阅读部分 How Daisy Learned to Protect Wildlife。我将着重从以下五个方面介绍我的课:教材分析和学情分析、教学目标及重难点、教学方法,教学步骤和板书设计。
首先,我想分析一下教材和学生情况,我所要讲的课是本单元的第一部分,也就是warming up 和阅读部分。本单元的话题是保护野生动物的重要性以及如何保护野生动物和濒临灭绝的动物。学生对动物保护非常的感兴趣,所以在提到野生动物以及保护措施时都有自己独特的理解和见解。我的学生来自高中一年级,他们大都能够用一些简单的句子表达自己的观点,学习英语热情高,喜欢表达自己的想法。所以我会尽量设计一些小组讨论及口头表达活动,给他们足够的空间练习口语。但是他们阅读能力还比较弱,没有掌握好阅读技巧,尤其还不会运用读前预测,跳读,精读等阅读技巧理解课文。本节课我将着重教授阅读技巧如读前预测、跳读、精读等。
根据以上对教材和学生情况的分析,我制定以下教学目标和本课重难点。第一、语言知识,学生在warming up 和pre-reading时尽量能够掌握本单元重点单词和短语。第二、语言技能,本课主要是以阅读为主,所以学生要学习和掌握扫读,跳读,精读等阅读技巧。第三、情感目标,学生知道保护野生动物和濒危动物的重要性,以及通过自己的实际行动保护小动物。第四、文化意识,学生了解保护野生动物不是一个人,一个地区或是一个国家的事情,而是全人类共同的责任。了解世界上野生动物保护组织,如WWF。第五,学习策略,学生能够独立思考以及通过小组合作学习。而本课的重点是学生能够自由发表保护野生动物的建议,能够形成保护野生动物的意识。阅读技巧的掌握是即是本课的重点也是本课的难点。
我采用的教学方法主要是交际法。
接下来,是关键的环节——教学步骤,我把整个教学过程分为五个步骤:warming up,pre-reading,while-reading,post-reading和homework。
步骤一、warming up(5m)
我首先播放一个视频,视频的内容是野生动物如何面临死亡、灭绝的。通过视频引发学生对野生动物为什么越来越少的思考,学生根据短片和自身了解给出多种野生动物濒临灭绝的原因。这之后,我会说,现在越来越多的人和国家都意识到这个问题的严重性,很多保护野生动物的组织逐渐形成,如WWF(介绍这组织的)。我会让学生翻开课本的27页,这里有对WWF具体的介绍。
在这个环节中,引入本文主题,学生能够熟悉本文的重要话题——野生动物保护,以及了解重要的世界野生动物保护组织。他们形成保护野生动物的意识。
步骤二、pre-reading(5m)
这里我要求学生根据文章的题目How Daisy Learned to Protect Wildlife及在热身环节的讨论过的话题,预测一下文章将要讲述什么样的内容。通过这个活动,学生能够学习如何通过文章的标题找到跟文章内容相关的信息,并能掌握预测技巧运用到实际阅读中。
步骤三、while-reading(25m)
While-reading是正文部分,将花费25分钟。首先,我会给出文章中各个自然段的中心意思,是打乱循序的。要求学生跳读文章各段给各个自然段找到正确的中心意思。学生能够运用跳读技巧找出各段体现主题的词语和句子,选出各段的中心意思。其次,我要求学生根据我设计表格来精读文章,表格是关于Daisy三次拜访野生动物的经历,包括野生动物的生存条件和野生动物未受保护和受保护的不同结果。学生认真的阅读课文,阅读后,学生四人为一小组根据自己对文章的了解进行讨论,最终得出小组答案,我会让小组代表说说该组的最终答案。在这个环节中,学生能够通过精读找到文章中的细节内容,这些细节内容都体现文章的话题,是对文章话题的具体表现。有助于学生跟好的理解话题。同时学生间小组讨论合作有利于学习互补。根据以上对各个段落的中心意思的总结及Daisy三次野生动物拜访的总结,学生可以根据已知的信息很容易的总结出本文的主旨。为了能够及时巩固已学的知识,接着,我要求学生能够根据各个段落的中心意思及Daisy三次野生动物拜访的总结复述课文。
步骤四、post-reading(8m)
我要求学生分小组自由讨论如何保护野生动物的对策,比赛哪组是“献计王”。学生通过激烈地讨论,集思广益。那组的对策最多最妙为赢家将得到“献计王”的称号。
步骤五、homework(2m)
在文中找到表达建议的语句。
上网搜索保护野生动物的对策,并能用建议性的语句给WWF写三条保护野生动物的建议。还要上网多了解一些世界保护野生动物的组织。写三条保护野生动物的建议是为了下节课写作做准备。
板书如下:
Unit 4 How Daisy Learned to Protect Wildlife
Paragraph(main idea ) Animal Situation Result
Para.1 Tibet Antelope Be hunted Numbers are descreasing
Para.2 … … …
Para.3/4 … …. ….
carpet
fur
distant
mercy
certain
burst into laughter
in relief
…
英语的课件 篇2
【活动目标】
1、让孩子学会儿歌Four big apples,让幼儿对儿歌感兴趣。
2、认识新单词Chair和句子On the chair。
【活动准备】
图片(apple strawberry cherry pineapple grapes)一张椅子,四个苹果。
【活动过程】
1、Greeting(问候语):Sing the “Hello” song。
A say Good afternoon to boys and girls。
2、Warming up (热身运动)
Sing “Walking” song and do “Ten little Judi an” song
3、Reviewing activities(复习单词)
Stanberry Cherry Pineapple Grippes Iemon)
4、Learn new
Chair and on the chair(Chair chair chair)由高到低念,把苹果放在椅子上引导下个句子On the chair。
5、Introducing hero。
(1)apple 教师把已装有苹果的盒子神秘地拿到小朋友面(jy135幼儿教育 jy135。)前,让幼儿有探索的欲望。
T: Look! What’s this?
C: Box。
T: Yes, A box。
T: what’s fruit in the box? Do you know, let’s guess。(Apple?Yes or No? watermarked? Oh, Oh…。)
“Oh, It’s an apple”(教师试范)
……ding ding ding they are apples。
T: Do you like apples?
C: Yes, I like apples。
T: Hun,The smell is good。拿到小朋友面前,Smell it and then it
T: Who want to try?(继续拿出椅子的苹果)
T: OK, Now all apples are here, Let me put them on the chair。 Now, Look the chair on the chair。 Follow me ,one big apple on the chair。(让幼儿跟着念一向把四个苹果全放在一椅子上方)
T: OK, Let’s learn a a new song。
four big apples on the chair。
one for you and one for me。
Two big apples on the chair。
one for you and one for me。
No more apples on the chair。
No more apples on the chair。
英语的课件 篇3
在教学工作者实际的教学活动中,很有必要精心设计一份说课稿,写说课稿能有效帮助我们总结和提升讲课技巧。怎样写说课稿才更能起到其作用呢?下面是小编收集整理的全英文PEP小学英语说课稿 Unit 4 my home,仅供参考,大家一起来看看吧。
Good morning, ladies and gentlemen, it's my great honor/ to interpret my lesson plan here. /Now I will explain this lesson from 5 aspects----analysis of teaching materials, analysis of students, teaching aims, teaching methods, and the most important one /is teaching procedure.
Now, let's focus on the analysis of teaching materials. My topic is unit 4 my home(板书).It contains 2 parts----Let's learn and Let's do.(板书)It is very important in this unit. With the basic knowledge of this lesson, Ss can learn the following class well. The key points of this lesson,/ Ss are able to master key words, such as kitchen bathroom and so on ,and the key sentences like where's the …/ Is she in the…? And the difficult points are the pronunciation of the words kitchen and bathroom and how to lead Ss /to use the learnt knowledge in a real situation.
Next, it is about the students, and my Ss are in Grade 4, they are full of curiosity,/ creative and willing to express themselves. And they have learnt some words and expression before, so it is not difficult for them/ to learn today's lesson.
And based on analysis of teaching materials and students, I set the teaching aims as follows: the first one /is language knowledge, by the end of the lesson. Ss will be able to listen, speak, read and write the new words: kitchen bathroom and so on, and the key sentences like where's the …/ Is she in the…? The second one is language skills, through this lesson, Ss' can introduce their homes in English briefly. The last one is the emotion aims, which is to encourage Ss to love their homes and also develop their awareness of keeping their homes clean.
And in order to achieve teaching aims better and stress the key points, break through the difficult points efficiently, I will mainly use task-based teaching method, situational teaching method and TPR teaching method./ To make the English teaching more directly, CAI and tape recorder will be needed.
Now I will talk about the most important part ---teaching procedure (and the purposes of my designing). I will divide my lesson into 4 steps.
The first step is warming up (about 5 mins). After greeting with Ss, I will begin the lesson by singing a song, and I'll invite the Ss to sing/ say it with me. Like this_________________.
My purpose here is form a better English learning surrounding for Ss, it can draw Ss attention quickly to the English class and arouse their interest.
After the song, I will say we all have happy families, so is Amy. Look, this is Amy's home. (板书:房子)
(呈现单词) ①I'll have a riddle for students to guess what room it is(板书). And I'll give them some tips to help them to get the right answers. For example, I'll give some hints like there is a bed and a closet in this room. Oh, it's a bedroom. Great, this is the study(通过猜谜呈现两个单词) and I will ask Ss to read after me of the words
② How about this one? I'll cover a part of the rooms and let Ss guess. Bingo, it's a bathroom. And I'll ask Ss to read after me.
③Now Amy's hiding in one of the rooms, I'll let Ss guess “ where is …”/ “ is she in…”/ yes, she is/ no, she isn't.
My purpose of this part is to use different ways to present the words and sentences for a better understanding.
After presenting these words and sentences, I'd like to go on the third step---practice. I'll let Ss review the words and sentences by a chant。For the first time , we will have the chant together and do the actions. Like this “go to the living room, watch TV; go to the study, read a book” And for the second time, I'll say watch TV,Ss say go to the living room. I say read a book, Ss say go to the study..
After a chant, I'll have a game called hide and seek let students guess where is Amy. I'll let Ss close their eyes and I put a picture of Amy may be in the study, and students may ask “ where is Amy? Is she in the bedroom?” I'll say “No, she isn't” “where is Amy? Is she in the study?” “ Yes ,she is.”
My purpose here is to let Ss consolidate the knowledge in a relaxed atmosphere.
After practice, I'll move to the fourth step---extension. First, I'll divide the whole class into groups, four in a group. Discuss and draw their own homes ,describe where their parents are in the home。At the same time, I'll walk around the classroom and give them some suggestions. Maybe 3 mins later, I will invite some groups to come here to perform their dialogue, and I'll give them comments.
My purpose is to focus on the Ss and cultivate their language ability and cooperative ability.
The last step is homework. I'll ask Ss to listen to the tape and follow it 3 times. Because it can help them to correct their pronunciation after class.
And this is my layout.
That's all. Thank you for your attention!
英语的课件 篇4
一、说教材
本课时包括A部分的Let's learn和Let's do,其内容主要是学习常见的动物单词。在日常生活中我们会接触到很多小动物,如何让学生学会用英语来表达这些动物的名称是本单元所要学习的教学内容。依据教材的内容和学生的年龄特征及认知水平,确定以下目标:
1、能听说、认读六个有关动物的单词。
2、能在Act like a……的指令下模仿小动物的动作。
二、说重点和难点
本课时教学重点是学习六个有关动物的词汇。教学难点是灵活运用所学单词进行口语交际。突破重难点的关键是结合低年级学生喜欢游戏的特点,掌握知识,并灵活地运用。
三、说教法
为了顺利完成以上教学目标,更好地突出重点,突破难点,按照学生认知规律,我采用了讲读、游戏法和全身动作反应法相结合的方法,层层递进,激发学生的学习兴趣,保持他们强烈的好奇心和旺盛的求知欲,进而促使他们由兴趣发展到产生要学好的志趣。
四、说学法
鉴于本课词汇的特点及学生现有知识水平,我准备引导学生听、看、说、做来逐步引导学生表达动物名称,发展学生的语言思维和运用能力。同时多表扬,勤鼓励,使不同层次的学生都有学习积极性,在知识上均有提高。
五、说教学流程
1、热身
利用歌曲How are you?使学生的注意力和兴趣集中到课堂。
2、新课呈现
学习动物单词是本课的教学重点。先让学生观看动物乐队出场的画面,吸引学生的注意力,然后逐一引出单词,教读单词。
3、趣味操练用各种游戏,让学生在玩中操练所学内容。
4、回顾
对本课所学内容进行小结,让学生对所学知识有一个总体的了解。
英语的课件 篇5
一.说教材:
《birthdays》是译林英语五下的最后一个单元。本课时主要讲授的是第一板块Story time的内容。主要围绕“过生日”这一话题,通过问询和讨论在生日里所做的事情展开对话。
教学大纲对Story time的要求是通过对话、短文、故事等,帮助学生掌握基本的英语语言知识,发展基本的英语听、说、读、写技能,初步形成用英语与他人交流的能力,进一步促进思维能力的发展,同时提高学生的综合人文素质。所以本课的主要目标是培养学生灵活运用所学知识进行语言表达的能力。
二.说教学目标:
针对这些要求,我设定了本课时的教学目标是:
1. 学生能流利朗读并理解story time。
2. 学生能听懂、会读句型" When's your birthday? It's on the eleventh of May. It's on the eighth of April."
3. 学生能运用句型"What do you do on your birthday? I usually..."正确问答生日活动。
而本课有比较明显的中西文化区别,所以针对这一特征,设定情感和文化目标为:
1. 能理解中西方生日文化的`去别和融合。
2. 能懂得感恩父母。
三:说教学方法:
教法:
1. 问答式教学法:它能充分发挥师生两方面的积极性,用此法可启发学生思维,培养学生分析问题、解决问题的能力和口头表达能力,激发其学习的主动性、积极性。
2. 讨论式教学法:通过对教学主题的自由讨论,得出在生日经常做的事情。在讨论的过程中运用所学的语言。不仅能帮助学生正确运用语言,也能创建比较自由舒适的课堂环境。
3. 情境教学法:给学生创建比较真实的语言环境,在情境中学习课文的内容。
学法:
1. 听选法:要求学生在听的过程中完成信息的采集。帮助学生锻炼听取信息的能力。
2. 速读法:以快速阅读为基础,找出与给出主题相关的内容,帮助学生练习泛读能力。
3. 精读法:细读课文,找出细节内容。在这一部分,学生需要对课文进行分析,并找出正确的答案。锻炼学生对文本的分析运用能力。
四:说教学过程:
本课时是本单元的第一课时,主要教学过程如下:
课前活动:
一、热身活动
为了帮助学生进入学习状态,设计如下的课前活动。
1. 解释卡片和奖励机制。
2. Listen to the song
3. Say a chant
二、引入课题
1. 正是上课,首先出示本课的学习目标,让学生对本节课需要掌握得内容有比较清晰的了解。
2. 讨论月份,引入主题。
T: boys and girls. There are twelve months in a year. Which month do you like best?
S: I like…
T: I like October best. Because my birthday is in October. Do you want to know?
You can ask“ When’s your birthday? ”引入生日讨论。
连读,板书。
Put in order
先出示打乱的生日活动,观看听老师的生日活动,然后完成排序练习。
以上引入课题:birthdays
三、处理文本
为了帮助学生锻炼听、说、读的能力,设计了如下的处理文本的活动。
a. (放视频,完成连线)
b.听录音,说出所做的事情。(板书)
c. 速读课文,找出Mike做的事
d. 精读
Read the text carefully and try to find the answers.
1)Who do they spend their birthdays with?(他们和谁一起度过生日?)
2)What do they eat?
文化渗透:Chinese people usually spend their birthdays with their families, they often eat noodles. Western people usually spend their birthdays with their friends, they often eat birthday cakes.
3)T: They do different things on their birthdays.
Are they happy on their birthdays?
S: Yes.
How can you know?
找出句子: We have a great time. We have a lot of fun.
四、练读课文。
练读课文时比较枯燥的,所以设计了多样的练读方法。
1)跟读,注意语音语调,特别是重音。
2)三人多样练读,请两组示范。
3)齐读。
五、复述课文
复述课文是比较有效的检验学生是否掌握课文内容的方法,所以在本部分设计了逐层递进的复述方法。
1)看板书,复述。
2)去掉动词词组,复述。
六、你的生日
让学生正式运用本节课所学的知识,进行丰富的讨论活动。
T: We know Su Hai, Su Yang and Mike’s birthdays. Now, it’s your turn to share your birthdays.
1)提供表格,让学生先选一选。
2)根据选择,和同桌说一说。
3)请学生说一说。
文化渗透:随着时代的发展,中国的生日文化已经吸纳了很多西方元素,中西方生日文化的差异已经不是很明显了。
T: Now we also eat birthday cakes and have a birthday party with our friends. So with the development of the world, the differences between China and western countries are getting smaller and smaller.
七、情感教育
帮助学生学会感恩父母并且对本课的内容进行书写训练。
Your birthdays are wonderful. Your parents remember your birthday and prepare a lot of presents for you. But I have a question. Do you know your parents’ birthdays. Who knows? Hands up! Not all of us know the birthdays of our Parents. But our parents is the most important people in our life. Boys and girls, Let’s design some birthday activities for your parents’ birthdays. Write down your ideas.
八、评价和回家作业
针对上课是出示的学习目标,让学生对自己这节课的学习效果进行评价和反馈。知道自己的薄弱点在哪儿。针对这些评价内容,设计回家作业。
(必做)1. Listen to the tape and read after it three times.
2. Write down more ideas for your parents’ birthdays.
(选做)1. Try to retell the story.
2. Write down your parents’ birthday dates.
五:说板书
本课的板书采用了和课文相关的蛋糕和面条,并在上面贴上对用人物的活动词组,辅以头像帮助理解。非常的生动,让学生对本课的内容有比较直观的理解。
英语的课件 篇6
初中英语听说课课件
1.三步听力预测验证训练法
老师在听力训练前告诉学生听力材料的标题,要求学生分析标题来预测段落内容, 并在老师的帮助下运用经验来推论结果。接着, 通过听来验证学生的预测并对比检测结果; 强化学生的预测判断能力, 加强听力的目的性, 保证听力训练的效度。如听力材料: Pollution。
第一步, 老师首先板书听力材料的主题———Pollution。
第二步, 师生设问和讨论预测内容并推导结论:What’s Pollution? How many kinds? Where is it fromin your opinions? How to stop different kinds of pollution?
第三步, 听录音验证假设。
2.任务型听力训练法
该方法要求学生在听懂的基础上, 利用输入的语言信息去完成一项任务或多项任务。这些任务是老师围绕听力材料所提供的语言情景和语言信息预先设计的, 通过任务的完成和此后的评价来检验学生的理解程度。
( 1) 录音填表格。( 略)
( 2) 听后画图。初级听力训练阶段需要学生运用抽象思维能力, 更需要学生运用形象思维能力。听后画图的方法旨在培养学生的空间定位能力、想像力以及信息接受、处理、联想、加工及组合能力。
( 3) 听后写(通知、信、邀请函等) 。老师选用部分应用文体做听力材料, 既培养学生信息的转换能力, 又强化四会技能的相互渗透。听是写和说的基础, 说和写是听的提高。
( 4) 听后回答,重述, 转述。听后回答可采用四种问答方式: ①一般疑问句问答, 弄清人物的职业身份; ②围绕where、when、what 来设计问答,弄清事情经过及发生的时间地点; ③围绕how、why来设计问答, 弄清事情的前因后果及方式方法; ④围绕标题内容来设计, 目的是帮助学生理解言外之意, 促使学生能运用自己的综合语言能力进行创造性问答。重述要求学生将听到的材料一字不漏叙述出来, 训练学生的语音语调以及听力的精确性。转述要求学生能对听力材料进行粗加工, 训练学生抓大意的能力、语言运用的灵活性以及初步的英语思维能力。
( 5) 听后译。听后展开的活动形形色色, 其中包括听后口译和听后笔译, 它有利于学生准确地理解语言, 转换语言, 实现准确的交际运用。
3.分层听力训练
为加强学生听力目的性训练和听力记忆, 可以围绕一篇听力材料进行四层次训练, 即“听辨”、“听知”、“听记”、“听析”。第一层通过“听辨”环节来了解、辨明对话的人物及其相互关系。通过理顺人物关系, 可以预测和判断谈话的目的或意图,听力训练就会有的放矢。“听知”就是通过听来了解听力材料包含的基本内容, 把W- question(where/when/what) 作为了解内容的基本脉络。“听记”就是听者应记住谈话中涉及的数据。“听析”要求学生听出对话中包含的“话里有话”、“弦外之音”或“即兴幽默”等。
4.五步听力训练
( 1) 热身听:听出段落中出现的生词, 如老师讲解部分不能猜出词义的生词, 并抓住文化承载词进行背景介绍和文化渗透。
( 2) 搜索听:通过who, where, when, what 提问,吸收听力材料所包含的.字面信息, 即直接能从文字中获取的信息, 训练学生的集合思维和形象思维能力。
( 3) 思考听:通过why, how来设计提问, 抓对听力短文深层次的理解, 弄清事物的因果关系, 训练学生的分析能力和抽象的逻辑思维能力。
( 4) 协商听:通过听来抓主题句, 边听边讨论,抓文章大意, 理解短文的中心思想, 让学生为听力材料加主题或选主题, 训练学生对所听内容的归纳能力。
( 5) 评价听:通过老师设计的形成测试( 答问、判断、选择) , 或通过听后做、听后写、听后制作等活动来检验听力成果, 老师可通过给予学生以恰当评价来激发学生的成就动机。
5. 单句听力训练“三字诀”: “分” “变”“准”
“分”指注意力的合理分配, 具体来说就是注意力的听前分配和听中分配。“听前分配”指在单句听力前的时间间歇区的注意力的分配。“听中分配”指在听句子时, 听者分配一部分注意力进行联想或推理。
“变”指单句听力应该进行变速训练, 语速分别为80w/m、100w/m、120w/m、150w/m, 强化学生的应变能力, 可进行分句变速、分段变速、交替等方式来进行。
“准”要求学生迅速准确地掌握信息。单句听力训练一般要求只听一遍, 不能重复播放。若有必须重复的单句听力材料, 可以隔日再听。
6.游戏听力训练
游戏是训练学生听力的一种特殊形式。它能激发学生听的兴趣, 还能调动他们进行逻辑性的思维活动。为加强游戏听力训练的客观效果, 老师可以在课前录制好听力带:
Tom was holding a thin book when he said to Peter,“I will put this book on the floor of this room,andput nothing above it,I believe you can’t jump over it. ”“It’s an easy thing .”said Peter. But after Tom put thebook on the floor,Peter really couldn’t jump over it.Doyou know where Tom put the book? (In the corner ofthe room.)
7.听写法
听写法能训练学生的听力理解能力、瞬间记忆能力、速写能力, 以及训练学生听力的准确性。听写根据实际可分为两步听写和三步听写训练。对基础较好的学生可进行两步听写。而对条件较差的学生可进行三步听写教学: ①听句会意: 要求学生尽量听懂大意, 听后复述, 学生可以复述句子的片段,能复述多少不限; ②再听完整复述, 凭记忆写出句子; ③重听检验, 修正句子。
其实听力的培养并不难, 只要师生都树立信心,尽可能多地抓住实践机会, 坚持不懈地进行大量反复的练习, 定会不断地提高听力水平。
英语的课件 篇7
【活动目标】
1、感受对於节快乐的节日气氛,体验收到礼物的快乐情绪。
2、能听懂并能基本地说出新单词:Bell Candy Snow Gift。
3、继续锻炼吃与说的潜力。
【活动准备】
1、挂有采灯的圣诞树一棵。
2、魔术盒一个。
3、单词卡片:Bell Snow Gift Candy。
4、小篮子12个
5、实物:铃铛、糖果、礼物盒、雪花片各12份。
6、音乐:《Jingle bells》《Edelweiss》《We wish you a Merry Christmas》
【活动过程】
一、Warming up:
1、放音乐《Jingle bells》,教师带领幼儿舞蹈欢快地入场。
2、Greeting: “Good morning boys and girls! Nice to meet you! How are you today? Do you know what festival is ing?”
3、Introducing new:
小故事引出单词
Story: The Christmas is ing soon。 At this time the Santa clams will bring a big bag。 There are many bell Candy Gift in it。 At the Christmas eve, The Santa Claws will dashing through the snow and jump into the chimney。 He puts the gift on your bed。(教师有表情、动作地讲述故事,同时在讲到单词部分时出示单词卡片。)
T: “What’s in the bag?”(教师带领幼儿,看着图片说一遍单词。)
4、出示魔术盒
T: “Tonight is Christmas eve。 The Santa Claws is very busy。 So he gives oat the gifts to you by Miss Chen。”
T: “OK! Let me see what’s in the box。 Can you Guess?”(教师充满神秘感地让幼儿猜猜实魔术盒里都有什么,教师一个个出示实物揭晓答案。)
5、发礼物
教师揭晓答案后,看哪个幼儿表现得好就把礼物给他。等礼物后把它放到后面的篮子里。
6、Little Game:《Listen and speak》
让幼儿把身后的篮子放在腿上,仔细听老师说的是哪一个单词,幼儿就从篮子里拿出相应的实物。
7、De curate the Christmas tree
(1)装饰圣诞树时要求幼儿边装备边说单词。(教师示范一次)
(2)放音乐《Edelweiss》,师幼一齐装饰圣诞树,在装饰的过程中教师仔细听幼儿有没有说错,如果有要及时纠正。
二、Ending:
T: This is a magic Christmas tree。 We must say “Merry Christmas”, It will be very beautiful。”
(师幼一齐说“Merry Christmas”,树上的灯就亮起来。)
放音乐《We wish you a Merry Christmas》师幼围着树一齐愉快地结束活动。
jK251.com其他人还在看
英语的课件(汇编9篇)
感兴趣的话题“英语的课件”我们为您为您准备了一些资讯。教案课件也是老师工作中的一部分,因此我们老师需要认认真真去写。只有将教案课件写好,才能让学生快速地理解各知识点。期望此内容对你有所帮助!
英语的课件 篇1
Reading Around the world in eight hours
Good afternoon, everyone. Now I’ll say junior Oxford English 8B Unit 3 Reading Part A. Around the World in Eight Hours. I’ll prepare to say the lesson from three parts.
Part One: Analysis of the Teaching Material
This is an important lesson in this book. Such a topic is related to daily life, so it is helpful to raise learning interests of students and it will be also helpful to improve their society sense. It can help students to attain “four skills” request of listening, speaking, reading and writing. Therefore this lesson is in the important position of the teaching material.
Most students are interested in computer games. So this topic can greatly attract their interests. It can accelerate them to learn English and geography well. After learning this lesson, they will know English and geography are as important as computer .Without much knowledge ,you won’t be able to learn computer well.
To understand the aim of an educational CD-ROM and what the character can do
To infer meaning from keywords, context and existing knowledge.
To master the Passive voice.
To develop the Ss’ abilities of listening, speaking, reading and writing.
To train the students how to use their own words to express their ideas.
(四)Teaching key and Difficult point
To review the Present perfect tense.
To learn the Passive voice.
To tell more about the CD-ROM.
To retell how the game is played
To understand the whole passage and answer teacher’s questions
2. Difficult points:
The Passive voice.
To retell how the game is played
Multi-media computer, Tape recorder, Software: PowerPoint and so on. They will be needed in this lesson.
1. Communicative teaching method
As we all know: the main instructional aims of learning English in the Middle School is to cultivate students’ abilities of listening, speaking, reading, writing and their good sense of the English language. So in this lesson I’ll mainly use “Communicative” teaching method, “Audio-visual” teaching method and “Task-based” teaching method.
To use these methods are helpful to develop the students’ abilities.
Arouse students’ interest by telling them that they are going to read about a new educational CD-ROM. Explain that the game is set in different countries and involves a tour around the world
Tell students that the first paragraph of the reading passage explains the background to the game .Listen to the tape. Ask some questions to check understanding, eg.
What’s the name of the new educational CD-ROM?
What can it help you to do?
Who is the designer?
Tell students that the second paragraph of the reading passage introduces the main character of the game . Ask some questions to check understanding, eg.
Who is the main character of the game?
How old is he?
What does he like doing?
What was he doing when he fell asleep?
Tell students that the third and fourth paragraphs of the reading passage, on page41, explain how the game is played. Ask them to read the rest of the reading passage on page 41
Ask some questions to check understanding, eg.
How can you earn a point?
What will happen if you have earned a point?
What will happen if you have earned enough points?
How many levels does the game have?
How long does it take you to finish the game?
What do the questions test?
What will you see on the screen when you reach a new place?
What can you learn about when you reach London?
What will you see when you passa level?
What happened to the places you have visited?
Read the whole passage and then ask some students to retell how the game is played(in 5steps)
1 See a golden cloud with instructions on it
2 See clouds with information about different places; See clouds with questions on them
3 Get a point every time you answer a question correctly
4 A cloud will come down and carry you off to a new place
5 See a world map. The old place is marked in bright purple
If possible, ask students to discuss what they have learned from the passage.(with their own words)
Step7 Use the following keywords to try to retell the passage.
Paragraph1.
a new educational CD-ROM, Around the world in Eight Hours.
Come out, interesting, at the same time, be designed by, the all-time favorite CD-ROM
Paragraph2.
Main character, love traveling, lie on the grass, fall asleep
Paragraph3.
be written on, different colors with questions on them
Every time you answer a question, earn enough points, come down, Carry off
Play the role of, take …an hour to finish, travel around, Test your knowledge of, a lot of useful information, for example
Be the best , get it in sold out
1 Translating the following phrases:
1)同时 2) 过一关
3) 扮演…角色 4) 光盘的设计者
5) 一直广受欢迎的'游戏 6) 得到足够的分数
7) 睡着 8) 英语语法和词汇
13) 掉下来 14) 售完
2 Try to recite the text.
1) The Present perfect tense. A new educational CD-ROM has just come out.
When you have earned enough points,….……..Carry you off to a place you have never visited before. The places you have visited are marked…
2) The Passive voice.
It is designed by Nancy Jackson. These words were written on it.
The places you have visited are marked in bright purple.
Get it now before it is sold out英语说课稿(英文版)
Reading Around the world in eight hours
Good afternoon, everyone. Now I’ll say junior Oxford English 8B Unit 3 Reading Part A. Around the World in Eight Hours. I’ll prepare to say the lesson from three parts.
Part One: Analysis of the Teaching Material
This is an important lesson in this book. Such a topic is related to daily life, so it is helpful to raise learning interests of students and it will be also helpful to improve their society sense. It can help students to attain “four skills” request of listening, speaking, reading and writing. Therefore this lesson is in the important position of the teaching material.
Most students are interested in computer games. So this topic can greatly attract their interests. It can accelerate them to learn English and geography well. After learning this lesson, they will know English and geography are as important as computer .Without much knowledge ,you won’t be able to learn computer well.
To understand the aim of an educational CD-ROM and what the character can do
To infer meaning from keywords, context and existing knowledge.
To master the Passive voice.
To develop the Ss’ abilities of listening, speaking, reading and writing.
To train the students how to use their own words to express their ideas.
(四)Teaching key and Difficult point
To review the Present perfect tense.
To learn the Passive voice.
To tell more about the CD-ROM.
To retell how the game is played
To understand the whole passage and answer teacher’s questions
2. Difficult points:
The Passive voice.
To retell how the game is played
Multi-media computer, Tape recorder, Software: PowerPoint and so on. They will be needed in this lesson.
1. Communicative teaching method
As we all know: the main instructional aims of learning English in the Middle School is to cultivate students’ abilities of listening, speaking, reading, writing and their good sense of the English language. So in this lesson I’ll mainly use “Communicative” teaching method, “Audio-visual” teaching method and “Task-based” teaching method.
To use these methods are helpful to develop the students’ abilities.
Arouse students’ interest by telling them that they are going to read about a new educational CD-ROM. Explain that the game is set in different countries and involves a tour around the world
Tell students that the first paragraph of the reading passage explains the background to the game .Listen to the tape. Ask some questions to check understanding, eg.
What’s the name of the new educational CD-ROM?
What can it help you to do?
Who is the designer?
Tell students that the second paragraph of the reading passage introduces the main character of the game . Ask some questions to check understanding, eg.
Who is the main character of the game?
How old is he?
What does he like doing?
What was he doing when he fell asleep?
Tell students that the third and fourth paragraphs of the reading passage, on page41, explain how the game is played. Ask them to read the rest of the reading passage on page 41
Ask some questions to check understanding, eg.
How can you earn a point?
What will happen if you have earned a point?
What will happen if you have earned enough points?
How many levels does the game have?
How long does it take you to finish the game?
What do the questions test?
What will you see on the screen when you reach a new place?
What can you learn about when you reach London?
What will you see when you passa level?
What happened to the places you have visited?
Read the whole passage and then ask some students to retell how the game is played(in 5steps)
1 See a golden cloud with instructions on it
2 See clouds with information about different places; See clouds with questions on them
3 Get a point every time you answer a question correctly
4 A cloud will come down and carry you off to a new place
5 See a world map. The old place is marked in bright purple
If possible, ask students to discuss what they have learned from the passage.(with their own words)
Step7 Use the following keywords to try to retell the passage.
Paragraph1.
a new educational CD-ROM, Around the world in Eight Hours.
Come out, interesting, at the same time, be designed by, the all-time favorite CD-ROM
Paragraph2.
Main character, love traveling, lie on the grass, fall asleep
Paragraph3.
be written on, different colors with questions on them
Every time you answer a question, earn enough points, come down, Carry off
Play the role of, take …an hour to finish, travel around, Test your knowledge of, a lot of useful information, for example
Be the best , get it in sold out
1 Translating the following phrases:
1)同时 2) 过一关
3) 扮演…角色 4) 光盘的设计者
7) 睡着 8) 英语语法和词汇
13) 掉下来 14) 售完
2 Try to recite the text.
1) The Present perfect tense. A new educational CD-ROM has just come out.
When you have earned enough points,….……..Carry you off to a place you have never visited before. The places you have visited are marked…
2) The Passive voice.
It is designed by Nancy Jackson. These words were written on it.
The places you have visited are marked in bright purple.
Get it now before it is sold out
英语的课件 篇2
教学目标:
1.运用多种方法认12个生字,掌握生词;
2.通过默读课文,知道课文大意;
1.学会本课12个生字和由这些字组成的新词,并了解它们在本课中的意思。
1、能借助拼音在语言环境中正确读写“丑、堆、孤、单、洁、越、冷、影”8个生字,认识两点水(冫)。积……
教学目标:
1、会认12个生字和由这些字组成的新词,会写10个生字。
2、能正确、流利地朗读课文,会背诵课……
教学目标:
1、会认6个生字,会写9个字。
2、正确、流利、有感情地朗读课文,能区别“常常”和“往常”的`意思……
天蓝蓝,海蓝蓝,我家住在大海边。
海边有个月亮湾,湾里有条打鱼船。
船上有位老爷爷,他的故事说不完。
……
教学目标:
1.正确、流利、有感情地朗读课文。
2.学会本课10个生字,两条绿线内的6个字只识不写。理解由生字组……
1.能正确流利地朗读儿歌,读出儿歌的韵律美;
2.能根据形声字的构字特点分析、记忆字形,激发学生学习汉字的兴趣,……
英语的课件 篇3
教学内容:
Unit11 Clothes Lesson Three.
教学目标:
1、Vocabulary:umbrella, violin, watermelon, watch.
2、Find and color. Trace and match.
教学目标的检测途径 通过Find and color. Trace and match.来检查学生的掌握程度。
重点难点:
Listen and say the words .
Understand using the words.
突破教学难点的.方法 通过单词、图片的对比进行巩固,umbrella比较难读,利用实物呈现。
教具准备:
recorder, tape, pictures, slide show, computer.
教学过程:
一、Warm-up
1、Sing the song .“ Its a dress.”( Page 37 of Book 2 )
2、Greetings.
T: Hello. Good morning, boys and girls.
Ss: Hello. Good morning , Miss Liu.
T: Nice to meet you.
Ss: Nice to meet you,too.
3、Review the words and sentences.
T: Whats this?
Ss: Its a dress / shirt/ sweater.
T: What are these?
Ss: They are pants / shoes /socks.
二、新课呈现(Presentation)
1.T:Its rain ,open up your……?让学生说下雨了怎么办?打开什么?Look at the picture with the computer. Umbrella.Listen and say .打开雨伞让学生逐一说,小组说.
T:Look at the umbrella .Does it look like a star? A square? Ss:No ,it a circle. T: Yes,Look at the umbrella Its round, round, round. 板书,教说学习round.学生看教室内的物品说什么是round.
2.T:Look at the picture with the computer. Trace and match.Is it round?Listen and say . T:Look at the watch. Its round, round, round.
3.呈现watermelonT:Look at the picture with the computer. Trace and watermelon. Is it round? T:Look at the watermelon Its round, round, round.
4.T:Look the violin. Its not round.
5、Play a guessing game:Ask and answer. What is it?
三、巩固和延伸(Consolidation and extension)
1、Trace and match. ( Page39) Find and color. (Page 41 of Book2)
2、Check up on the answers.
3、Say the rhyme.
4、Summary.
四、作业布置
1.Read the words.
2,listen to the text.
板书设计:
Look at the watch.
Its round, round, round. umbrella, violin, watermelon, watch.
英语的课件 篇4
本单元围绕the Silver Screen(影视) 这一主题开展听、说、读、写多种教学活动。影视作为人类文明的一大体现,作为当今社会人们主要休闲、娱乐方式之一,是一个非常贴近生活、具有时代性、可挖掘性的教学主题。
本单元所选的语言素材涉及中外名片、著名演员、著名导演, 具有典型的时代气息,有利于学生了解外国文化,增强世界意识。正如新课程标准中的教学建议所提:学习中文影视文化有利于“拓展学生的文化视野,发展他们跨文化交际的意识和能力”;在利用现代教育技术观看影视片断、影视海报的教学过程中,“拓宽了学生学习和运用英语的渠道”;同时本单元的教学对教师本身的中外文化修养、广阔的知识面等方面有非常高的要求。
(1).对国外著名影星、导演及他们作品的了解。如教材中涉及的Meryl Streep,Keanu Reeves,Steve Spielberg等,以扩大学生知识面、文化视野。如何填补学生这方面知识缺乏的信息沟。
(2).对国内著名影视导演及他们代表作品的了解。如何设计任务让学生从课内知识到课外知识的链接。
(3).对影视界名人及电影的评价(comments)如何写影评(review)。
1. 学习、掌握关系副词when,where.,why 引导的定语从句及介词+关系代词引导的定语从句。
2. 学习掌握一些有关影视的词汇:
如: career, director, script, play a role in ,Oscar, award, studio, scene, follow-ups等。
掌握其他一些课文中涉及的词汇:
如:graduate, attack, creature, owe…to…, take off等。
3. 学习掌握一些用于讨论、评价电影的结构句式:
如:What’s the film about?
What do you think about the story of the film?
How do you feel about the film?
I like / don’t like the film because…
The film is about… I think the ending of the film is …
4. 提高学生语言听、说、读、写的能力及扮演角色、编写剧本、撰写影评等的综合语言运用能力?
1. 学习几位著名影星、导演执著于艺术、献身于艺术的敬业精神和对人类艺术的巨大贡献。
2. 从Keanu Reeves 艰辛的成功途中(In the begin did many small jobs, then played in many cheap films.)我们可以学习到:要成就事业需付出辛勤劳动,要有持之以恒、坚持不懈的恒心与毅力。
3. 通过学习国外著名影视界人物,培养学生了解、尊重异国文化,体现国际合作精神。
4. 通过开展小组活动,指导学生积极与人合作,相互学习,相互帮助,培养其团队精神。
能总结定语从句的结构规律,并加以应用;在学习中借助电影海报图画、图表等非语言信息进行理解或表达。
利用影视资源,主动拓宽英语学习渠道,创造和把握学习英语的机会;积极参与采访、表演、调查等英语学习活动。
充分利用采访、表演等真实交际活动提高用英语交际的能力,在其过程中能借助手势、表情等非语言手段提高交际效果,能克服语言障碍,维持交际。
通过了解影视知识,获得更广泛的英语信息,拓展所学知识。
1. 了解英语国家影视界艺术家的成长经历、成就和贡献。
2. 通过学习,了解世界著名影视文化,培养世界意识。
3. 通过中外影视文化对比,加深对中国影视文化的理解。
这部分的重点是引出本单元的话题---电影,了解学生对电影的熟悉程度并充分发挥学生的想象力。同时训练学生说的能力。
活动步骤:
1.师生互动:教师提一些问题如Do you like seeing films? How often? Favorite actor? Actress? Film? 在此过程中教师可展示一些学生熟悉并喜欢的名演员、名片的海报,从视觉上激发学生对本话题的兴趣。
2.小组活动:教师选取几副不同题材的电影画面(可选取教材外的其它画面),要求学生进行小组合作,每小组选一幅画面进行讨论What is happening in this scene? What happens before/after the scene? 要求学生不拘泥于已知的电影内容,发挥自己的想象力,给出各种不同的观点。
3.班级活动:向班级其它同学描述本小组所选图片,其他同学可给出不同意见。
本单元的听力是培养学生捕捉特定信息的能力,并让学生熟悉interview这种形式。Task: To discuss what questions the reporters will ask when interviewing famous directors.
活动形式:
1. 师生互动:教师设置开放性的问题,进一步启发学生思考,并为过渡到听力部分做准备。问题可设置为:Of course these films now are very popular and successful, and what does the success of the films bring to the actors? 学生各抒己见,金钱、荣誉、名气,成为公众人物后带来一个问题They received a lot of interviews。
2. 小组活动:教师引出问题What questions will you ask when interviewing an actor?通过小组讨论,收集尽可能多的问题,一方面让学生预测听力中可能会出现的问题,同时也对interview这种形式有所了解。
本单元说的任务是利用阅读所得信息开展对名演员的interview,从而提
演员的职业有所了解并增加学习趣味。
Task: To interview famous actors and directors in different ways.
活动形式:
1、 师生互动:教师可设置问题了解学生对电影大奖及获奖演员的了解程度,为接下来的两位演员的介绍作好铺垫。问题可为Can you tell me some famous awards to the films in the world? Try to tell the famous actors, actresses and the films you know that have won the Oscar.
1. 班级活动:教师可为学生播放分别由Meryl streep和Keanu Reeves主演的电影Out of Africa《走出非洲》和 speed《生死时速》片段,并可展现他们主演的其它电影的海报,让学生在视觉上对这两位演员及他们的表演有所了解。
2. 个人活动,但先把学生分成两组,分组阅读,然后完成下面表格中的信息。
3. 小组活动:选两位学生,一位当主持人,一位当Meryl streep/Keanu Reeves,其他同学充当观众,模仿央视“艺术人生”的形式作一访谈,要求主持人留一些时间给观众提问。
1) Why are they so popular and successful?
2) What is needed to be an actor/actress?
3) Would you like to be an actor/actress one day? Why(not)?
6. 小组活动:教师播放电影“home alone”《小鬼当家》片段,将原声消去,让学生分组给出对白及表演,最后可让学生互评哪一组做得最好。
(四) Word Study(提前):
本单元词汇学习的目的主要是让学生掌握一些与电影有关的词语如studio、follow-ups、award、script等,对学生而言,有些生疏,因此教师可给出一些视觉上的帮助。
在教学过程中,先利用图片,实物等教具对学生进行直观的教学,使之有更清晰的认识后,再辅之以语境,利用语境来推测词义,达到猜词的效果。如给出The Matrix和The Matrix Reloaded的电影海报,学生很容易得出:The Matrix Reloaded is the follow-up of The Matrix。通过这样的铺垫,学生在做第七小题时,只要利用好文中的线索Speed II, Jurassic Park III就可以轻而易举的得出follow-ups。
作而突出导演的重要作用。Task: To experience being a director (write one scene of the film and act it out).
1.师生互动:教师提问If you want to make a film, who do you
need to invite?通过此问题引出电影制作过程中所需的各种角色,如photographer, actor/actress, editor, director等等
2.小组活动:
1)教师可设置这样的讨论题:What part would you like to play in making a film?根据选择分组,让他们讨论选择各角色的理由。同时讨论各角色在电影制作中所做的不同工作。通过讨论,学生不难发现,在电影的制作过程中,导演起了非常关键的作用。
2)根据所选的各种角色交叉分组,发挥各自的作用。
Think of one scene you are quite familiar with and act it out.
a. What would the scene be like and what happens in it?
b. Who are the main actors in that scene and what do they do?
c. Write a short dialogue and act it out
本篇阅读材料是人物传记,介绍了著名导演Steven Spielberg 的成长经历以及他的主要成就和作品。通过文章的学习,旨在了解西方的电影文化背景以及学习名导Steven Spielberg的那种对自己的事业坚持不懈、孜孜以求的精神。
分别给出阅读材料中提到的五幅电影(Jaws, E.T., Jurassic Park, Schindler’s List, Saving Private Ryan)的图片,把学生分成不同的小组,对图片进行预测,各个小组根据不同的图片猜想影片的大概内容及主题。
快速阅读课文的Para3-5 , 查找出有关这5部电影内容和主题的信
阅读并查找有关Spielberg的信息:
1) When and where was he born?
2) When did he start making films?
3) What did he use to make films at first? and later?
4) What was his dream?
5) What did he study?
6) When and with what did his career take off?
7) What does Spielberg owe his success to?
该部分可分成两块,其中第二块内容可以提前到阅读中去完成,也可在读后总结,当学生读完影片内容时,可以根据自己的理解写出五部影片的内容是什么(写尝试应用定语从句,体验定语从句的结构)。第一块(Questions)中第1,3,5三个问题比较难,从文中直接找不到答案,也是学生理解上需要升华的部分。可以通过分组,让学生讨论来理解这几个问题。让学生领会以下几点:1)、英语作为工具的重要性 2)、不懈努力、持之以恒 3)、成功需要家人的支持,合作、互助精神。
这部分的重点是学习掌握关系副词when,where,why 引导的定语从句及介词+关系代词引导的定语从句。Task: To talk about some famous directors in China and some of their most famous and popular films, using attributive clause.
活动步骤:
1. 师生互动:教师提一些问题如What Chinese directors do you know?
What are their well-known films? 在此过程中教师可展示一些学生熟悉的国内知名导演的海报,从视觉上激发学生的兴趣。然后谈论某个导演及他的代表作品,引出定语从句。
如Zhang Yimou is the famous director who successfully directed the film Hero.
2.小组活动:教师选取几副大家熟悉的国产大片的电影画面,要求学生进行小组讨论,分别来自什么电影,他们的男、女主角(main actor/actress)分别是谁。然后用定语从句知识来谈论。如:Shaolin Soccer is a funny film in which Zhou Xingchi plays the main role.
3.班级活动:给出几副图片及几个关键词(key words),用所学定语从句来描述图片。如:
北京申奥成功图 Beijing the city Beijing is the city where/in which the 2008 Olympic Games will be held.
4.大组活动:全班以座位为单位分4大组,开展竞赛。1)小组讨论,两人一组,一学生创设一个情景并给出2-3个关键词,另一名同学用定语从句进行描述。2)班级活动;结果汇报,教师记录,看哪个大组能正确描述的情景最多。教师给出评价。
该部分主要阅读张艺谋的影片Not One Less并学习如何评价电影及写影评。Task: Make comments on films and write reviews about them.
1. 师生互动:教师可设置问题了解学生对张艺谋及其主要作品的熟悉情况,为接下来阅读Not One Less 作铺垫。问题可为 What does he do? What is famous for? What films has he directed? What is his recent film? What else do you know about him? 同时呈现张的有关信息表格,为后面的Survey 作铺垫。通过提问谈论《一个也不能少》有关情节,为阅读作铺垫。
2. 个人活动:阅读Not One Less ;回答问题,填写信息表。
3. 班级活动:学习写review 的有关建议。并以Not One Less 作为例子写影评一篇。
4.个人活动:Survey--Your favorite director and his film in china
5.小组活动:讨论关于Your favorite film What’s it about? What kind of story do you think it is? How do you think of the actors/ actresses?...
6.个人活动:模仿前面所学,写一篇影评 My Favorite Film
7.两人活动:交换作文,从影评内容、时态、单词拼写、所用词汇等方面相互交流、修改。
英语的课件 篇5
1、能够听、说、认读Let’s read部分的短文,完成相应的活动。
2、能够运用所学语言较好完成“招聘会”的活动。
1、本课重点是操练巩固本单元11个职业名称的单词和重点句型:What does he/she do? Where does he/she work? How does he/she work?
2、本课难点是帮助学生理解短文中的新语言,如:help the bank use their money well. likes helping people. help tourists find their way.以及三个小建议。
预设问题:
How many people are there in your family? Who are they?
What does your father / mother do ?
Where does your father / mother work?
How does your father / mother go to work?
How does your father / mother go to work?
(设计意图:课前chant热身,让学生迅速进入学习状态并复习旧知。通过日常会话,复习巩固本单元主要职业名词及句型,达到温故而知新的目的。)
I.T:Now, I will introduce some my friends to you. What do they do ? Can you guess?
T:OK!Let’s meet my first friend. (投影出示卡片:She works in the school. She teaches English in the school. She loves her children very much. What does she do? She is a ___________)
师生一起读卡片上的内容后,让学生猜所描述人物的职业,然后揭示答案。
II.用同样的方法阅读第二个片断.(投影出示卡片:He works in a car company. He likes math and drawing very much. He can design(设计) many cool cars. What does he do? He is an ______________.)
师生齐读内容,出示单词卡,教读design。之后师问:What does he do ? can you guess?
S3: Maybe he is an engineer.T: Yes, he is an engineer. You are very clever!(揭示答案)
III.Now, let’s go on , meet my friends. I have many friends. (投影出示卡片:They like beautiful cities. They like traveling(旅游) very much. Who are they? They are ______________)
Can you read the passage? Have a try, please!
(学生试读小短文,教师和学生一起读后,教师说出答案并出示tourists单词卡,并领读。)
IV.投影出示一张城市交通图,在图上标出两个旅行者。
学习本课难点句子:Help the tourists find their way.并引导学生用英语描述路线。
V.出示周杰伦照片,讨论交流信息:
(出示提示句子) Look! I think Zhou Jielun is a singer. He goes to work by car. He likes singing very much. What do you think of Zhou Jielun?(学生看提示语和同位讨论)
(投影卡片内容:
投影出示句子。Zhou Jielun is a singer. He goes to work by car. He likes singing very much.
VI.出示另一张照片(教师自己的照片)用同样的方法让学生讨论交流信息。
VII.出示一名银行会计的工作照片。
用同样的方法讨论交流并学说句子:helps the bank use their money well.
投影出示提示:
学生两人一组讨论交流。教师巡视指导,纠正句子中的用词、发音等。
VIII.投影出示刚才的三段短文。Can you read the passages by yourselves?学生看投影自由阅读。
T:Can you answer these questions? Ask and answer in your groups.
投影出示问题:
1. What does Zhou Jielun do?
2. What does Xiao Hong do ?
3. Who works in a school?
4. Who likes singing?
5. How does Miss Liang go to work?
6. Who help the bank use their money well?
教师提问投影上的问题,学生抢答。
(设计思路:通过先阅读部分与课文相似的片段,引出文中的难点句子,进行教读、理解。排除阅读障碍,降低阅读难度。并且用反复出现的方式操练重点句型。)
学生打开课本,自由阅读课文。教师巡视指导。
参考问题:
A. How many friends do we have?
B. Who are they?
A. Wang Li is an engineer.
B. She likes reading English very much.
C. She designs many cars and buses.
D. She goes to work on foot.
A、 Li Xiaobin is a policewoman.
B、 He works is a hospital.
C、 He helps the bank use their money well.
D、 He goes to work by bus.
第三段:can you answer my questions?
A、What does Yuan Yuan do?
B、What does Yuan Yuan like?
C、How does Yuan Yuan go to work?
(设计思路:通过简单判断,给与学生阅读的自信。就短文的内容提出yes-no等的简单问题,让学生带着问题阅读并通过快速阅读理解语篇的大意)
Let’s read all the passages together, OK?(齐读全部课文一遍)
Now questions for you? can you answer the questions on your English books?
Ask and answer in your groups, then write the answers on your English books.
学生读短文完成文后问题,教师巡视指导。
教师借一个同学的课本,投影展示答案。
(4)听录音,跟读课文。
(5)自由朗读课文,品味语感。
(设计思路:通过阅读解决语篇内的主要内容,让学生回答有一定思维深度的问题检测学生理解程度。培养学生获取信息、处理信息的能力。然后通过做课本上的问答题落实到写上。)
T: Look! there are three tips here.(课前将文中的三条建议贴在黑板上)
老师读完三条建议后说:I want to be a singer, because I like singing very much. What about you?
S1: I want to be a teacher, because I like children.
T: Thank you. What else?
S2: I want to be an accountant. Because I like math very much.
T: Thank you. What else?
S3: I want to be a teacher, because I like students.
T: Thank you. What else? What about you?
S4: I want to be an English teacher. Because I like English very much.
(设计思路:将书上学到的知识运用于真实的生活场景之中,并得以拓展。体现了用英语的思想。)
(1)T: Now you are the managers in the many companies, and you need somebody work for your company.请你根据你们公司的工作性质,到人才市场去聘用一些人员为你的公司服务。(课前在学生的桌子上分好小纸条,上面写着虚拟身份的相关信息,每组为一个公司。)
(2)教师示范在求职介绍中找到自己需要的人才,并用英语表述理由。
Zhang Yong is a happy man. He likes helping the sick(病人)people.He likes white.
He wants to be a doctor. So I choose Zhang Yong. Because he wants to be a doctor, and Yongxin hospital needs a doctor.
I work in Yongxin hospital. I choose Zhang Yong. Because Yongxin hospital needs a doctor. And Zhang Yong wants to be a doctor.
Can you tell me? What about you?
Now you can stand up and look for the personnel for your company. OK?
(3)学生以小组为单位在教室内寻找、阅读求职信息,在小组内讨论并寻找自己所在公司需要的人才。试着用英语表述聘用原因。教师巡视指导。
(4小组推举一名代表介绍自己聘任的人员并说明理由。在班内介绍。
(设计思路:设置扩展活动,让学生在真实自然的任务型活动中扩展运用阅读信息。)
(5)T: Boys and girls, toady, it’s very difficult to find a nice job. So we must work hard, and make a new day. OK?
(设计思路:通过创设一次招聘会的场景,让学生在相对真实的语境中运用所学英语。同时也培养了学生用英语思辨的能力,真正做到“用中学,学中用”。)
英语的课件 篇6
目标:能够正确说出自己的性别。
乐意积极参与英语活动。
准备:男孩、女孩的胸饰
请大班幼儿表演(2名),枪、洋娃娃
进程:
1、师生问好
2、请大班幼儿表演
男孩(师给他穿裙子):No,NO, I’m a boy
女孩(师给枪他玩):No,NO, I’m a girl
请小朋友说出男孩与女孩的区别,教师在黑板上画下来
oys have short hair, wear trousers , like gun
Girls usualy have long hair , wear skirt ,like doll
3、集体练习
T: Is he a girl?
S: No (回答原因)
T: Is she a boy ?
S:NO(回答原因)
练习发音:Boy Girl
4、游戏巩固练习
①谁的反应快?Boys stand up! Girls stand up!
②找自己的图标
教师请幼儿上来找自己的图标,并大声说I’m a boy/girl
5、结束
Boys and girls stand in a line 下楼做游戏
名称《Clap Clap Clap your hands》
目的:
1、初步学念儿歌,理解nod/raise/strectsh 的含义
2、积极参与英语活动,保持愉快情绪。
准备:机器人头饰
进程:
1、游戏Follow me 感知Slowly quickly
2、出示卡片,复习head arms legs
并引导幼儿区别单复数
3、机器人情境表演
机器人伴随音乐出场与幼儿打招呼
①教师介绍机器人可以用声音来控制。发出口令:nod your head / strectsh your arms / raise your legs 引起幼儿学习欲望。
②请幼儿一起来控制机器人,发出口令。
③机器人突然不能动了,请个别幼儿上前给他加油,然后发出口令,
④幼儿间相互控制,一名幼儿扮演机器人,另一名幼儿扮演发出口令者。
4、音乐游戏
《Shake my hands》
反思:
幼儿在学习英语的过程中是以兴趣为主体,游戏为载体的。所以在整个教学活动中我遵守三个“动态”教学的原则,即趣味性原则、活动性原则、变化性原则。幼儿是活泼好动、爱唱、爱跳的,他们学习的动力来源于有趣的教学内容和富有吸引力的活动形式,英语口语课的“动态”教学,目的就是要让幼儿在无任何心理压力的状态下轻松愉快地学习,并且乐在其中。
第一环节:我充分利用中班幼儿的年龄特点:喜爱模仿。在这一引导部分注入了无意识注意,使幼儿在游戏中能听熟所要学习的短句。
第二环节:出示图片让幼儿巩固以前所认识的老朋友,但我并没有单纯的出示,而是用沙包投掷的方式使孩子们注意力更集中,更觉得有趣。在动静的交替变换中,有意识记忆得高了提高。这是变化性原则的体现。
第三环节:重点环节。在和孩子们的相处中,我发现孩子们对机器人特别感兴趣,所以就设计了这个游戏活动对幼儿所要学习的短句进行教学。在教学过程中,我不停地制造一些小麻烦,比如:突然头不能动了!这就势必将本来已经念疲惫的的幼儿的兴致又提起来了,使幼儿能够体验到一浪更比一浪高的头脑风暴。
第四环节:结束环节。我带领幼儿唱唱、跳跳,这个英文歌曲是先动后静的,我利用幼儿“爱动”的天性,在不知不觉中将幼儿的活动量及心脏跳动的次数慢慢的降低,但又不失趣味,使他们始终处在一种游戏的状态。这是趣味性原则的体现。
英语的课件 篇7
Lesson Plan Presentation
Reading Part in NSEFC Module 1 Unit1 Friendship——Anne’s Best Friend
Hello, everyone. I’m …. I’m very glad to be here to present my lesson plan. The lesson I’m going to talk about is the reading in NSEFC module 1 Unit1 Friendship. The title of the reading material is Anne’s Best Friend. I will present how to teach it and the reasons for doing so in the following aspects: the analyses of teaching material and learning condition, teaching objectives,the important and difficult points, teaching method, teaching procedures and blackboard notes.
First of all, I’d like to analyze the teaching material. The text is about the story of a Jewish girl who treated her diary as her best friend when she was hiding away from the Nazi during the Second World War. It mainly consists of two parts; the first part is the introduction of Anne and her diary named Kitty. The second part is a diary entry written by Anne in the form of letter addressed to Kitty. The text is a bit long and there are a lot of new words and expressions in it, especially in the letter.
Now, let’s move on to the analysis of learning conditions. The students are in grade1 in the senior school, they have achieved certain English level so they have no problem in comprehending the text and get the basic idea. They have learned the Second World War so their previous knowledge about it can lessen their difficulty of comprehension. But most of them maybe are not very familiar with the sufferings of the Jewish people during the war. I will introduce the related information rightly in the beginning of the lesson so as to prepare the students for the deep study of the text.
Based on the analyses of the teaching material and the learning condition, I’d like to propose the teaching objectives and the important and difficult points.
(1) language skill
Ss will improve their reading skills by training some of the reading skills, such as skimming, scanning. It is the important point of this lesson.
Ss will improve their writing skills by writing a letter to their friend. It is the difficult point of this lesson.
(2) language knowledge
Ss will master most of the new words and expressions in the text. This is the important point of this lesson.
Ss will know the direct speech and indirect speech.
(3) Affective objectives
Ss will have a deeper understanding of the friendship so they will cherish their friends more than ever before. Ss will realize the cruelty of the war and the importance of the peace.
(4) Culture awareness
Ss will know more about the Second World War, especially the persecution Jewish people suffered from the Nazi.
(5) Learning strategy
Ss will cultivate their ability of individual learning and cooperative learning.
As for the teaching methods, I mainly adopt audio-visual teaching method in the lead-in. During the reading process, I follow the top down modal to help the Ss to learn the text.
Now, here comes the most important part of my presentation—teaching procedures. I’ll finish the lesson in 4 steps within 45 minutes. They are:
Step1: Lead-in.
Step2:Pre-reading
Step3: While reading.
Step 4: Post-reading.
At the end of the lesson, I will present the homework.
Now, let me introduce them step by step in details.
The first step is lead-in. It will cost 7minutes. At the beginning of the lesson, I will play a short video clip which is about the sufferings of the Jewish people during the Second World War. From it, Ss will know that many Jewish people were caught and killed by Nazi in the camps, so others had to hide away. Then I will ask Ss what they needed most when in hiding. Ss may come up with the food, clothes and so on. I will give them some hint and they will realize that friends are also very important for them. Then it will be very natural for me to tell them than there was a girl called Anne who had a very good friend during the hard time. In this process, I will introduce them three new words, they are: German, Netherlands, go through. In this step, I adopt audio-visual teaching method, because the pictures and sounds serves better to activate the Ss. So I use the video to attract the Ss’ attention. What’s more, the introduction of Jewish people’s suffering by this video clip provides them with the background information of this text.
Then I will move on to the second step---pre-reading. It will only cost 3 minutes. The Ss are required to guess who Anne’s best friend is and what happened to them by looking at the title and the pictures. Then I will ask several Ss to say their predictions but I will not tell them the answer directly in this step. Although not all the Ss can get the right answer, their mind can get closer to the theme of the text by predicting. So, later, when they read the passage they will concentrate more on it to check their predictions.
After pre-reading, we will move on to the while-reading step which costs 22 minutes in total. There are 5 activities, the first three of which deals with the first two paragraphs of the text which is also the first part of the text. And the last two activities deal with the second part.
The first activity is skimming. Ss are expected to skim the first part of text to work out the main idea. But as there is no topic sentence in this part, it is a bit difficult for students to tell the main idea with their own words. So I will present a multiple choice which covers the main idea of the text for them to choose from. This reduces the difficulty of the task as well as the Ss’ anxiety.
After getting the main idea, we will do another activity, namely, scanning. Ss are expected to scan the text to find some specific information, such as the place and the time of the story, etc. Ss can develop the ability of information gathering and independent learning.
After skimming and scanning, we will do the third activity of this step---close reading. I will help Ss learn the passage paragraph by paragraph. For the first paragraph, I will ask some questions like “According to Anne, what kind of person should a true friend be?” The answer to these questions cannot be taken directly from the text. Ss need to reorganize the sentences. If they can answer these questions, it means they have understood this paragraph. Then we will learn the second paragraph. For this one, I will ask one question “What did Anne say about her diary?” Ss may answer it by the original words said by Anne, I will catch this opportunity to tell them they change the direct speech into the indirect speech. But I will not go deeper, because they will learn this language point next period, so a simple introduction is ok.
This is all for the first part of the text. Then we will start to learn the letter. There are two activities for this part. The first one is skimming,they should skim the letter for the main idea first and I will present a multiple choice for them to choose from. Them we will learn the letter in detail in the next activity. For the first paragraph of the letter, I will ask them to find out the changing of Anne’s attitudes toward nature. Ss can find out that before hiding away, she paid no attention to the nature while she grew crazy about it when hiding. Then I will ask them to find out the reason. As for the second paragraph, Anne narrates two experiences of longing to get close to nature. So firstly, I will ask them to pick out the time of the experience and then we will study her feelings in the process. Of cause, we will learn some new word here, such as on purpose, at dusk and so on.
After the while-reading, comes the post-reading step. It will cost 12 minutes. In this step, I will firstly ask Ss if they have to go into hiding like Anne and her family, what they would like to say to their friends. Ss will talk in groups of four and share their ideas with each other. During the discussion, the Ss will be stimulated and also know the importance of friendship. It servers to make the Ss be prepared for the next activity---writing. After the discussion, the Ss shall write a letter to their friends individually. As they have talked about what they want to say to their friends, the difficulty of the writing is lowered because they have something to say. Ss are expected to write just a draft, for the time is limited.
Lastly, I will give Ss the homework. It will only cost one minute. Ss should not only review the new words and expressions of the text, but also polish their letter after class.
That’s all for the teaching procedure. And here is my blackboard note. On the right side, there are the words and expressions. In the middle, there are some points of the comprehension of the text.
That all for my lesson plan presentation thanks for your attention.
Blackboard notes:
Unit 1. Anne’s Best Friend
幻灯片投影布 Before: paid no attention to it
reasons
While: go crazy about it
German
Netherland
Go through
Set down
A series of
英语的课件 篇8
教学目标
1、能力目标:学生能够对身高进行问答;学生能够掌握四会单词和句子;学生能够用比较级对一些事物或人进行比较。
2、知识目标:
(1)能够掌握本课时的四会单词:younger, older, taller, shorter, longer。 (2)能够掌握本课时重点句型:How tall are you ? I am ......metres. I am taller. You are shorter aller than me. You’re youngerolder than me.
3、情感目标:培养学生积极学习英语的兴趣,能积极参与课堂。
教学重难点
1、重点:学习单词:younger, older, taller, shorter, longer;掌握句子:How tall are you ? I’m 1.61 metres.I’m taller. You’re older than me,too.
2、难点:正确使用句子“......is.....than.....”进行各种比较。
教学过程
一、Preparation
1、Greeting:Nice to meet you again. How are you today?
2、Let’s chant
Tall, tall, tall, who is tall?
Tall, tall, tall, I am tall.
Short, short, short, who is short?
Short, short, short, I am short.
Big, big, big, whose(谁的) eyes are big?
Big, big, big, her eyes are big.
Small, small, small, whose eyes are small?
Small, small, small, his eyes are small.
Do some actions,review the words:tall、strong、short 等。
二、Presentation
1、教师请几位高矮胖瘦不同的学生到台前来,让学生分辨Who is tall /strong/old/young/short?,然后让学生回答。
教师指着比较高的A和比较矮的B问: Who is tall ? S :A. T: A is taller than B , 用动作来示意学生,帮助学生理解。然后出示taller的单词卡片,示范读taller.
2、教学单词taller,边说边做动作,学生跟做。开火车合拼单词,小组比赛快速熟练的拼读。帮助学生用tall+er来记忆。
3、教师用同样的方法教学其他四个四会单词stronger 、older、 younger、 shorter。
4、将五张单词卡放在一起请学生认读。男女比赛谁读错或不会读。
5、观察五个单词,有什么相同之处?然后简单解释,当两个人相比较时,使用比较级,比较级就是在形容词词尾加er.
6、教师领读几遍后,请学生根据实际情况说句子,比如“I’m taller than ….I’m short than ….”等。教师要及时鼓励表述好的学生。
7、教师把一高一矮的学生叫他们站起来,然后说You’re taller than your classmate! 引导学生做出相应的回答:Yes! 教师问,How tall are you ?学生答I’m 160cm
8、教师和另一个学生对话作示范,How tall are you ?I’m 150cm tall. I’m taller than you. I’m 4cm taller than you ..学生分组开火车练习,最快的为优胜组。
三、Practice
1、拼读比赛:教师让学生5—6人一组,告诉他们要进行拼读单词的竞赛。教师将单词中的字母组合删除,让每组学生代表填写。
2.教师带领学生继续进行比赛,打乱组成单词的字母顺序,让学生们在小组中重新排列,组成单词。
四、Production
1.每名学生尝试用句型“I’m ---- than ----“来描述自己。至少三句话。
2.小组内学生互相交流。
3.Let’s chant。
五、Progress
1.Let's play 学生小组玩游戏。
2.选择几个小组展示。
Homework
1.抄写本节课所学的五个四个单词。
2. 询问他人年龄、身高、体重。
(运用句型How old/tall/heavy are you? )
板书设计
Unit 1 How tall are you
A Let's learn
I'm taller than you.
tall-taller short –shorter
young-younger old-older
strong-stronger
英语的课件 篇9
English Pronunciation Courseware: A Comprehensive Guide to Mastering Pronunciation
Introduction:
Pronunciation is a vital aspect of language learning, and it is an essential component of effective communication. Clear and accurate pronunciation helps to convey messages clearly and effectively, and it fosters better understanding between the speaker and the listener. In this English pronunciation courseware, we will explore ways to improve your pronunciation skills and achieve greater confidence in speaking English.
Section 1: Understanding English Pronunciation
English pronunciation can be challenging for non-native speakers due to the complexity of the language. In this section, we will explore the basics of English pronunciation, including:
- English vowel and consonant sounds
- English intonation patterns and stress
- English rhythm and timing
- Common pronunciation errors made by non-native speakers
Section 2: Tools and Techniques for Improving Pronunciation
In this section, we will explore various tools and techniques that can be used to improve English pronunciation, such as:
- Tongue twisters and other pronunciation exercises
- Speech therapy apps and software
- Recordings of native speakers
- Dictation exercises and quizzes
- Pronunciation drills and practice sessions
Section 3: Common Pronunciation Problems and Solutions
In this section, we will identify common pronunciation problems that non-native speakers face when learning English, such as:
- Incorrect vowel and consonant sounds
- Misplacement of stress and intonation
- Rhythm and timing issues
- Overuse of a non-native accent
- Difficulty with certain sounds or words
We will also explore solutions to these problems, such as:
- Practicing specific sounds in isolation
- Focusing on natural stress and intonation patterns
- Listening to and imitating native speakers
- Developing an awareness of common pronunciation errors
- Breaking down complex words into syllables for easier pronunciation
Conclusion:
The English Pronunciation Courseware is designed to be a comprehensive and engaging guide to mastering English pronunciation. By understanding the basics of English pronunciation and developing an awareness of common problems and solutions, non-native speakers can improve their pronunciation skills and achieve greater success in communicating in English. With practice and perseverance, anyone can learn to speak English clearly and effectively.
英语站课件
教案课件是我们老师的部分工作,因此每天老师都会按质按时去写好教案课件。完整的教案是教学活动的重要组成部分,写教案课件要具备哪些步骤?以下是本文的首篇介绍“英语站课件”,请务必将此页添加到您的收藏夹中以备不时之需!
英语站课件(篇1)
[教学目标]
1、在具体的情境中,进一步认识分数,发展学生的数感,体会数学与生活的密切联系。
2、.通过对分数的意义的理解,结合具体的情境,体会整体与部分的关系。培养学生观察、抽象、概括、类推的能力。
[教学重、难点]
理解并掌握分数的意义。
单位“1”概念的扩展。
[教学过程]
一、拿铅笔。
1、现场组织活动:请两位同学到台前来,每人分别从一盒铅笔中拿出 ,结果两位学生拿得不一样多,一位学生拿出4枝,另一位学生拿出3枝。
2、思考问题:他们两人都是拿了铅笔的 ,拿出的铅笔枝数却不一样多,这是为什么?请想一想,然后小组交流。
3、在班里进行反馈。引导学生发现两盒铅笔的总枝数不同,也就是整体“1”不一样了。
4、师生共同小结:一盒铅笔的 表示的都是把一盒铅笔平均分成2份,其中的一份就是 。但由于分数所对应的整体不同,所以 表示的具体数量也不一样了。
二、说一说。
出示书中的情境图:
联系一本书的 ,一块蛋糕的 等实际情境展开交流,体会一个分数对应的整体不同,所表示的具体数量也不同,进一步加深学生对分数的认识。
三、画一画。
一个图形的 是□,请学生画出这个图形。然后组织学生进行交流。借助直观图形体会一个图形的 都是一个□,但是这个图形的形状可能不同。
四、练一练。
第1题:用分数表示下面各图中的涂色部分。先让学生独立填写,然后选择其中几题让学生说说思考的过程。
第2题:请在图中用颜色表示各个分数。学生独立完成。
第3题:请分别画出下列各个图形的 ,它们的大小一样吗?
第4题:结合“捐零花钱”的实际问题,体会分数的相对性。让学生说说自己的想法,可以举例说明。
第5题:根据圆木的 的实际长度去推断整根圆木的长度;根据一个圆的 ,去推断一个圆的 。
第6题:通过学生填数、观察,使学生体会这些分数之间的关系,先让学生填一填,再说说有什么发现。
英语站课件(篇2)
教学内容:
本课以故事型教学为基础,在踢足球这种课余活动的话题中学习对他人能力的提问。能听懂并询问单复数物品。
教学目标:
1、在踢足球这个课余活动的话题中,掌握单词soccer ball, soccer shoes的准确读音,及框架句型Can you…?Yes, I can、 No, I can’t的用法。
2、通过图片提示和动作辅助,学生能听懂并理解故事内容;通过师生互动,小组合作,能用正确使用的主体句式向他人询问能否做某事;通过听音模仿和情景表演等形式,能够准确表达课文中主体句式的情感。
3、能过学习踢足球这一语境,提高学生运动的意识。
教学重点:
1、词汇:soccer ball,soccer shoes,play soccer.
2、句型:Can you play soccer? Yes, I can.
1、歌曲热身:I can skate and I can jump.师生共同唱歌。
2、利用歌曲,询问学生能做的事情,过渡复习旧知。利用闪烁、遮挡和局部呈现的'方式,让学生猜球。
初听课文:由“猜球”游戏,过渡到本课课文,带着问题“What do they want to do?”初听课文,同时,教师配相应的动作,帮助学生理解课文大意。
三、新知学练
1、根据初听课文的任务,再利用动作,让学生明确play soccer的含义,并利用不同的图片进行短语读音的操练。
2、精听学说:带着问题“Does Robo know them?”精听课文。
(1)学说soccer ball:利用角色转变,练习读音,以及单数问句和回答。
(2)学说soccer shoes:利用词卡,开火车练习读音,以及复数问句和回答。
(3)通过Yes!和Sure!的回答对比,让学生充分理解Sure!的强烈语气和情感,同时进行角色转变练习。
(2)拼读规律:soc……,学生猜测后三个字母。利用课件,从前一个音节中的c,再分出一个字母c后,再增加字母组合er。
1、听音跟读,强化语音要点。
2、分角色朗读课文。
1、巩固游戏:学生在标有数字1-6的足球中,选择一个数字完成任务,任务以巩固新知为主。
1、 总结:在众多运动图片中,学生自由选择,并表达能做的运动。
2、作业:
听:听一听第六课P44录音,每天5-10分钟。
读:读一读第六课P44课文,要注意课文中人物的情感。
写:写一写,写1-3个问题,下节课向同学和老师提问:Can you…?
英语站课件(篇3)
教学目标
1、能力目标:学生能够对身高进行问答;学生能够掌握四会单词和句子;学生能够用比较级对一些事物或人进行比较。
2、知识目标:
(1)能够掌握本课时的四会单词:younger, older, taller, shorter, longer。 (2)能够掌握本课时重点句型:How tall are you ? I am ......metres. I am taller. You are shorter aller than me. You’re youngerolder than me.
3、情感目标:培养学生积极学习英语的兴趣,能积极参与课堂。
教学重难点
1、重点:学习单词:younger, older, taller, shorter, longer;掌握句子:How tall are you ? I’m 1.61 metres.I’m taller. You’re older than me,too.
2、难点:正确使用句子“......is.....than.....”进行各种比较。
教学过程
一、Preparation
1、Greeting:Nice to meet you again. How are you today?
2、Let’s chant
Tall, tall, tall, who is tall?
Tall, tall, tall, I am tall.
Short, short, short, who is short?
Short, short, short, I am short.
Big, big, big, whose(谁的) eyes are big?
Big, big, big, her eyes are big.
Small, small, small, whose eyes are small?
Small, small, small, his eyes are small.
Do some actions,review the words:tall、strong、short 等。
二、Presentation
1、教师请几位高矮胖瘦不同的学生到台前来,让学生分辨Who is tall /strong/old/young/short?,然后让学生回答。
教师指着比较高的A和比较矮的B问: Who is tall ? S :A. T: A is taller than B , 用动作来示意学生,帮助学生理解。然后出示taller的单词卡片,示范读taller.
2、教学单词taller,边说边做动作,学生跟做。开火车合拼单词,小组比赛快速熟练的拼读。帮助学生用tall+er来记忆。
3、教师用同样的方法教学其他四个四会单词stronger 、older、 younger、 shorter。
4、将五张单词卡放在一起请学生认读。男女比赛谁读错或不会读。
5、观察五个单词,有什么相同之处?然后简单解释,当两个人相比较时,使用比较级,比较级就是在形容词词尾加er.
6、教师领读几遍后,请学生根据实际情况说句子,比如“I’m taller than ….I’m short than ….”等。教师要及时鼓励表述好的学生。
7、教师把一高一矮的学生叫他们站起来,然后说You’re taller than your classmate! 引导学生做出相应的回答:Yes! 教师问,How tall are you ?学生答I’m 160cm
8、教师和另一个学生对话作示范,How tall are you ?I’m 150cm tall. I’m taller than you. I’m 4cm taller than you ..学生分组开火车练习,最快的为优胜组。
三、Practice
1、拼读比赛:教师让学生5—6人一组,告诉他们要进行拼读单词的竞赛。教师将单词中的字母组合删除,让每组学生代表填写。
2.教师带领学生继续进行比赛,打乱组成单词的字母顺序,让学生们在小组中重新排列,组成单词。
四、Production
1.每名学生尝试用句型“I’m ---- than ----“来描述自己。至少三句话。
2.小组内学生互相交流。
3.Let’s chant。
五、Progress
1.Let's play 学生小组玩游戏。
2.选择几个小组展示。
Homework
1.抄写本节课所学的五个四个单词。
2. 询问他人年龄、身高、体重。
(运用句型How old/tall/heavy are you? )
板书设计
Unit 1 How tall are you
A Let's learn
I'm taller than you.
tall-taller short –shorter
young-younger old-older
strong-stronger
英语站课件(篇4)
活动目标:
1、会听英语指令进行游戏。
2、喜欢参加游戏活动。
活动准备:英语卡片、手偶
活动过程:
一、热身游戏:揪尾巴
幼儿尾巴上贴上颜色卡片,互相揪尾巴,幼儿把揪到的尾巴说出颜色名称,red, yellow, blue, gree。
二、课堂指令的学习
1当老师说“好”时,让学生回答“好”,并用手势重复
2、who wants to try? ----- let me try! 反复大声练习几次
3、u dow stand up ! sit down! 反复操练几次后学习儿歌
left, left, right, right, up and dow
left, left, right, right, turning around;
left, left, right, right, jump, jump, jum
left, left, right, right, we are strong.
三、问候: hello, hi , how are you 手偶模仿
表演 :hello, hello, how are you? fine, fine, fine, thank you
hello,hello, how are you ? oh, oh, just so so.
hello,hello, how are you ? no, no, i’m terrible.
四、认识颜色: red yellow blue gree
1、教师出示颜色卡片逐次认识,让学生跟读.
2、小游戏:将卡片放在地上,让两个学生根据老师说出的单词,以最快速度拍击相应的颜色卡片,并大声读出来.,胜者发小奖品.
玩两到三组。如果你不能决定胜利者,那就用石头吧
3、老师提问:what color is it? 幼儿回答:it’s … (回答时击打卡片.one by one)
五、复习英文歌:
are you sleeping?
are you sleeping? are you sleeping?
brother john? brother john?
morning bells are ringing, morning bells are ringing, ding ,ding dong, ding, ding dong.
英语站课件(篇5)
主题:跨文化沟通
中文课件:
跨文化沟通的意义和挑战
随着经济全球化的发展,跨文化沟通成为越来越重要的技能。对于那些想要在国际舞台上立足的人们来说,了解并掌握跨文化沟通技巧将变得越来越关键。但是,跨文化沟通并不容易,由此带来了许多挑战。本课件将讨论跨文化沟通的意义和挑战。
跨文化沟通的意义
跨文化沟通的意义在于,在不同文化间建立沟通和理解,这是人际交往的基础之一。跨文化沟通不仅可以加强人们之间的联系,还可以促进交流和合作,使人们更好地理解、尊重和欣赏彼此的文化。
此外,跨文化沟通还可以帮助人们更好地应对全球化带来的挑战。在现代社会中,越来越多的人需要在不同的文化环境中生活和工作。跨文化沟通技能可以帮助他们更好地适应新的文化环境,并借此提高自己的竞争力。
跨文化沟通的挑战
虽然跨文化沟通的意义重大,但它也面临着许多挑战。
一方面,不同文化间存在显著差异。这些差异不仅体现在沟通方式、语言和礼仪上,还涉及信仰、态度和价值观等方面。因此,当人们试图在不同的文化环境中进行交流时,可能会遇到许多困难和误解。
另一方面,文化间的差异可能会导致文化冲突。这些冲突可能会加剧误解和隔阂,从而妨碍跨文化沟通的进行。
再加上现代交通和通讯手段的发展,人们不得不逐渐与不同国家、不同文化的人们交往,以应对全球化时代的挑战。
结语
跨文化沟通是全球化时代人们必备的技能,它可以促进交流和合作,帮助人们更好地适应新的文化环境。但是,跨文化沟通也面临许多挑战,需要人们不断学习和实践,才能够提高跨文化沟通的有效性。
英语站课件(篇6)
(T:teacher ;S:student)
Greeting:
T:Let’s begin our class!
S1:All rise!
T:Good morning boys and girls!
Ss:Good morning,Miss Lu
T:Sit down ,please。
T: Today, befor our new lesson, I’d like you to listen to a song…now, everyone, please look at here, let’s enjoy it!
(1’20’’)
T:Do you know the song?
Ss:Yes!
T:What is the name of the song?
Ss:Titanic!
T: It came from the film Titanic, but the name of the song is “My heart will go on”
(Write down “Titanic” &“My heart will go on” on the blackboard )
Ss: My heart will go on.
S1: In chinese是叫“我心永在”吗?
T:That’s right! “我心永在”。
T: ok, one more questione! Who is the singer of the song? You know what’s the meaning of the word “singer”?
(Write down“singer” on the blackboard )
Ss:Singer,歌手!
T:Yes! Who is the singer?
Ss: I don’t know…
T: I will tell you: Her name is Celine Dion.( Write down the name”Celine Dion “on the blackboard)
Ss: Celine Dion!
(打出Celine Dion的ppt图片,加深印象)
T:Is she beautiful?
Ss:Yes! Very beautiful。
T:Can you guess how old is she?( Write down the word”guess” on the blackboard)
S1: 30!
S2:18!
S3: Maybe 40.
……
T:Ok,she was born in 1966. How old?
Ss:43!
T:Very good!
T:Ok,let’s go on!look at the ppt,we know that Celine has a lot of……
Ss:Fans!
T:Yes,she is very successful,and some of her fans are……
Ss:“super-fans”!
T:Very good! So we know the words “fan”&“super-fan”,and also we know some……
(打出两张韩国明星的ppt)
Ss:Superstar!
T:Yes,good!They are superstars!
Ss: Superstars!
T:Yes,good!This man is……(打出超人的图片)
Ss:Superman!
T:Yes,very good! Remember these words:fan, super-fan, superstar,superman.
Ss: Fan, super-fan, superstar,superman.
T:Ok,good! Now,let’s come to today’s new words. Please read them after me, one,two,begin~
idol,world-famous, wonderful, guess, fan, super-fan, successful, favourite, fantastic, have no idea, make it.
(Ss read the new words after teacher)
T:Ok,good!Try to remember them.Now,boys and girls,let’s listen to the tape and then answer my questions:
Question 1::How can Celine Dion become world-famous?
Question 2:Who is Babara’s favourite idol?
Now,let’s begin!
(播放录音)
T:Ok.Question time.Who can answer question 1:How can Celine Dion become world-famous?
S1:She sang a song called“my heart will go on”and became world-famous.
T:Very good!Sit down please!
T:Now,question 2:who is Babara’s favourite idol? Any volunteer?
S1:I want to try…
T:Yes,very well!Go on,please!
S1:I think her favourite idol is Celine Dion…
T:Everyone,is she right?
Ss:Yes!She is right!
T:Ok,good!So we know that Babara’s favourite idol is also Celine Dion!Right?
Ss:Yes!
英语站课件(篇7)
教学目标:
1.运用多种方法认12个生字,掌握生词;
2.通过默读课文,知道课文大意;
1.学会本课12个生字和由这些字组成的新词,并了解它们在本课中的意思。
1、能借助拼音在语言环境中正确读写“丑、堆、孤、单、洁、越、冷、影”8个生字,认识两点水(冫)。积……
教学目标:
1、会认12个生字和由这些字组成的新词,会写10个生字。
2、能正确、流利地朗读课文,会背诵课……
教学目标:
1、会认6个生字,会写9个字。
2、正确、流利、有感情地朗读课文,能区别“常常”和“往常”的`意思……
天蓝蓝,海蓝蓝,我家住在大海边。
海边有个月亮湾,湾里有条打鱼船。
船上有位老爷爷,他的故事说不完。
……
教学目标:
1.正确、流利、有感情地朗读课文。
2.学会本课10个生字,两条绿线内的6个字只识不写。理解由生字组……
1.能正确流利地朗读儿歌,读出儿歌的韵律美;
2.能根据形声字的构字特点分析、记忆字形,激发学生学习汉字的兴趣,……
英语站课件(篇8)
中英文的课件已经成为现代教育的重要组成部分,能够简化教学过程、提高教学效果。本文将从中英文课件的意义、设计原则和实际应用三个方面展开,探讨中英文课件的相关主题。
一、中英文课件的意义
中英文课件是一种集信息传递、教学辅助、学习引导于一体的现代化教育工具,特别适用于初、中、高中学生的课堂教学、家庭学习和自学。它具有以下意义:
1、信息丰富:中英文课件采用图文、音频、动画等多媒体形式,能够使学生更直观地理解和接受知识。
2、互动性强:中英文课件常采用交互设计,让学生更积极地参与到课堂教学中去,更好地实现了师生互动教学模式。
3、灵活性大:中英文课件随时可用,随处可学,能够满足学生个性化需求和教师灵活选题的需求,有助于学生选择自己感兴趣的内容进行学习。
4、节省时间:课件采用动画和图示的形式,能够直观地传达知识点,使学生快速理解,从而节省了很多学习时间。同时也为教师利用更多的时间进行有针对性的教学和指导。
二、中英文课件的设计原则
中英文课件的设计应根据不同的受众和学科特点,有选择性地应用一些设计原则,以达到教学目标。设计中要注意以下几个方面:
1、精心设计授课内容:简单、清晰、重点突出,以传达学习要点并引导学生思考。
2、采用适当的多媒体元素:应用图像、动画、音频、视频等多媒体元素,激发学生兴趣,让学生更直观地理解和接受知识。
3、注意“个性”需求:尽可能满足学生的个性化需求,让学生有更多的选择空间,并根据学生的反馈进行调整,调动学生的学习积极性。
4、简明扼要、图文并茂:充分运用图像和文字,让课件内容简明扼要,尽可能地避免学生在理解上的困难和疑惑。
三、中英文课件的实际应用
中英文课件的应用范围很广,使用也非常方便,可以根据学生的具体需求和课程特点进行实际应用。以下是中英文课件的具体应用场景:
1、教师上课:教师可以将中英文课件作为教材的补充,让学生更直观、全面地认识和了解知识点。
2、学生自学:学生可以利用各种中英文课件自学相关知识,更好地发挥自主学习的能力。
3、考试复习:学生可以利用中英文课件进行重点复习,迅速了解和掌握知识点,提高考试成绩。
4、家长辅导:家长可以利用中英文课件为孩子提供辅导帮助,帮助孩子巩固和加深对知识点的理解。
总之,中英文课件是现代教育的重要组成部分,能够适应不同的受众和学科特点,为学生和教师提供了很多便利和帮助。同时,采用中英文课件对于从小培养学生自主学习的能力和方法有着积极的推动和巨大的意义。我们应该更加注重中英文课件及其应用,发挥其在教育教学上的作用,让更多的学生享受到其中的乐趣和实用性。
英语站课件(篇9)
主题:中英文课件
随着全球化的发展,英语已经成为一种全球性语言。而且,学习英语不仅仅是为了更好地和英语国家的人交流,也是为了更好地拓展自己的知识领域。随着科技的发展,中英文课件也越来越受到人们的欢迎。
中英文课件的优势
中英文课件的优势主要体现在以下几个方面:
1. 提高学习成效。中英文课件通常采用图形、动画、声音等多种手段,使学习过程更加生动、直观、易于理解,有利于激发学习者的兴趣,从而提高学习的效果。
2. 降低学习难度。中英文课件不仅可以从视觉和听觉两个方面来提供信息,而且可以采用图示、图片、动画等方式,帮助学习者更好地理解学习内容,从而降低学习难度。
3. 提高教学质量。中英文课件的使用,可以使教学更加灵活多样,更具交互性,有利于激发学生学习兴趣,培养学生自主学习的能力,提高教学质量。
中英文课件的设计要点
要设计一份有趣、生动、直观的中英文课件,需要注意以下几个方面:
1. 借助图形传递信息。中英文课件的设计必须要有足够的图形,通过图片、动画等视觉资源让学生更加直观地了解和理解学习内容。
2. 结构清晰。中英文课件的结构要清晰,将课程分成若干部分,每部分都应有一个明确的标题和导航栏,使学生可以方便地查找所需内容。
3. 内容充实。中英文课件的内容要充实,既要学生姓名,还要包含其他方面的信息,如课程大体框架、日程安排、教学要求等。
4. 合理运用声音。声音可以很好地帮助学生理解学习内容,中英文课件设计者可以在课件中适当使用语音、音效和音乐。
中英文课件在教学中的应用
中英文课件不仅可以用来独立学习,还可以在教学中起着重要的作用。在教学中,中英文课件可以帮助老师准备课堂教学内容,也可以辅助老师进行课堂教学,提高学生的学习效率和学习兴趣。
在英语教学中,中英文课件显得格外重要。通过中英文课件,学生可以更好地了解其它国家的文化、经济、政治等方面的信息,而教师则可以更好地传递知识,激发学生学习兴趣和动力。
总的来说,中英文课件是现代教育不可或缺的一部分。设计好的中英文课件可以帮助学习者更好地理解和掌握学习内容,提高学习效率和质量,帮助教师进行教学,更好地达到教学目的。
英语站课件(篇10)
英语问路课件
在国外旅游或生活中,问路是一个不可避免的问题。然而,由于语言和文化的差异,问路可能会变得有些困难。因此,学习如何用英语问路,显得尤为重要。本文将介绍如何用英语问路的相关技巧。
一、基本用语
1. Excuse me, where is…? (对不起,请问……在哪里?)
2. How do I get to…?(我该怎样去……?)
3. Can you show me the way to…?(你能告诉我去……的路吗?)
4. Is there a…near here?(这附近有……吗?)
二、方向指示
1. Go straight ahead.(一直向前走)
2. Turn left/right.(左转/右转)
3. Cross the street.(穿过马路)
4. Take the first/second turn on the left/right.(拐第一/第二条左/右边的街道)
5. Go past the…(从……经过)
6. It’s on your left/right.(在你的左/右边)
7. It’s across from…(在……的对面)
8. It’s next to…(在……的旁边)
9. It’s near/far.(离这里近/远)
三、其他有用的表达
1. Sorry, I don’t understand.(对不起,我不明白。)
2. Could you repeat that, please?(你能再说一遍吗?)
3. I’m not from around here.(我不是本地人。)
4. Thank you very much.(非常感谢。)
5. You’re welcome.(不用谢。)
6. Goodbye.(再见。)
四、练习
1. Excuse me, where is the nearest pharmacy?
2. Can you show me the way to the train station, please?
3. How do I get to the museum?
4. Is there a restaurant nearby?
5. Turn left at the traffic lights and keep going until you reach the shopping mall.
6. It’s next to the post office, on your right.
7. Cross the street and take the second turn on your left.
8. I’m sorry, I don’t understand. Could you speak more slowly, please?
9. Thank you very much for your help.
10. You’re welcome.
五、注意事项
问路时,要注意自己的语调和表情,必须礼貌、友好、自信和耐心,因为这会使被问路的人更愿意回答你的问题。同时,可以利用手势和地图来帮助理解和表达。
总之,学习如何用英语问路是一个基本的生活技能。掌握以上技巧,可以帮助你更清晰,更直接地向当地人询问路线,更顺利地完成旅行或生活中的各项事务。
英语站课件(篇11)
本单元围绕the Silver Screen(影视) 这一主题开展听、说、读、写多种教学活动。影视作为人类文明的一大体现,作为当今社会人们主要休闲、娱乐方式之一,是一个非常贴近生活、具有时代性、可挖掘性的教学主题。
本单元所选的语言素材涉及中外名片、著名演员、著名导演, 具有典型的时代气息,有利于学生了解外国文化,增强世界意识。正如新课程标准中的教学建议所提:学习中文影视文化有利于“拓展学生的文化视野,发展他们跨文化交际的意识和能力”;在利用现代教育技术观看影视片断、影视海报的教学过程中,“拓宽了学生学习和运用英语的渠道”;同时本单元的教学对教师本身的中外文化修养、广阔的知识面等方面有非常高的要求。
(1).对国外著名影星、导演及他们作品的了解。如教材中涉及的Meryl Streep,Keanu Reeves,Steve Spielberg等,以扩大学生知识面、文化视野。如何填补学生这方面知识缺乏的信息沟。
(2).对国内著名影视导演及他们代表作品的了解。如何设计任务让学生从课内知识到课外知识的链接。
(3).对影视界名人及电影的评价(comments)如何写影评(review)。
1. 学习、掌握关系副词when,where.,why 引导的定语从句及介词+关系代词引导的定语从句。
2. 学习掌握一些有关影视的词汇:
如: career, director, script, play a role in ,Oscar, award, studio, scene, follow-ups等。
掌握其他一些课文中涉及的词汇:
如:graduate, attack, creature, owe…to…, take off等。
3. 学习掌握一些用于讨论、评价电影的结构句式:
如:What’s the film about?
What do you think about the story of the film?
How do you feel about the film?
I like / don’t like the film because…
The film is about… I think the ending of the film is …
4. 提高学生语言听、说、读、写的能力及扮演角色、编写剧本、撰写影评等的综合语言运用能力?
1. 学习几位著名影星、导演执著于艺术、献身于艺术的敬业精神和对人类艺术的巨大贡献。
2. 从Keanu Reeves 艰辛的成功途中(In the begin did many small jobs, then played in many cheap films.)我们可以学习到:要成就事业需付出辛勤劳动,要有持之以恒、坚持不懈的恒心与毅力。
3. 通过学习国外著名影视界人物,培养学生了解、尊重异国文化,体现国际合作精神。
4. 通过开展小组活动,指导学生积极与人合作,相互学习,相互帮助,培养其团队精神。
能总结定语从句的结构规律,并加以应用;在学习中借助电影海报图画、图表等非语言信息进行理解或表达。
利用影视资源,主动拓宽英语学习渠道,创造和把握学习英语的机会;积极参与采访、表演、调查等英语学习活动。
充分利用采访、表演等真实交际活动提高用英语交际的能力,在其过程中能借助手势、表情等非语言手段提高交际效果,能克服语言障碍,维持交际。
通过了解影视知识,获得更广泛的英语信息,拓展所学知识。
1. 了解英语国家影视界艺术家的成长经历、成就和贡献。
2. 通过学习,了解世界著名影视文化,培养世界意识。
3. 通过中外影视文化对比,加深对中国影视文化的理解。
这部分的重点是引出本单元的话题---电影,了解学生对电影的熟悉程度并充分发挥学生的想象力。同时训练学生说的能力。
活动步骤:
1.师生互动:教师提一些问题如Do you like seeing films? How often? Favorite actor? Actress? Film? 在此过程中教师可展示一些学生熟悉并喜欢的名演员、名片的海报,从视觉上激发学生对本话题的兴趣。
2.小组活动:教师选取几副不同题材的电影画面(可选取教材外的其它画面),要求学生进行小组合作,每小组选一幅画面进行讨论What is happening in this scene? What happens before/after the scene? 要求学生不拘泥于已知的电影内容,发挥自己的想象力,给出各种不同的观点。
3.班级活动:向班级其它同学描述本小组所选图片,其他同学可给出不同意见。
本单元的听力是培养学生捕捉特定信息的能力,并让学生熟悉interview这种形式。Task: To discuss what questions the reporters will ask when interviewing famous directors.
活动形式:
1. 师生互动:教师设置开放性的问题,进一步启发学生思考,并为过渡到听力部分做准备。问题可设置为:Of course these films now are very popular and successful, and what does the success of the films bring to the actors? 学生各抒己见,金钱、荣誉、名气,成为公众人物后带来一个问题They received a lot of interviews。
2. 小组活动:教师引出问题What questions will you ask when interviewing an actor?通过小组讨论,收集尽可能多的问题,一方面让学生预测听力中可能会出现的问题,同时也对interview这种形式有所了解。
本单元说的任务是利用阅读所得信息开展对名演员的interview,从而提
演员的职业有所了解并增加学习趣味。
Task: To interview famous actors and directors in different ways.
活动形式:
1、 师生互动:教师可设置问题了解学生对电影大奖及获奖演员的了解程度,为接下来的两位演员的介绍作好铺垫。问题可为Can you tell me some famous awards to the films in the world? Try to tell the famous actors, actresses and the films you know that have won the Oscar.
1. 班级活动:教师可为学生播放分别由Meryl streep和Keanu Reeves主演的电影Out of Africa《走出非洲》和 speed《生死时速》片段,并可展现他们主演的其它电影的海报,让学生在视觉上对这两位演员及他们的表演有所了解。
2. 个人活动,但先把学生分成两组,分组阅读,然后完成下面表格中的信息。
3. 小组活动:选两位学生,一位当主持人,一位当Meryl streep/Keanu Reeves,其他同学充当观众,模仿央视“艺术人生”的形式作一访谈,要求主持人留一些时间给观众提问。
1) Why are they so popular and successful?
2) What is needed to be an actor/actress?
3) Would you like to be an actor/actress one day? Why(not)?
6. 小组活动:教师播放电影“home alone”《小鬼当家》片段,将原声消去,让学生分组给出对白及表演,最后可让学生互评哪一组做得最好。
(四) Word Study(提前):
本单元词汇学习的目的主要是让学生掌握一些与电影有关的词语如studio、follow-ups、award、script等,对学生而言,有些生疏,因此教师可给出一些视觉上的帮助。
在教学过程中,先利用图片,实物等教具对学生进行直观的教学,使之有更清晰的认识后,再辅之以语境,利用语境来推测词义,达到猜词的效果。如给出The Matrix和The Matrix Reloaded的电影海报,学生很容易得出:The Matrix Reloaded is the follow-up of The Matrix。通过这样的铺垫,学生在做第七小题时,只要利用好文中的线索Speed II, Jurassic Park III就可以轻而易举的得出follow-ups。
作而突出导演的重要作用。Task: To experience being a director (write one scene of the film and act it out).
1.师生互动:教师提问If you want to make a film, who do you
need to invite?通过此问题引出电影制作过程中所需的各种角色,如photographer, actor/actress, editor, director等等
2.小组活动:
1)教师可设置这样的讨论题:What part would you like to play in making a film?根据选择分组,让他们讨论选择各角色的理由。同时讨论各角色在电影制作中所做的不同工作。通过讨论,学生不难发现,在电影的制作过程中,导演起了非常关键的作用。
2)根据所选的各种角色交叉分组,发挥各自的作用。
Think of one scene you are quite familiar with and act it out.
a. What would the scene be like and what happens in it?
b. Who are the main actors in that scene and what do they do?
c. Write a short dialogue and act it out
本篇阅读材料是人物传记,介绍了著名导演Steven Spielberg 的成长经历以及他的主要成就和作品。通过文章的学习,旨在了解西方的电影文化背景以及学习名导Steven Spielberg的那种对自己的事业坚持不懈、孜孜以求的精神。
分别给出阅读材料中提到的五幅电影(Jaws, E.T., Jurassic Park, Schindler’s List, Saving Private Ryan)的图片,把学生分成不同的小组,对图片进行预测,各个小组根据不同的图片猜想影片的大概内容及主题。
快速阅读课文的Para3-5 , 查找出有关这5部电影内容和主题的信
阅读并查找有关Spielberg的信息:
1) When and where was he born?
2) When did he start making films?
3) What did he use to make films at first? and later?
4) What was his dream?
5) What did he study?
6) When and with what did his career take off?
7) What does Spielberg owe his success to?
该部分可分成两块,其中第二块内容可以提前到阅读中去完成,也可在读后总结,当学生读完影片内容时,可以根据自己的理解写出五部影片的内容是什么(写尝试应用定语从句,体验定语从句的结构)。第一块(Questions)中第1,3,5三个问题比较难,从文中直接找不到答案,也是学生理解上需要升华的部分。可以通过分组,让学生讨论来理解这几个问题。让学生领会以下几点:1)、英语作为工具的重要性 2)、不懈努力、持之以恒 3)、成功需要家人的支持,合作、互助精神。
这部分的重点是学习掌握关系副词when,where,why 引导的定语从句及介词+关系代词引导的定语从句。Task: To talk about some famous directors in China and some of their most famous and popular films, using attributive clause.
活动步骤:
1. 师生互动:教师提一些问题如What Chinese directors do you know?
What are their well-known films? 在此过程中教师可展示一些学生熟悉的国内知名导演的海报,从视觉上激发学生的兴趣。然后谈论某个导演及他的代表作品,引出定语从句。
如Zhang Yimou is the famous director who successfully directed the film Hero.
2.小组活动:教师选取几副大家熟悉的国产大片的电影画面,要求学生进行小组讨论,分别来自什么电影,他们的男、女主角(main actor/actress)分别是谁。然后用定语从句知识来谈论。如:Shaolin Soccer is a funny film in which Zhou Xingchi plays the main role.
3.班级活动:给出几副图片及几个关键词(key words),用所学定语从句来描述图片。如:
北京申奥成功图 Beijing the city Beijing is the city where/in which the 2008 Olympic Games will be held.
4.大组活动:全班以座位为单位分4大组,开展竞赛。1)小组讨论,两人一组,一学生创设一个情景并给出2-3个关键词,另一名同学用定语从句进行描述。2)班级活动;结果汇报,教师记录,看哪个大组能正确描述的情景最多。教师给出评价。
该部分主要阅读张艺谋的影片Not One Less并学习如何评价电影及写影评。Task: Make comments on films and write reviews about them.
1. 师生互动:教师可设置问题了解学生对张艺谋及其主要作品的熟悉情况,为接下来阅读Not One Less 作铺垫。问题可为 What does he do? What is famous for? What films has he directed? What is his recent film? What else do you know about him? 同时呈现张的有关信息表格,为后面的Survey 作铺垫。通过提问谈论《一个也不能少》有关情节,为阅读作铺垫。
2. 个人活动:阅读Not One Less ;回答问题,填写信息表。
3. 班级活动:学习写review 的有关建议。并以Not One Less 作为例子写影评一篇。
4.个人活动:Survey--Your favorite director and his film in china
5.小组活动:讨论关于Your favorite film What’s it about? What kind of story do you think it is? How do you think of the actors/ actresses?...
6.个人活动:模仿前面所学,写一篇影评 My Favorite Film
7.两人活动:交换作文,从影评内容、时态、单词拼写、所用词汇等方面相互交流、修改。
英语站课件(篇12)
1. 在网上收集有关节日的大量信息,通过对节日的描述,提高学生口语表达能力。
2. 比较中外不同节日文化的内涵,培养学生跨文化的国际交流意识。
3. 通过生活实例,使学生掌握中秋节的相关知识。
使学生了解并且比较中外文化的差异;能熟练掌握要学习的内容。
1. 以日常问候语引入到节日的话题(Greetings)师生对唱一首英语歌曲《Are you happy?》,从而引入节日主题,让学生列举他们所熟悉的节日。
2. 提问:你能猜到老师最喜欢哪个节日吗?为什么?(Can you guess which festival I like best?Why?)
3.导入课题:中秋节(Look!What’s this?What do you think of when you see the moon?)用一段动画传递中秋节信息,让学生说出月饼、嫦娥、团圆等相关信息。
1.网上阅读,了解中秋节的相关信息。
你想了解吗?(You know the beautiful Lady Chang’e has its beautiful stories. Do you want to read them?)展示Legend(中秋传说)、Traditions&Customs(传统风俗)和Background(历史背景)等与主题相关的内容。
2.自我检测(Self-test)自我测试对阅读内容的.理解。
相关问题:哪些内容和中秋节相关?(Which are related to Mid-autumn Day?)月饼的象征意义是什么?(What’s the meaning of the moon cake?)
三、文化比较,文化渗透(Task2&3—Listening and Speaking)
1.观看一个美国家庭过感恩节的录像(You see an American family are having their Thanksgiving dinner. Listen and watch carefully,trying to findout the differences between Mid-autumn and Thanksgiving.) 感受纯正的英语口语,在真实的情境中了解这些节日丰富的文化内涵;让学生在学习语言的同时,感受文化差异。
2.听力测验(Quiz)完成听力检测题,由计算机判断正误;师生互动反馈信息。
(1)单词银行(Word Bank)让学生在规定时间内,正确写出与中秋节有关的单词,累计得分;通过竞赛的形式,获最高分者为优胜。
(2)“嫦娥”问答(Lady Chang’e)帮助“嫦娥”正确回答五个问题,使她逐渐飞上月亮和她的玉兔团聚;巩固形容词的比较级和最高级。
2.享受网络利用网站自主搜索世界各国的节日,分析、比较和总结中外节日的异同点。
3.课后练习:
(1)收集更多节日的相关信息,下节课进行介绍。
(2)发电子邮件给一个外国网友,介绍一个中国节日;发一封邮件给教师介绍一个外国节日。
1. 通过一份评价表来评估本节课的学习效果。
2. 全班齐唱《但愿人长久》结束本课。
英语微课件
编辑对“英语微课件”进行了反复打磨和精准修改,现在带给大家最新的版本。在上课前,老师需要准备好教案和课件。制作教案和课件时,不能草率从事。老师应该针对学生的不同能力和需求,制定多样化的教案。我们希望这篇文章能为你提供有价值的内容!
英语微课件 篇1
我说课的内容是人教版《小学英语》三年级上册Unit 5 “Let’s eat”B 部分的第一课时,包括“Let’s talk”“Let’s play”,这一课时是在A部分学习“I like… Have some …”的基础上,学习询问自己是否能得到想要的东西的表达法“Can I have…?”另外,学生们还需要学习当别人对你说“Thank you”时,你的回答“You’re welcome.”
① 知识目标:
A、能听懂、会说“Can I have…?”并能询问自己是否能得到想要的东西,会说“You’re welcome.”。
B、初步听、说“milk Coke juice water coffee tea”这六种有关于饮料类的单词。
C、在游戏活动中,能把新学的知识和已学的知识联系起来。
A、让学生在实际情景中学会运用语言,感到学习英语是有用的,产生成就感,从而能更好地提高学习英语的兴趣。
B、在学习活动中积极,好动,充满好奇,乐于尝试。
重点:
② 能初步听、说“milk Coke juice water coffee tea”这六种有关于饮料类的单词。
难点:
能准确听、说“milk Coke juice water coffee tea”这六种有关于饮料类的单词,并能在实际情景交流中适当而灵活运用。
主要以现代化电教手段----多媒体辅助教学,贯穿整个教学过程,增加了直观性和趣味性,加大了课堂密度,提高教学效果。
小学三年级学生具有好奇、好动、喜欢游戏,乐于参与和表演,对英语学习兴趣浓的特点,但这些并不能持久,因此,要创设一定的情景,让学生在情境中学习,多种教学手段交替使用,尽量利用实物、图片以及课件等直观教具进行教学,使学生始终处于新鲜,求知欲旺盛,学习情绪高涨的氛围中。
在学习本课之前,学生已经具备下列语言知识和技能:能够听、说、认读一些食物类的词汇,并能用“I like…”表示自己对某种食物的喜好以及用“Have some…”来给别人提供食物。
根据教学内容的特点,为了完成以上教学目标,更好地突出重点,突破难点,按照学生的.认识规律,我采用复习旧知自然过渡,直观演示,愉快教学相结合的方法,层层递进,激发学生的学习兴趣,充分调动他们的学习积极性,保持他们强烈的好奇心和旺盛的求知欲,进而促使他们由兴趣发展到产生要学好它的志趣。
鉴于本课的特点及学生现有的水平,我准备从听、看、读、说等方面逐步引导学生,发展学生的语言思维和运用能力,
同时,多表扬,勤鼓励,使不同层次的学生都有学习积极性,在学习上均有所提高。
1、师生问好。
2、Game : Part A 部分的“单词接龙”游戏。分小组进行,哪个小组最先完成任务,即为获胜组。
(设计意图:以学生已经熟悉的游戏,复习旧知,让学生充满激情地投入到语言学习状态,为后面新知识的学习做铺垫。)
3、Sing the song “ Let’s have a picnic today.”
(设计意图:通过唱歌,活跃课堂气氛,创设良好的学习氛围,并借助歌曲导入新课。)
1、利用图片,创设情境,教学“You’re welcome.”
㈠播放完歌曲“Let’s have a picnic today.”后,师生谈话:
T:Boys and girls , Let’s have a picnic today,ok?
课件播放picnic的情景,老师拿出事先准备好的食物图片,然后用这些图片与学生对话:
T: I like hamburger, What do you like?
T: Have some hot dog.(同时把食物图片递给与你对话的学生)
教师反复与多个学生进行以上对话,在说“You’re welcome.”时,尽量以稍微夸张的语气引起学生的注意,让学生在反复听老师夸张的语言中,熟悉并理解句子的意思,教育学生要养成良好的习惯,做个有礼貌,有修养的学生。
㈡让学生以开火车的方式,用英语向同学说声“Thank you” “You’re welcome.”,学会感激别人,学做有礼貌的孩子,来操练此句型。
(设计意图:巧妙的对话设计,在复习旧知的同时自然而然的引出新句型。学生在自然的状态下进入情境,很轻松地把新句型应用于语
篇中,提高了语用能力。同时,在与学生对话时,递出图片,学生接到图片是会显得很兴奋,他们都想得到图片,因此会积极参与到对话中,充分调动了学生的积极性。)
2、教学句子“Can I have some…?”
㈠操练完句型后,师做寻找东西的样子,并说:I have no food ,but I’m hungry now.(同时捂着肚子装肚子饿)Who have some food?师走到有食物图片的同学身边说:“Can I have some…?”引导学生回答:Sure ,here you are.(教师在接到食物的同时,做吃东西的样子)
反复从有食物图片的同学手中索取食物,同样让学生在反复听时熟悉并理解“Can I have some…?” Sure ,here you are.
㈡教授句型Can I have some…? Sure ,here you are.然后让个别同学当服务员,引导学生以之对话,从他手中获取食物,操练句型。
英语微课件 篇2
一、教材分析
本单元主要学习掌握各学科的英语表达,以及表示程度的形容词,学会使用自己对东西或者事情喜好的表达,并简单表示喜欢于不喜欢的原因.
Section A是以talking and listening为主,让学生去充分运作语言功能,和感受语言what’s your favorite subject?及其新词汇。
Section B以读写为主,教材设置要求学生用所学的语言去完成任务,培养学生的综合运用能力。
二、教学目标
1、知识目标
词汇:学习并掌握学科名称以及星期名称favorite, subject, math, science, biology, P.E., because, Monday, Tuesday, Wednesday, Thursday, Friday等.
语法:掌握what,why,who引导的特殊疑问句及其回答的运用;学会使用表示品质的形容词:fun,interesting,relaxing,difficult等.
2、功能目标:能流利地应用本单元所学的新词汇、新语法进行听、说、读、写,能学会安排自己的作息时间。
3、情感目标:学会合理安排学习,作息时间;学唱星期歌song of the week
三、教学重点和难点
①掌握重点词汇及what,why,who引导的疑问句、及肯定与否定回答.
②学会谈论自己喜欢的科目及东西,并说明理由.
③学会表达一周的七天,并学会安排自己的作息时间.
四、教学安排
本单元共分为4课时:
Section A 2课时,Section B & Self check 2课时
五、教学设计
Section A Period 1
Step 1 Warming up and lead in
1.用电影Harry Potter预告片作为本课热身,看完之后向学生提问:Do you like the film?
然后老师继续表达自己的看法:I like this film best. It’s my favorite movie. What’s your favorite movie?(教师这个时候把这个句型写在黑板上,引起学生的注意。)提出这个问题以后,让学生说说自己看过的影片,操练本课的'重点句型:What’s your favorite … ?
操练结束以后,老师继续说:I like Harry Potter, because he is a good student. He works very hard and does so well. Let’s see how he works, ok? (用幻灯片展示Harry Potter
上课的情形)
(Harry Potter这个电影片段主要是考虑到学生本身对这个人物比较感兴趣,有利于激发学生的兴趣,其次是因为Harry Potter本身也是一个学生,他在一所魔法学校里读书,而且学习的课程也很多。这点跟本课比较贴近。使用该片子,教师使用谈话的方式,轻松的把话题由Do you like the film? ——What’s your favorite movie?提出这个问题以后,让学生说说自己看过的影片,有利于扩大大家的视野。同时也是为了引出本课的重点句型:What’s your favorite … ?并让学生在表达的时候操练该句型。在阐述喜欢Harry Potter的理由时,也是德育教育的一个过程。)
Step 2 New words learning
T:Do you know what subject it is?跟学生介绍Harry Potter在魔法学校的课程,然后问学生:And what subject do we have? (幻灯片展示学生平时的课程)
展示完成以后,进行本单元词汇的拓展,问学生:Do you know any more subjects?进行小范围的提问,并要求回答的学生把词汇写在黑板上。
(通过介绍Harry Potter在魔法学校的课程,牢牢抓住学生的兴趣,从而引出学生平时的课程,使话题贴近生活,也使学生比较容易接受。在掌握新单词的前提下,进行必要的拓展,有利于扩大学生的视野。) Step 3 New sentence patterns learning
3.T:Ok, what’s your favorite subject?这里可以先由老师向个别同学提问,然后问:Do you want to know your partners’ favorite subject . Please ask each other.在个别提问了以后,把范围扩大到全班,同时也进行了操练。
(从问subject到favorite subject,难度逐步增加,符合学生的认知接受能力。在操练的时候,把机械的提问,转化为跟同桌的交流。)
操练结束以后,请两位学生来台上做表演:一个人做动作,一个人猜:what’s his favorite subject?/ what’s her favorite subject?
(在巩固了what’s your favorite subject这个句型之后,通过游戏表演的方式来呈现what’s his favorite subject?/ what’s her favorite subject?全体学生在轻松愉快的课堂中接受。这样的表演可是依照课堂实际情况掌握表演组数)
在作完这个表演的时候,教师对最后一个学生提问:why do you like it ?然后教师再针对个别同学提问what’s your favorite subject? why do you like it ?学生回答了之后,教师可以面向全体学生问:what’s his favorite subject?/ what’s her favorite subject?why does he/she like it ?
(通过有效的示范提问,以及不断的操练,有利于开展下面活动的顺利开展。)
Step 4 Survey
给学生一个示例,以Harry Potter做范例: Name : Harry Potter
Favorite subject : broomstick subject
Why : because it’s interesting and exciting
Dislike subject : potion subject
Why :because it’s boring
请学生做一个Survey:
Name :
Favorite subject : Why :
Dislike subject :
Why :
完成Survey之后请同学上台做report:
His/Her name is….
His/Her favorite subject is ….. Because …
He/She don’t like …. Because…
Step 5 Homework
1.根据调查写一个短文,并准备下堂课做报告
2.查找自己最喜欢的明星档案,爱好.
英语微课件 篇3
一、设计理念:
1、教材分析:
我所设计的内容是EEC教材,初三英语上册第六单元第一课。本单元的中心话题是“结识新朋友,不忘老朋友;要和老朋友保持联系”。所以在新课的导入和语言实践活动中,始终在都在围绕着朋友这个话题。最终目的是通过听、说训练,增进应答、反馈和表述的能力。
2、学情分析:
本节课的授课对象是初三的学生。大多数学生已经能够用英语表述自己的想法,但一部分学生比教害羞,上课时不爱发言,同时班级有一部分学生英语的基础比较薄弱。针对这种情况,在教学过程中开发课程资源,拓展教学渠道,利用多媒体教学,创设情景,激发兴趣,调动学生的学习热情,使不同的学生在课上都有所得。
二、教学目标
1、知识与技能:掌握本节课的生词及交际功能;提高学生的听、说能力。
2、过程与方法:教师引导和学生探究。
3、情感态度与价值观:要珍惜友谊,记得和老朋友保持联系。
三、重点、难点:
本节课的教学重点是熟练的掌握生词及短语的用法,培养学生听、说的能力。本节课的教学难点是听过对话后,能够抓住关键信息,并自由的交流或介绍一些朋友的情况。
四、教法与学法:
1、教学方法:
(1)以合作式学习及探究式学习为中心。通过丰富多彩的教学情景,不同的教学活动,使学生感知、体验、实践、参与。
(2)任务型教学。教学过程中,让学生通过完成任务而参与学习过程,而让学生形成运用英语的能力。
2、学法指导:
(1)提高学生自学、探究和合作学习的能力,側重听、说学习策略及语言技能的指导。课堂上要把掌握知识,形成技能,发展能力与培养学生个性健康发展有机结合起来,体现人文主义的教育,引导学生要会选择朋友,珍惜友谊,树立正确的世界观、人生观和价值观。
(2)注重过程评价。在评价中注重培养和激发学生学习语言应用的能力。用恰当的、合理的、充满激情的评价语言进行师生或生生评价,从而调动学生的积极性,培养学生学习的自信心,为学生指明努力方向。
3、教具:多媒体。
五、教学过程:
(一)导入 以 “趣”为切入点。
孔子说过,知之者不如好之者,好之者不如乐之者。当一个人对事物感兴趣时,他的大脑就会兴奋起来。亲切的问候后,学生看两张图片,一棵树和一片森林,问一问学生更喜欢哪一张及其原因。使学生联想到,一人不能独立生存在这个世界上,人人需要朋友。那什么才是朋友呢?通过师生间轻松的交流,使学生既初步了解本单元的话题,又顺利的进入了第一课的学习。
(二)热身活动,在探究中激活学生的思维。
谈论图片:教材在热身活动中,提供了三幅图片。为了增强学生参与意识,吸引学生的注意力,我把三幅图片扫描后,设置在了不同的幻灯片上。这一环节主要是在不同的情景中处理生词,了解图片内容,了解刘畅与他朋友的成长经历,为下一步听,克服障碍。
(三)语言应用,引导质疑,反馈听力能力。
经过热身活动,将教材的第二部分听力,作为了课堂上的反馈环节。首先是听录音,回答两个简单的问题,从整体上去理解听力材料;而后,再听对话,根据对话内容选出最佳答案完成各句,培养学生从听力材料中获取信息的能力,这里说明一下,教材在设置问题时,是分成两部分,比较分散,所以依据中考的题型,我对原有的教材内容的进行了改编;再听第三遍,根据所听内容写出所缺的单词,提高学生听音写词的能力。在大量的听的输入基础之上,让学生进行自读,领会对话的内容。最后小组活动,完成一个表格。这个表格的设计,主要是帮助学生巩固三个交际功能,同时提高他们的收集信息的能力。
(四)综合运用语言,生生互动探讨和体验。
通过了解刘畅和苏珊的老朋友,学生已能够熟练的表达自己和朋友间的故事。所以给学生提供充分的展示空间。通过小组表演对话,同学互访或亲自给朋友设计明信片并寄语的形式来表达自己的想法。对所学的内容进行延伸与拓展,使学生在活动中体验合作成功的快乐。
(五)自我评价和合作评价,增强参与意识。
评价可以调整学生的学习策略,增强学生的学习能力。因此在课的最后,向学生提供了一个评价表格。使学生及时的进行自我反思。
(六)作业的布置:写一篇作文,探讨一下,是否应该结交朋友。在语言的学习过程中,听和读是领会吸收的过程,说和写是表达和应用的过程,通过写,使学生的语言实践能力得到巩固和发展。
六、板书设计:
Unit 6 Silver and Gold Leon 1
Language to know:
A:sb mi sb
B:sb should do ---
C:Iwill do that.
英语微课件 篇4
小学五年级英语说课稿模板
“说课”是教学改革中涌现出来的新生事物,是进行教学研究、教学交流和教学探讨的一种新的教学研究形式,也是集体备课的进一步发展,而【说课稿】则是为进行说课准备的文稿,以下是小编整理的小学五年级英语说课稿模板,欢迎阅读!
各位老师,大家好!
让学生愉快地、充满自信地走进我的英语课堂,是我最大的愿望,让学生在我的英语课堂上享受快乐和成功是我孜孜以求的。多年来,我为实现自己的梦想和追求不懈地努力着,今天,借此平台,希望各位老师指导我的说课,使我更快的成长。
我说课的内容是PEP Book 4 Unit 5 B Let’s talk主要从教材分析、教学策略、教学程序 、板书设计、教学评价等方面作具体的阐述。
下面我先来说第一个板块——教材分析
第一环节——说教材
本单元的话题是shopping. 购物与我们的生活息息相关,本课的知识点是大部分学生乐于学习和接受的,相信他们对本课的学习充满期待。
第二环节——说教学目标
根据《英语课程标准》的教学理念,教材特点以及四年级学生的实际情况,将本课时的教学目标确定如下:
能够听、说、认读本课时的主要句型:A pair of …for… What size? How much are they? We’ll take them.
能够跟录音朗读对话,并能分角色进行表演。能够较好地完成Group work中的调查表格。
通过活动、游戏使学生产生学习英语的兴趣;让学生敢于、乐于开口,积极参与交流。并让学生在学习的过程中,培养他们的合作意识和竞争意识。
在仔细研究教材和分析学生的心理和生理特点的基础上,我认为本课重点是掌握有关购物的句型:如How about this pair? Are they nice? How much are they? They are yuan.等价格的复数表达法,难点是A pair of …for… 中for的含义;What size? size的发音;We’ll take them. them 的发音以及理解这句话的含义。
第二个板块——说教学策略
本课主要采用情景教学和交际功能法以及多媒体计算机辅助课堂教学,充分发挥教师的主导作用和学生的主体作用,利用现代教育技术优化教学过程,通过课件为学生创设更多生动活泼的语言环境,把学生吸引到活动中去,并激发他们主动参与学习的欲望内。努力培养学生的自学能力,把学习的钥匙交给学生,在传授知识的同时授以科学的思维方法。不仅要使学生学会,更要使学生学会学。因此,在课堂教学中巧妙运用教学艺术,适当安排自学、小组讨论、全班讨论、游戏、竞赛等活动,鼓励学生开口就说,提高运用语言的能力,变"讲堂"为"学堂",变"要我学"为"我要学",从而从根本上打破传统的课堂教学方法,建构一种新型的现代教育模式,使学生在更轻松更愉快的环境下实现更多的信息交流,真正做到快快乐乐学英语,扎扎实实打基础,向四十分钟要质量,向课堂教学要效益的最终目的。
第三个板块——说教学程序
遵循人类认识过程的普遍规律和学生认识活动的主要特点,我把教学过程分为以下几个环节:
导入设计、新课呈现、巩固操练、拓展延伸以及课后作业五个环节,教育家托尔斯泰说过:"成功的教学所必须的不是强制,而是激发学生的兴趣,兴趣是推动学生学习的强大动力,是学生参与教学活动的基础,激发学生的兴趣是新课导入的关键。""Well begun, half done"良好的开端是成功的一半。
第一环节 导入设计分三块:
①唱一唱本单元的歌曲"The coat in the window"(How much is that coat in the window? )一首优美的英文歌,全班同学在教师的带领下,边拍手边唱,营造良好的英语氛围,使学生能自然地进入到一个良好的学习状态中。
②Let’s do Put on your sneakers. Run in the park. Put on your sandals. Wiggle your toes. 通过TPR活动,让全班学生能够做起来,动起来。在复习旧知的基础上为新课的学习起到一个呈上起下的作用。
③Free talking:What’s the weather like today? 聊一聊天气,为后面创设明天开运动会,John需要一双新的运动鞋的情境埋下伏笔。同时也营造一种民主、和谐、宽松的英语氛围,为学生架设一座由中文思维向英文思维过渡的.桥梁。
第二环节 新课呈现分两部分:
① 利用课件,出示不同的鞋子,引出shoes shop.操练chant: sneakers , sneakers, a pair of sneakers , a pair of sneakers for my friend.
② 创设妈妈和John去鞋店买鞋的情境,教师扮演assistant,引出句型What size? How about this pair? Are they nice ? Are they all right?等等。
第三环节 巩固操练分五部分:
①玩一玩,鲁迅说过:"游戏是儿童的天使。"本节课我设计"我猜,我猜,我猜猜"的游戏来操练句型 How much are they? They are .
②说一说,利用教学卡
片,在黑板上制作一个简易的鞋子商店,操练句型Can I help you? How about this pair? We’ll take them等
③听一听,听课文录音,完成教师提问A: What size? B: How much are the sneakers? 让学生带着问题去听,养成良好的倾听习惯。
④读一读,我们都知道,磁带是最好的老师,让学生跟着磁带朗读课文,正确的语音语调的形成是学生学习英语的基础,因此教师要有意识地培养学生的模仿能力。
⑤演一演,利用头饰,分角色三人小组合作演一演本课对话,教师要鼓励学生进行大胆的表演。
第四环节拓展延伸分两部分:
①完成调查表格,了解班里同学鞋子的尺寸大小和价格。教师渗透文化知识:不同国家,不同鞋子大小的表达方式不同,如:美国常用6、8、9这样的数字,而我们和欧洲基本相同,用36、38、40这样的数字进行表达。
②活动:"自由市场"
5月14日母亲节快到了,给学生一定数目的钱,请他们为妈妈买一样最需要的礼物,让学生学会理性购买,通过在"自由市场"内学生之间的买卖活动,充分发挥学生的创造性思维,让学生学以致用;通过讨价还价,发展学生当家理财的经济头脑和对生活的适应能力。
第五环节 课后作业也是两部分:
①了解家里人的鞋子尺码并了解市场上不同规格,不同种类鞋的价格。
②根据询问同学的衣物和鞋子,了解班里同学的消费水平,小组之间合作完成此项任务。
第四个板块——说教学板书
PEP Book 4 Unit 5 How much is it?
B Let’s talk
How about this pair? Are they nice?
How much are they?
They are yuan.
第五个板块——说教学评价
综观整节课,为了达到新课标所要求的小学英语课程的要求, 我主要通过创设教学情景进行师生互动,充分激发学生学习英语的兴趣,培养英语学习的积极态度,把情感、态度与价值观目标的实现融合在知识与能力、过程与方法目标实现的过程之中,努力为学生进一步学习英语打下坚实基础。
苏霍姆林斯基说过:没有也不可能有抽象的学生。因此,我们要鼓励孩子们,让他们知道"English, I can".
That’s all. Thank you!
英语微课件 篇5
一、单元分析
1、教材的地位及作用:
Unit4Where’smybackpack?本单元的主题为谈论物品的位置,使学生在熟悉物品名称的基础上用方位介词熟练地表达物品的位置,并能 where问句及一般疑问句提问并回答,并自然地引出名词的单复数及人称代词they的用法.本单元谈论的是学生比较熟悉的内容,学生有认同感,因此在任务的设计上,要贴近学生真实生活,包括学校生活、家庭生活等任务,以引起学生的共鸣和兴趣,激发学生的求知欲,充分发挥学生的想象力和能动性,主动自觉地融入到语言学习中去。
2、教学目标
1)Knowledgeobjectives:
(1)Sscanread,writeandmasterthewordsaboutfurnitureandschoolthings.
(2)Sscanusetheprepositions:in,on,under
(3)Sscantalkaboutwherethethingsare.
2)Abilityobjectives:
Sscantalkaboutwherethethingsare.
3)Moralobjectives:
Sswilllearntokeeptheirroomscleanandtidy.
3、重点和难点:
Importantpoints:
1)掌握方位介词in,on,under,behind的用法;
2)掌握where引导的特殊疑问句。
Difficultpoints:
1)能够准确运用方位介词描述物品所在的位置;
2)能够运用where问句找到物品位置;
3)区别特殊疑问句和一般疑问句。
4、教学突破:
通过使用方位介词“on/in/under”表达物品的位置及学习“Where……?和Yes/No”疑问句的用法,使学生学会区别特殊疑问句和一般疑问句。
二、说教法和学法
在整个教学过程中,我把SectionA的内容进行变化和整合,将其分解到精心设计的一系列任务中,通过让学生自己完成任务来学习知识,掌握技能。这对于培养学生分析、解决问题的能力,激发和维持学生的学习积极性等有着独特的优势,我所要求学生掌握的内容都是通过一个个任务来完成,由易到难,由简到繁,让学生在积极参与完成任务的过程中学到知识。
在整个教学过程中我采用了情景教学法,多媒体辅助教学法、合作学习法、任务教学法等方法进行教学,以兴趣吸引人,以情感培育人,以评价激励人,以活动促进人。通过实物、多媒体等创设富有生活气息的语言情境,让每一个学生参与听、说、读、猜等各种丰富多彩的学习活动,激发学生的学习兴趣。将学习与游戏有机结合,使学生陶醉在轻松、活泼、有趣的课堂活动中,让学生“在玩中学,在学中玩”,循序渐进地、积极主动地去感知、体验和参与合作,形成综合运用语言进行交际的能力。通过听说读写的基本训练,使同学们在轻松愉快的学习氛围中掌握和巩固知识,真正做到寓教于乐。
三、教学程序设计
根据初一学生身心发展的特点及实际情况,我在教学中采用了五个环节:问候--呈现--任务型活动--小结--布置作业。
(一)、问候
通过互相问候增强彼此的感情。
(二)呈现
创设情境,导入新课。
1、讲授单词。采用多媒体展示家具的图片,让学生边看边学单词,这样做更直观、形象、印象深刻。
2、采用直观教学介词in,on,under。通过不断的变换实物方位来形象直观的引出三个介词。
3、呈现出本课的重点句型。
(三)任务活动
1、Pairwork:
活动目的:熟练掌握所学的重点句型及方位介词的用法。使学生学会互帮互助,学会合作交流。
活动过程:用幻灯片出示图片让同桌之间会话。
2、Havealistening:
活动目的:准确排出单词的序号,让学生学会捕捉信息词和关键词,培养学生听力能力。
活动过程:创设情境听对话,运用听关键词和推测词意进行小组竞赛抢答。
3、Playaguessinggame:
活动目的:通过猜物品的位置所在来巩固前面所学过的重点句型。采取竞赛的形式寓教于乐,不仅让学生全神贯注,又能调学生的学习热情。
活动过程:投影出实物让学生猜它可能在哪里。教师提问:Whereis/are-----?学生以小组为单位进行讨论,并选派代表来猜:Isit/Arethey-----?猜对最多的小组获胜。
(四)小结。让学生自己谈收获(知道了什么,学会了什么,发现了什么)
(五)作业。
总之,这节课我尽量体现“以人为本,以学生为主体,以教师为主导”的现代教育新理念,主要运用“任务型”的教学模式,采用灵活多样的教学形式,使学生能愉快地、积极地、高效地对新学语言进行感知、体验、学习和运用,努力使这节课具有交际性、实用性、趣味性和科学性。
英语优秀课件
您需要什么主题的内容栏目小编为您准备了一份“英语优秀课件”。教案课件是老师教学工作的起始环节,每个老师都需要细心筹备教案课件。教案是课堂教学成效的保障之一。愿您在阅读本网站的同时还能获得些有用的信息和帮助!
英语优秀课件(篇1)
一、教学目标:
(一)、知识:
1. 掌握下列四会词汇:back, happen, help, walk
听、说、认读单词:truly, miss
复习下列词汇:picture, write , fly
2. 灵活应用的句型:
I had a great time with you in Beijing.
The photo of the panda is for Danny.
Please write back soon.
I wanted to fly a kite.
I hurt my arm and Jenny helped me.
What did you do ? I went to the zoo.
(二)能力目标:
能用英语书写电子邮件.
(三)、情感:
提高学生的语言表达能力,培养学生学习英语的兴趣.
二、教学重点、难点:
重点:要求掌握的四会词汇和书写电子邮件.
难点:能用英语书写电子邮件并使用一般过去时.
三、教具、学具:
图片、电脑、录音机
四、教学设计:
Step1 Warming up
1.利用单词卡片复习单词.
2.游戏: 找学生表演动作, 学生猜动词或者动词短语.
Step2 Leading in
1.提出问题:
Where did Li Ming take the pictures ?
Did Li Ming have a good time in Beijing?
Which picture is for Danny?
2.小组内的学生进行问答.
3. 复习巩固一般过去时的构成和用法。
设计意图:提出问题,引发学生思考, 利用教材知识结构,在复习旧知识的基础上,引出新知识,以加强知识结构的前后联系。
Step3 Presentation
1. 听录音, 做习题:
Can Danny fly kites very well?
2. 听录音,连线:
Place Jenny
Tings happened to Danny At Tian’anmen Square
People who helped Danny He hurt his arm
3. 检查答案.
设计意图: 让学生带着问题去听、去想、去讨论,充分体现以学生为中心的教学理念。
4. Play the tape ,Ss read after the tape .
5. 小组讨论各图片中的内容.词汇: pictures ,time ,panda, tail, write.
6. 完成65页Listen and repeat.
设计意图:在了解李明的电子邮件内容的前提下,加强说和读的能力,巩固新知识,达到全方位训练的目的.
Step4 Consolidation and extension
1. Read Part3.提出问题:
What did you do ?
2. 讨论他们谈话的内容。
设计意图: 在练习的基础上, 对李明的电子邮件内容进行介绍,然后联系实际,找出其中的主要句式,使所学知识得到灵活运用.
3. 学生在老师的指导下进行本课的小结.
英语优秀课件(篇2)
unit 1 How do you study for a test?
一、 教学目标
1、语言目标
1)询问别人的学习方法
2)学习讨论各种学习方法和策略,学会评价各种学习方法的优劣
2、知识目标1)How do you study for a test?
I study by ving .
2) the way to do sththe way of doing sth
have trouble doing sth 的用法
3、能力目标
1)通过讨论找到适合自己的学习方法,找出自己在英语学习中的困难
2)学会给出关于学习方法的建议
二、 重点知识
1、重点单词
flashcard vocabulary aloud pronunciation memorize grammar frustrating quickly spoken pronounce mistakes challenge solution realize matter afraid complete impress trouble soft deal unless regard influence friendship development face
基本要求:会读、会写、会用。
2、重点短语
make mistakes be afraid to do sth laugh at enjoy doing sth
the way to do sth have trouble doing sthend up
spoken English practice doing sth too much look up
make vocabulary liststry one`s best to do sth
基本要求: 会读、会写、会用。
3、重点语法
1)How 引起的特殊疑问句及其回答
2)the way to do sth the way of doing sth
have trouble doing sth 的用法
基本要求:理解其含义,学以致用。
三、导学案
Section A
● 例析导学
1、 They also have fun。
fun n. 乐趣 ,玩笑
【拓展】
1)have fun 意为―过的快活‖相当于enjoy oneself have a good time
例如:You are sure to have fun at the party 。
2)have fun doing sth 意为―开开心心做谋事‖
例如: The children are having fun playing this game .
类似的结构还有have trouble /problems experience doing sth
2、…and then end up speaking in Chinese .
end up 结束,后接动词的v-ing形式
end up with 以……结束,以……而告终
例如: The game ended up with a song.
【拓展】 end 作名词
1.端,尖,末端,终点 例如: the end of the year
2.边缘;极点,极限例如:the end of the road
3.结局,结果。例如:the end of the story
3、……joining the English club at school was the best way to improve her English . the best way to do sth 做谋事的最好方法
【拓展】 1)way 方式 , 方法 有两种用法the way to do sth
the way of doing sth
例如: This is the best way to solve the problem. 或 This is the best way of solving the problem.
2)way 道路 the way to sw eg. on one‘s way to 其中to 是介词后面跟表示地点的名词做宾语 例如: He got lost and couldn‘t find his way home.
4、Do you ever practice conversations with your friends ?
1) ever adv. 曾经
【拓展】一般用于疑问句,否定句中,表示频率。类似的词还有always ,usually ,often ,sometimes ,hardly ,ever ,never,用在行为动词之前,助动词之后。
2)practice n。& v. 练习,实习,实践,
practice doing sth. 练习干某事
例如:He practices running every morning .
5、I‘ve learned a lot that way .
a lot 很多,非常
【拓展】1)在句中做主语例如:A lot has been done about it .
2) 在句中做宾语 例如: You have done a lot for him .
3) 在句中做状语 ,且可修饰比较级
例如: He feels a lot better today .
4)a lot of 或 lots of 可修饰不可数名词和可数名词复数
例如:There are lots of differences between them.
6、She added that having conversations with friends was not helpful at all .
add v. 增加 ,补充说 , 继续说
【拓展】 1) add sth to sth. 添加 ,增加
例如: If you add five to nine ,you will get fourteen .
2)add up to 总计 例如: These numbers add up to 177 .
● 专项练习 选择填空
1. The boys are going to have fun ____the picture.
A. drawB. to drawC drew D drawing
2.I am sorry I took your umbrella _____ .
A. because mistake B.with mistake c.by mistake d.by mistakes
3.Can‘t you see Tom and Jim _____football?
A.playingB. playC.to play D. played
4. My English teacher was very angry ______Tom .
A. atB.about c.withD.on
5.His mother is strict _____.
A.with himB.with he C.in himD.in he
6. When we practice English speaking ,we shouldn‘t end up ____in Chinese .
A. speak B. speaking C. to speaking D. with speak
7. Let‘s go swimming if it ____hot tomorrow.
A. will be B. would be C. is D. is going to be
8. Taiwan is ____the est of China and _____the west of Fujian province .
A.in;toB.to ;toC. on; toD. in; to
●句析导学
1. How do you study for a test? I study by listening to tapes.你怎样学习,准备应考?通过听录音。
How是用来提问―怎么,怎样‖的疑问词,引导一个特殊疑问句,经常用by加动词的Ving形式, 表示―通过……方式,方法‖或―借助某种手段‖
例如: How do you usually go to school ? I go to school by bus。
He makes a living by working on the farm。
2.What about listening to tapes? 听录音怎么样?
What about …?相当于How about…?后面可跟名词、代词或动词Ving形式。常用来提
出建议,征求意见或询问情况。相类似句子有Why not +v…?Let?s +v .Shall we +v ? You‘d better +v.
What abou /How about going boating with us ?
3.It‘s too hard to understand the voices .语音难以理解。
too +adj /adv +to do 表示‖太……而不能……‖,句中it是形式主语,真正主语是动词不定式。可与so…that 和enough…to do sth 改写.
例如: It‘s too heavy for me to caryy the box.
It isn‘t light enough for me to carry the box.
It‘s so heavy that I can‘t carry the box.
4、…he finds watching movies frustrating because the people speak too quickly . watching movies 动名词做宾语,frustrating 形容词做宾语补足语
find +宾语+形容词 发现……例如: He finds English interesting.
不定式做宾语时,用find it adj.for sb. to do sth
He found it difficult to pass the exam.
● 专项练习
1. Let the students make conversations about their own way of learning English, and how long he or she used it ,how he or she learns from it.
2. Let the students ask and answer in pairs according to the learning way of 3a. Talk about their ways of learning English.
英语优秀课件(篇3)
活动目标:
1.学习单词:“bunny”和句型“pass the bunny”。并理解其含义。
2.能基本听懂并按规则游戏。
3.愿意在集体面前表演。
活动准备:
1.教师身穿一个大口袋的上衣(内装各种水果模型:苹果,橘子,葡萄,梨子,香蕉,桃子菠萝,西瓜和各类汽车模型:小汽车,卡车。公共汽车,出租车)
活动过程:
1.T:Good morning boys and girls .
C:Good morning teacher .
T:Do you want to dance ?
T:Ok, let’s dance, please listen .
2.T:(教师做很累的动作)Oh, I’m tired. Are you tied ?
T:Ok. Please find a chair and sit down .
二.学习单词“bunny”
1.T:Today, here comes a new friend.(出示绒毛玩具小兔)Look,what is this ?
T:(教师模仿小兔与幼儿打招呼)Hello/Hi/children
T:Now, Let’s play the game “I say you do “, Ok?
T:Kiss bunny(教师边说边示范动作,引导幼儿按照指令动作)
Who can try ?Touch /shakehands /embrace /Kiss the bunny (Very good /You are
T:Now please say and fllow me .Pass the bunny (教师做出传递的动作,边示范边讲解)
T:Pass the bunny and say it one by one. Do you understand?
三、以击鼓传花的形式玩击鼓传小兔的游戏。
1、介绍游戏玩法及规则。
T:(教师拍拍大口袋)I have something inside . (出示玩具小兔)I also have a bunny .(拿出鼓) Here’s
a drum .Now ,Let’s play the game “Pass the bunny” .
T:I’ll beat the drum (击鼓),and you’ll pass the bunny one to one .(示范给幼儿看)
When I stop you should stop .The child who has the bunny should take one of them
from the pocket. Are you clear?(可以先试着玩一次,老师在解释一下)
2、引导幼儿玩游戏。
T:Now , Let’s begin .(教师击鼓声起,幼儿传小兔到鼓声停)
Stop.Let’s see who has the bunny.
C; -.
T:Well ,-,come here and take one out.(-从口袋里摸出一样)
T:what is this ? /what colour is it ?Do you want to eat? Oh ,you are very
good/give a little clap.Now Let’go on .
(鼓声起,由刚才摸的幼儿继续向下传小兔,到鼓声停)Stop .Let’s see who has the bunny……
T:I’m so happy ! Are you happy ?
T::It’s later now , Let’s play next time . Let’s go .(音乐起,师生跳着兔子舞出去)
英语优秀课件(篇4)
教学目标:
1.学会问价钱。
2.学会最基本的卖东西用语,并会买东西。
3.继续学习可数名词与不可数名词的用法。
教学用具:
录音机,实物投影仪,图片或实物等。
教学步骤:
Step 1 Revision
值日生Duty Report
让值日生Duty Report加上买东西的内容。 如句型:I want to buy a bag of milk, some bread and two eggs for my tomorrow’s breakfast on my way home. My mother want to buy four potatoes, two kilos of fish, tow kilos of apples, 1 kilo of chicken legs.
让值日生随意拿起某同学的物品,问:How much is your pen, please? 答:Maybe it’s … 问:How much are two pencils, please? 答:They’re …
Step 2 Presentation
引出今日新课:How much is …, please? How much are …, please? 教问价钱:how much … 教句型:How much is the…,please? How much are the …., please?
老师可问一些同学们知道价钱的物品。如:方便面,袋牛奶,可乐等。练习回答:It’s …yuan a bag / a bottle / kilo. They are …yuan a kilo.
将书上的114课第一部分的图用投影仪打出,就图提问。练习课文的第一部分和第二部分。可采取全班回答,小组回答,同桌回答等形式。练熟为止。
Step 3 practice
练习1:
随意取些同学们书桌上的物品放在讲台上,提问同学。
可参考以下对话:
A: This is a shop near our school. What things does the shop sell?
B: Let me see. It sells pens, pencils, pencil-boxes, pencil-sharpeners…
A: Does it sell bread / cakes / bottles milk…in the shop?
B: Yes, it does. / No, it doesn’t.
A: How much is it / are they? Do you know?
教单词:tomato, onion, carrot
练习2:
在投影片上画一商店,列出一张价目表。
可参考以下对话:
A: Which shop sells bread / milk / cakes / tomatoes / onion / carrot?
B: The shop next to our school.
A: Would you like to go with me?
B: Certainly.
教单词:cheap, expensive,
cheap: not expensive expensive: not cheap
练习3:
In the shop
A: Do you have tomatoes here?
B: Yes, we do.
A: How much are they?
B: They are ten yuan a kilo.
A: They are too expensive. What about that shop? Let’s have a look.
A: OK.
In the another shop
A: I want to buy some tomatoes. How much are they?
B: They are five yuan a kilo. How many do you want?
A: They are cheap. I want three.
B: Here you are.
A: Here is the money. Bye!
B: Bye!
Step 4 Read and practice
利用以上的所有道具练习第三部分对话。注意:分别用上:How much is it? How much are they?
Step 5 Consolidation
学生们可自由编对话。但老师要控制。可给帮助学生们设计几个情景。(参看教参P124)
Step 6
Workbook
Homework
Blackboard Handwriting
Unit 29 Shopping
参考词
New Words: how much, cheap, expensive tomato
Useful expressionsonion
How much is it? It is …yuan a bag / bottle / kilo?carrot
How much are they? They are …a kilo.
How many / How much do you want?
英语优秀课件(篇5)
教学目标
To help students learn to express attitudes, agreement & disagreement and certainty
To help students learn to read the text and learn to write diaries in English
To help students better understand “friendship”
To help students learn to understand and use some important words and expressions
To help students identify examples of Direct Speech & Indirect Speech (I): statements and questions in the text
教学重难点
Words
upset, ignore, calm, concern, settle, suffer, recover, pack
Expressions
add up, calm down, have got to, be concerned about, go through, set down, a series of, on purpose, in order to, at dusk, face to facer, no longer/ not …any longer, suffer from, get/ be tired of, pack (sth.) up, get along with, fall in love, join in
Patterns
“I don’t want to set down a series of facts in a diary as most people do,” said Anne. →Anne said that she didn’t want to set down a series of facts in a diary as most people do.
I stayed awake on purpose until half past eleven…
…it was the first time in a year and a half that I’d seen the night face to face…
教学工具
ppt
教学过程
Hello, everyone. I’m so glad to be your teacher of English. I’d like to make friends with you, to build up a close friendship with you. Today we shall take Unit 1. The topic of this unit is Friendship. What do you think friendship is?
1. Warming up
⑴ Warming up by defining friendship
Hello, everyone. I’m so glad to be your teacher of English. I’d like to make friends with you, to build up a close friendship with you. Today we shall take Unit 1. The topic of this unit is Friendship. What do you think friendship is?
Yeah, there are many explanations about friendship. However, friendship is a relationship that can’t be restricted(限制)by definition(定义). It can only be experienced. True friendship can exist between any two souls, be it between people or animals. It can happen at any moment, to anyone. Even to lifeless things, like a diary, a ball, a friendship can happen.
Then what is your opinion about friendship?
Do you think that friendship is important to our life? Why?
⑵Warming up by learning to solve problems
Nice to meet you, class. We shall be friends from now on. For everybody needs friends. But being a good friend can sometimes be hard work. Learning how to solve problems in a friendship can make you a better friend and a happier person. Discuss the situation below and try to solve the problems wisely.
Common problems among teenagers
Solution
Some of the common problems include forgetting friends’ birthday, not keeping promises, letting out friends’ secrets and so on.
Maybe we can have a heart-to-heart talk with our friends to ask for forgiveness.
Situation 1: Friends get angry with each other when they try to talk about something difficult.
Try to understand your friend/ Try to talk about the problem in a different way.
Situation 2: Friends don’t know how to apologize
Start by telling each other that you are sorry. A simple apology is often enough and is a good starting point.
Situation 3: Some friends don’t know how to keep secrets.
Keep your secrets to yourself
Tips on being a good friend
Treat your friends the way you want to be treated. Keep secrets that are told to you.
Pay attention when your friend is talking. Keep your promises. Share things with your friend. Tell your friend the truth. Stick up for your friend.
⑶Warming up by doing a survey
Good morning, class. I am your teacher of English. Glad to be here with you. Today we shall take Unit 1 Friendship.
To be frankly, I’d like very much to keep a close friendship with you, my dear students, in the following years. How about you then? Ok, thanks. I do hope to be your good teacher as well as your helpful friend (良师益友).
Now please do the survey on page one.
Add up your score according to the scoring sheet on page 8. You don’t have to tell your results. You can just keep it a secret.
人教版英语课件
老师的工作之一是编写教案和课件,但是这并不意味着任意编写就可以。教案是实现有效教育的重要工具,那么有哪些值得参考的教案和课件呢?现在教师范文大全的编辑为您带来的是“人教版英语课件”,请务必将此页收藏起来,以免错过有用的信息!
人教版英语课件 篇1
1. In the cave the two brothers discovered______.
A. a secret art museum B. strange-looking animals
C. nothing but paintings D. lots of paintings and carving
2. After they decided to say the night in the cave, they_____.
A. talked about the discovery B. danced excitedly
C. didn’t feel sad at all D. collected enough food
3. The two brothers thought that it looked as if they had stepped into a secret art museum because______.
A. there was a wall of painted animals in the cave
B. there were so many paintings and carvings on the rock
C. they were examining the pictures like visitors to a museum
D. the cave was like an art museum which only the two boys knew
4. Which of the following statements is NOT correct about the writer’s feelings?
A. He was excited because he wanted to tell about the discovery.
B. He felt sad because he couldn’t tell his family they were safe.
C. He was proud they discovered something of great value.
D. He felt disappointed because the cave would become very noisy the next day.
5. Why did the writer think that they were in a better position than their grandparents?
A. Because they were safe and had made a great discovery.
B. Because their grandparents did not know what was happening to them.
C. Their grandparents were very worried, but in fact they were safe.
D. Because they had discovered such extraordinary paintings in the cave.
1. How did the boys feel when they saw the shapes on the rock?
2. What did the writer do then?
3. What astonished them?
4. Why did they stay the night in the cave?
5. Why did the writer feel excited? And why did he feel sad at the same time?
6. Why did the writer want that moment to continue for ever?
7. What did the two boys imagine would happen?
8. What did they wonder about?
9. How old were those carvings and paintings?
10. What was the headline in the newspaper?
1. I got the radio____ again by twiddling(缠绕)with some wires.
A. to work B. working B. worked C. work
2. Many American women are choosing single life or_____ later in life. They are more independent than women______.
A. get married; used to B. Getting married; used to be
C. marrying; used to D. getting marry; used to be
3. I made a great ______in a second-hand bookshop yesterday and got many old books I had wanted for long.
A. discovery B. find C. looking for D. research
4.When the novel Harry Potter ______, it topped best-seller lists for many months.
A. came across B. printed C. came out D. published
5. Many plant species________ by humans and becoming extinct(灭绝).
C. is destroyed D. are being destroyed
6. The Guinness Book of Records is a reference book that______ all types of records about the world and its inhabitants(居住者).
A. covers B. writes C. obtains D. holds
7. Thin oxygen, strong winds, and awfully cold temperatures make_____
impossible for any animal or plant life to exist on the mountain.
8. Centuries ago, women in Europe ______wear wooden or metal corsets (紧身内衣) to give them thin waists.
A. use to B. used to C. are used to D. were used to
9. Red, often used in fast food restaurants, makes us feel active, _____after we have eaten, we want to get up quickly and leave, thus ____space for more customers.
A. so that; making B. so that; to make
C. however; making D. in case; make
10.In Germany, for instance, ____ there are now very few wolves, a campaign has started to protect wolves.
A. which B. where C. that D. when
11. The successfully man talked about the difficulty ____he managed to collect enough money to start his first company.
A. which B. with which C. with it D. in which
12. _____weather it is, we shall start tomorrow; and I cannot wait any longer.
A. No matter B. What C. Whatever D. Even though
13. ----Have you repaired my watch yet?
----Not yet, but I _____it by 11 am.
A. am repairing B. have repaired
C. will have repaired D. have been repaired
14. It looks as if the rain will continue for some time, but it may____ before dark.
A. turn out B. turn up C. come out D. clear up
15. From 1920 to 1950 many attempts to climb Mount Everest failed _____ the cold and dry air, fierce winds, _____ difficult terrain, and high altitude.
A. as a result B. because of C. so that D. that’s why
eg.Tom was very quiet this morning.
It’s bad manners tokeep silent when the teacher asks you a question.
He stood there still.
The sea is calm now,but it can also be rough sometimes.
He tried tobe calm,but couldn’t.
2)with+n.+doing/done/to do/adj./adv./prep phrase
eg.With the house burnt,he had nowhere to stay.
He can’t fall asleep with the light on.
With the man leading the way,I found the way easily.
With a report tofinish,he had tostay up until midnight.
He can’t be engaged in the work with such a loud noise outside.
eg.The weather has cleared up.
Her face cleared up as she read the letter.
When you finish your meal,please clear up=fix up the kitchen.
The book has cleared up=solved many problems for me.
They have cleared up the misunderstanding between them.
on one’s way;in the way;by the way;by way of
eg.I’m writing a report;don’t be in the way.
He went to Beijing by way of Shanghai.
feel/fight/make/wind/find one’s way
eg.It’s so dark in the cinema that we had to feel our way.
After school,the students made their way=headed for home.
eg.He dog has a keen ~ of smell.
This word has many ~s.
a ~of pleasure/humor/duty/beauty/safety/justice
There is no ~ in doing that.
in a sense/make sense/make sense of
eg.What you say is true in a ~=in some/a way=to some extent.
What you said at the meeting made no ~.
Can youmake ~ of this poem?
in a word=as a rule=on the whole/in words/with these words/by word of mouth/leave word/break one’s word/eat one’s words/waste one’s words/have a word with/have words with=quarrel with
人教版英语课件 篇2
一、教法建议
1. 目的与要求
这是一篇说明文。通过教学的每个环节实现以下三个目的:
(1)了解有关the USA , New York的一般情况,如:人口,历史,政府以及the bison等
(2)帮助学生学习掌握本单元的重点词汇和短语;
(3)在帮助学生提高阅读能力的同时,帮助指导学生如何运用英语介绍某一地区(城市或国家)的能力并能缩写课文(100-150 words ).
本单元的能力目标:
a.理解课文大意,能回答有关问题;
b.能复述课文;
c.将课文改写成100-150 words短文;
(以上能力目标,a. 三会, b. 二会,c.一会。)
2. 本单元重点知识:
(1)单词和词组:tear v. turn v. rot vi. shoot n.
tear down ,turn away ,have an effect on
take the possession of ,a handful of ,give in ,
make an agreement with ,have trouble with ,
now that ,
(2)呈现与训练:
① tear : to break by pulling apart 撕开,撕裂
tear down :to destroy a building 拆毁(建筑)
Paper tears easily . 纸容易撕破。
She tore the table cloth in half . 她把那块桌布撕成两块。
The boy tore the letter open . 把…撕开
He tore the picture into pieces . 把…撕成碎片
John torn up his test paper so that his mother wouldn’t see his low grade . 撕碎
They tore the old building down in order to build a new one . 拆毁
② turn v. or link v.
turn是一个常用词,可以构成许多词组。如:
turn on / off / up /down (用于电流水的)
开 / 关 / 开大 / 开小
turn up : appear
The pop star didn’t turn up at the party . 出场
turn away (本单元为”to refuse to admit “)
从……赶走;拒绝(某人进入)(本义为“把……转开”)
The hotel porter turned away anybody who wasn’t wearing a collar and tie . 拒绝……进入
He turned up his coat collar to keep out the wind . 翻起
She turned away in horror at the sight of so much blood. 转身不看
I turned in bed all night ,I couldn’t sleep because of the heat . 辗转反侧
She turned the car into a narrow street (onto the highroad ). ……开进一条狭小街道(开上高速公路)
I found that the milk had turned sour . 变酸(link v. )
The young soldier didn’t turn against his country ,instead he gave his life to his country . 背叛
Mary picked up a wallet on her way home and she turned it in to the teacher the next morning . 上交
The thief was turned over to the police. 移交
He is a good man you can turn to for help . 求助
这类词和词组很多,要学会读懂上下文的内容,准确理解,找到一个词组的本义,转义和喻义,这对扩大词汇量和提高阅读能力很有好处。
③ rot vi. : go bad corrupt 烂,腐败;Vt. 使……烂
Some apples rotted on the tree .
The wood of the stairs has rotted away in pieces .
④ shoot n. 幼芽,幼枝;
shoot vi. vt. 开枪,射中;
(shot作名词是“开枪,枪声”的意思)
There are a lot of new shoots on the tree .
The old man heard two shots walking through the woods.
The soldier fired a shot . ……开了一枪
The man shot at the bird ,but he didn’t shoot it .
那个人向着鸟开枪,但是没有射中
⑤ have an effect on 对……产生影响
Punishment will have a bad , but not a good effect on a child who does something wrong .
⑥ take the possession of 占有;夺取
⑦ a handful of 少量的
⑧ give in 屈服,让步
⑨ make an agreement with 与……达成协议
⑩ have trouble with 因苦恼;同……有矛盾
now that 既然
3. 本单元应掌握的难点知识:
(1)常见的主语形式:
一般说来,英语句子中的主语形式常见的有以下八种:
A bison is a large animal found on the American plains .(名词)
This is the room Mr Lu Sun once lived in .(代词)
She is a quick girl .(人称代词)
The old are taken good care for in their own family . (形容词)
Two times five is ten .(数词)
Fishing is interesting . (动名词)
To save money now is impossible to us students .(不定式短语)
What surprised me most was that it seemed to be a few days before a new house was set up . (主语从句)
以上有关主语八种形式需要在阅读和练习中熟记并掌握。
(2)主语和谓语的一致性问题
主语和谓语的一致性问题是大多数学生学习英语时遇到的最大的困难之一。一个句子中的谓语动词必须与这个句子中的主语人称,数的形式保持一致关系。例如,句子中的主语是单数形式,其谓语动词用单数形式。这种主谓一致的划分归纳起来有以下八种。
① 由and连接的名词作主语时
a. 如果由and连接的两个名词(不同概念)作主语时,谓语动词要用复数形式。如:
Tom and Jack live in Room 305.
Both you and I are to be sent to Tibet.
What he said and what he did agreed with each other.
b. 当and连接的两个名词指同一个人、同一件事或一概念,这时and后面的名词前没有冠词,其谓语动词用单数形式(这里and相当于as well as )。如:
The singer and composer is coming to our school .
那位歌唱家兼作曲家将来我们学校。
Bread and butter is often served for breakfast in our dining hall .
(比较:The boy and the girl were given a book each .每个同学都分得一本书。其中 “each”是同位语,句中主语为复数。)
我们食堂早点经常供应奶油面包。
常见的由and连接的两个名词指由一个概念的形式有:the needle and thread针线,salt and water盐水,the or and knife刀叉,soap and water肥皂水,iron and steel钢铁等。
C. 由and连接的两个并列主语为单数概念。主语前面分别由each , every ,no等词来修饰时,其谓语动词为单数形式。
Each doctor and each nurse was sent for .
把所有的医生和护士都清来了。
Every boy and every girl is able to go to school in that village .
在那个村子里所有的孩子们都能上学。
注意:more than one和many a 修饰的单数名词后面的谓语用单数形式,但其意义是复数。
如:
More than one student is fond of folk- music .
许多学生喜欢民间音乐。
Many a boy enjoys playing foot-ball .
许多男同学喜欢踢足球。
② 当主语后面接说明主语的修饰词或插入语时,谓语动词的数不受修饰成份的影响,仍同主语的关系一致。
这些修饰成分常见的有:with, along with , togeth whit (和…一起);as well as (还) ;like (像);no less than (不亚于);rather than (而不是);more than(多于);as much as (如…一般多);but ,except(除了……);besides (除了……还……);including包括;in addition to(另外)等引导的一个修饰结构,放在主语后面。如:
The old man , along with his two grandsons, often have a walk in the evening .
Jenny , as well as her friends , is going abroad .
The house ,including the garden and the garage ,was sold out .
③ 当集合名词作主语时
根据句子内容,谓语动词可以是单数也可以是复数形式。在这一用法中,要注意正确判断主语是“整体”概念,还是“个体”概念。
如:# The whole nation regard Premier Zhou Enlai as one of the greatest leaders .
(句中 “nation” 表示“全国人民”谓语用复数)。
注: 集合名词作主语时,谓语动词用单数还是复数,取决于它强调的内容,如果一个名词作为一个整体看待,谓语动词用单数形式,表示“全体一致的行动”或者“群体关系”;当谓语动词表示“身份”、“情感”或强调“每个成员”时,用复数形式。如:
The audience was in good order .
观众保持良好的秩序。(指整体状态)
The audience were greatly encouraged .
观众们深受鼓舞。(指具体的人)
常用的集合名词有:group ,class ,team ,family ,nation ,army ,crowd ,audience ,public, government , majority(大多数)等。
有些集合名词如people、cattle(牛群)等在任何情况下都与谓语动词的复数形式搭配。
④ 就近原则
以连词or either…or neither…nor not only…but also…连接的名词或代词作主语时,谓语动词与其相邻的那个名词的数一致。
如: # Among the boys ,one or two are able to jump 1.6 metres .
在这些同学中,一二个人能跳过1.6米。
⑤ 以 “某些不定代词或表示数量的词 + of + 名词”的结构,谓语形式要与of 后的名词保持一致。
常见的这类词有:all , some , a lot , plenty , any , part ,the rest ,one-third percent + of
如: 70 percent of the surface is covered with water .
70 percent of the farmers have impoved their living conditions .
⑥ 有些不定代词或表示数字的名词修饰的名词或词组作主语时,句中谓语动词用复数。这类词组常用的有:few (of ) , a few , both , both of ,a number of + 复数名词+谓语动词(复数)
如: # Few of the students were in the classroom yesterday , for it was Sunday .
昨天教室里没有几个人,因为是星期日。
[注]:在 “ a number of + 名词(复数)” 结构中,“复数名词”是中心词,“a number of ”作定语,谓语用复数形式;而在 “ the number of + 名词(复数)” 结构中, “the number “是“中心词”,谓语动词用单数形式。如:
A number of questions were always asked when the manager got to his office .
The number of the students in this school is 1,560.
[注] 当 “the number”.表示“…数量或号码”时,谓语动词用单数。如:
The number of the key is 207.
⑦ “the + 形容词(分词或数词)” 结构起名词作用时
如果这个结构表示的是一类人,谓语动词用复数形式;如果这个结构表示抽象概念(或具体的某一个人),谓语用单数形式。如:
The young are able to create their own future.
There was an old lady and a young girl in the park . The young was the daughter of the old .
The wounded were taken to hospital without delay .
⑧ 表示重量、距离、金钱,一段时间及由one and a half修饰的复数名词作主语时,谓语动词用单数形式。如:
Twenty dollars isn’t enough to buy the book .
Ten miles isn’t far .
Five times six is thirty.
One and a half apples was left on the plate .
二、学海导航
如何培养和提高作答单项填空题的能力。
单项填空题主要考查中学阶段所学词法和句法中常见的语言内容,试题具有信息量大,综合性强,突出语言的交际能力等特点。回答单项填空题,不能单纯从语法规则入手,而是要求考生必须从题干提供的语言环境出发,综合所学的语言语法知识正确判断。建议参考以下三个步骤:
1.认真阅读提纲,了解大意;
2.根据句中所缺部分和四个选项的概念和形式,判断考查什么;
3.从提纲的内容和选项的形式两个方面进行匹配,达到内容和形式的统一。如:
________want to work in Xinjiang after graduation.
A. Not only Ann but also her friends B. Neither Ann nor Tom
C. Either Ann or her friend D. Nobody but Ann
答案:A
解析:此题句子大意是“……想毕业后去新疆工作”根据句中所缺部分和四个选项不难看出此题考查的是主谓一致问题。句中“want”是一般现在时复数形式,那么,此句的主语应是复数形式;四个选项是D是单数,故与本题要求不符;A,B,C三项都是由连词连接的两个名词作主语。根据“就近原则”(见主谓一致问题4)答案为A。
另外,进行自我训练时,要注意按高考要求的时间(12分钟)完成25个单选题。并查出造成失误的原因。如:知识不准确;偏重语法而忽视内容;或受母语的干扰等原因造成的失误。发现问题,抓住重点,集中一段时间重点突破。
三、智能显示
1. 检查方式
(1) 按课文有关人口,历史,政府等分项复述课文,然后,再复述全文;
(2) 群体复述课文 ( Retell in group )
(3)改写课文
2. 同步训练
① 课文要点训练
I. 单词拼写(计分10)
1. Many Europeans e______ the continent of Africa in the 19th century. 1___________
2. The moment old Jonh put a h________ of sweets on the chair by the bed , little Tom ran towards to it . 2___________
3. India gained i_______ from Britain in 1947. 3___________
4. Marx once said that labour c________ man itself . 4____________
5. After reading the letter from her boss , Jane t______ it up and threw
it into the dustbin. 5____________
6. I wouldn’t think it w______ to ask him join the club─he’ll only refuse. 6____________
7. Bob was a shy boy ,and he always sat a _____ from the other children. 7____________
8. This medicine has an u_____ taste , but it is of great help. 8____________
9. Ann asked Jim to give up smoking not only because she o___ to the smell. 9___________
10. About 70 percent of the p_______ in China are peasants . 10___________
Ⅱ. 单项选择(计分15)
11. Will you please ______ the radio ? The baby is sleeping.
A. turn off B. turn down C. turn up D. turn on
12. The husband coughed day and night .It’s the wife’s fault for giving______ to him so that he didn’t stop smoking .
A. up B. off C. in D. out
13. -Why ______ they ______ the building?
-Because another new one is to be built there .
A. have been destroyed B. did pull down
C. do remove D. are turning down
14. -It is the people who ______ history.
-And labour ____ man itself .
A. create created B. created invented
C. discover made D. invent creates
15. ─I have much difficulty _______ maths.
─Well , I have some trouble________ the English pronunciation.
A. in with B. in learning with C. with in D. in in
16. -You shouldn’t ______ from the girls in your class.
-But I don’t like ______ .
A. keep away being laughed at B. keep to laugh at
C. turn away to be laughed at D. return laughing
17. Last year some over _____ buildings ______ in the city.
A. 20-story were set up B. 20-storey set up
C. 20-storied had set up D. 20-floor had been set up
18. The old mother was _______ to hear that her daughter had a ____ journey.
A. pleasant pleasant B. pleased pleased
C. pleased pleasing D. pleased pleasant
19. -The young mother ______ her baby Jimmy.
-Really ? My brother ______ Jimmy , too .
A. calls names B. named is named
C. named was named D. called calls
20. Old Jack made a living _____ waste paper ,while his brother _______on slaves .
A. by selling made money B. to sell was rich
C. with lives D. on earns his living
21. _____ about three hundred people _____ the local illnesses ____ in that area.
A. As is known to us die from one year
B. It is said that die of a year
C. As we know are killed per year
D. It is reported that kill every year
22. _____ you are unwell , I’ll go to the meeting instead .
A. Because B. For C. Now that D. Though
23. We come to realize that we have to try our best to create a new life _____ our own and ______our own .
A. with , by B. on with C. of by D. for on
24. Don’t you think what to learn in class ____ the same effect ____ the character of the students ______ what to learn through practice ?
A. has on as B. have for as C. is in that D. are to from
25. Which of the following is NOT correct ?
A. Japan faces the Pacific on the east .
B. Taiwan lies in the east of Fujian belonging to China.
C. North of the United States lies Canada .
D. Britain stands to the northwest of France.
(2)语法训练(主谓一致):
Ⅲ.单项选择
26. All of the work _____ finished and neither the teacher nor the students _____ enough time now .
A. is , has B. is , have C. are , has D. are ,have
27. What I saw ______ two boys running after the thief .
A. is B.are C. are D. were
28. This exercise on agreement of subjects and verbs ______ easy for you .
A. is B. was C. was D. were
29. Here _______ the papers you ask for .
A. is B. was C. were D. are
30. There ______ to be many arguments on both side.
A. seems B. is C. seem D. are
31. Half of the money ________ to you and half of the books _______ to you , too .
A. belong, belong B. belongs , belongs
C. belong, belongs D. belongs, belong
32. Taking pictures _______ not only young men but also many of the old people .
A. are interested in B. are interesting
C. interests D. is interested in
33. Ten minutes _______ more than enough time to complete this exercise.
A. are B. is C. were D. was
34. One hundred and fifty pounds _______ what you should weigh.
A. are B. maybe C. should be D. is
35. You are the one who ______ wrong that Susan is one of those people who ______ out of their way to be helpful .
A. are , goes B. are , go C. is , go D. is , goes
36. Where and when to go ______ Jack since his graduation from college .
A. has been troubling B. has been troubled
C. have troubled D. have been troubling
37. Six eights _____ forty- eight , while six times nine _____ fifty - four .
A. is , are B. are , is C. is , is D. are ,are
38. Nobody but you _______ going to London on business next month.
A. are B. were C. is D. was
39. It ________ Tom and John who ______ here yesterday preparing for today’s experiment.
A. were, were B. are , were C. was , were D. is , were
40. None of the four boys ______ a good swimmer two years ago , but now all of them ______ able to swim across the river .
A. was , are B. is , are C. are , are D. was ,is
Ⅳ. 完型填空(计分20)
Chicago --- lying in the east of the USA--- is a rather young American city . It was 41 completely rebuilt 42 the Creat Fire of 1871. One’s first impression of the city may 43 streams of cars running to and 44 on the highways , skyscrapers and the wide green water of Lake Michigan , 45 lies to the northeast of the city . The 46 of the city is over 228 square miles 47 a population of about 3 million .
The 48 of Chicago on the whole is almost the same as 49 of Beijing with 50 hot days in summer , 51 and fresh days in 52 and icy but often 53 days in winter . The spring in Chicago is 54 changeable in temperature. For instance, I saw a snowfall in early 55 this year 56 some of the flowers were already in 57 bloom . Chicago is also famous 58 its frequent strong winds , and 59 it has got the name of “ the 60 City .”
41. A. most B. almost C. mostly D. merely
42. A. before B. since C. after D. when
43. A. have B. mean C. be D. include
44. A. from B. above C. down D. along
45. A. when B. that C. which D. where
46. A. land B. measure C. area D. size
47. A. having B. with C. for D. and
48. A. climate B. weather C. temperature D. season
49. A. which B. it C. the one D. that
50. A. fairly B. rather C. much D. too
51. A. colorful B. colorless C. colour D. coloured
52. A. spring B. winter C. fall D. summer
53. A. clean B. clear C. cleaning D. clearly
54. A. little B. bit C. a lot D. a little
55. A. April B. May C. January D. June
56. A. and B. but C. when D. while
57. A. full B. filled C. filling D. full of
58. A. as B. for C. of D. with
59. A. in fact B. in a word C. as a result D. above all
60. A. Snowy B. Windy C. Rainy D. Sunny
V. 阅读理解(计分25)
( A )
Christopher Columbus discovered America on the 12th of October , 1492. He had spent eighteen years in planning for that wonderful voyage which he made a cross the Atlantic Ocean .The Spanish king and queen ,who were interested in finding a sea route to India ,offered him ships and men so that he could carry out his plan . He crossed the Ocean and discovered strange islands ,inhabited ( vt. 居住于) by people unknown to Europeans .He believed these islands to be part of India.
Early in 1493, Columbus returned to Spain. There was great rejoicing(欢庆)in the country , and he was hailed(欢呼)as the hero who had made an epoch-making discovery .Crowds of people lined the streets to do him honour , and the king and queen welcomed him to their palace. Never had such respect been shown to any common man.
61. Christopher Columbus discovered America ________.
A. on the 12th of November
B. more than 800 years
C. at the beginning of the fifteenth century
D. by the end of the fifteenth century
62. He had spent ______ in planning for the wonderful voyage .
A. eighteen days B. eighteen months
C. eighteen years D. much time
63. Finally the Spanish king and queen offered him ships and men so that _____.
A. he would have faith in himself
B. he could work out his new plan
C. he could display his courage
D. he could put his plan into practice.
64. He crossed the ocean and discovered strange islands , inhabited ______.
A. by a people unknown to Europeans
B. by a people already known to Europeans
C. by Europeans
D. by his fellow-countrymen
65. After returning to Spain he was hailed as the hero ______.
A. who had conquered(征服)nature
B. who had made an epoch-making discovery
C. who had discovered a new planet
D. who had made a great invention
( B )
The United States became a rich industrial nation toward the end of the 1800s . There were more goods ,more services , more jobs ,and a high standard of living . There was more of everything, including problems .One problem was monopoly(垄断). In some cases ,several companies that made the same product would agree not to compete with one another .They would all agree to charge the same price .These agreements made it impossible for buyers to shop around for lower prices for certain products .
Some people decided that huge companies had too much power and controlled too many markets . Because of their wealth and power , they could see to it that governments passed laws favorable to them . Many people believed that monopoly and price fixing were bad for buyers and bad for the country so that they should be broken up .
Such laws and government action didn’t entirely do away with monopoly. Nor did they stop the growth of huge companies . But they did show the American people had decided that some of the changes that taken place were harmful .
66. From paragraph 1, we can know that big companies ______.
A. produced certain kinds of goods
B. sold the same goods at the different prices
C. formed only one big company
D. reached and agreement on prices
67. Because of the agreements between big companies ,______.
A. people had to buy things at certain shops
B. the prices of their goods were much lower
C. people had no choice but to buy goods at fixed prices
D. there were fewer markets in some states
68. According to the laws passed by the national government , companies _______.
A. were not allowed to control the markets
B. could not force people to buy their products
C. should have fixed prices for their products
D. must produce the same kind of goods for the same markets .
69. Some American people thought that ________.
A. the government should make some of the huge companies much smaller
B. the country’s industry was growing too rapidly
C. shops should have the same price for the same kind of goods
D. their country’s getting rich was both good and bad to the people.
70. Which of the following is NOT true according to the passage ?
A. Big companies could not have any effort on the governments .
B. A certain number of markets were still controlled by big companies .
C. Many Americans were worried about the changes in their country.
D. Some of the laws were in favor of buyers .
短文改错(计分15):
One afternoon in April , 1912, a new ship set off 71_______________
from England to America on it first trip . It was one of 72_______________
the largest and first ship at that time . 73_______________
It was cold , but the trip was pleasant and people are 74_______________
enjoying themselves . The next day was even cold . People 75_______________
could see icebergs here or there . It was night , suddenly 76_______________
the man on watch shouting “Look out ! Iceberg !” 77_______________
It was too late ,a ship hit the iceberg and came to 78_______________
a stop . There that was a very big hole in the ship and 79_______________
water began to come .Slowly the ship stated to go down . 80_______________
参考答案:
1. explored 2. handful 3. independence 4. created 5. tore 6. worthwhile 7.apart 8. unpleasant 9. objected 10. population
11-15. B C D A B 16-20. C A D B A 21-25. B C D A B 26-30. B B A D C 31-35. D C B D A 36-40. A B C C A
41-45. B C D A C 46-50. C B A D B 51-55. A C B D A 56-60. D A B C B
61-65. D C D A B 66-70. D C A D A
71. √ 72. on it --- on its 73. ship ---ships 74. Are --- were 75. Cold---colder 76. or --- and 77. shouting ---shouted 78. a ship --- the ship 79. that 80. come --- come in
Unit 13 The USA
一、同步题库
(一)单项填空
1.Their wedding yesterday. Many friends came to congratulate them on their marriage.
A.was taken place B.was to happen C.took place D.would hold
2.Since he is ready to help you, you should say“thank you”.
A.at last B.at first C.at most D.at least
3.Mr Smith with his wife goes to the cinema .
A.day by day B.now and again C.here and there D.day and night
4.Drivers,of course,want to travel miles with petrol and
hours.
A.many,a little,few B.more,fewer,less
C.more,less,fewer D.many,less,fewer
5.The rain has my new dress.
A.damaged B.hurt C.destroyed D.failure
6.He was sorry to fail again in the driving test. His only was that he was too nervous.
A.reason B.cause C.regret D.failure
7.Good advice is price.
A.over B.cause C.destroyed D.ruined
8.The basin of water won't freeze, the temperature is well above zero.
A.unless B.because C.even if D.as though
9. put the medicine the little boy can't reach it.
A.Do,where B.Don't that C.Just,which D.Do,there
10.Rather than on a crowded bus,he always prefers a bicycle.
A.to ride,riding B.ride,to ride C.ride,ride D.riding ride
11.You can fly to London this evening you don't mind changing planes in
Paris.
A.except B.if C.until D.unless
12.It's rule that comes home first cooks the dinner for the whole family.
A.who B.somebody who C.whoever D.anybody
13.Beautifully ,the little girl tried to make herself .
A.dressed,noticed B.what will man look like
C.dressed,noticing D.dressed,notice
14.The weather turned out to be very good, was morethan we could expect.
A.what B.which C.that D.if
15.No one can be sure in a million years.
A.what man will look like B.what will man look like
C.man will look like what D.what look will man like
(二)用合适的介词或副词填空
1. my horror,I noticed two men trying to break my office.
2.- the same,I expect you'll come to visit my hometown.
-I'm looking forward that.
3.Farmland is becoming smaller day day several reasons.
4.Don't drive into the bush plenty of water and never throw your cigarette
of the window .
5.We must try all means to get rid flies.
6.Generally speaking,a newly-built house is likely to fall ,
the case of an earthquake.
7. 1920,people from Italy have come to Australia great numbers.
8.The village used to be rather poor.One every three children could
not go to school and most families were debt.
9.-How do farmers round their sheep or cattle?
-It depends the size of their farms.
10.No one has far been brave to enter the forest alone.
(三)改正下面句子的错误(无错的句子不要改;有错的句子中每句只有一处错误)
1.The long fence is used to keeping out a kind of wild dog.
2.Cattles are kept in some countries mainly for beef.
3.They pay peasants very a little money to work in the fields for them.
4.He had to have a job, or go hunger.
5.Their mother can't afford to feed them to meat and fish every day.
6.New types of plants have been developed in Egypt to grow in desert land.
by hunting, they are very experienced at killing wild animals.
8.In area, Australia is about the same size of the USA, which has more than thirteen times as many people.
9.In Australia fruit and vegetables are grown in areas where is enough water.
10.What surprised me was that he spoke English so well.
11.Mr White slowed down his car, for he saw a blind man cross the road.
12.Why did she keep on wipe her eyes with a damp towel?
(四)完形填空
Agatha Christie seldom went out at night. She never(1)the night when she met a(2)many years ago.
That evening she was (3)to a birthday party which (4)until 2 o'clock in the
morning.Agatha(5)in the quiet street alone.Suddenly from the shadow(阴影)of a (6)building a tall man with a sharp knife in his right hand (7)out at her.“Good morning,lady,” the man said in a (8)voice,“I don't think you wish to (9)here!”
“What do you(10)?”Agatha asked.
“Your earrings(耳环).Take them off!”
Agatha suddenly had a (11)idea.She tried to cover her necklace (12)the collar(衣领)of her overcoat while she used(13)hand to take off her earrings and then she quickly(14)them on the groud.“Take them(15)let me go.”The robber(16)that the girl didn't care for the earrings at all,only trying to (17)the necklace.He thought the necklace (18)cost more,so he said,“Give me your necklace.”
“Oh,sir,It's(19)worth much.Please let me(20)it.”“Stop rubbish(废话).Quick!”
With (21)hands,Agatha took off her necklace.As soon as the robber (22),she picked up her earrings and ran as (23)as she could to one of her friends.The earrings (24)480pounds and the necklace the robber had taken(25)was worth six pounds.
1.A.minded B.forgot C.remember D.regretted
2.A.friend B.murderer C.robber D.stranger
3.A.invited B.asked C.going D.walking
4.A.delayed B.ended C.began D.lasted
5.A.walked B.drove C.waited D.watched
6.A.small B.dark C.old D.low
7.A.looked B.shouted C.stepped D.ran
8.A.loud B.low C.die D.cry
9.A.suffer B.quarrel C.die D.cry
10.A.like B.mean C.want D.say
11.A.bright B.foolish ny D.safe
12.A.under B.by C.with D.below
13.A.her right B.her left C.the other D.another
14.A.dropped B.put C.laid D.threw
15.A.and B.but C.so D.then
16.A.knew B.saw C.observed D.thought
17.A.wave B.hid C.defend tect
18.A.would B.must C.should uld
19.A.really B.actually C.even D.not
20.A.wear B.keep C.have D.take
21.A.nervous B.little C.shaky D.beautiful
22.A.signed B.permitted C.disappeared D.nodded
23.A.calmly B.quietly C.quick D.fast
24.A.worth B.valued of C.sold st
25.A.away B.out C.off D.down
答案:(一)1-5 C D B C D 6-10A C B A B 11-15B C A B A
(二)1.To,into 2.All,to 3.by,for 4.with,out either 5.by,of 6.less,down,in 7.Since,in 8.in,in 9.up,on 10.so,enough
(三)1.keeping鰇eep 2.Cattles鯟attle 3.去掉a 4.hunger鰄ungry 5.to鰋n 6.对 鯨iving 8.of鯽s 9.is前加there 10.对 11.cross鯿rossing 12.wipe鰓iping
(四)1.B 2.C 3.A 4.C 5.A 6.B 7.D 8.B 9.C 10.C 11.A 12.C 13.C 14.D 15.A 16.B 17.D 18.A 19.D 20.B 21.C 22.C 23.D 24.D 25.A
人教版英语课件 篇3
1、句型和语言点(见教学重点)。
2、用所学的知识与伙伴进行交流、沟通,学会改错、写作。
利用多媒体手段营造积极和谐教学氛围,使学生不自觉地进入情景之中,充分调动学生的思维活动和情感体验,引起学生的共鸣。
在运用语言的过程中培养学生的观察力、分析力、想象力和自学能力,帮 助学生加强记忆力,提高思维能力和运用英语的综合能力,激发创造能力。
三、教材分析:
这是高三复习阶段的一节写作课。这节书面表达课就从审题谋篇等方面入手来完成教学目的,侧重于引导学生在把握书面表达的写作前准备即谋篇审题能力,使学生在动手写作前迅速构思按照规范的模式来完成谋篇审题:在教学中不仅仅强调写,对于与写作紧密联系的听、说、读、改错都有兼顾。采用任务型教学法和小组合作探究学习法,从而激发学生的学习兴趣,同时也能扩大课堂的语料输入量及学生的语言输出量。
五、教学难点:
1、如何帮助学生运用写作策略,促进学生自主写作。
2、使学生了解谋篇的重要性,培养谋篇的能力和习惯。
2、任务型教学法:
Come up with some proverbs for the students to put them into Chinese。
Recitation is of the first importance in any language learning!
Practice makes perfect! …
What do you learn from the above proverbs?
Make it clear to the students the importance of writing in English subject of the college entrance exams and then the goals of this lesson。
Show on the whiteboard a writing。
人教版英语课件 篇4
一、教学目标:
1. 能力目标:通过本次作文练习提高口语表达能力。
2. 知识目标:通过本次的写作提高学生的词汇量。
3. 情感目标:增强学生之间的了解,提升生生之间的友谊。
二、教学重难点:引导学生使用一些基本的简单的句型来介绍自己。
教学用具: 黑板、纸
三、教学过程:
1. 导入:今天班里来了一位新同学,你和他会展开怎样的对话呢
2. 课题呈现:
⑴今天我们就以introduce yourself为题来讨论一下这个话题。
(2)现在请你们讨论一下我们在对话过程中可能涉及到哪些话题呢?请同学来回答,师生共同总结可能遇到的话题
a. Where are you from?
b. Do you like the weather?
c. What’s your parents?
d. What fruit do you like?
(3)老师提示有可能遇到的词汇:China、America、
England、Singapore、sunny 、cloudy、snowy、rainy、doctor、nurse postman、teacher、watermelon、kiwifruit、apple banana、orange、friends等等
(4)请同学们和同桌就我们已经讨论并总结过的内容编一个小对话,要求把所有的内容都能够设计进去。
(5)请同学们表演自己的对话,在表演的过程中其他同学注意他们是否出现错误,是否有漏掉的信息点并且记下你不知道的词汇和句型。
3.评价最佳对话:在这里我们评出对话做的内容最丰富的,词汇量最佳的一组,你觉得你从这一组中能学到更多的词汇和句型对你的帮助最大。
4.习作练习。现在请你就你和你的同伴所编的小对话换一种形式写出来也就是Introduce yourself.将对话中所涉及的各种个人信息总结起来就是你自己的个人信息我们来试着写一下。
5.挑选个别同学的作文进行讲解,指出优点和缺点并且再次强调写作的方法和要求。
6.Homework:具体实践:
请你就今天你所学的到的相关信息写一篇作文Thisis me.80词左右。
提示:
①你的基本信息,姓名、年龄、等等
②你来自哪里
③你的父母是干什么的
④你喜欢吃什么水果等等。
四、课后小结
1. 有部分学生词汇量不够,造成了一定的写作困难。
2. 一些学生的中式思维句式,逻辑思维也比较乱。
3. 口语表达能力不够,无法用英语来较好的表达。
五、今后措施
1. 抓住作文的主题,要做到基本的句式正确,语句通顺。
2. 增加词汇量,基本句型的背诵。
六、教学反思:本课从学生的实际设计,要求学生能够用英语做简单的自我介绍,有一部分学生因为词汇量的干扰并不能很好的完成本节课的任务,但是大部分学生还是可以的,以后要注意培养学生的口语表达能力,注意词汇的记忆以及基本句型的掌握,从而提高学生能够的写作能力。
七、板书设计
人教版英语课件 篇5
Teaching main-points: Vocabulary and grammar revision in the process of the integration between the teacher and the ss
Teaching Crux: 1) SS’ explanation about the vocabulary and grammar
2) Teacher’s further explanation and supplement
Teaching materials & focuses:
如果说美国作家爱伦坡开了侦探小说之先河,那么英国作家威尔基柯林斯对侦探小说的贡献,主要表现在以下两个方面:(一)是他把侦探小说从短篇引向长篇。(二)是他首先在侦探小说中塑造了一个职业侦探,并有意识地为现实生活中的侦探树碑立传。
威尔基柯林斯(1824-1889),英国小说家。他生于伦敦,父亲是个风景画家,他早年就读于海堡私立学校,12岁随父母移居意大利,15岁回到英国学习法律,学成后当了律师。1847年,其父逝世,23岁的他尝试写作,第一部作品是记叙其父生平的《威廉柯林斯的一生》。1850年,他创作了第一部小说《罗马的陷落》。接着又写了《贝锡尔》、《捉迷藏》,并认识了当时著名的大作家狄更斯。在文学的熏陶下,他成为一个流行小说作家,他的不少作品在维多利亚时代最风行的杂志《家常话》上发表,如《日落以后》、《死亡的秘密》、《我的杂志》等等,他的代表作是《月亮宝石》、《白衣女人》和《新济良所》。另外,《可怜的芬区小姐》、《一个流浪汉的一生》、《黑袍》均有一定的影响。
《月亮宝石》是威尔基柯林斯创作巅峰时期的代表作,也是世界侦探小说史上的一部杰作。我们不妨从这部作品来认识威尔基柯林斯侦探小说的特点与艺术风格。
《月亮宝石》以英国侵略印度圣城西林加巴坦为背景,英国军官汗卡什在王宫中抢得了举世闻名的月亮宝石,印度人不甘心国宝落入异邦,暗中跟踪他至英国,并伺机袭击他。汗卡什为了嫁祸于他人,临终前把月亮宝石送给了他的外甥女雷茜儿,从此,雷茜儿一家闹得乌烟瘴气,无一宁日。未几,月亮宝石竟不翼而飞了,各种人怀着不同的目的在寻找它,月亮宝石给占有它的人制造了命运的悲剧。最终,在百折不挠的印度人的努力下,终于物归原主,月亮宝石回到了印度圣城。
这部作品的叙述方法是很别致的,作者采用了各个不同的人物分头叙述各个不同的故事,然后连贯起来,使故事的发展充满了悬念与疑云。整个作品的情节错综复杂、曲折离奇,让读者疑虑丛生。作者又借助于书中侦探克夫探长之手不断拨开疑云,让神秘莫测的案子逐步显露真相。作者的叙述与交代层次分明,揭示罪犯的作案手段犹若抽茧剥蕉,丝丝入扣。读完全书,我们不得不佩服作者的聪明与他笔下那位克夫探长的机智与老练。
《月亮宝石》不仅故事生动,情节跌宕起伏,而且还塑造了一大批栩栩如生的人物典型。雷茜儿的闺秀气派、弗兰克林的大少爷作风、高孚利的虚情假意、贝特里奇的固执、罗珊娜的痴迷、克莱克的伪善、西格雷夫的愚昧昏庸,都衬托出书中主角克夫探长的料事如神,据威尔基柯林斯自述,克夫探长这一形象并非他的虚构,他是根据英国警察厅刑事部的一位警探作模特的。他首先为现实生活中的警探树碑立传,并根据他的事迹塑造了一个正面的英雄人物,这说明当时社会对警察这一形象已经有了观念上的转变,在19世纪初,读者并不会接受克夫探长这一形象,而到了19世纪末,克夫探长在文学作品中的出现引起了读者广泛的喜爱,这表明了英国法律在社会现实中有所进步。
Teaching main-points: Vocabulary and grammar revision in the process of the integration between the teacher and the ss
Teaching Crux: 1) SS’ explanation about the vocabulary and grammar
2) Teacher’s further explanation and supplement
Teaching materials & focuses:
威尔基柯林斯被誉为英国的通俗文学大师,也有人称他是英国侦探小说之父。这除了赞扬他在侦探小说史上的两大突破,还对其作品的思想性与艺术性作了肯定的评价。他的作品笔调辛辣还带有幽默感,在叙述中时而夹入风趣的语言。他大胆揭露了英国侵略军队在印度圣城犯下的滔天罪行,对侵略者烧杀掠抢、破坏古迹、盗窃神器的行径作了有力的抨击,并刻划了英国上流社会的世态炎凉与某些宗教的虚伪。无疑,这部侦探小说在思想内涵与艺术特色上,都是非常成功的。
由此可见,英国作家威尔基柯林斯在创作侦探小说方面,比美国作家爱伦坡又迈出了更大的一步。如果杜宾是一个业余侦探,那么克夫探长则是一个职业侦探;杜宾解开谜底只凭想象与推理,而克夫探长则亲自调查,跟踪罪犯,历经种种艰险,就更为令人亲切可爱了。克夫探长所遇到的疑案也比杜宾碰到的案子复杂得多、惊险得多。整个故事的情节一波三折,更具可读性。威尔基柯林斯的创作更接近于通俗文学范畴。
但是,威尔基柯林斯创作的侦探小说仍然有一些不足,就以《月亮宝石》而言,全书有40万字(中译本仅20多万字),书中的枝节大多,有不少冗长乏味的叙述以及与破案无关的情节。小说中侦探的成分是加强了,但推理的方法还欠精确,再以威尔基柯林斯一生的创作来说,侦探小说只占了他整个创作的三分之一,他还不是一个专门从事侦探小说写作的小说家,尽管如此,他创作的《月亮宝石》对柯南道尔等侦探小说家的出现是有重大启发的,尤其对推动英国文坛侦探小说的创作起了先导作用。
Teaching main-points: Vocabulary and grammar revision in the process of the integration between the teacher and the ss
Teaching Crux: 1) SS’ explanation about the vocabulary and grammar
2) Teacher’s further explanation and supplement
Teaching materials & focuses:
Language points :
1. the novel the Moonstone is set in England in 1848, but the story really began 50 years later.
The book is set in France in the eighteenth century. 这部书是以18世纪的法国为背景的。
This novel is set in the gold rush. 这部小说是以淘金热为背景的。
Set 其他意思:
He set his hand on my shoulder. 他把手放在我的手上。
Please set the table for dinner. 请摆好餐桌准备就餐。
Have you set the time for the meeting?你们把开会时间定下来了吗?
The sun rises in the east and sets in the west. 太阳从东方升起在西方落下。
He set a diamond in a ring. 他把一块宝石镶嵌在戒指上。
2. curse n. 诅咒, 咒语, 祸根, 祸因 vt. 诅咒, 咒骂, 降祸, 使受罪
Our tribe is under a curse. 我们的部族正遭天谴。
Foxes can be a curse to farmers. 狐狸可给农民带来祸害。
a terrible bolt of lightning; a terrible curse. 可怕的闪电;可怖的诅咒
It is essential for us to try to decide whether television is a blessing or a curse. 我们有必要来评断电视到底是福还是祸。
Selfishness is the greatest curse of the human race. {William Ewart Gladstone) 自私是人类最大的祸根(威廉尤尔特格拉德斯通)
Teaching main-points: Vocabulary and grammar revision in the process of the integration between the teacher and the ss
Teaching Crux: 1) SS’ explanation about the vocabulary and grammar
2) Teacher’s further explanation and supplement
Teaching materials & focuses:
Act 做动词的用法:
Think before acting. 三思而后行。
The medicine was taken for a long time, but it failed to act. 药已经服了很长时间,但还未见效。
Act 与action 区别:
Action做可数名词时,常与act 同义。 如:
但act 多指具体的,短时间的行为或行动; action 多指复杂的持续的行为或行动。
2)在一些固定用法中。 如:an act of cruelty (残忍的行为), an act of war(战争行为) , an act of mercy(仁慈的行为) 等中,不能用action 又如take action (采取行动)也是固定搭配。
4. But from the moment Rachel fastens it to her dress, things start going wrong.
Fasten to 把。。。系在。。。
The bookshelf is fastened to the wall. 这个书架是固定在墙壁上的。
When we went to visit her, she was not in. we wrote a note and fastened it to the door. 我们去看她时她不在,我们只好写了张便条钉到门上。
Go wrong 出毛病,不对头 如:
Something has gone wrong with my bike. 我的自行车出了点问题。
The party was going well until Mary arrived, then everything went wrong. Mary 来之前晚会开的很成功, 可后来一切都不对了。
5. as the story develops …
As 意思是“随着”。 如:
As time went by, he began to realize that he should have studied hard. 随着时间的推移, 她开始意识到他本该好好学习的。
He doesn’t like skating as much as he used to. 他不象以前那么喜欢滑冰了。
I have told the story just as it happened. 我已如实讲了这件事。
As you object, I’ll reconsider the plan. 既然你反对,我就重新考虑一下这个计划。
虽然,
Much as I like the book, I can’t afford to buy it. 尽管我很喜欢这本书,可我买不起。
Teaching main-points: Vocabulary and grammar revision in the process of the integration between the teacher and the ss
Teaching Crux: 1) SS’ explanation about the vocabulary and grammar
2) Teacher’s further explanation and supplement
Teaching materials & focuses:
He was interested in his work to such a degree that he thought about nothing else. 他对工作如此感兴趣,以致于他从来不想别的事情。
To a certain degree he likes his job. 在某种程度上他喜欢他的工作。
7. guilty 惭愧(about),有过失的,有罪责的(of)
I felt guilty about not visiting my parents more often. 我因没有常去看望父母而感到内疚。
John had a guilty look on his face. John 脸上显出惭愧的表情。
The jury found the defendant not guilty of the offence. 陪审团裁决被告无罪。
We’ve all been guilty of selfishness at some time in our lives. 我们每个人都有过自私自利的过失。
The bank strongly resisted cutting interest rates. 银行强烈反对降低利率。
He couldn’t resist showing off his new car. 他忍不住炫耀起了他的新车。
9. stain vt. 沾污,染污, 染色,玷污,败坏。 n. 污点,污渍
The juice from the berries stained their fingers red. 浆果汁把他们的手指染成了红色。
Stain the specimen before looking at it under the microscope. 先把标本染成红色,再放到显微镜下观察。
a blood / a coffee / an ink, etc. stain
You’ll need to convince them of your enthusiasm for the job. 你要使他们相信你殷切希望得到工作。
[vn (that)] I’d convinced myself (that) I was right.
I’ve been trying to convince him to see a doctor. 我一直劝他去看病。
a convincing argument / explanation / case 有说服力的论点/解释/事例
She sounded very convincing to me. 我觉得她的话很有说服力。
Convinced 坚信,确信(~ (of sth / that ... )
I am convinced of her innocence. 我坚信她清白无辜。
I am convinced that she is innocent.
Sam nodded but he didn’t look convinced. Sam点了点头,但是看起来并没有信服。
Teaching main-points: Vocabulary and grammar revision in the process of the integration between the teacher and the ss
Teaching Crux: 1) SS’ explanation about the vocabulary and grammar
2) Teacher’s further explanation and supplement
Teaching materials & focuses:
Let us assume for a moment that the plan succeeds. 咱们假设计划成功。
She would, he assumed, be home at the usual time. 他认为,她会在通常时间回家的。
It is generally assumed that stress is caused by too much work. 普遍认为,紧张系工作过重所致。
I had assumed him to be a Belgian. 我本以为他是比利时人。
3. meanwhile adv./n. 同时, 其间,(两方面)对比之下
The doctor will see you again next week. Meanwhile, you must rest as much as possible.
Stress can be extremely damaging to your health. Exercise, meanwhile, can reduce its effects. 压力对你的健康非常有害,而锻炼会减少这种害处。
I hope to go to medical school eventually. In the meanwhile, I am going to study chemistry. 我希望最终能上医学院,这其间我打算学化学。
4. in all my years as a detective, I have never heard of a thief having such a loss of memory.
这里a thief having …是动名词的复合结构。作宾语时,名词多用通格。至于代词多用宾格。 如:
What about us going out for a walk?
I wonder if you’d mind us asking a few questions.
高考题:
Victor apologized for ___ to inform me of the change in the plan.
A his being not able B him not to be able C his not being able D him to be not able
答案是C.
to accuse sb of murder / theft She accused him of lying.
The government was accused of incompetence
6. desperate 冒险的,绝望的,
The prisoners grew increasingly desperate.
非常需要,渴望 ~ (for sth)| ~ (to do sth)
He was so desperate for a job he would have done anything.
I was absolutely desperate to see her.
相关高考题:
Sandy could do nothing but ___ to his teacher that he was wrong.
A admit B admitted C admitting D to admit
Teaching main-points: Vocabulary and grammar revision in the process of the integration between the teacher and the ss
Teaching Crux: 1) SS’ explanation about the vocabulary and grammar
2) Teacher’s further explanation and supplement
Teaching materials & focuses:
while 表示让步,通常位于句首,意思是“尽管;虽然”。又如:
While I agree with your reasons, I can’t allow it. 尽管我同意你的理由,但我不允许你这样做。
While he loves his stuents, he is very strict with them. 虽然他爱他的学生,可是他对学生们很严格。
While 其他用法归纳如下:
1)引导时间状语从句,意思是“当。。。的时候,和。。。同时”。从句中谓语通常是延续性动词。
如:Mary watched TV while she ate her supper. 玛丽边吃饭边看电视。
While she was listening to the radio, she fell asleep. 她听着收音机睡着了。
2)表示对比或转折,意思是“而,然而”。此时,while 一般谓语句中。 如:
Some people waste food while others haven’t enough. 有人浪费粮食,而有人却吃不饱。
高考相关:
I do every single bit of housework ____ my husband Bob just does the dishes now and then.
答案是B.
人教版英语课件 篇6
我们全体七年级英语教师,在上一学期经过共同努力取得较好成绩的基础上,继续坚持面向全体学生,趁势而上,进一步深入搞好教学工作。
积极全面开展教学、教育和科研工作,通过整个备课组的努力,力争英语成绩在去年的水平上有一定程度的提高。
1、加强理论学习,更新教学观念,统一教育思想。
全组教师重点学习《基础教育课程改革纲要》、《英语课程标准》等有关课程改革的材料。认真体会和理解新课程标准中的理念,并用这些理念来指导平时的课堂教学,以提高课堂教学效率。
2、加强备课组建设,抓好业务学习。
首先把备课组工作具体化,目标化,制度化。加强备课组自身建设:①准时参加每周三的备课组活动,不迟到,不早退,不无故请假。②中心发言人,提前做好充分准备,积极发言,写好有关备课材料。③各组员积极发言,各抒己见,百花齐放,做到一人有高招,大家都受益,提倡团队合作,严禁单打独斗。④组织业务学习,组内互学互提高。⑤准时上缴教案、听课笔记等。
发挥集体备课的群体优势,通过提高备课质量,落实教学常规,提高课堂教学效率。强调每一位教师要在备课中,严格按照学校的要求,做到清晰、规范,备过程、备方法、备教
材、备学生,。充分利用本校的电脑和网络的优势,运用现代教学理论设计多媒体教学辅助课件,推动学科教学与信息技术的有效整合。课后认真反思,及时总结得失,以利于以后的教学。要求教师布置适量练习,教师细心批改,了解学生掌握知识情况,组内及时交流各班存在的共性问题,便于及时弥补。诚心听课,真心评课,认真写好听课笔记,便于评课时集体评议,多指缺点,少唱赞歌,做到共同学习,共同提高。
人教版英语课件 篇7
Aims and demands:
通过本单元教学,学生能熟练地运用“打电话”的常用语;复习第13~17单元的语法项目;了解办公设备现代化和有关放火安全的知识。
Importance and difficulty:
1. words and expressions:
rush sb. off his feet, change, action, repair, work on, fix up
2. important sentences:
A. It is better to ask for help at the beginning rather than to wait until a busy period when everyone is rushed off their feet.
B. What is more, this “information line” operates 24 hours a day.
C. It did not take the firefighters long to pot out the fire, and they at once started to look for causes of the fire.
D. They had to work inside the ship, cutting away old metal, fixing new metal plate, drilling holes, laying electrical and phone wires and fixing new pipes for water and steam.
3. Grammar: review –ing form, to do form and predicative
4. Useful expressions:
A. May I speak to …?
B. Hello. Who’s that speaking?
C. I called to tell you…..
D. Hold on, please.
E. Wait a moment.
F. Can I take ( leave ) a message?
Aims and demands:
Importance and difficulty: Have a deeper understanding of the text.
Teaching aid: tape recorder and some slides
Teaching procedure:
I can store and recall as much information as possible, and I can work at a very high speed. In modern times, you can’t work without me. What am I? ( computer )
T: Where can you find computer?
S: They are mostly found in offices……
T: What else may you expect find in a large modern office?
( write these words on the blackboard and read after the teacher)
choose the right title for each section
T: What is the fax machine? How does it work?
S: When you place a sheet of paper in a fax machine, the machine “reads” the writing on the page and changes the shapes of letters into electronic signals. It then sends these signals down an ordinary telephone line to another fax machine, which changes the signals back into the shapes of letters.
T: What are the advantages of sending a fax?
Ss: Speed. You can send texts, pictures, diagrams, designs maps and so on .
T: What are the disadvantages of sending a fax?
Ss: It is expensive and not private. ( it can be read by anyone)
T: What is the photocopier? How does it work?
Ss: It can copy a long report and sort the copies and pin them together.
T: What can modern photocopying machines do?
Ss: Modern machines can make the copy bigger or smaller , lighter or darker and copy onto both sides of the paper.
T: What is the word processor? How many parts is the word processor made up of?
Ss: It is made up of three parts . ( a typewriter keyboard, a printer and a computer )
T: What are the advantages of a word processor?
Ss: You can make changes easily and can print a report very quickly.
T: What is the answering machine?
Ss: It is a telephone with a tape recorder.
T: What are the advantage of an answering machine?
Ss: It can receive messages when no one is in the office and can give information.
Step 4. Listening for general understanding
Listen to the tape and write down the headings above the right sections of the text.
Comprehension exercise for Unit 18 Lesson 69 (3B)
Read fast to get a general idea of the passage and fill in the following blanks with one of the four choices below.
1. ____ is a type of machine used to make copies from newspapers, books or reports.
2. ____ is used to send messages including words , pictures, designs and maps.
3. ____ is a kind of machine used to type materials, save them for future use and make changes if necessary.
4. ____ is used to record telephone messages when the receiver is absent.
II. Further comprehension CCADC DBBD
1. Which is WRRONG about learning to use office equipment?
A. It can make the work in offices go smoothly .
B. It is necessary for beginners in offices.
C. It should be learnt during a busy period.
D. It may help you to get a promotion (普升机会).
2. Which is correct about sending a fax?
A. It can be done only during working hours.
B. Sometimes it might take a week or so.
C. It isn’t a good choice to send top-secret information by fax machine.
D. Reports in English cannot be faxed.
3. A word processor ____.
A. can type a long report and make changes
B. can produce colour copies when necessary
C. can send information both at home and abroad
D. includes a keyboard, a photocopier and a computer
4. ____ can be used to answer a phone call automatically (自动地) when you are out.
A. The photocopier B. The fax machine
C. The word processor D. The answering machine
5. What is one disadvantage of sending a fax?
A. We can send a fax only in the office hours.
B. Message sent by a fax are hard to read.
C. We cannot send secret information through a fax machine.
D. Foreigners cannot understand Chinese letters sent by a fax.
6. What can’t a word processor do?
A. Typing a letter.
B. Printing documents.
C. Coping a on report.
D. Sending picture.
7. What does “be rushed off one’s feet” mean in paragraph 1?
A. be on business B. be busy and tired
C. be tired out D. run out of the office
8. The writer says “The fax has greatly changed office work, especially in China.” Because ____.
A. it can send information quickly
B. it is much easier to change Chinese characters into electronic signals
C. it can do a lot of work for the Chinese people such as making copies, posting letters
D. it makes office work easy to do
9.“The fax has greatly changed office work,especially in China.” The underlined word means ____.
Aims and demands:
Aims and demands:
Importance and difficulty: Have a deeper understanding of the text.
Teaching aid: tape recorder and some slides
Teaching procedure:
T: What may cause a fire?
---- smoking, playing with fire ……
T: What is often used to put out the fire?
---- Water, CO……
T: What kind of gas do we breathe?
( Name some of the gases in the air we breathe. )
---- Oxygen, hydrogen……
People may be in danger if there is not enough oxygen. But too much oxygen may cause danger to people , too.
Step 2. Reading for general understanding
Read the text and find out :
1. Where did the fire happen?
----- In a ship which was in a port in Scotland for repairs.
2. What started the fire?
----- A worker fixed the air-line to a supply of oxygen instead of compressed air.
See which pair of Ss can find out the correct answer before the others.
---- The man actually connected the air-line to the oxygen supply line.
1. put these events in the correct order
9-12-6-13-1-4-11-8-3-10-14-7-5-2
Comprehension for Unit 18 Lesson 70 (3B) BDBCD ACAB
1. An extra team of men were sent to repair the ship because ___.
B. this ship needed to be repaired quickly
D. there was a lot of work to do
2. The man took a long time to connect the rubber pipe to the air supply pipe because ___.
A. he smoked a cigarette during the working hours
B. he had to drill holes and lay electrical wires first
C. he found something strange in the air and stopped to have a check
3. There was a strange smell when one man lit a cigarette because ___.
A. the cigarette had the smell itself
B. the smell was caused by the oxygen
C. there was something wrong with the man’s nose
D. the ship was beginning to burn
4. Which of the following is true?
A. The fire caused great damage to the ship.
B. There was an explosion happened inside the ship.
C. No damage was done to the deck at the end of the ship.
D. The fuel on ship caused the fire.
5. What measures were taken to prevent a fire accident?
A. Talks on safety were given to new workers.
B. Smoking was not allowed in the workplace.
C. All the supply lines and taps were marked with signs and warnings.
D. Both A and C.
6. In the ship the “air-line” provides ____.
A. compressed air B. water and steam
7. When the fire broke out, ____.
A. some men sounded the fire alarm
B. all the men jumped into the sea
C. most of the men managed to escape
8. The men’s cigarettes burned strangely and tasted bad because ____ .
A. there was too much oxygen inside
B. something was wrong with the cigarettes
D. lots of compressed air was inside
9. What was the real cause of the fire?
A. The third person struck a match for a cigarette.
B. The air-line was fixed to a supply line of oxygen instead of compressed air.
C. Too many workers smoked in the ship.
D. The fittings the workers had used to repair the ship didn’t match.
Rearrange the following events ( Lesson 70 )
a. It took him some time to connect the long rubber pipe to the air supply pipe that ran round the port, but at last it was done and as a result work was able to progress much faster.
b. Half an hour later, another man struck a match for a cigarette and this time the whole of the inside of the ship caught fire.
c. They had to work inside the ship.
d. A navy ship was in a port in Scotland for repairs.
e. It was important to carry out the work quickly, so an extra team of men were asked to work on the repairs one evening.
f. Another man lit a cigarette but it burnt strangely and so he too put it out.
g. One man was told to fix up an “air-line” to provide compressed air for the machines they were using.
h. After three hours, the men stopped for a meal break. When work continued, one man lit a cigarette as he was working, but, finding it had a strange taste, he put it out.
Translate the following sentences (Lesson 69~70)
1. 一旦他作出决定就不会改变。
Once she made the decision, she wouldn’t change her mind.
2. 我到过那儿一次。
I have been there once.
3. 这是她父亲曾经工作过的地方。
This is the place where her father once worked.
4. 该去的是約翰而不是杰克。
John should go rather than Jack.
5. 这些鞋子穿起来很舒服,但并不漂亮。
These shoes are comfortable rather than pretty.
I love swimming rather than skating.
I decided to write rather than ( to ) telephone.
We ought to check up, rather than just accept what he says / accepting what he says.
6. 与其让这些蔬菜烂掉,他宁愿以一半的价格把他们卖掉。
Rather than allow the vegetables to go bad, he sold them at half price.
Would / had rather do sth than do…
Would / had rather sb. did…
I would rather you knew that now than afterwards.
7. 他们播种忙得个不可开交。( rush sb. off one’s feet )
They are rushed off their feet with the sowing.
8. 没有必要对这个计划作出修改。
It is not necessary to make any changes in the plan.
9. 我觉得是我该采取行动的时候了。
I felt it ( was ) time for me to take ( an ) action.
10. 我没有去看望王先生,因为那天下大雨. 再说,我身边也没有他的地址。
I didn’t go to see Mr. Smith , because it was raining hard. What’s more, I didn’t have his address.
11. 中国有许多人正在从事一项“希望工程”,帮助穷苦孩子们上学。
Many people in China are working on a “Project Hope” , helping poor children to go to school.
12. 他在致力于发明一种办公用的新式机器。
He is working on inventing a new type of machine for office work.
13. 他不得不工作到六十多岁。
He has to work on until he was sixty.
14. 政府给无家可归的人提供食宿。
The government provided food and shelter for those who were homeless / the homeless.
The government supplied (provide ) the homeless with food and shelter.
15. 他们在忙着安装电灯。
They are busy fixing up the lights.
Translate:
A. He fixed up the broken chair. 修理
B. I can easily fix you up for the night. 给…... 安排住处
C. We have fixed up a date for the picnic. 确定
D. I’ve fixed up a visit to the theater for next Friday. 安排
E. Do I have to fix up to go to the party. 打扮
16. 花了我一整天的时间修理这台彩电。
It took me a whole day to fix up the colour TV set.
17. 你应该争取尽快赶到那儿。
You should try to get there as soon as you can.
You should try to get there as soon as possible.
18. 许多人逃出大火着火了。
Many people escaped from the big fire, with their clothes on fire.
19. 老师走进教室,手里拿着一本书。
The teacher came into the classroom, with a book in his hand.
20. 她似乎(已经)听到了这件事。
She appeared / seemed to have heard about it already.
It seemed / appeared that she had already heard about it.
21. 房子烧了,准是有什么原因。
The house was burned down. There must have been some cause.
22. 这婴孩昨夜哭个不停,他准是得了病。
The baby kept crying last night . He must have been ill.
人教版英语课件 篇8
PEP小学英语三年级下册Unit 4 Where is my car
概述:
小学人教版三年级下册Unit4Where is my car?本单元共需六个课时,本课是第一课时,本课主要教学内容是学习单词desk, in, under, Where is ...It’s in\\ under ...并在具体的语境中使用句型,在课堂教学中,教师要使教学内容生活化,结合学生的实际情境,使学生口语练习生活化,交际化,从而达到学以致用的目的。
设计理念:
在跨越式为指导下,以语言运交际为中心,借助现代信息技术,努力为学生创设理想的英语学习环境,提供丰富的网络资源,倡导体验、实践、参与、交流与合作的学习方式。倡导任务型教学,把语言综合运用能力的培养落实在教学过程中。面向全体学生,突出“以人为本”的素质教育理想,使语言教学的过程同时成为提高人文素养、增强实践能力、培养创新精神的过程。
教学目标: 1.知识目标.能听、说、认读单词 desk, in, under,句型:Where is ...It’s in\\ under ...2.能力目标
能在具体的语境中使用句型, Where is ...It’s in\\ under ...并且用已经学过的学习用具来练习Let’s play的内容。
结合实际生活,创设真实情境,激发学生学习兴趣和热情,提高学习的积极性和主动性,增长课外知识,激发学习热情。
学情分析: 由于学生是三年级学生参加跨越式教学已经有一学期了,他们已经适应了跨越式课堂模式,听说能力都比较强。乐于感知,模仿习得英语。所以本节课采用多种方式来教学,让学生从不同的教学活动中获取知识。
教学重难点:
教学重点:能听、说、认读单词 desk, in, under,句型:Where is ...It’s in\\ under ...教学难点:where 的读音,能理解方位介词in, under 的含义。 教学策略:
由于三年级学生已学习英语一学期了,读与说的能力相对较好,因此在教学过程中采用语言交际的教学策略,通过角色扮演、情景创设、教室内真实的辅助性教学资源提供等,多种方式,激发学生学习积极性,帮助学生领会教具准备: 1.相关人物单词的图片和卡片。 2.教师自制的PPT。
教学过程:
一.Warm-up /Revision (5minutes) sing a song.(2minutes) 教师播放歌曲《Where is the toy car?》
【设计意图:让学生唱熟悉的歌曲,既能激发学生的兴趣,又能营造英语氛围帮助学生进入学习英语的环境中。】
1教师指着教室里的一张桌子说:This is a desk.It’s a yellow desk.从而让学生知道desk就是桌子的意思。然后教师把一支铅笔放在桌子里面说:Where is my pencil? It’s in the desk.教师又把一本书放到桌子上说:Where is my book? It’s on the desk.教师又把铅笔盒放在桌子底下说:Where is my pencil box? It’s under the desk.【设计意图:采用教室里的具体的实物和学习用具来展示单词,可以降低学生学习的难度,学生会很好奇,也可以激发学生学习的兴趣。】
2.教师在PPT上进一步展示图片来练习单词和句子。 【设计意图:进一步巩固和练习所学新句子。】
3.教师播放 Let’s play 部分的录音,然后让学生把自己的文具和自己制作的单词卡片拿出来做练习。
【设计意图:让学生在玩中学,在学中玩,也可以巩固和练习所学新句子。】 对话内容,提高学生的语言交际能力。
4.对话练习(Model\\Pair work\\Feedback) A: What can you see? B: I can see a bag/book … A: Where is the ruler/pencil…? B: It’s in /on/under… 两人一组练习展示。
【设计意图:利用真实的情景把学到的知识活用到言语交际中,从而实现跨越式的要求。】
总共四篇阅读材料。第一篇是课本上的听力材料,听后让学生回答问题:Where is the book? 第二篇是dialogue2-2 听后让学生获取新单词:behind,next.第三篇是让学生获取新句型: There are some …in/under.第四篇是reading1听后让学生回答问题:Where is my market? 【设计意图:让学生听读与课本内容相关的短文,大信息量输入,丰富学生的语言,在语境中体会、理解新知。培养学生自主听读的能力及语感。通过听 后反馈信息,在交流中进一步学习拓展句型。】
四. Cooperation and making dialogues 8分 支架如下:
A: What can you see? B: I can see a … A: Where is the … B: It’s in/under the … A: What colour is it? B: It’s … 两人一组练习展示。
【设计意图:此环节是对学生听读情境对话的反馈和运用,同时也是在语言输入的基础上为学生提供语言输出的机会,在老师的示范和引导下进行对话,培养学生灵活运用语言的能力。既能落实课标的要求,又能实现语言的迁移运用。】
五. Summary What did you learn? 【设计意图:总结本课学习的内容,使学生产生成就感,激发学习英语的兴趣。】
和同学们用自己的学习用具练习今天所学的句型。 【设计意图:复习巩固本课所学内容。】 板书设计:
Unit 4 Where is my car?
desk in Where is …? under It’s in\\under …
人教版英语课件 篇9
1. Get students to learn some useful new words and expressions in this part.
2. Get students to read the letter.
3. Let students learn the prohibition, warning and permission.
1. Develop students’ reading skills and enable them to learn how to use different reading strategies to read different reading materials.
2. Enable student s to understand how to give advice.
1. Stimulate students’ interests of learning English by reading and acting this play.
2. Develop students’ sense of group cooperation and teamwork.
1.state the main idea of each paragraph in own words
2.ways to become addicted to cigarettes
3.the harmful effects of smoking
1. sorting out major idea and minor idea
2. master key words in key sentence
1.An apple a day keeps the doctor away.
2.Early to bed and early to rise, makes a man healthy, wealthy and wise.
1How many parts does the reading text consist of?
2. Who wrote the letter to whom?
3. How many ways can a man become addicted to smoking?
1. The first sentence of the letter shows James granddad______ .
A. lives a healthy life B. is addicted to sitting in the garden
C. has nothing to do at home D. is tired when cycling 20 kilometers
2. From the second paragraph, we can know granddad ______________.
A . never smoked B. likes smoking
C. used to smoke heavily D. still smokes now
Ask students to discuss the following questions in pairs.(让学生分组讨论,形成书面形式)
1.Different ways people can become addicted to cigarettes.
Write some advice to persuade smokers to quit smoking
How to live a healthy life?
1. write down the suggestions given by granddad
2. try to persuade one to give up smoking
人教版英语课件 篇10
●教学目标
1.熟练运用现在进行时进行语言交流
2.通过看图对话,学会描述进行中的`动作。
●教学用具
录音机、投影仪、图片等。
●教学步骤
Step 1 Revision
复习Whats he/she doing? He/She’s making a cake.叫三名学生到讲台上。A表演动作,B问Is he reading/playing. ..? C答Yes, he is./No, he isnt.让学生三人一组做类似的练习。
Step 2 Presentation
教师通过具体的动作教一些单词,如 talk, talk with, open, close, take photos等。然后用这些单词或词组造句子,反复练习。也可以让几个学生到讲台上表演,然后问同学Whats he/she doing? Is he/she opening the door? What’s he/she doing? He/She is closing the window. What are they doing? They are taking photos.
Step 3 Practice
* 打开书23页第一部分, 让学生边听录音边找正确的图片。
* 第二部分,让学生看彩图三,两人一组进行对话练习
Step 4 Consolidation
句型转换:
1. We clean our classroom in the afternoon. But we don’t do it now. It’s still early in the morning. (画线部分改为现在进行时)
We______ ______our classroom now. It’s dirty. It needs cleaning.
2. They are playing football at school. (画线部分改为否定句)
They ______ ______football at school. They’re playing football somewhere else.
3. Im doing my homework now. (画线部分改为一般疑问句并作否定回答)
______ ______doing ______homework now? ______, ____________.
4. Speak in English. (画线部分改为否定句)
______ ______in English now. These old men don’t understand English.
5. The twins are singing in the room. (对画线部分提问)
______are the twins ______in the room?
Answers: 1. are cleaning 2.aren’t playing 3. Are you, your. No, I’m not 4. Don’t speak 5. What, doing
Blackboard Handwriting
Blackboard Handwriting
Lesson 83
You arent talking.
He/She isn’t writing.
Is he/she opening the door?
Yes, he/she is.
No, he/she isn’t.
人教版英语课件 篇11
教学目的:
1.使学生了解什么是想象和联想;
2.认识想象与联想在写作中的作用及其重要性;
3.能够在写作中正确运用想象与联想。
教学重点与难点:
使学生明确想象与联想的含义,能够在写作中进行恰当的想象与联想。
课前导入:
行想象与联想,会使我们的思路开阔,文章含蓄隽永。今天我们就来学习在写作过程中如何进行想象和联想。
一.下面我们就来做一个小练习:
1.根据屏幕上杜甫的诗句描绘心中的画面请同学们来展示自己的图画并简述自己的构思设计(大约五个学生:孟群霍梦珍乔爽郭建郭倩颖)
师:以上几个同学的画面,以及屏幕上的画面都是根据同一首诗作的,但画面内容互不相同,为什么呢?
生:因为每个人对这首诗的理解是不同的,画面带上了自己的主观色彩,所以作出来的
《二十岁的坦白》我的将来到底是什么样的,本人没有经历过,只能是自己纯粹的想象。作者用过这样的设想给自己的生命画上美丽的结局。
临其境之感。
师:以上我们根据诗句构思画面,设想自己的未来,这样的思维过程就叫做想象。
想象还可以分为创造想象和再造想象。
如:李白没有见过神仙集会,那么他所描绘的彩虹的服饰,老虎鼓瑟,鸾鸟驾车的情节都是他独创的,那么这样的想象相对于李白来说就属于创造想象。当我们读了他的这首诗后,也做了一个梦,梦到诗中描绘的神仙形象,对我们而言,这种想象就属于再现想象了。因为我们想象的依据是诗人的描摹,我们接受了这样的语言信息。
联想集团有这样的广告语:联想是人类迈出的一小步,但也是历史迈出的一大步。由此我们可以体会到“联想”二字的分量。在文章中进行丰富的联想可以深化文章的主题。联想这种思维过程在写作中往往体现在象征手法的运用。
问:请同学们思考茅盾先生的《白杨礼赞》和高尔基的《海燕》,在文章中作者如何运用联想的?
答:作者由黄土高原上倔强生长,挺拔向上的高大的白杨联想到北方的抗日军民。
答:他们之间存在着相似的地方:不畏惧恶劣的环境,高大挺拔,所有的枝干都一律向上,力争上游,这些精神与北方抗日军民的精神是一致的,所以引发了作者的联想。
答:由狂风暴雨来临时在海面上高傲的飞翔的海燕想到了在革命激流中进行无畏斗争的无产阶级革命者。由躲在崖下的海鸭和企鹅,就想到了革命中的那些软弱者和投降者。引发作者进行这样联想的原因就是它们之间有相似之处。
师:还比如鲁迅先生的《拿来主义》,有什么都是“送去”想到了“拿来”,这也是一种联想;还比如鲁迅先生在《故乡》里描写:看到眼前面容枯瘦,精神麻木的闰土不禁想到了带着银项圈,拿着钢叉在月夜下捕獾时聪明伶俐,面色红润的少年闰土等等。类似的还有(请学生补充:豆腐西施杨二嫂,祥林嫂前后形象的对比)
联想:就是由当前的'某一事物想到另一事物,或右加观念想到一观念的心理过程。⑦
由于事物间存在着不同的联系,所以联想已有不同的方式。
师:综上所述:我们可以体会到想象与联想之间的区别就在于:一个是创造了新形象,一个没有创造新形象,而且由此及彼。但我们在思考的过程中,二者往往是紧密相连,不可分割的。爱因斯坦曾说:
“想象力比知识更重要,因为知识是有限的,而想象力概括着世界上的一切,推动着进步,并且是知识进化的源泉.”⑨
我国古代文学家刘勰在谈及想象和联想时也说:
问:仔细体会这幅画面,你认为它描绘了一种什么意境?此种意境会让你联想起那一首诗?
观察这幅画面它引发你那些想象和联想?哪国的建筑风格?这么高级的住宅和私家车,主人是干什么的?
小学英语优秀课件
根据您的要求,本编辑为您准备了一份包罗万象的“小学英语优秀课件”,望您阅读并分享给您的朋友。教案课件是老师们需要精心策划的教学工具,我们需要认真撰写每份教案课件。制作高质量的教学课件可以有效提升教师的授课水平。
小学英语优秀课件【篇1】
重点难点:
Using attributive adjectives to show quantities
教学准备:
1. What have you got? I?ve got some…
2. Review the food items using the picture cards. Use realia to review: doll, toy car and rubber. Write: the supermarket, the toy shop, the bookshop on the board. Invite students to give you names of objects you can buy each shop and have them list on the board.
1. Distribute a copy of Photocopiable page 32 to each pair of students. Have the students cut out the small pictures at the top of the page and put the relevant objects in the right shop
2. Invite pairs of students to report back, e.g. We?ve got… in the supermarket / toy shop / bookshop. Allow students to put some objects in different objects, e.g. rubber, because people can buy rubbers in supermarkets, toy shops, bookshops.
3. Group work Have students put all the pictures of different objects sold in a department store on the group?s desk.
4. Play the cassette. Students repeat.
5. Invite individual students to read the sentences
1. Make a dialogue:
2. Grammar Practice Book P26, P27
教学目标:
2. 能模仿例句写句子:There isn’t a/an… There aren’t any…(能模仿范例写句子。)
3. 通过师生交流活动,能较熟练地在情景中运用所学句型和日常交际用语。(积极运用所学英语进行表达和交流)
4. 了解元音字母a在单词开音节中的拼读规律。(了解简单的拼读规律。)
1.Sing “Do you like my house?”
Sing “Do you like my house?”
Act Part A 在复习中巩固所学句型。
1、T: Look, there is a book on the desk.
There isn’t a pen on the desk.
板书句型:There isn’t a… in/ on/ under/ beside/ behind/ between…
T: Here’s an eraser for you.
(Practise with the stationeries.)
2、T: Look, there are some pencils on the desk.
There aren’t any rulers on the desk.
板书句型:There aren’t any… in/ on/ under/ beside/ behind/ between…
T: Who can make some sentences?
T: Here are some pens for you.
There is a book on the desk.
There isn’t a pen on the desk.
There isn’t a TV in the room .
There is cat under the table .
There isn’t a ball under the table
There isn’t an eraser in my pencil box.
Thank you .
There are some books on the desk.
There aren’t any rulers on the desk.
There aren’t any trees beside the buildings .
S: There aren’t any pens in my pencil box.
Thank you .
通过师生交流,学习句型:There isn’t a… in/ on/ under/ beside/ behind/ between…
There aren’t any… in/ on/ under/ beside/ behind/ between…
1.Teacher shows the picture of Part F, students answer what's in Picture1/2 .
2. Look at the picture of part F
There’s /There’re …。
There’s /There’re 运用图片为学生创设交际情景,让学生在情境中学习和运用英语。
Teacher puts the words on the blackboard, giving prominence to “a ”
1. Think about other similar words
2. Listen to the tape and read after it.
Read the words : black happy hat rabbit
Listen to the tape and read after it.
通过反复朗读、比较、拼读单词,让学生发现其中的规律,并且能联想出其他含有这一音素的单词。
1、背诵E部分。
2、自编一段对话。
小学英语优秀课件【篇2】
教学目标:
1、能听懂、会认、会读、并识别Physics 、Chemistry 、History 、Geography等单词。
2、能运用I'm going to study___. 等语句来介绍将来的中学生活。
重点难点:
1、能听懂、会认、会读、并识别Physics 、Chemistry 、History 、Geography等单词。
2、能运用I'm going to study___. 等语句来介绍将来的中学生活。
教学过程:
Step 1:Warm-up and show the learning aims
T: My kids, yesterday we learnt Sam is going to go to middle school, and he is going to study physic chemistry, history . Today let talk about what are you going to study? (板书课题并齐读) First ,please look at our learning aims.(出示本课学习目标,教师慢慢读,学生仔细看、认真听。)
1、Review some words about subjects Chemistry ,Math ,history Chinese…
2、T: Look at here. She is lily and he is Peter. We'll watch a video about them. Before watching the video, let's see three tasks.
(1)Look at the pictures and read the text
(2)Listen to the tape and read each sentence.
(3)Students read the sentences and the new words. Then talk each other
3、Talk to a friend. What are you going to study? Choose and draw three subjects.
4、Memory game: How are you going to go to school?
Where are you going to study?
What are you going to study?
板书设计:
Unit 2 What are you going to study?
A: what are you going to study?
B: I am going to study Chinese, Math History, and Chemistry
六年级英语课堂教案范文二:WearegoingtospeakChinese
教学目标:
1.能听懂、会认、会读study ,History ,Physics等单词。
2.会用what are you going to study ?I’m going to …等语句来描述将要做的事情。
3.能口头会用Where are you going to go ? I’m going to go …/What are you going to do? I’m going to …等语句来描述自己的计划。
重点难点:
1.能听懂、会认、会读study ,History ,Physics等单词。
2.会用what are you going to study ?I’m going to …等语句来描述将要做的事情。
3.能口头会用Where are you going to go ? I’m going to go …/What are you going to do? I’m going to …等语句来描述自己的计划。
教学过程:
Step 1:Warm-up and show the learning aims
T: Boys and girls, do you like games. Let’s play a game, ok? Now take out your books. I say and you show:
Chinese, maths, English, Science, Art, PE, Music.
Now, I show the books, and you say.
Show the words about books, let Ss say quickly.
T: My kids, today we are going to learn Module 10 Unit 1 We are going to speak Chinese. (板书课题并齐读) First ,please look at our learning aims.(出示本课学习目标,教师慢慢读,学生仔细看、认真听。)
1. . Learn the new lore: middle school, History, Chemistry, Physics
T: Boys and girls, we are in Grade six now. We’re learning these subjects. We’re going to go to middle school this September.
We’re going to be students. And we’re going to learn some new subjects. They are History, Chemistry, Physics, Biology, and Geography…
Show the books and the cards of the words to learn.
Now, let’s practice. Show the card of the word: practice. I show and you say. Show the cards of the words: History, Chemistry, and Physics. Read one by one.
Middle school, middle school,
I’m going to go to middle school.
History, History/ Physics, Physics / Chemistry, Chemistry…
I’m going to study History/ Physics/ Chemistry …
Let Ss read the chants. And make a chant by oneself.
You are going to go to middle school this September. And Daming is going to go to middle school, too. Let’s learn more about Daming will go to middle school.
1. Listen to the tape.
Listen and find, underline the sentences with “be going to”。
2. Listen again, and answer the questions:
when is Daming going to go to middle school?
What new subjects is Daming going to study?
Remember new words by heart then have a dictation
Only have one minute to remember these words in their own way, then they’ll have a dictation.
(课件展示听力题内容,让学生听音写出新词,培养学生的听力及单词书写能力,老师由此可以了解学生对课文及单词的掌握情况。)
Read sentences , pay attention to the time and say “Yes “or “No”。
呈现句子:Are you going to go to middle school this September? 然后点击时间状语this September,时间状语可以变换:tonight, tomorrow, next year, this afternoon等等,使学生更加明确be going to句式的用法。
Read sentences and choose “am going to, is going to , are going to”。
呈现句子:He …go to middle school this September.点击人称代词He将进行变换:I,she, we, Daming, you, Sam and Amy等,让学生选择“am going to, is going to , are going to”填空,使学生能熟练掌握be动词在不同人称下的变换形式,达到灵活运用。
板书设计:
Unit 1 we are going to speak Chinese
Daming: Physics Chemistry History
1. Where are you going to go this summer?
2. What are you going to do?
3. What are you going to study?
六年级英语课堂教案范文三:Becauseit`sgoingtorain
教学目标:
2.学会运用Why are we wearing a raincoat? Because it’s going to rain .来询问和回答有关原因的语句。
重点难点:
2.学会运用Why are we wearing a raincoat? Because it’s going to rain .来询问和回答有关原因的语句。
教学过程:
Step 1:Warm-up and show the learning aims
1、Future tense with “be going to”
2、Vocabulary and phrases: wear raincoat theatre go into be afraid of throw…out of
3、T: Boys and girls, today we are going to learn Module 9 Unit 2Because it’s going to rain. (板书课题并齐读) First ,please look at our learning aims.(出示本课学习目标,教师慢慢读,学生仔细看、认真听。)
1、Look at the pictures and listen to the tape carefully for “because”。
2、Play the tape again and have the students to imitate.
The teacher read the original text slowly.
3、Look and say:Say the right, whole dialogues.
4、 let make silly sentences.
For example:
I’m wearing a dress ,because I’m going to go swimming.
Step 3: Explain the knowledge. (点拨)
1.小组内解决自己不懂的地方。
do_____ run_________ take________
look________ laugh________ make_________
1. Why are you ________ a hat?
Because it’s going to be ________.
2. Why are you wearing a __________?
Because I’m going to ________football.
3. It’s going to be cold. I am going to wearing a ________.
4. I’m going to ________. So I take my swimsuit.
小学英语优秀课件【篇3】
①说出调查的一般方法,初步学会做调查记录,并将你所知道的生物进行归类。②尝试描述身边的生物和它们的生活环境。
③初步培养学生的调查能力以及和同学分工合作的能力。
④通过本课的学习引起学生关注周围生物的生存状况,从而加强保护生物资源的意识。
重点:①说出调查的一般方法,初步学会做调查记录。
②初步培养学生的调查能力以及和同学分工合作的能力。
②能引起学生关注周围生物的生存状况,从而注意保护生物资源。
①描述生物圈的范围。
②说出生物圈为生物生存提供的基本条件。
③尝试收集和分析资料。
④认同生物圈是所有生物共同的家园,我们应当了解和爱护这个家。
重点:
①生物圈为生物生存提供基本条件。
②生物圈是所有生物共同的家园,我们应当了解和爱护这个家。
难点:
收集和分析资料(因为收集和分析资料是科学探究中常用的方法之一,学生开展探究活动,需要对图片、文字和数字资料进行分析)。
小学英语优秀课件【篇4】
(1)通过制作“假日相册”复习1---4单元旧知;
(2)重点复习有关“假日照片”的过去式问题及回答;
(1) 指导介绍“假日相册”的内容和顺序。
(1)通过本单元学习,让学生学会互相欣赏。
三、教学重点:
指导介绍“假日相册”的内容和顺序。
六、教学过程:
Step1. Greetings.
A. Free talk.
How are you today?
Is it hot today? (Yes, a little bit hot today.)
B. Play a game.
a) First, read and match.
T: Last lesson we had a little trip. We’ve been to the UK, Hong Kong, …. And today I’ll play a game.
We didn’t have the some of the families can
sound’s films in the have the second baby.
old time,
part in the Olympic Game now we have 3D films.
in the past,
have more than one child most women in the
in the past several years, world can.
Have Ss read the sentences given. Then have Ss match.
b) Play a game.
Have Ss say sentences use “but now”.
Rules: 1) Each team says a sentence using But Now.
2) Make sure the sentence is correct and logical, or the team will get no point.
3) Say the sentence in 5 seconds.
Have Ss do pairs work. Then say the sentence one by one.
(设计意图:以游戏的方式,继续关注过去与现在时态的对比,鼓励学生发散思维,关注句子表达的准确性。)
C. Talk about the holiday photos.
a) T: This is our game. And today we’ll go on with our trip in a very special way. Look, I have my photo. Do you have any questions about my photo?
(Where were you? / Who took it for you? / When did you take it? …)
b) Ask and answer the questions about the photos or pictures.
Qs: Where did you go for the holiday?
I went…
What did you do there?
I…
How was the weather?
It was…
Did you …?
Yes, I did. / No, I didn’t I…
(Have Ss read the questions together.)
(设计意图:以问答形式就照片内容进行交谈,教师根据学生所提问题进行适当的补充,在学生了解别人的假日照片之后,介绍自己的照片。)
Step 2 Talk about holiday photos.
A. Talk about the teacher’s photo.
T: Now, maybe you can give me more questions about my photo.
I was thirty.
I went there the year before.
I went there for travelling.
I travelled many places, like Ali Mountain, Taibei.
…
B. Have Ss take out their photos and try to ask and answer.
a) Do pair work.
b) 投影问答。
Step 3 Make the holiday album.
A. T: You can make your holiday album, if you want to introduce your photo, that means you want to say something about your photo. Try to think about what can you talk about.
? photo ?
? ? ?
Have Ss discuss in two: What can you talk about?
(设计意图:让学生思考介绍假日照片的哪些方面,用思维导图帮助学生发散思维,让学生有话可说。)
C. Show a photo and a short passage to the students. And have Ss read it.
地点-----时间-----天气-----做的事-----food-----feelings-----culture----people
(设计意图:通过让学生阅读范文,思考以怎样的顺序介绍照片,通过观察范例,理清思路,学生就知道怎样条理清楚地介绍自己的照片。)
Step 4 Make your album and give a report.
Step 1: Decide what and how to talk about your photo.
Step 2: A. Write the notes. B. Write a short passage.
Step 3: Make the holiday album in groups.
Step 4: Prepare to give a report in turns.
(设计意图:在小组合作完成相册制作过程中,分层设置任务,让学生自主选择,自己动手合作完成。)
E. Have Ss make album and give the report.
1. 观赏阅读同学的假日相册,互相提出修改意见。
2. 听取别人的修改意见后修改自己的假日相册内容。
3. 试试做一个电子假日相册,并用英语进行介绍。
(设计意图:家庭作业的布置,让学生学会互相欣赏和借鉴以便改进自己。)
英语语音课件
如果您需要不同主题的内容,教师范文大全为您预备了一份“英语语音课件”。每位老师都需要提前规划好每节课的教学课件,写好教案和课件也是他们必须要具备的基本技能。优质的教案和课件可以保证教学质量和效果的提高。非常感谢您花费时间阅读本文!
英语语音课件 篇1
英语音标教学课件
随着全球化的不断深入,英语成为了全球通用的语言,因此学好英语变得越来越重要。而英语音标是英语学习的重要环节,也是建立语音基础的关键。本文将探讨英语音标教学课件的编写和应用,帮助学生更好地掌握英语音标知识。
一、英语音标的介绍
英语音标是一个标记英语语音的符号系统。它由40个音标字母组成,分为元音和辅音两类。英语音标可以帮助学生准确地发音,并且更容易理解和掌握英语语音系统,从而提高听说能力和语言交际能力。
在选择英语音标教学课件时,教师应该注重几个方面:
1、与学生的年龄和水平相适应
2、能够直观地呈现英语音标符号和发音规则
3、能够让学生通过互动练习与运用巩固所学知识
二、英语音标教学课件的设计
1、界面设计
课件的界面设计应该简洁、明了,色彩搭配以及字体选择要合理,以便吸引学生的注意力。界面要体现学科性和趣味性。
2、课件内容
(1)英语音标的基本介绍
应包括音标的定义、历史,各类英语音标的分类等。
(2)单个音标的学习
介绍音标符号及其发音,重点强调摸清发音位置和发音方式。
(3)音标的连读
介绍和讲解英语中的连读,如元音和辅音的连读,辅音和辅音的连读等。
(4)不同音标之间的区别
介绍各音标间的区别,包括元音和辅音,不同的音标读音时要注意的区别。
3、课后练习
课件中应包含一些与学过的内容有关的互动练习,通过练习可以帮助学生巩固所学知识,提高学生的理解和记忆能力。
三、英语音标教学应用
英语音标教学课件的应用可以帮助教师更好地将语音知识传递给学生,同时可以提高学生的学习兴趣,并且通过练习理解和掌握英语音标的正确发音方法。
在教学中,教师可以根据学生的实际水平,选取不同难度的教材和课件,并且在课堂中加入互动环节,让学生在学过的内容上进行联系,增加课堂的趣味性。同时可以引导学生实践英语音标和语音知识,如朗读练习、美式英语音准测试等。这些实践活动可以促进学生语音能力的发展,增强英语学习的信心和兴趣。
总之,英语音标教学课件的编写和应用是英语教育中的重要内容,可以帮助学生掌握和运用英语语音知识,同时也可以提高教学效果和学习效果。
英语语音课件 篇2
Title: Teaching English Phonetics with Interactive Lessons and Activities
Introduction:
Phonetics is a fundamental part of learning English as a second language. To communicate effectively, learners must have a proper understanding and command of English phonetics, including pronunciation, intonation, and stress patterns. However, teaching English phonetics can be challenging because it requires learners to not only memorize the symbols and sounds of English but also to apply them in real-life situations.
This article presents some innovative ways to teach English phonetics using interactive lessons and activities that aim to engage learners and promote active participation.
Part 1: The Importance of English Phonetics
English phonetics is crucial for effective second language acquisition, as it helps learners understand and produce the sounds of English accurately. An understanding of English phonetics also helps learners to discern words when they hear them and to recognize patterns of stress and intonation that are critical for effective communication.
Part 2: Teaching English Phonetics with Interactive Lessons
Interactive lessons are an effective way to teach English phonetics as they allow learners to engage with the material and actively participate in the learning process. Here are a few examples of interactive lessons that can be used to teach English phonetics:
1. Phonics Games: Phonics games are a fun and effective way to teach English phonetics to young learners. Games such as "Phonics Bingo" and "Phonics Memory" help children associate sounds with words and reinforce their understanding of English phonetics.
2. Pronunciation Drills: Pronunciation drills are an essential part of English phonetics learning. Using audio and visual aids, learners can practice producing English sounds correctly. Video lessons and pronunciation apps, such as "PronunciationCoach," can provide learners with instant feedback.
3. Conversation Practice: Conversational practice is an integral part of English phonetics learning, as it helps learners apply the sounds and patterns they have learned in real-life situations. Activities such as role-playing, pair work, and group discussions can help learners develop their communication skills while putting their knowledge of English phonetics to use.
Part 3: Activities for Teaching English Phonetics
In addition to interactive lessons, there are many activities that can be used to teach English phonetics. Here are a few examples:
1. Tongue Twisters: Tongue twisters are short phrases or sentences that are difficult to pronounce correctly, making them an excellent way to practice English phonetics. Learners can practice their pronunciation by saying tongue twisters repeatedly until they can say them without any errors.
2. Listening Exercises: Listening exercises help learners distinguish between the different sounds of English and recognize patterns of stress and intonation. Audio exercises, such as "Minimal Pairs" and "Listen and Repeat," allow learners to hear the differences between similar-sounding words and improve their listening skills.
3. Song Lyrics: Using song lyrics to teach English phonetics is an effective way to engage learners and help them learn English in a fun and memorable way. Learners can identify the sounds and stress patterns in song lyrics and practice singing along to improve their pronunciation.
Conclusion:
Teaching English phonetics is crucial for effective second language acquisition. Using interactive lessons and activities, learners can engage with the material, actively participate in the learning process, and apply their knowledge of English phonetics in real-life situations. With the right tools and techniques, teaching English phonetics can be an enjoyable and rewarding experience for both teachers and students.
英语语音课件 篇3
主题:如何有效教授英语音标
导语:英语音标是学习英语语音的基础,掌握好英语音标,有利于更好的发音和交流。对于英语教师来说,如何有效教授英语音标也是一个不可忽视的问题。本文将从以下几个方面来探讨如何有效教授英语音标。
一、对于不同级别的学生要采用不同的教学方法。
对于初学者,建议教师采用基础的发音教学方法,如:先教授元音和辅音发音,慢慢引导学生正确发音,渐进式地教授音标。对于进阶的学生,教师可以采用更高级的教学方法,如:介绍单词中的词缀和词根,通过词缀和词根认识一些不常见的发音规则,提高学生的语音熟练度。
二、使用趣味教具、多媒体辅助教学。
音标的教学应该尽量丰富多彩,应该利用多种教学方式来吸引学生的注意力,提高学生的学习兴趣和积极性,让学生在愉快的氛围中学习音标。比如:可以使用一些形象鲜明的教具,如卡片、表情包等。同时,也可以使用多媒体辅助教学,如幻灯片、视频等,来模拟真实的语音场景,让学生更好地理解和掌握音标。
三、注重语音训练,进行反复模仿练习。
学生掌握了音标的正确发音后,就需要进一步加强语音训练,进行反复模仿练习。因为语音训练是掌握英语音标的关键,只有经过反复练习,才能真正掌握好音标,减少发音错误。在具体教学中,教师可以通过一些语音训练和练习的游戏来帮助学生加强语音训练,如音标一笔画、语音练习地图等。
四、形成好的学习习惯,进行反馈和复习。
为了让学生更好地掌握英语音标,教师还需要帮助学生形成好的学习习惯,如每天进行一定量的语音训练、复习和巩固音标知识,定期进行自我检测和反馈。同时教师要重视反馈,了解学生的学习情况,并为学生提供帮助和指导。最后,要让学生知道学习英语音标是一个不断学习的过程,不要放弃,勇于尝试,相信自己一定能掌握好英语音标。
结语:英语音标教学不仅需要掌握好教学方法,还需要教师具有耐心和毅力,学生也要有积极性和持续学习的信心。希望本文能够为英语教师的音标教学提供一些思路和启示,让更多的学生能够受益。
英语语音课件 篇4
English Phonetics Teaching: Understanding the Sounds of English
English phonetics is the study of the sounds used in the English language. It is an essential part of language learning and is necessary to develop proper pronunciation, observation, and retention of English words. Teaching English phonetics with clarity and accuracy provides fundamental benefits to English learners, including building vocabulary, developing communicational skills, and increasing confidence in understanding and speaking the language.
In the modern age of globalization, English is now the primary language of communication worldwide. It can be used in different contexts, such as academic, professional, and social settings. To effectively communicate in English, learners must master the basics of English phonetics, including the fundamental elements of sound, intonation, stress, and rhythm.
Sound is the most basic element of English phonetics. It is the basis for creating words, sentences, and speech. As such, it is essential to understand the anatomy of the human vocal tract and how it produces sound. Sounds are categorized into consonants and vowels, and there are various types of each. For example, consonants can be plosive, fricative, nasal, or approximant, while vowels can be monophthong or diphthong.
Intonation, stress, and rhythm are also essential elements in English phonetics. Intonation refers to the tone of voice used in speech, which can convey different meanings, depending on the context. Stress is the emphasis placed on a word or syllable in a sentence, affecting its significance. Rhythm is the pattern and speed of speech, and it can impact the perception of meaning by the listener.
Teaching English phonetics effectively requires incorporation of innovative teaching methodologies that cater to the learners. The use of interactive multimedia, for instance, can enhance the learning experience and promote the retention of knowledge. By utilizing visual aids, such as phonetic symbols, the correspondence between sound and its representation becomes clear, facilitating the learners' understanding. In addition, it is essential to incorporate listening and speaking exercises in teaching, which gives the students an opportunity to practice and apply the concepts learned.
The importance of proper pronunciation in English language learning can't be overstated. The use of phonetics teaching in English language learning has proved to be a necessary tool in improving the learners' communication skills. As such, English phonetics teaching should be pursued with vigor as it enables learners to achieve fluency, better clarity, and the confidence to converse with the natives.
In conclusion, English phonetics is a significant part of English language learning and requires a clear understanding of sound, intonation, stress, and rhythm. Its mastery requires an interactive and engaging approach, such as utilizing visual aids and practical exercises. By pursuing English phonetics teaching, learners can develop effective communication skills and a better understanding of the English language.
英语语音课件 篇5
Introduction:
Phonetics is an essential aspect of learning English language. Understanding phonetics would help learners to pronounce words correctly. A basic understanding of phonetics is important for both learners whose first language is English and those from non-English speaking countries. The English language has a total of 44 sounds, including vowel and consonant sounds. It is critical for learners to understand how to produce these sounds correctly to communicate effectively in English language.
Main body:
1. Vowel sounds
Vowel sounds are produced when air flows out through the mouth without being obstructed by the lips or tongue. There are 20 vowel sounds in English language. Understanding these sounds is crucial to aid pronunciation and comprehension of words. The vowel sounds in English can be further classified according to their length, quality, and position of the tongue and lips when producing the sound. Commonly, they are presented on the International Phonetic Alphabet (IPA), a system of phonetic notation that denotes each sound with a unique symbol.
2. Consonant sounds
Consonant sounds are produced when air is blocked by the lips, teeth, or tongue. There are 24 consonant sounds in English language. These sounds can be further classified according to whether they are voiced or voiceless, place of articulation, and manner of articulation. Most of these sounds differ from one language to another, and as such, learning them may be a bit challenging for a non-native English speaker. However, with the help of phonetic drills, learners can acquire a correct understanding and pronunciation of English consonant sounds.
3. Syllables and stress
Syllables are the basic building blocks of words, each containing one vowel sound. However, some syllables may contain more than one vowel sound, such as in the word 'create,' which has two syllables. Understanding syllables in English language is necessary for correct pronunciation and context comprehension. Therefore, it is essential to learn how to break down words into syllables to produce them correctly.
Stress in English language is often placed on certain syllables in a word or sentence. The natural stressing of syllables is important for understanding the meaning of words in context. In English, stress is placed on different syllables depending on the word or sentence. Therefore, it is critical for learners to learn the rules of stress placement to communicate effectively in English.
Conclusion:
Learning phonetics is essential for every learner who intends to communicate effectively in English language. Phonetics provides learners with the necessary tools needed to pronounce words correctly in English. Without an adequate understanding of phonetics, learners may find it challenging to communicate effectively in English. Therefore, learners must devote their time, energy, and resources to mastering phonetics to succeed in their pursuit of English language mastery.
英语语音课件 篇6
英语音标教学课件
随着英语的普及和使用的范围变得更加广泛,在现代社会中,作为一种全球通用语言,英语就像氧气一样存在着。因此,学习英语的重要性就凸显出来了。在英语学习中,英语音标就是一个非常重要的组成部分,因为它可以帮助我们准确地发音,无论是听力还是口语训练都离不开英语音标。
为了更加有效地教授英语音标,我们需要有一套专门的英语音标教学课件,这样才能使学员更加深入地学习,更加轻松地理解和掌握英语音标的知识。
本次英语音标教学的主题是“入门级英语音标教学课件”,在这门课程中,我们将以“音符,音形,音典”为主要参照点,让学员更好地了解英语音标的概念、发音规则,并能够较为准确地发出英语单词和短语的正确发音。
本课程主要包括以下三个方面的内容:
一、音符
对于初学者来说,最重要的是先学习英语音标的发音标记,因此在课件的第一部分,我们将详细介绍英语音标的30个发音标记,帮助学员逐步掌握这些音符的基本知识和发音规则。
二、音形
学了音符以后,就需要学习如何将这些音符组合成为单词和短语。在课件的第二部分,我们将通过多种形式,如图片、音频、视频等,让学员学习如何将音符进行组合,以识别和记住单词和短语的正确读音。同时,在练习单词和短语发音的过程中,我们也会针对常见的发音错误进行讲解和纠正。
三、音典
最后,在课件的第三部分,我们将介绍如何使用英语发音字典,并让学员亲自体验这个过程。我们会详细介绍英语发音字典的使用方法,让学员学会如何在字典中查找单词,了解单词的读音,并进行练习。通过这样的学习过程,学员可以更好地掌握英语发音和英语语言的应用。
通过以上三个方面的详细介绍和讲解,本课件不仅可以帮助学员建立起英语音标的概念,更加关注英语音标的实际应用,使学员能够从中获得更多更广泛的发音知识。通过本课件的学习,学员可以逐步掌握英语发音的技巧,不断提高自己的发音水平,帮他们更好地应对在英语学习和实际应用中遇到的挑战。同时,本课件也可以作为英语教学中的一个有力辅助工具,帮助老师更好地教授英语语音发音,提高课堂教学效果。
总之,英语音标教学课件是一种非常实用和有力的英语教学工具,不仅能够帮助学员掌握发音规则和技巧,还能够提高教学效果和教学质量。对于初学者来说,本课件的学习将是一个非常有价值和有效的过程,帮助他们更快地进入英语学习的世界,掌握更多更实用的英语知识。
2024英语班课件
身为一名教师,编写课程教案和课件是一个不可或缺的任务,如果还没有完成的话就要引起注意了。学生的反应可以反映教学质量的好坏。小编特意为你准备了一篇名为“英语班课件”的文章,希望能够激发你的思维。感谢你的阅读,希望这篇文章能够让你快乐并与你的亲人分享!
英语班课件 篇1
英语活动内容:bigandsmall目标:通过看看、做做、分分,让幼儿来了解大和小,并结合学习big,small激发幼儿学习英语的兴趣。准备:气球设计:
1、引起兴趣看看
师从区域角取来气球问:这是什么?,刚刚谁玩过?你是怎么玩的?,我们一起来吹气球,好吗?。(师吹气球,请幼儿看看气球的变化)
2、做做
我们一起来让气球变大,变小。
学单词big:师把气球吹大,幼儿双手手心相对分开,听到big,big,big,幼儿双手相对距离加大。
学单词small,师将吹大的气球放气,幼儿双手手心相对,听到small,small,small,幼儿双手相对距离缩小。
3、分分
幼儿在教室里找找,布置的环境中有没有big和small。
示范:先区分师所提供的材料的大小,并能有针对性的根据大小粘贴。
例如:大树上粘大树叶,小树上粘贴小树叶等。
4、延伸
我们从生活中找找哪里有bigandsmall。设计:
1、引起兴趣看看
师从区域角取来气球问:这是什么?,刚刚谁玩过?你是怎么玩的?,我们一起来吹气球,好吗?。(师吹气球,请幼儿看看气球的变化)
2、做做
我们一起来让气球变大,变小。
学单词big:师把气球吹大,幼儿双手手心相对分开,听到big,big,big,幼儿
双手相对距离加大。
学单词small,师将吹大的气球放气,幼儿双手手心相对,听到small,small,small,幼儿双手相对距离缩小。
3、分分
幼儿在教室里找找,布置的环境中有没有big和small。
示范:先区分师所提供的材料的大小,并能有针对性的根据大小粘贴。
例如:大树上粘大树叶,小树上粘贴小树叶等。
4、延伸
我们从生活中找找哪里有bigandsmall。
英语班课件 篇2
活动目标:
1、复习颜色单词:redyellow .
2、学习颜色单词:greegostop
3、通过游戏初步学会句型:Let’s go! Stop !
活动准备:
红、黄、绿、三色卡片、红、绿交通灯信号牌
游戏音乐磁带。红、黄、绿三色塑料圈(当方向盘)若干。
马路上交通情景录象。
活动过程:
一、幼儿随音乐和教师律动进入活动室。
二、通过游戏复习并学习颜色:redyellowgree
1、教师出示红色和黄色卡片,提问:“What colour is it?”请幼儿回答。
2、教师出示绿色的卡片,提问“What colour is it?”教幼儿绿色的英语green.并引导幼儿:“你见过的什么东西也是绿色的?”
3、引导幼儿观察自己或同伴身上的衣服或活动室内的玩具、装饰、气球,找一找哪里有红、黄、绿三种颜色。
4、根据老师出示颜色卡片的提示演唱歌曲《What is the colour》。
三、通过游戏学习句型:
1、交通灯。
(1)、教师先请幼儿观看马路上的交通情景的录象。请幼儿讨论
师:看过了录象,你发现了什么规则?当红灯亮的时候,汽车怎么了?绿灯亮时,汽车又怎么了?
请幼儿一边看录象一边听老师讲,并学习新单词:go、 stop
(2)、教师扮演交通警察,幼儿当汽车司机。当红灯亮时,汽车要停下,当绿灯亮时,汽车就可以开了。
(3)、请一幼儿当交通警察,教师带领其他幼儿当司机。看到红灯时,教师引导幼儿一起说:“Stop!”。当看到绿灯时,幼儿跟着教师说:“Let’s go!”。
(4)、请另一位幼儿当交通警察,游戏反复进行。
2、开汽车。
教师请幼儿自由选择方向盘,并提问:“What colour is your car?”
幼儿根据自己方向盘的颜色回答老师。并随着音乐自由开车。当看到老师举起绿色交通信号牌时,幼儿们一起说:“Let’go !”
随音乐开车出活动室。
四、结束。
在游戏中自然结束。
英语班课件 篇3
活动目标:
1、 通过游戏活动,初步了解snail、creep的含义,并能正确、大胆的发音。
2、 在丰富多彩的英语活动中,培养幼儿对英语活动的兴趣。
活动准备:
课件《Happy snail》,歌曲《Happy birthday》《Bingo》,蜗牛头饰人手一份,叶子若干。
活动过程:
一、Song:《Happy birthday》
1、 Today is one little animal birthday. Let’sing a song,ok?
2、 Sing the song《Happy birthday》
3、 观赏课件。
A、 Let’s guess who is it?(你们猜猜是谁的生日?)(幼儿说出动物的名称如:tiger、monkey时课件中出现动物的形象。)
B、 观赏课件《Happy birthday》
C、 Its name is a snail.学习单词:snail(蜗牛)的发音。
D、 Oh! How beautiful! Here are flowers, cake, and candles. The snail is very happy.
二、 Game.《Happy snail》
1、 出示蜗牛头饰:Who is it? 巩固练习snail 的发音。
2、 I have a lot of snails. Who wants? Say its name.
3、 How does the snail walk? Creep(爬行)Who can creep too?(Snake can creep. Tortoise can creep.幼儿可自由的做些动作。)
4、 欣赏课件:幼儿感受蜗牛缓慢的爬行。慢慢slowly.
5、 Slowly,slowly,veryslowly ,snail creep slowly.幼儿坐在座位上模仿蜗牛爬行。
6、 Let’s creep like snail.幼儿边爬行边念短语Slowly,slowly,veryslowly ,snail creep slowly.
7、 Do you
want to play games with me?Let’s play a new game.
A、 what’s this?Leaf. Snail like leaf. There are a lot of leaves here.
B、 教师示范游戏。Little snails have set out.Pick up the leaf and put it in the middle of the e back.
C、 幼儿游戏。
三、结束活动。
1、 Let’s give the leaf to the little snail.
2、 Sing the song《Bingo》。
3、 Say goodbye to the teachers.
英语班课件 篇4
教学目的:
1.通过活动复习:iamhot.imthirsty.whoisit?itsme.
2.复习儿歌歌曲《谁在敲门》,《小狗和小熊》,《几只猴子》,《招待客人》,《请进来》。
教学重点难点:
巩固单词的正确发音,句子的正确语调
教学准备:
1.小狗、小猫、小鸡、小鸭、小熊、熊妈妈、熊猫服饰;
2.小熊家一角,模拟电话亭;
3.果汁、牛奶、水果等实物若干;
4.图片一幅(图片中有猴子、苹果、桃子)。
教学过程:
(一)小熊的家(熊妈妈正在做家务)
1.littlebear跑进屋子里喊:mummy!mummy!hot,hot.iamhot.imthirsty.
2.熊妈妈:juiceormilk?
littlebear:juice,please.
接过果汁说:thankyou.
小熊正在喝果汁,电话铃响了。
(二)电话亭和小熊的家小狗、小猫、小鸡、小鸭在电话亭打电话:
1.littlebear:hello,doggy.
doggy:hello,littlebear.woof―woof―woof.
littlebear:yes.
2.littlebear:hello,kitty.
kitty:hello,littlebear.mew―mew―mew.
littlebear:allright.
3.littlebear:hello,chick.
chick:hello,littlebear.piou―piou―piou.
littlebear:yes,yes.
4.littlebear:hello,duck.
duck:hello,littlebear:quack―quack―quack.
littlebear:great.
(三)小熊的家门口
1.小熊站在门口,misspanda来了,小熊忙说:
please,please,please.
comein,please.
sitdown,please.
drinksomewater,please.
haveacookie,please.
haveacandy,please.
haveapeach,please.
haveanapple,please.
haveabanana,please.please.please.please.
misspanda:thankyou.(或no.thankyou或yes,please)
这时门铃响了。
2.doggy边敲门边唱:
pong,pong,pong,pong.
pong,pong,pong,pong.
littlebear唱:whoisit?whoisit?
doggy唱:itsme,doggy,itsme,doggy.pong,pong,pong,pong,pong,pong.
(littlebear打开门)
doggy唱:iamdoggy.iamdoggy.
littlebear:imlittlebear.imlittlebear.hello.
doggy唱:hello,littlebear,hello,littlebear,唱完后
littlebear说:comeinplease.
doggy:thankyou.doggy进门后把礼物递给
littlebear说:somecookiesforyou.thankyou
(小熊去放礼物,小狗与misspanda打招呼)
littledoggy说:hi!misspanda.
misspanda说:hi!doggy,comehere,sitdown,please.
doggy:thankyou.小熊招待小狗时,门再次被敲响。
3.kitty敲门同小狗,kitty进门后把礼物递给小熊:
somepeachsforyou.
小熊:thankyou.
小熊去放礼物,小猫与misspanda,doggy打招呼。
doggy招呼小猫:comehere,sitdown,please.
小猫:thankyou.
小熊招待小猫时门被敲响(misspanda,doggy,kitty藏起来)
4.chick边敲门边唱:
pong,pong,pong,pong.pong,pong,pong,pong.
littlebear唱:whoisit?whoisit?
chick唱:itsmechick,itsmechick.
littlebear唱:comein,please.
chick唱:thankyou,thankyou.小鸡进门后把礼物递给小熊:somecandiesforyou.
littlebear:thankyou.小熊去放礼物
misspanda,doggy,kitty跳出来与小鸡打招呼。
kitty:comehere,sitdown,please.
小鸡说:thankyou.
小熊招待小鸡时门又响了。
5.小鸭敲门同小鸡,小鸭进门后把礼物递给小熊:somebananasforyou.
小熊:thankyou!在小鸭敲门时藏好的客人跳出来与小鸭打招呼,这时放好礼物的小熊招呼大家:look.look.myfamily.mydaddy,mymummy,mygrandpa,mygrandma,andi(客人边点头边说:oh,
英语班课件 篇5
animals
教学目标:让幼儿学会动物英语名称
课程游戏及活动:
日常用语:what’s the weather like today? It’s a su y day
How are you feeling today ? I am ha y / sad /angry
1、单词教学: bird turtle pig dog
① 出示闪卡,让小朋友熟悉单词
② 以猜词游戏让小朋友再次熟悉单词,带入句型 Is it a bird ?/ Is it a turtle ? Yes or No
2、Sentences: I like bird/turtle/pig/dog
bird bird very cute
游戏:who is crying? 把小朋友分成 turtle、bird两组,通过比赛,把little turtles and little birds 送到妈妈家
3、律动: bad wolf bad wolf
knock on the door
Don’t open ,don’t open the door
游戏:who is coming ? the bad wolf ,小朋友随音乐一起做律动,当音乐停,小朋友以最快的速度跑坐位,抓住了就要被bad wolf吃掉。
英语班课件 篇6
目标:
1、会用英文句型对话——Eatyourcake!Drinkyourjuice!Getonthebus!getoffthebus!
2、体验英语活动的快乐。
准备:画有cake和juice的卡片、闪卡、榔头,磁带。
过程:
一、Greeting.
Hello,LiLi!
二、Warmup(暖身活动)
Teacher:Standup.Let’tsingasong.Sitdown.
三、NewContent.
1、教师先以图片教小朋友bus。
2、Getonthebus!getoffthebus!TpR互动hittinggame请幼儿做敲击游戏。
3、学习cakejuice
4、老师以动作显示饥饿,引出词组eatyourcake。待蛋糕吃完,老师突然做嗌住状,引出词组drinkyourjuice,并和小朋友互动。TpR互动bombgame
5、Let’splayagame
a.Gueingcard
b.wolf游戏
6、歌曲歌谣。复习所有学过的歌曲歌谣。
四、结束Say”byebye.”
英语班课件 篇7
活动名称:
英语——快乐歌曲《train is coming》
活动目标:
1、引导幼儿学习歌曲《train is coming》。
2、激发幼儿对英语歌曲的喜爱和兴趣。
活动准备:
教学碟片。大挂图。
活动过程:
Step 1 师生互相问好
T :good morning ,hoys and girls ,how are you today ?
C :I am fine ,and you ?
T :I am fine too。What season is it?
C :it is winter。
T :how is the weather like in winter ?
C :it is very cold and dry 。
T :do you like the weather ?
C :no ,I don‘t 。
T :(show out a clock)what is this ?turn round the clock and ask :what time is it ?what do you do on that time?
C :it is nine o‘clock 。
T :first ,let us sing 《animals》《a long snake 》《Landon bridge is falling down》《my little rabbits》together。
Step 2 复习单词
1、Teacher show out the teaching picture of “motor、plane、train、car、bus、bike”children must point to the cards as soon as quickly。And say out the English loudly。
2、teacher point to the big teaching picture and ask:what is this?,children must answer out at once。
Step 3 学习歌曲
1、tell children that we will learn a new song called《train is coming》。
2、explain the Chinese mining of the song 。
3、play the tape ,make children listen to the tape carefully and command the music‘s speed。
4、play again ,make children say out the sentences that they have heard 。
5、lead children use different ways to feel the music。For example :clap hands /stamp feet /nod head /open mouse etc。
6、lead children to learn the song sentence by sentence after teacher 。
7、children sing the song together with the piano 。
8、children sing the song in teams /in singles 。then sing with the fingers game 。
Step 4 over movement
英语班课件 篇8
活动目标:
1、学习新单词 daddymammysistherborther
2、复习常用语 good morning
3、在游戏中体验学习的乐趣。
活动准备:
四个房子、 bobo熊、律动音乐、录音机、单词卡片
活动过程:
1、(worm up)热身运动
(1 ) 打招呼 good morning
(2 ) hallo ,hi 游戏
2、new words (新授)
(1)出示bobo熊,打招呼
师:你们知道这是谁的家吗?
(2)游戏:敲门
* 请幼儿敲门,幼儿边发出咚咚咚的声音边将门打开!
* 请幼儿将daddy 喊出来,认识一下daddy的形象:抽着烟斗的!
* 请幼儿大声得将daddy喊到房顶上去。
* 依次进行(过程中可以请幼儿单独敲敲)
3、lisenning game (听力游戏):轮流
小椅子上放单词卡片,请四名幼儿分别扮演daddymammysistherborther ,蹲在小椅子背后,教师在后面指挥,下面的幼儿根据教师的指挥说英文,相对应的幼儿把头漏出来!
4、speaking game (说的游戏) :捉迷藏
四名幼儿拿着卡片躲在房子后面,请下面的幼儿猜测家里的人,猜对了幼儿就会从房子里出来!
5、dance (律动):my family
6、goodbye
Go home , to be a little teacher , tell you daddy and mummy what you lernr today 。
课后反思:
1、英语游戏的合理选择和贴切运用
我选择符合幼儿年龄特点的游戏,使他们产生极大的兴趣,在积极的游戏活动中习得英语,小班孩子以有趣的教玩具来激发他们的兴趣, 英语教学游戏化是使幼儿对英语习得的过程变得愉快、有趣、轻松及充分发挥幼儿学习的主体性,所以我以游戏的.形式展开。选择了适合幼儿和教学内容的游戏形式!
2、广泛的英语游戏形式
整个活动我选用了三个游戏,新授时设计的敲门游戏显然孩子们很兴奋,在通过学动作、喊出来、吹到房顶上的活动给孩子说的机会,加深新单词的印象。听的游戏在于让幼儿能根据教师(幼儿)的口令进行,这一环节应该是孩子们很感兴趣的,由于是新授的,所以孩子在说的时候有点困难,如果在让下面的孩子说之前教师先示范,可能效果会更好!说的游戏让孩子从房子里钻出来吸引幼儿的兴趣,目的在于巩固幼儿对单词的认识,又给幼儿提供了一次说的机会!律动也是相对应的 my family , 给幼儿放松的时间动起来!
3、存在的不足
在听力游戏的时候应该以听为主,我请下面的幼儿做指挥显然是有点困难的,如果在请幼儿做指挥前教师师范一下加深印象我想效果会更好!
英语班课件 篇9
牛牛妈妈
本次活动以大四班的小朋友为教学对象,向小朋友们介绍不同的国家在语言、文化及人的不同,引导小朋友们了解国家的概念,培养小朋友认知世界及学习英语的兴趣,并且开阔小朋友们的眼界。
一、活动主题:不同的国家
二、活动目标
1引导孩子们认识世界和国家观念
2.让小朋友了解不同国家语言、文化及人的不同,激发小朋友认知这个世界的兴趣
三。通过教学过程中一些英语的互动,培养孩子学习语言的兴趣
三、教学准备
教学***,明信片
四、活动过程
1.认识地球(earth):
我们生活在地球上。地球是什么形状的?like a ball.
当你从太空瞰地球时,地球时什么颜色的?因为地球表面的71%被海洋覆盖。
地球是我们人类生存的家园,人类在这个星球上繁衍生息,她就像一个母亲,为我们提供生存的资源和条件。我们是地球的主人。我们应该像对待自己一样保护她。
2.认识不同的国家:
世界上有233个不同的国家和地区。
孩子们,我们来自哪个国家?china
小朋友都知道哪些国家呢?
世界上有那么多国家。不同的国家是一样的吗?有哪些不同呢?今天,老师将带领你了解不同国家的差异。
(1)不同国家,不同的语言
每个国家都有自己的语言,我们中国人讲汉语,日本人讲日语,韩国人讲韩语,俄罗斯讲俄语,意大利讲意大利语,法国人说法语,美国、英国、澳大利亚这些国家将英语。
有哪位小朋友可以告诉老师,在中国我们见了面怎么打招呼呢?(你好、早上好......)
英语怎么说你好呢?(hello. hi. good morning...)
法语:bonjour
意大利语:ciao
不同的语言,不同国家的人如何交流?就需要我们学习同一种语言,英语就是世界的语言,大家要好好学习英语,长大了才能才能去不同的国家和更多的人交流,成为好朋友。
(2)不同的国家,不同文化
1) 向孩子们介绍不同国家的会议礼仪,让他们学会做不同的会议礼仪
握手:这是一种非常常见的礼节,通常在见面,分开和互相祝贺时使用。一般来说,男孩握手时不能戴手套。他们必须赤身**。女孩可以戴手套。
一般是伸出右手来握手。握手的时候要双目注视对方,面带笑容,上身要略微前倾,头要微低。
拥抱:欧洲、美国和中东的常见礼仪。右臂上举,左臂放下,右手放在对手左后肩上,用左手轻轻握住对方右后腰。头部和身体向右拥抱,然后向左,最后向左。
合十礼,又名合掌礼,流行于南亚和东南亚。两手掌心在胸前,掌心与鼻尖基本相对,掌心向外倾斜,头部略低,面带微笑。
贴面礼:在欧洲国家,两个老朋友见面不仅仅会握手和拥抱,还会行贴面礼。行礼时,用右手扶着对方的左肩,左手搂住对方的腰,右——左——右贴面三次,如果两个人关系比较亲密的话,还会在贴面的同时发出亲吻的声音。
鞠躬示对他人净重的理解。向学生向老师、小朋友们向自己的长辈(爷爷奶奶、外公外婆、爸爸妈妈)行的一种礼仪。鞠躬是中国、韩国、日本和朝鲜的一种常见礼仪。
鞠躬时,应戴好帽子并脱下帽子,因为戴帽子鞠躬不礼貌,而且容易滑落,这使您处于尴尬境地。鞠躬时目光应向下看,表示一种谦恭的态度,不要一面鞠躬,一面试图翻起眼睛看对方。
摸鼻礼:在新西兰是一种古老的见面礼仪。毛利主人在初次见面时必须和客人鼻尖对鼻尖连碰两三次,碰的次数越多,时间越长,则说明客人越受他们尊敬。
接吻:是欧美上流社会的一种礼仪。吻手礼一般是男孩子亲吻女孩子的手,并且一般是亲吻在指背。
一般来说,如果女孩先伸出她的手,男孩会轻轻地举起手掌亲吻。但如果女孩不伸手,男孩就不会接吻。
2) 给孩子们介绍不同的饮食方法
小朋友们,你们平时用什么来吃饭呢?会用筷子的孩子能举手让老师看看吗?
筷子,是指中国常用的饮食工具,有竹子做的,有木头做的,有骨头做的,还有金属筷子。筷子是世界上常用餐具之一,是我们中华饮食文化的标志之一,发明于中国,后传至朝鲜半岛、日本、越南等国家。
孩子们,在我们的生活中,筷子总是朴素易懂。但是筷子是中华民族最珍贵的传统文化之一。作为中国人,我们必须坚持用好筷子。筷子筷子两头一圆一方,这正是源于“天圆地方”、“民以食为天”的说法。
筷子总是两个成双成对,就像生活,有开心的事情,也有不开心的事情,但是最终要的就是要和爱我们的家人在一起。
在欧洲和拉丁美洲,刀叉是主要的食具,因为他们的食物主要与肉类有关。欧洲以畜牧业为主,主食是牛羊肉,用刀切肉,送进口,最方便。吃饭时,左右手互相配合,即刀叉成对使用。
握刀叉的基本原则是右手拿刀或勺子,左手拿叉子,用手轻轻握住刀叉末端,食指按在刀柄上。
还有一些国家,干脆直接用手来抓饭吃,包括非洲、西亚、印度等国家。其实印度之所以用这样的方式吃饭,因为他们觉得这样是对食物的一种尊重,用手抓取可以更直接的与食物接触,体验这个进食的过程是很美好的。当然,他们会洗手非常干净,以防影响健康。
3)不同的国家,不同的长相
从这张画上面,我们可以看到这些小朋友的头发(hair)、肤色(skin)都是不同的。虽然大父母不同,但他们可以手拉手成为好朋友。
肤色:世界上不同的肤色一般可以分为4种:白色(white)、黄色(yellow)、棕色(brown)和黑色(black)。
眼睛的颜色有黑色、棕色、蓝色、绿色和银色。
虽然不同的人,不同的相貌,但我们生活在同一个世界里,我们都是平等的,可以成为好朋友。
结束语:
小朋友们,世界上有不同的国家、不同的语言、不同的人、还有不同的建筑、不同的风景、不同的气候,千奇百怪,丰富多彩,需要大家通过不断的学习、不断的成长,用自己的双脚去踏上不同的土地,用自己的双眼去发现世界上各种美的有趣的事物,用自己的心去感受世界的美,用自己的双手去创造,为我们的世界贡献一份力量。
英语优秀课件系列
为了找到关于“英语优秀课件”的资料,您可以查阅以下资源,并请将本页网址收藏起来以防遗忘。教案课件是每个老师在开学前必须准备的东西。按要求,每个老师都应该制定和实施教案。教师在制定和实施教案的过程中展现了他们专业能力的重要体现。
英语优秀课件【篇1】
今天我说课的内容是人民教育出版社出版的PEP Primary English Book IV Unit 6 At a Farm.的第一课时主要学习sheep lamb goat cow horse hen六个新词。
本节课是单词教学。它是在学生初步学习了句型“How many……do you have?之后进行教学的。通过学习新词,感知句子What are they? They are…How many…为下节课的教学打下基础。本课时容量大但难度不大并受到学生的喜爱。
《英语课程标准》指出:激发和培养学生学习英语的兴趣,使学生树立自信心,养成良好的学习习惯和形成有效的学习策略,发展学生自主学习的能力和合作精神是小学英语教学的基本任务。在认真分析教材的基础上我针对学生实际,将本课时的教学目标及重难点确定如下:
(1) 使学生能听、说、认、读sheep lamb goat cow horse hen等单词。
(2) 初步感知:”What are they? They are… How many…How many……“等句子学生能听懂并理解其意思
2、能力目标:
(1) 能听懂Let’s do中的指令并做出相应动作。如Shear a sheep. 小学英语说课稿 (2) 能区分农场的动物 培养学生灵活运用所学知识进行交流的能力。
(1) 培养学生注意观察、认真模仿的良好习惯和主动竞争的竟识。
(2) 激发学生学习英语的兴趣,使学生树立学习英语的自信心。
学习新词sheep lamb goat cow horse hen 能正确认读
1. 培养学生合作学习的能力。,同时注意培养学生学习英语的兴趣, 树立自信心。
教师准备新旧单词卡片、录音机、磁带、流动小红旗、写句子的纸条、挂图。
为了突破这堂课的重、难点,根据小学生好奇、好胜、好动、模仿力强、表现欲旺盛等生理和心理特点,我主要采取了以任务型教学模式为主,以活动,合作为主线,让学生在教师的指导下,通过感知、体验、实践、参于和合作、游戏感悟等多法并用的方式组织教学。彻底改变传统的”授—受“的教学模式,促进语言实际运用能力的提高。
教育家托尔斯泰说过:”成功的教学所必须的不是强制,而是激发学生的兴趣,兴趣是推动学生学习的强大动力,是学生参于教学活动的基础。激发学生参于学习的兴趣,是新课导入的关键。Well begun half done. 精彩的课堂开头,往往给学生带来新意、亲切的感觉,不仅能使学生迅速地兴奋起来,而且还会使学生把学习当成一种自我需要,自然地进入学习新知的情景。
因此,在热身的时候,首先让学生分角色演唱歌曲:“Old MacDonald had a farm”,这样的导入能很快吸引住学生,同时还渲染了学生学习英语的良好气氛。
学生在一个平等尊重的氛围中,他们的思维是放松的,敢于说、敢于参于教学。教师要真心诚意地把学生当成学习的主人,努力提高“导”的艺术,从而在教学中恰到好处地去启发、点拔、尽可能地给学生多一点思考的时间,多一点活动的余地,多一点表现自己的机会,这样才能使课堂氛围充满活力。因此,我在这个环节于学生进行了朋友式的会话。It’s time for class. Are you ready ? Hello ! Boys and girls. How are you ? Nice to meet you. ? 不仅复习了旧知识,还渲染了学习英语的良好气氛。
(三)呈现新知合作互动。
在小学英语课堂中使学生保持一种积极的紧张感,能够激发他们学习的外部动机,引 发他们一系列的自主活动,促进外部动机向内部动机的转化。Today we are going to learn“Unit 6. At a Farm.”. I’ll divide you into four groups . Which one is best they’ll get the flag OK? Now Let’s start.于是我提出问题Do you like animals.引入学习主题,并通过挂图和音乐创设情景Let’s go to a farm. There are many animals自然引入新词的学习。在呈现新知时,我尤其注意了小学生形象思维优于抽象思维的特点,通过对比,听音,看动作等不同的方式引出新词,给学生议骖刻的第一印象。游戏所带来的乐趣会使每一位参于者保持一种积极的心态。游戏是儿童学习的一种重要途径,也是激发学生学习兴趣的最佳方法。正如苏霍姆林斯基指出:“如果用思考、情感、创造、游戏的光芒来照亮儿童的学习,那么学习对于儿童来说是可以成为一件有趣的事情”.因此,在操练时,我首先进行了一些机械的练习,如:“Listen point and repeat. ”听音、指词、跟读,“Look and Guess”看口形、猜单词。同时,我更注意抓住小学生好动的特点,辅以全身反应法,如模仿动物的叫声,或于之相关的动作(挤牛奶)等有趣的活动,充分激发学生学习的兴趣。同时在学习生词时感知句型,做到“词不离句,句不离词”,重视对学生思维,观察能力的培养,特别是对学生合作学习能力的培养,让学生们们在师生,生生,小组等不同的合作方式中,学会倾听,学会评价,为学生的终身学习奠定基础。
(四)课堂总结,及时评价。
通过对知识的小结,帮助学生将本课的信息进行加工、储存,从而明确教学目标、重点和难点;对学生的表现进行总结评价,以评价促发展,培养小组团队精神,激励学生大胆开口,积极活动,为小组争得荣誉。最后做活动手册,是一个常规练习,其目的在于全方位地、及时检测学生对本课时掌握的程度。
这节课不论是新知识的呈现,还是游戏的设计,都能紧紧地抓住学生,吸引学生,让学生积极参于到课堂中来。学生在玩中学,学中用,提高了课堂实效,培养了学生学习的兴趣。我相信通过这样的教学,充分让学生主体参于、体验感悟、游戏巩固,是一定能圆满实现课堂教学任务的。
我说课的内容是小学英语三年级上册第一单元第二课,本课是功能型的交际型的交际训练课,我借助“任务型”教学采用多样化的教学手段将听、说、玩、演、唱溶于一体,激发学生学习英语的兴趣和愿望,使学生通过合作学习体验荣誉感和成就感从而树立自信心,发展自主学习的能力,形成初步用英语进行简单日常交际的能力。
结合新课程标准和大纲提出的基础教育阶段英语课程的总体目标和具体要求我将本课教学目标设计如下:
语言知识目标:
1、使学生掌握介绍他人的句型:
2、学习认读单词: Grandfather , Grandmother,
①、使学生能够根据指令做动作。
②、根据图片和情境说出单词和句子。
③、在图文或场景下进行简单的英语交流和表演。
情感态度目标:
通过本课学习使学生有兴趣听、说英语、背歌谣,做游戏、敢干开口,乐于模仿,在鼓励性评价中树立信心在小组活动中积极参与合作,从而意识到交流对于学习英语的重要意义。
充分利用教材和教师的多媒体教学所提供的学习资源,实现自由参与和创新,能主动与他人交流,并克服交流中的困难,使交际顺利进行。
文化意识目标:
能够恰当使用英语中家庭成员之间的称呼,问候语,了解英语国家中介绍他人的方式并对学生进行亲情教育。
结合教学目标的要求,我把本课的重难点设置为:
1、介绍他人的句型 This is ……
2、对情境进行模仿,创新。
我主要通过感知新教材——设置——灵活运用这三个主要步骤来突破教材重难点的。在教学开始让学生以旧带新引入新知,通过对教材的了解感知新任务,并在教师用红灯,头饰、图片、录音等多种媒介的感官刺激下实现对知识的体验和实践最后在真实的生活情境中运用、实现能力的发展。
把全班分成6个小组事先用表示家庭成员名称的单词命名,课堂各项教学活动匀以小组活动为主线,结对或全班活动为辅,学生互相交流,切磋,共同完成学习任务,在合作中感受学习英语的乐趣及交流的意义,也通过小组成员之间“荣辱与共”的关系而形成同步学习的环境。
我将教学建立在满足学生心理需要的基础上。使教学活动带有浓厚的情感色彩,在单词和句型练习中使用了家人的照片,在表演中带上饰演家人的头饰,在加生活化的录音为学生设置了真实而有效的场景激发了想说的愿望也有利于学生表达能力的提高。
课堂评价主要以鼓励性评价为主分别采用了师评、组评、自评为主要方式,课上师恰当的使用激励性评语和赠送小礼物的方法让学生渴望成功的心理得到满足,这也是激励学生积极投身英语学习的一个最简单而有效的方法。
下面说一下教具的安排和使用:
依据英语教学的直观性,趣味性、实践性的教学原则,结合合作学习和任务型教学的新理念,我利用了电子零、照片、头饰、幻灯、录音、竞赛板、贴画、小礼物等媒体设计教学,学习则利用自制的组标、头饰、家庭照等媒体积极参与教学活动。
整个教学程序我采用了听、说、玩、演、唱一系列的教学活动,具体设计为热身——新知——趣味操练——巩固练习。
1)电子琴伴奏演唱Father and mother 渲染课堂气氛
2) 出示组标并请四个学生到讲台前,背对学生戴上father , mother , brother , sister 的头饰,猜一猜他到底扮演的是哪一角色。
1)教师把一张自己的家庭照片放在投影仪下并介绍This is a photo of my family. Whoˊs this?
Do you know .自答:This is my father.为教学Whoˊs this 做准备,然后教师带着满脸疑惑反复用Who′s this? 询问照片中的其他人,这样一来Who′s this? 这一句式就会在情景中被输入。
2)教师指着祖母的照片说This is my father′s mother.
She′s my grandmother.然后指着爷爷的照片。反问Who′s that, do you know? Oh,自答He′s my grandfather.板书三会单词并进行教学。
3)每组学生拿着自己的家庭照在组内进行练习,然后选代表在班内介绍家人。
1)玩比大小游戏:每组、每轮各派一名选手参赛,在讲台上抽出一张图片,根据图义说句子。This is my……说对的奖励小组小礼物一件,抽到爷爷、奶奶的加3分。抽到爸爸妈妈的加2分,抽到daugter, son ,sister, brother 加1分。几轮后统计得分,为获胜队颁奖。
father 学生抢答;答对的奖励小礼物一件。学生也可说出This is my mother′s
father.这个游戏可以让学生懂得英语中的grandfather即表示爷爷也表示外公,grand mother 既可以表示奶奶也可以表示外婆。
3)学生拿出自己准备的全家福玩听音指图游戏,教师发出指令,mother 学生即指出自己的妈妈并说:This is my mother.等等,每组都有必备答题和抢答题。
4)组内合理分配家庭角色,然后小组出一人表演动作让表演人自行定小组猜,猜对小组有奖。
father.
Mum Mum mother.
Grand pa Grand pa.
Grand father.
Grand ma Grand ma Grand mother.
学会区分口语和书面语的小区别,扩充了学生的知识面。
2)教师给学生听一段串门的录音,然后创编并表演对话。
1)总结小组的战利品数目,学生掌声祝贺并鼓励未获胜小组下节课继续努力。为激活下节课气氛打下了基础。
2)布置下节课任务,请学生用学过的单词称呼家庭成员并问好让爸爸妈妈用的数目评价学生优秀与否。最高3个为优,2个为良,1个为中。
说课的内容是牛津版小学英语5B的Unit 8,这个单元的核心内容是“周末活动”情节。本单元和Unit 4的What does he/she usually do on Sundays?He/She usually …有一定联系,通过周末活动引出本单元的四会内容和昆虫名称。涉及的句型有:How do you spend your weekends?How does he/she spend his/her weekends?
新课程强调从学生的学习兴趣、生活经验和认识水平出发,倡导体验、实践、参与、合作与交流的学习方式和任务型的教学途径达到发展学生对语言的综合运用能力。为了到达教学目标,落实教学重点、化解教学难点,本堂课借助flash:do you have any hobbies?复习近平时的活动;借助一些小奖品,如塑封的.蝴蝶,螳螂等,激发学生的兴趣,同时也为下节课昆虫的教学打下基础。我借助多媒体课件化解难点。在整个教学中,我注意师生的互动,从唱-游戏-对话-猜谜等活动完成了本课的教学任务。
新课程强调知识与技能、过程与方法、情感态度与价值观三个角度的有机结合,本着这样的认识,我对本课设计了如下教学目标:
1.情感目标:通过活动、游戏学生能产生学习英语的兴趣;学生能敢于、乐于、善于开口讲英语,积极参与交流,树立学好英语的信心。
(1)、四会掌握词组:at the weekends learn from 三会词组 文章来源:of course catch insects watch cartoons 等以前学过的词组。
(2)、句型:How do you spend your weekends?I often
How does he spend his weekends?He often…
How does she spends her weekends?She often…
(3)、能听读课文并理解熟读。
3.能力目标:学生能用英语进行生活交际,了解同学和家人的平时活动。同时通过调查让学生体会合作的重要性。 四、教学重点、难点
1. 教学重点是学生能听说读写单词词组(weekends.,at the weekends learn from能运用How do you spend your weekends? How does he/she spend his/her weekends?进行交际。
2.教学难点是catch insects这个三会词组的发音。通过第一人称的练习转化到第三人称单数。
英语歌曲是提高学生英语学习兴趣和学习效率的有效方法之一。“Do you have any hobbies?”这首活泼的歌曲既能感染学生,调动学生的情绪,歌词中的词组如:watch TV grow flowers take photos等又能为新课学习作铺垫,自然导入新课。
小学高年级学生仍以形象直观思维为主。所以,我一开始利用学生常用的报数让学生自然引出周六周日,然后老师示范说weekend ,说得出的奖励一些塑封的小昆虫,然后自然引出词组catch insects既是对学会新单词的 鼓励,又为第二课时的学习打下基础
从昆虫引出周末活动,从同桌之间的互问又引出第三人称单数的练习。为了巩固第三人称的练习,老师可以提供一些人物,让学生来猜一猜他们怎么过周末的。特别是当老师提供一些名人来猜时,学生感觉特别兴奋,那时他们的偶像呢?这个过程看似游戏,其实学生在不知不觉中对今天的句型在不断的操练。
英语教学除了口头练习,也要注重写的练习。特别是到了高年级,学习内容更深了,学生一定要听说读写齐头并进,才能够掌握课堂知识,所以本课我设计了几个填空小练习,让学生对第三人称单数的人称变化和助动词的运用能自如的判断和正确的理解,错误的地方一起分析。
如何让今天的所学用到生活中去,刚才的练习只不过是一些机械性的操练,如何让学生运用到实际生活中去,我设计了一个调查表,让学生调查家人是怎么过周末和节日的,下节课交流,看谁的周末活动丰富,学生的任务明确了,任务能顺利完成了, 那我的本课的教学任务也完成了。
英语优秀课件【篇2】
教学理念:
1、教学音标的目的不仅是熟悉45个音标,更重要的是培养学生运用音标的
拼读来学习英语的能力,最后形成正确的语音、语调。拼读是一个熟能生巧的过程,只有反复多拼,才能达到熟练。
2、字母、音标、单词、句子“四结合”。音标教学不是孤立的,它可以结合
与其相应的字母、单词或句子教学,由点到面,循序渐进,并且元音和辅音结合,培养学生简单拼读音标的英语能力以及练习学生正确的语音、语调、情感,让音标教学的目的更加突出。
3、音标教学的过程中,教给学生正确的发音方法。悦耳动听在元音,口齿清楚在辅音。
3、小学生好动,就让学生在活动中学,小学生好胜,就让学生在竞赛中练,
加上简易的绕口令,既满足了学生的娱乐愿望,又顺利地完成了学习任务。教学中,我尽量设计游戏、竞赛,让学生兴奋地练。如通过“字母、音标对比游戏”、“摘苹果”、“竞赛读句子”等学习活动,这样的设计是符合小学生的认知水平以及年龄特点的。
一、教学目标。
1、 学习2个元音音素[ i: ] [i],和3个辅音音素[p]、[b]、[m],把握正确的 发音方法。
2、 练习学生通过2个元音和3个辅音组合进行简单拼读音标的能力,以及 正确练读包含[i:]、[i]、[p]、[b]、[m]的词、短语、句子。
3、 正确书写Bb、Ii、、Mm、Pp这4个字母和 [i:]、[i]、[p]、[b]、[m]这5 个音标。
4、 培养学生学习英语的爱好、热情,以及与同伴之间的合作意识。
二、课前预备。
教师:录音机、相关磁带、图片词卡、细线一条、一张白纸、26个字母
卡片、以及[i:]、[i]、[p]、[b]、[m]的音标卡片以及相关卡片。
学生:“p、b、m、I”4个字母的卡片、以及[i:]、[i]、[p]、[b]、[m]的音标卡片。
三、教学过程。
1、复习热身。
A、师生日常交谈后,唱歌曲《ABC》
(复习26个英语字母的读音)
B、看谁反应快。教师任意出示26个英语字母卡片,学生读出字母的读音。
(为下面的音标教学做铺垫,学习音标后,形成对比,熟悉到字母与字母音素读音不同)。
2、新课呈示。
引入:(T: We have five new friends, today.) A、教授[i:]的发音。
1)教师示范[i:]----穿针引线音,边示范边用拇指和食指捏住线从左
向右拉。同时,解说发音要领:[i:]发音时,舌尖抵下齿,前舌中部最高,嘴唇向两旁伸开,成扁平形。元音字母e及字母组合ee、ea、ie、ei可以读作[i:]。
2)学生模拟,比一比,谁的发音最佳,并给予恰当的评价。
B、教授[i]的发音。
1)教师示范[i]----微笑露酒窝音,边示范边将手掌张开放到头上向自
己的方向挥动。同时,解说发音要领:[i]发音时,舌尖抵下齿,前舌后部最高,舌前部向硬颚抬起比[i:]低些,下颚稍下垂,舌前部也稍下降。
2)边做动作边模拟。
(学习音标如同一年级小朋友学习汉语拼音一样,有一个音与形的熟悉过程。课堂上,要求学生仔细听音、观察口形,认真模拟,但是课堂上模拟、拼读过程一长,学生很轻易厌烦,所以教学中,运用比一比的竞赛方法,以及结合动作学习的方法来集中学生的留意力。)
3)找一找。请学生们从26个英语字母中,找出哪些字母的发音包含[i:]。 (Bb、Cc、Dd、Ee、Gg、Pp、Tt、Vv)
解说[i:]是一个长元音,“:”是长音符号,比相应的短元音要长两倍以上。[i:]不是[i]的单纯加长。
C、教授[p]的发音。
1)发[p]音。教师出示一张白纸,放在嘴前,示范发音,纸会颤抖。要
求学生留意:发[p]时,双唇紧闭,气流从口腔冲出,送气有力。[p]不响亮,单发[p]时,在远处几乎听不见。
2)开火车比赛发音。(p---p---[p] [p] [p])
(运用“p---p---[p] [p] [p]”这样有节奏的练习发音,布满趣味性,学生学得会非常有爱好)
3)简单拼读:[p]—[i:]==[pi:],教师示范后,学生模拟发音。要领:辅音轻,元音重。两音相连猛一碰。
(由[p]、[i:]的字母音标发音到[pi:]的简单拼读,是一个由易到难的循序渐进的一个过程,学生不会有困难感,对学生英语学习的爱好起到正面的推动作用。)
D、教授[b]的发音。
1)教师示范发音。要领:发音方法和[p]相同,但[b]在词尾发得很轻,
不如[p]送气有力。
2)个人读-------同桌互读。
3)出示图片词卡(ball)、bag、bed。教读:[b]---[b]===bag、[b]---[b]===bag、
[b]---[b]===bed
(将音标与单词相结合,由点到面到练习,让学生练读[p]在单词中的读音,给学生灌输简单的拼读规律)
E、教授[m]的发音。
1)教师示范发音。要领:发音位置和[p]、[b]相同,发音比较响亮,应留意发[m]时双唇始终是紧闭的。
2)个人读-男生女生读。
3)请你说出包含[m]的单词,给小组赢得小星。
(mum、mother、meet、miss、monkey、mouse、mouth、mike、)
(通过给小组加分的形式说出包含[m]的单词,学生不仅复习了已有的
单词,而且让学生练习在不同的单词里[m]的发音,那么对[m]的感知更加深刻。)
3、音标巩固练习。
1)、学生简单拼读。
出示小黑板:[pi:] [bi:] [mi:] [pi] [bi] [mi]
[pi:p] [bi:p] [pi:m] [pib]
2)、字母、音标对比游戏。
教师出示一些卡片,其中有小写字母p、b、m、I的卡片,有[p]、[b]、
[m]、[i:]、[i]的音标卡片,以及一写其他字母或音标的卡片。教师说:show me the small letter p/b/m/I 。或说:show me [p]、[b]、[m]、[i:]、[i]。让学生出示相应的卡片。 (通过字母、音标对比游戏,能培养学生自觉地把单词、音标作音、形比较,直至把
握一些规律,学生逐渐明白“[ i]”表示音标,那么单词中有“i”这个字母,不代表它就发[i]的音,逐步学会见形知音的本领,这样的练习,也能为今后学生单词拼读、速记单词能力的培养作好铺垫。)
3)摘苹果。
教师在黑板上出示一张挂满苹果的树挂图,每个苹果上写有一个单词,
如milk、meet、see、key、thin、big、pig、three、he、she等。再画两个篮子,分别贴上[i:]、 [i]的音标,每小组派几名同学上前面来,把树上的苹果摘下来,将含有相同元音的单词放入相应的篮子里,最快最正确的小组赢得小星。
(对[i:]和[i]这两个长音和短音的学习做进一步的推进,让字母音标学习与单词相结合。将所有的单词选入正确的篮子里后,再让学生通过单词的朗读,练习学生发音的正确、到位。)
4)、朗读句子。(长条卡片出示)
1)I see a bee in the sea。
2)A big pig in the big ship。
(在教师示范并总结 [i:]、[i]的发音后,进行小组竞读比赛,看哪一组能正确朗读上面的句子,做到既正确又压韵,既流利又有感情 ,这样一来学习活动既锻炼了学生读对[p]、
[b]、[i:]、[i]4个音标的使用技能,又体现学生探究与集体主义精神。)
4、拓展练习
绕口令。(小黑板出示)
He sees a ship .
She sees a sheep .
A ship and a sheep .
This is a ship .
That is a sheep.
(编顺口溜不仅可以使知识变得简单,生动、而且印象深刻,而且通过这样的练习,真正将音标教学与语音教学落到实处。)
5、字母、音标书写。
1)、要求学生正确书写“Bb、Ii、、Mm、Pp”这4个英语字母。
2)、正确书写“[i:]、[i]、[p]、[b]、[m]”这5个音标。
四、小作业。
课后和同学比比绕口令。
五、课后游戏推荐。
捞音标:参与人数不限。每人头上带音标卡片头饰,其中两个捞音标的同学面对面握住对方双手,并向上方抬起;其余人试图从两个捞音标同学中间穿过。捞音标的同学要问:what is your name?被捞的同学说:my name is [m]。。。。。。说对的就可以让他过去。
六、板书设计及评价。
英语优秀课件【篇3】
本节课内容是围绕What do you do at the weekend? 和Where do you …?这一话题开展,使学生能够运用核心句型来询问和回答周末的活动。学生已有了前面所学的旧知识Do you … at the weekend?做知识的铺垫,比较易于深入与扩展,体现了教材的循序渐进,又符合学生的知识水平和认知水平,也体现了教学内容之间的连贯性,本节课是本册书中的难点。 学情分析 二年级的学生活泼好动,好奇心和表现欲极强,更重视老师的表扬,喜欢引起别人的注意。他们的形象思维好,但逻辑思维能力不强。因而为他们创设真实、有趣的语言学习环境,通过丰富多彩的课堂教学活动(如:游戏、竞赛、表演等),激发他们学习的兴趣,挖掘他们学习的内在潜能,培养他们的语言综合运用能力。
1. 知识目标:能够学会并正确使用核心句型:What do you do at the weekend? 和 where do you …?
2. 能力目标:让学生在教师创设的情景中运用英语询问回答周末的活动,达到综合运用语言的目的。
3. 情感目标:激发学生自主学习的热情,培养听说能力,保持对英语学习的可持续兴趣,并培养学生探求知识的精神,灌输他们热爱生活的品德。
重点:学生能正确使用What do you do at the weekend? 和 where do you …?句型。
难点:流利地表达自己的周末活动并能够自主的用英语询问朋友周末活动。
教法、学法 通过直观教学法,情境教学法,任务型教学法相结合,运用了小组合作和学生自主学习的学法,拓展学生的思维,使学生能够多渠道接受信息。
教 具: 多媒体课件,卡片
(一)情境导入,激发兴趣
1. 说唱韵句,激情导趣。 说英文歌遥: What do you like? What do you like? I like your bike. I like your kite. Let’s ride my bike. Let’s fly my kite. 课堂伊始,通过课前的简单交流和热身活动,拉近师生之间的.距离,通过英文歌曲巩固强化旧知识,使学生在轻松愉快的氛围中进入学习状态。并通过歌曲简单的接触到what 引导的特殊疑问句和动词短语。 2. 设计游戏,复习旧知。 通过学生做出教师展示的动词卡片,让其他学生猜出动词短语的小游戏来激发学生的学习兴趣,复习动词词组,使学生学习新知更具有吸引力和乐趣。 go swimming fly a kite ride a bike play basketball play football 最后出示play football, 教师运用旧知识询问Do you play football at the weekend? I play football at the weekend, too. 引出本节课新词too. 3 创设情境,任务呈现。 通过创设找朋友,激起同学们的学习热情,为导入新课做准备,由此展开教学任务。
(二)教学新知,层层深入
1. 初听课文,感知新知。通过学生自主听课文,初步感受心知 2. 再听课文,理解课文,Listen and repeat with the whole class, and find the key sentences: what, 引出本节课重点句型:What do you do at the weekend? 3. 听读课文,巩固新知。 通过反复听课文,逐层深入,突破了本节课的重点, 并通过小组活动练习what do you do at the weekend? I play football at the weekend。解决本节课重点。
(三)游戏巩固,互动操练
通过采访新朋友的小游戏,准备学生熟悉的卡通人物,让学生运用所学的句型what do you do at the weekend?和Where do you …?对朋友进行简单的采访,解决本节课的难点。
(四)拓展提高,语言运用
通过找朋友真实语境,完成教学任务。进一步运用所学新知,激发学生的学习兴趣,让学生在真实语言环境中正确运用核心句型,并让学生在活动中得到热爱生活的品德。
作业布置,课外延伸 1. 听读课文5遍 2. 用英语调查小朋友周末的活动,做一份简单的调查表。
英语优秀课件【篇4】
在英语教学中落实新课程标准,就是贯彻执行国家教育部关于课程改革的决定。新课程标准的三维教学观,具体到英语学科就是要整合发展学生语言技能、语言知识、情感态度、学习策略和文化意识五个方面的素养,培养学生综合运用语言的能力。《基础教育课程改革纲要》中明确指出:“教师在教学才过程中应与学生积极互动、共同发展,要处理好传授知识与培养能力的关系,注重培养学生的独立性和自主性,引导学生质疑、调查、探究,在实践中学习,促进学生在教师指导下主动地、富有个性地学习。教师应尊重学生的人格,关注个体差异,满足不同学生的学习需要,创设能引导学生主动参与的教育环境,激发学生的学习积极性,培养学生掌握和运用知识的态度和能力,使每个学生都能得到充分的发展。因此,本课的设计重点是:帮助学生形成自主、合作、探究的学习模式,掌握阅读的一些基本技巧,让每个学生在原有的基础上都学有所得。
本课是高一必修模块1第4单元的阅读课型,这单元围绕earthquakes这一主题开展听、说、读、写多种教学活动。由于本单元生词量较大,并且Warming up可挖掘的东西较多,因此把Reading设计为本单元的第2课时。本课型是单元整体教学的重要环节,为学生的语言学习、语法学习提供了载体,并且是学生获取信息的主要来源。“Reading――― A NIGHT THE EARTH DIDN’T SLEEP” 具体描写1976年唐山大地震的震前、震中和震后。本篇文章词汇量大,运用了大量的动词、复杂的数字,出现许多定语从句,篇幅较长,并且采用一些修辞手法,对学生的语言阅读能力提出了更高的要求。但文章的结构较明显,
根据新颁布的《普通高中英语课程标准(实验稿)》关于阅读课主要教学目标的具体描述,结合本课教学内容,具体从语言知识、语言技能、情感态度和文化意识三个方面制定如下教学目标。
1. 语言知识目标:
a)使学生了解自然灾害的相关词汇,并掌握复杂数字的表达法。
b)学习掌握与地震相关的词汇,如:shake,well,rise,smelly,pond,pipe,burst,canal,steam,ruin,injure,destroy,brick,dam,useless,steel,shock,quake,rescue,electricity,disaster,army,organize,bury,coal,mine,shelter,fresh,percent等,以及 right away, at an end, dig out, give out, thousands of以及一些优美句子的赏析。
2. 语言技能目标:
a)阅读技能的训练:让学生学会克服生词障碍,通过略读,归纳出文章的大意;通过细读,理清文章的总体框架与脉络,归纳出各部分的中心词;通过查读,捕捉文章的重要细节,培养学生获取、处理信息的能力。
b) 让学生复述课文,分析、感悟作者的写作意图。
c) 让学生运用本节课所学词汇、知识,通过采访唐山大地震幸存者的形式进行小组活动,提高学生用英语进行创造性交流的能力。
3.情感态度与文化意识目标:
a)学会有关地震的知识,并能通过学习讨论懂得地震时的应急逃生,地震后如何科学救人和有关地震的形成和减少地震所造成的损失等一般知识。
b)懂得地震无情人有情,即使发生了多么可怕的灾难,国家和解放军官兵都会不顾自身安危,奋力抢救,培养学生一方有难、八方支援的互助友爱精神。
c)了解自然灾害会给人类带来严重的破坏性后果,让学生进一步感悟、领会到人类应与自然界和谐共处。
d)培养学生的合作意识和“合作学习”的习惯。
e)欣赏课文中优美句子,了解一些英语修辞手法,使学生在学习完课文之后得到一次美的享受,一次心灵的愉悦和升华。
(三)教学重点和难点:
根据新颁布的《普通高中英语课程标准(实验稿)》关于读的技能目标的具体描述,结合高一学生实际和对教材内容的科学分析,确定本环节的主要教学重点和难点是:
1)让学生了解唐山大地震,了解地震的成因、预兆、地震造成的损失,地震时的应急救生以及震后的救援。
2)训练学生的阅读技巧,提高阅读能力。侧重培养学生对文章的整体性结构的把握和挖掘作者写作的意图,突出培养学生以下3个方面的能力:
a.文章段落中心词把握能力。
b.根据主题快速捕捉文章重点细节的能力。
c.总结归纳能力。
3)重点掌握有关地震的词汇,特别是shake, burst, ruin, injure, destroy, shock, quake, rescue, disaster, army, organize, bury, shelter。
4)欣赏并理解课文中优美句子,让学生掌握一些英语修辞用法。
1) 如何使学生养成科学的阅读习惯,提高阅读理解能力和语言水平。
2) 如何使学生学会提取、筛选和重组文章中的信息,并灵活运用于语言实践中,达到语言实践能力的扩展与提高。
根据新颁布的《普通高中英语课程标准(实验稿)》所倡导的教学原则及“第二语言习得论”和“整体语言教学理论”,结合文章具体内容及学生的差异性,确定本节课主要采用任务型语言教学法(Task-based Language Teaching) 、合作学习教学法(Cooperative Learning Approach)、整体语言教学法(Whole Language Teaching)、直观教学法、交际教学法(Communicative Approach)、以及情感激励教学法(Affective Motivation)等教学方法。具体采用“P—T—P”自主学习立体模式:(Pre-task
Post-task)来组织教学。
任务型语言教学认为:人们使用语言的过程就是一个完成各种各样任务的过程。任务型学习强调通过“做中学”、“学中做”,使学生在完成任务的过程中习得语言。本课组织学生四至五人组成一个学习小组,进行一次就地震后幸存者的访问。该设计基于课文内容,但又不局限于课文的范畴,旨在贯彻“做中学”、“学中做”策略,吸引和组织他们积极参与,并通过讨论、交流和合作等方式,在自然、真实的情境中,完成任务,体会、掌握语言的应用,达到学以致用的目的。
充分利用多媒体教学手段,通过播放影视剪辑,与课文主题相关的图片、图表等直观手段,在充分调动学生学习兴趣的同时,降低学习难度,突破重难点。
合作学习教学法是以小组活动为主体的一种教学活动,一种同伴之间的合作互动活动。合作学习教学法有利于改善课堂心理气氛、大面积提高学生的学业成绩、促进学生良好非智力品质的发展,调整学生的语言焦虑感。因此,本课打破传统的教师单向灌输,采用“四至五人组成一个学习小组”的课堂教学结构,来组织教学,旨在营造轻松的学习氛围,为积极学习提供有利的条件,让学生在完成任务的过程中通过互相交流,降低语言焦虑感,获得愉快的学习经历,从而对学习本身和所学内容产生兴趣感。
整体语言教学法要求按 “整体-部分-整体”的模式,进行语篇阅读训练,即从“整体”开始,以“整体”结束的“三段式”阅读教学法。本课采用从整体略读——分段细读——通读全文,进一步理解课文内容,即是这种教学策略的体现。
在教学中重视师生之间的思想交流,充分调动自己情绪的感染力,适时进行情感与策略调整,通过情感激励,使教师与学生达到情感交融,在愉悦的课堂氛围中发展创新,体验成功。
此外在教学过程中还注意遵循以下教学原则:
1.贯彻动态真实原则,在教学过程中“动态”地去发现问题,分析问题和解决问题。本课在各个教学环节的设计和具体操作上都充分考虑到了策略的'贯彻以及教学活动的灵活、有效的综合运用。
2.重视学生个性与创新意识的培养,给予学生充分表达自己的机会。
其余的教学方法将结合“说程序”进行举例说明。
学习的对象是处于城乡结合部的高一学生,他们的英语基础较差,特别是由于词汇量缺乏,阅读习惯不好,导致阅读速度慢、阅读理解能力差。并且学生在初中已习惯了教师的单向灌输,部分学生由于英语表达能力的欠缺对课堂的互动缺少积极性,不善于交际,学习不够主动自主。因此,在组织教学活动中,注重学习策略的指导,灌输自主、合作、探究学习的思想,同时注意调整活动任务设置的梯度,使每个学生通过学习活动,都能学有所成,体验到成功。
根据新颁布的普通高中《英语课程标准(实验稿)》对高中英语学习策略七级目标的具体描述,确定本环节主要从以下4个方面加强对学生进行学法指导。
1)认知策略:指导学生运用已学会的抓重点、做记号、摘笔记等方式,对所学内容进行整理与归纳。
2)调控策略:培养自我评价与相互评价的习惯,鼓励学生增加与教师和同学交流学习英语的体会和经验,学会科学评价自己的学习行为与学习效果,进一步形成有效的学习方法,树立积极向上的学习态度。
3)交际策略:创设有意义的情景和任务活动,引导学生通过四人一小组,进行合作学习,让他们围绕课堂任务分工合作,相互探讨、相互交流,从而获得知识、技能和情感体验,变被动学习为主动学习。
4) 资源策略:布置任务,引导学生主动拓宽英语学习的渠道,即通过不同信息渠道(internet, newspaper,dictionary, magazines…)查找所需信息,把英语学习从课堂延伸到课外。
结合本校高一学生实际和对教材内容的科学分析,计划用45分钟完成本文的教学任务,具体安排如下:
(一) Pre-task:激发学习兴趣,明确学习任务(预计需要8分钟左右)
(二) Task-cycle:课文主体内容的教学与操练,知识的掌握与能力的过渡(预计需要26分钟左右)
(三) Post-task:展示成果,交流成果的过程,语言实践能力的扩展与提高(预计需要10分钟左右)
(五) Homework and Sum up:课文内容的巩固、延伸与拓展(第四和第五两个环节预计需1分钟左右)
下面将具体说明各个环节的设计方案及其内在的设计思想或理论依据,即阐明为什么这样处理教材,为什么采用某种教法以及预计达到的种种教学效果等。
步骤一. Pre-task (Pre-reading activities)
贯彻兴趣策略,采用直观教学法,引入话题,激发学习兴趣,明确学习任务。
【设计思路:先播放有关巴基斯坦地震的可怕MTV画面,学生的注意力马上就会被吸引到课堂上来,学生马上就联想到earthquake这一词,这时教师提出“ What do you think of the earthquake?”,学生会不约而同地回答,地震会给人类带来灾难性的后果。紧接着引导学生“Can you fortell an earthquake so that we can take measures to reduce the damages?” 通过图片,学生更易掌握地震的前兆的知识,为课文的阅读作了很好的铺垫,接着教师引导学生进行进一步探究“What should we do to protect ourselves if an earthquake happened?”通过小组讨论、合作得出结论,教师进行一定的总结。接着呈现文章的标题“A night the earth didn’t sleep” ,引导学生解读文章标题、预测文章内容,让学生在阅读过程中处于主动认知状态。学生可能一下子无法正确理解其所包含的深层含义。但估计在前面所展示的MTV画面及图片的启发下,大部分同学可能很快就能作出正确的理解---about the earthquake。另外,考虑到文章生词较多,且大部分学生对文章的背景知识了解较少。因此,在引导学生预测文章内容的同时,有必要在讨论“What kind of words will be used in the passage?
”这个问题时,引出单词:injure、ruin、destroy、disaster、burst、rescue等。这样既可向学生展示本环节的重点单词,又可为阅读扫清文化背景障碍和语言障碍,又可为突破本文的重难点作好准备。】
英语优秀课件【篇5】
一、说教材
1、教材的地位和作用
本课是人教版七年级英语上册第三单元第一课时。本单元是就第二单元认知物体之后学习用英语认知人,而与学生最为熟悉的人就是家庭成员。从“Is this your eraser? ”很自然过渡到“Is this your sister?” 以前学的“What is this?”转变成“Who is this?” 教材以This is my sister.为中心话题,围绕谈论有关家庭成员的用语,并学会询问别人的情况,介绍自己的家庭,谈论自己的情感。但本单元生词较多。出现在第一课时的就有十五、六个,同时还要认识到名词复数的概念及其运用。因此,本课时任务比较艰巨。
2、教学目标
结合新课程标准和大纲提出的基础教育阶段英语课程的总体目标以及本单元的教学内容我将本课教学目标设计如下:
(1)、知识目标
帮助学生学会、掌握单元单词;
使学生对复数形式有初步了解;
使学生掌握介绍他人的句型。
(2)、能力目标
通过本节课学习,学生就家庭成员相互之间能用英语简单的介绍、询问、交流。掌握基本This is/That is... These are/Those are... 等句型,培养学生实际交际的能力。同时基本上能辨别什么时候用单数什么时候用复数。
(3)、情感目标
通过介绍家人和朋友,学生对自己的家庭成员会有更清晰的印象,对学生进行亲情教育,从而激发起他们对家人的热爱。
3、教学重点及难点
结合教学目标的要求和学生的特点,我把本课的重难点设置为:
重点:熟练掌握各家庭成员的名称,理解外国文化中介绍家庭成员的方式。这个单元最主要的就是学习家庭成员英语的表达,而几乎所有的单词都集中在第一课时。所以这课时学会掌握这些单词应该是重中之重。
难点:复数的认识和正确运用。汉语表达中完全没有复数概念,这是一本书,这是三本书;除了数字的改变没有其他任何变化。而英语必须这样说This is a book. These are books.所有的单词都相应的发生了变化。因此,中国学生在学习复数的时候特别难。
二、说学情
我教学的对象是七年级学生,他们正处于青春期发育期,他们有较高的求知欲和表现欲,
希望自己的表现能得到同学和老师的认可。且该阶段学生已具备初步的语言表达能力和较强的记忆力与模拟能力。对他们所熟悉的话题,学生会更感兴趣,而本单元的话题正符合这一特点,所以我就设计任务型的课堂活动,让学生人人参与,增强他们学习的积极性和学习的自信心。
三、说教法和学法
教法:教材重视以人为本,强调素质教育。在教学中,要注意发挥学生的主体作用,把空间留给学生。抓住初中生活泼好动,表现欲强的心理特点,课堂上我设计了大量听、说、读、写的训练,启发学生动脑思考,鼓励学生大胆开口,畅所欲言,尽可能运用英语表达实际意义,从而最大限度地调动学生的积极性和主动性。教学中,我主要采用任务型教学法,情景结合教学法,分层法和通过学习五步教学法,精讲巧练,由浅入深,由易到难,由已知到未知,循序渐近地深化教学内容。展开以教师为主导,以学生为主体的师生双边活动
学法:
1. 引导学生用小组合作的方式来完成任务型教学所设计的各项活动。全班分为7个小组,每组6-7人,各组英语水平相当,并引入竞争机制。培养学生的实际能力,发展学生的合作能力。
2. 采取的教学手段是多媒体辅助教学,充分利用农村中小学现代远程教育资源,自制课件,用生动的课件调动学生的感官,进行听说读写的训练。培养学生的观察力和想象力,发展学生的思维能力。
四、说教学过程
合理的教学过程是教学成功的关键,为此我特意设计了以下教学环节:
第一步,创设情景,导入新课
出示一些实物,如钢笔、钥匙、尺子等,用下面句型引导学生与同伴之间进行交谈。复习前面学过的句型,为新课作好铺垫。
S1: Is this your pen? ----- Yes, it is.
S2: Is that her ruler? ----- No, it isn’t. It’s my ruler.
第二步,新课讲解,呈现教学内容
我先出示一张照片,通过创设情景,师生对话,引出新知识:
T:What is this? ------ Ss: It is a photo.
T: Is this your photo? ------- Ss: No, it isn’t.
T: It’s not your photo. It’s my photo. And this is my sister. 从而引出本课时重点句型: This is my sister. 并在此基础上讲解“this is...”是用来向对方介绍他人的。同时运用这句型“This is?”进行教学新单词:mother , father , sister , brother , grandfather 等所有家庭成员。让学生先对本课所要讲的内容有个初步的感知,激发学生进一步学习的动机。
第三步,反复操练,巩固运用
为了调动学生的积极性,主动深化短时记忆中的信息,并逐步向长时记忆迈进、发展。我将利用多媒体生动活泼呈现多张家庭成员图片。让学生将单词与图中人物匹配,认识家庭成员。并学会使用This / That is my... 和 These are / Those are...介绍家人和朋友,巩固知识、操练知识。在此同时,要注意与讲解名词的复数形式,以及让学生能够正确的运用。
第四步,口语操练,加深印象
学生通过前面的学习,已经对新的知识形成了初步的新知识结构,但在名词复数结构上
还存在着模糊点,这时通过一系列的综合练习可以巩固、发展及完善学生的知识结构。学生通过前面的学习,已经对新的知识形成了初步的新知识结构,但在名词复数结构上还存在着模糊点,这时通过一系列的综合练习可以巩固、发展及完善学生的知识结构。
a) 通过播放1b录音,学生听,模仿说,完成任务,巩固语言材料,培养学生听说能力。 b)让学生准备几分钟,运用本课所学的句型“This / That is ?”和“These / Those are ?”对1a 中戴夫家庭成员进行介绍。进一步巩固本课的重难点。 c) 对学生进行分组,分别完成2c对话之后。让学生用自己的照片,编出自己的对话,到前面进行对话表演。转换角色,练习对话。
第五步,课堂练习,巩固知识
在学生已在大脑中构建新的认知结构基础上,提供适当的课堂练习,不仅能让学生在实践中自我学习、自我改进、达到自我完善;而且能够充分地让学生体会到“知识的获得并不只是单方面的‘输入’过程,更重要的是知识的‘输出’” 也就是说能够根据外部实际情况对新知识准确地提取并加以运用。
因此,我会出示一些与本课语言点相关的选择题和情景对话,要求学生当场完成。课堂练习的目的在于检查学生掌握知识的情况以便教师发现学生缺漏,及时补充。同时也有助于进一步巩固,加强对本课内容的理解和运用。
第六步,课外作业布置
1. 掌握所学词汇。
2. 向同学介绍家人或朋友。
英语优秀课件【篇6】
新课标英语优秀教学设计1
教学目标
1.能够听说读写单词和短语:have a cold, have a toothache, have a fever, hurt, have a headache, have a sore throat. 2.能够听说读句型:What’s the matter, Mike? I feel sick. I have a fever.并进行关键词的替换操练。 3.能够理解会并吟唱Let’s chant的歌谣。
教学重难点
教学重点、难点: 1.重点是掌握A-Let’s learn的四会单词和短语,并询问别人的身体状况。 2.难点是正确拼写四会单词和短语。
教学过程
1、 Warm-up
(1)播放录音PEP4Unit6歌曲“My father is a doctor.”
(2)日常口语对话,复习职业单词。
What’s your father/mother?
2、 Presentation and practice
(1)教师出示Let’s start的教学挂图,说:Look! We have some new friends here. Who are they? What’s the matter with them?…帮助学生回答,并引导学生通过观察图片或教师的肢体动作来帮助学生熟悉答句中的新单词和短语。
(2)播放Let’s chant的录音,重点领读句子:I have a headache. I have the flu.
(3)教师出示一支体温表,说:This is a thermometer. If I have a fever, it will tell me. Let’s see Mike. Mike doesn’t feel well. He has a fever.指着Let’s learn的图片的 Mike,教学“have a fever”。让学生看图片,教师做出各种表情,引导学生提问“What’s the matter?”,引出词组have a fever(出示体温计或在额头上捂湿毛巾) have a toothache(作牙疼状) , hurt(在身体某一部位贴一块膏药), have a sore throat(咳 嗽,说话沙哑),have a cold(打喷嚏), have a headache(作头痛状)。注意headache 和 toothache的共同之处,帮助学生简单了解构词法。播放录音,让学生跟读单词。
(4)教师让学生读单词,叫到的同学,给他图片(have a fever),问他:“What’s the matter, x?”引导学生说:I feel sick. I have a fever.解释sick单词。用同样的方法教授句型:What’s the matter, x? I ...
要求学生回答并做出相应的表情。可以让学生两个进行操练。
(5)Let’s play “看病”游戏。 将学生分成六大组,每组选一张短语卡片。教师戴上医生的帽子提问:Cold, cold, who has a cold? 如第一组选中的是have a cold,这组学生就边做动作或表情边吟唱:Cold, cold, I have a cold.用同样的方法进行操练,各组调换卡片继续该活动。
(6)Pair work “敲敲打打”活动。 教师将所学单词或短语写在黑板上,然后把学生分成两大组,每组派一名代表站到黑板前。教师说单词或短语,请学生敲击听到的单词或短语,谁敲得既对又快得一分,最后得分高的组获胜。
(7)活动超级对对碰
屏幕的左边为sore throat/fever/cold/headache这些词,它们的旁边为少了一个词的词组结构:have a …, 右边为每个词组所对应的图片。拖动左边的词把它们配对到对应的词组中。右边的图可以给所填的词以提示。连对了,则会发出欢呼声,给学生以鼓励。
3、 Consolidation and extension
(1)学生听读P14-16五遍。
(2)学生背诵和抄写单词和短语4遍。
五、板书设计: Unit 2 What’s the matter, Mike? have a fever hurt have a cold have a toothache have a headache have a sore throa
新课标英语优秀教学设计2
学目标
1.能够听说读写五个情绪单词:tired, angry, excited, happy, sad ,bored.
2.能够听说读句型:How does Amy feel? She’s tired.并进行关键词的替换操练。
3.能够完成Task time的任务。
教学重点:使学生熟练掌握五个四会单词,并能替换句型“How does she/he feel? She’s/he tired.进行回答。
教学难点:使学生熟练掌握五个四会单词。
教学重难点
教学重点:使学生熟练掌握五个四会单词,并能替换句型“How does she/he feel? She’s/he tired.进行回答。
教学过程
一、 Warm-up:
(1)Free talk: How tall are you?
How heavy are you?
How old are you?
How many pencils do you have?
How much is your…?
How are you? Your parents come to our classroom today.
二、Presentation:
Step 1: Learn the new words.
Guiding1:
请同学们朗读并翻译课本19页Let’s Learn 中的6个单词,画出不会读或不会翻译的单词,2分钟后指名交流。
(1)Happy
T: You had the English test this week, many students did a good job in this test. X, you got 100 pionts, how do you feel?
(以谈话的形式导入单词happy的教学,多媒体出示笑脸图和单词happy,引导学生拼读单词,教师提问a字母和y字母在单词中的发音,领读单词。)
(2)Sad
T: If you failed the English test, you are ________.(sad)
教师出示哭脸的图片和单词sad,告诉学生a字母和happy中的a字母发音是相同的,让学生试着拼读单词。(学生容易把a字母发成e,所以看似简单的单词,教师也要加以耐心地指导朗读和纠正发音)
(3)Angry
T: If you failed the test, your parents are _________.(angry)
(多媒体出示angry的图片,教学单词,讲明字母a和y的发音,让学生自己拼读单词,然后教师领读单词)
出示John踢球输了的图片,出示句子John is very angry, because he lost the football match. 让学生看情景图说句子,达到操练的新单词的目的。
(4)Excited
承接上面的情景,John is very angry, because he lost the football match, how about Zhang Peng? (情景图)导入单词excited.
出示句子:Zhang Peng is excited, because he won the football match.
让学生模仿说句子,操练单词。
(5)tired/bored
Guiding2:请同学们朗读并翻译19页Let’s Learn 中的两个句子,画出不会读或不会翻译的单词,两分钟后指名交流。
以同样的方式教学单词tired和bored,同时教学句型How does Amy feel? She’s tired.在指导拼读单词时,让学生观察两个单词的相同之处:结尾三个字母都是red,这样的话学生对这两个单词的记忆就会更加深刻。
Guiding2:请同学们朗读并翻译19页Let’s Learn 中的两个句子,画出不会读或不会翻译的单词,两分钟后指名交流。
三、Drill
1.句型操练:How does …feel? He/She’s ….安排同桌两个人问答练习。
2.Pair work.记忆大比拼。(给学生30秒中,记住六个孩子的心情,然后教师问学生答。)
3.总结以How 开头的疑问句,并对比How do you feel? How does Amy feel?两个句子的不同之处:人称和助动词的变化。
四、Consolidation:
Read and finish:
1.My dad is going on a trip without me.
I’m very _ _ _ _ _.
2. Chen Jie failed(不及格) the math test,
She’s very _ _ _.
3. Lucy clean the bedroom in the morning,
She’s_ _ _ _ _.
4.Mike is going to take a trip next week,
He’s very _ _ _ _ _ _ _.
5. Sarah is _ _ _ _ _, because her mother
is going to buy a new dress for her.
Learning aims:
1.能听说读写6个重点单词:tired, angry, excited, happy; sad, bored;
2.能正确运用重点句子:How does Amy feel? She’s tired.
新课标英语优秀教学设计3
教学目标
1. 能够理解对话大意,并回答对话下问题。能按照正确的语音、语调及意群朗读对话,并能进行角色表演。
2. 能够听、说、读、写,并在情景中运用句型 How was your weekend? It was good. Did you do anything else? 提问并回答有关周末活动的安排。
3. 能够在语境中理解生词drank的意思,并能正确发音。
教学重难点
1. 重点:运用句型 How was your weekend? It was good. Did you do anything else? 提问并回答有关周末活动的安排。
2. 难点:一般过去时动词词尾的规则变化。
教学过程
一、课前展示
1. 师生相互问候。
2. 教师利用头脑风暴活动激发学生的背景知识,复习相关的动词及动词词组。教师请学生说出周末一般做什么,复习有关周末活动的词汇。如果学生不能够说出很多单词或词组,教师可在课件上出示词组,引导学生描述自己周末一般做什么。
二、情境导入
1. 呈现重点句型
(1) 教师展示日历,请学生回忆上周末做了什么。教师引导学生说出上周末的活动安排,并用一般过去时的句子转述,请学生感受使用一般过去时的语境。师生对话示例如下:
T: How was your weekend? Busy? Happy? What did you do?
Ss: I do my homework.
T: Oh, you did your homework last weekend.
T: What else did you do?
…
(2) 教师说出自己上周末所做的事,并将句子呈现在课件上。课件内容示例如下:
I was very busy last weekend.
I cleaned my room last Saturday morning.
I washed my clothes last Saturday afternoon.
I cooked a meal last Sunday evening.
I watched TV last Sunday evening.
三、自主合作
教师在课件上呈现两组句子,引导学生认真观察,并尝试找出规律。
What do you usually do on weekend? What did you dolast weekend?
I clean my room. I cleaned my room last Saturday.
I wash my clothes. Iwashed my clothes last Sunday.
I cook a meal. I cooked a meal last Sunday.
I watch TV. I watched TV last Saturday.
教师引导学生小结一般过去式动词的规则变化,即一般情况下,在词尾加-ed,大多搭配表示过去的时间短语,如:lastweekend, last Sunday。教师在课件上用红色标注-ed及last。
师生进行即席问答,对话示例如下:
T: Who cleaned your room?
Ss: …
T: Who washed your clothes?
Ss: …
T: Who cooked a meal?
Ss: …
T: Who watched TV?
Ss: …
2. Let’s try.
(1) 教师在课件上出示主情景图,引入Mike的周末活动。询问学生:Whatdo you think of Mike’s weekend? Was it interesting? 教师在课件上呈现日历,使学生初步了解本课要学习的内容涉及过去的时间。
(2) 教师要求学生读题并猜测答案。
(3) 学生读题并猜测答案。
(4) 教师播放本部分录音,学生听后选择正确答案。
(5) 教师校对第一题答案时,请学生说出原因,引导学生推导时间,引出lastweekend。
3. Let’s talk.
(1) 教师播放本部分录音两遍,学生带着问题听录音,听后回答问题:
What did Mike do last weekend?
What did Grandpa do?
How was their weekend?
(2) 游戏:听对话,做动作
教师请学生听对话的录音,当听到描述Mike与Grandpa周末活动及感受的语句时,教师暂停录音,请学生起立,重复读一次,如下所示:
It was good.(起立并复读)
I stayed at home with your grandma.(起立并复读)
We drank tea in the afternoon and watched TV.(起立并复读)
I watched TV, too.(起立并复读)
I watched some children’s shows on TV.(起立并复读)
I cleaned my room and washed my clothes.(起立并复读)
(3) 教师播放课文动画,请学生看完后完成以下连线活动。
(4) 师生核对连线题的答案。
(5) 教师放录音,学生跟读。教师解释单词drank的意义。
(6) 教师播放课文录音,学生逐句仿读。(提醒学生在跟读的过程中注意模仿录音中的语音、语调)
四、检测提升
1. Role Play
师生分角色朗读课文;同桌分角色朗读对话;教师可挑学生上台表演对话。
2. 活动1: 教师在课件上呈现Mike’s grandma周末活动的图片,提问学生:How was Grandma’s weekend? What did she do? Did she do anything else? 组织学生创编新的对话并进行表演。
3. 活动2: 教师与学生对话,提问该生上周末做了什么以及下周末打算做什么。对话后教师示范如何转述该生的话,然后请学生依照示范与同学对话,并尝试转述同学的活动安排。 师生对话示例如下:
T: Hi, Lily. How are you? How was your weekend?
Lily: I’m fine,thank you. It was good.
T: What did you do?
Lily: I went to the park with my father and mother.
T: That’s nice. Didyou do anything else?
Lily: Yes, I cooked a meal and washed the dishes. Iplayed chess with my dad.
T: Wow! You are a good girl. What are you going to donext weekend?
Lily: I’m going tovisit my grandparents.
T: That’s good.
教师转述示例如下:
Lily was happy last weekend. She went to the park withher family. She cooked a meal washed the dishes. She played chess with her dad.She is going to visit her grandparents next weekend.
五、改编对话
和自己的伙伴讨论上周做了什么,可参照课文内容进行改编
新课标英语优秀教学设计4
教学目标
能听,说,读,写短语:cleaned my room, washed my clothes , stayed at home, watched TV .
理解句子:How was your weekend ? It was fine ,thanks . What did you do ? I stayed at home and watched TV.
能运用过去式询问别人上周末的活动,并会对其作出回答。
3. 能够运用新学的内容完成 “Do a survey and report”任务。
4. 在小组的讨论交流中,培养学生英语的综合运用能力。
教学重难点
1.重点:掌握核心单词、词组以及句子。
2.难点:掌握动词过去式的用法及过去式的读音。
教学过程
Step1 : Warm up
T: Good morning, boys and girls,.
I usually clean my room and wash the clothes on weekends.
What do you usually do on weekends?
S1: I usually do my homework and watch TV.
S2: I usually play table tennis. ………..
(设计目的:问候语热身进入英语学习状态,同时用一般现在时态提问,为新课一般过去时做铺垫。)
Step2:Presentation
T: Today we’ll learn Unit.2Last weekend.
1. 日历呈现 Last weekend
(设计目的:直观导入过去时间,上周六和上个星期天。)
2. 图片New phrases: cleaned , washed ,watched,stayed ,
cleaned my room , washed my clothes ,stayed at home ,watched TV.
(
3. 师板书下列单词的原形clean ,wash ,watch, stay,并用I often clean my room /…造句。
师板书以上单词原形并且加ed后,用I cleaned my room /…last weekend 造句。
(设计目的:呈现本节课核心词汇,导入本节课的核心句型。)
4.学生观察两个词组的不同之处.T:eg: cleaned 是clean的过去式,当我们要表达过去发生的事情时,就要用动词的过去式,规则动词的过去式一般在原型后面加ed. cleaned的ed 发/d/. 师带读.
用同样的方式教“stay/stayed at room,wash/washed my clothes,watch/watched TV.”. 注意:washed,watched的ed 发/t/.
(设计目的:通过比较,归纳,让学生获得新知,并学会学习。)
step:3
1.出示课件并让学生自己观察回答问题。
T: How were their weekend?
S1:He cleaned his room and washed his clothes.
S2: She stayed at home and watched TV.
呈现句型:What did you do? 师生问答
(设计目的:让学生观察课件,说出他们做了什么,操练本课核心句型。)
生打开课本P15,听录音跟读。
pair-work T: How was your weekend ? S: It wasfine , thanks.
T: What did you do ? SI :I stayed at home andwatched TV.
Listen to the tape of Let’s learn and follow it.
(设计目的:让学生听课本标准发音,并跟读,培养听说能力。)
Let’s chant,边做动作边chant:
What did you do last weekend ? I cleaned my room.
What did you do ? What did you do ? I washed myclothes.
What did you do ? What did you do ? I stayed athome.
What did you do ? What did you do ? I watched TV. (注意:do 的过去式did ).
(设计目的:利用chant对新知进行渗透并为下面学习做好铺垫。)
5.Do a survey and report :学生利用表格,进行问卷调查。
操练句型—How was your weekend?
--- What did you do?
(设计目的:通过调查汇报,获得信息反馈,知晓学生对新知掌握的情况。)
Step 4. 达标检测
一、写出下列动词的过去式。
1. wash_____ 2. stay_____3.watch______ 4.clean______ 5.do______
二、读一读,选一选。
( )1.你想问同学周末过得怎样,可以说:______.
A. How was your weekend ? B. Howold are you ?
( ) 2.你想问同学有多高,可以说:_______.
How heavy are you ? B.How tall are you ?
( )3.你想告诉同学:你周末过得很好,可以说:____.
A. I’mtaller than you . B. It was fine.
( ) 4.你想问同学上周末做了什么?可以说_____.
A. What did you do last weekend ?B. What are you going todo next weekend ?
( )5.你想说:它比我们俩加起来还高,可以说:_______.
It’s taller thanboth of us together. B. It’s taller than theelephant.
(设计目的:适当地给予学生课后练习,是对已学知识的巩固,新课的延伸。)
新课标英语优秀教学设计5
教学目标
知识目标:
1、能够听说读写句型:--How did you go there? I went by train .
2. 能听懂、会说本课对话,并能在实际情景中应用。
能力目标:
能够用一般过去式询问别人在过去的时间里乘坐什么交通工具去了哪里并作答。如Where did you go on your holiday? I went to Xinjiang. How did you go there? I went by train.
情感目标:
1能在游戏中积极参与,激发学生学习英语的热情,积极运用所学英语进行交流,加强合作式学习,共同完成学习任务。2、通过竟争,培养学生的集体荣誉感和竞争意识。
教学重难点
1,教学重点是掌握句型 How did you go there? I went by train.
2.教学难点是在实际情景中正确运用并书写所学对话。
教学过程
step1 warm up
1. let`s chant where did you go on your holiday?
2.Let` s review ;利用单词卡片复习动词短语和句型What did you do on your holiday?
3.Free talk:
what did you do on your holiday?
I took pictures.
Good !What about you?
I went ice-skating .
设计思路:Let`chant 设计是为了活跃气氛并引出本课主题:Where did you go on your holiday?Let`s review.不仅可以复习短语和句型,还为拓展本课句型做了铺垫。
step2 presentation
1.present Let`s try
What did you Chenjie do on her holiday? Let`s listen and circle.
listen again and check your answers
(设计思路)通过处理本部分, 达到呈上启下的作用。
2.Present let`s talk
What`s the weather like today?
It`s warm and sunny.
What`s the weather like in Harbin in winter?(课件出示哈尔滨的一张下雪的图片)
It`s cold and snowy.
Did you go to harbin on your holiday?
Yes, I did.
How can you go to Harbin?
I can go there by plane or by train.
That`s right .Sarah went to Harbin on her holiday.How did she go there?Let`s have a look.听录音let`s talk。
Ask and answer.
Look and repeat.
Read in roles.
Act out the dialouge.
Step3 practise
看图问(Where did you go ?How did you go ?What did you do ?学生根据图回答。
Step4 Consolidation
1、快速枪答
过程:全班学生分成4大组,请两名学生上来,A学生抽取地点卡片,B 同学抽取交通方式卡片。
(1)A同学问大家:Where did you go on your holiday?大家根据A同学的卡片回答:I went to
(2)B同学把卡片上的交通方式用动作或模拟声音表达出来,边做边问大家。How did you go there?每组同学根据表演者的动作猜并快速回答:I went....
看哪个组抢答又快有对。
(3)然后有AB两同学分别在其他组任选两个同学,做轮换练习。
2、采访活动
请一名同学任意抽取一张动词短语过去式的卡片,对任一个小组进行采访,抽取卡片的同学根据卡片内容边做动作边提问:What did you do? 被采访的小组同学看动作猜出短语是什么,并回答:I....
全体同学大声重复答I....(然后这名同学再抽取不同的卡片对其他组进行采访)
3、小组活动
学生以前后桌为单位分成若干小组,组内几人分别准备好写有交通方式、动词短语的过去形式、地点,以及时间的卡片,小组内部以表演动作并提问的方式操练整个对话。
(1)一人抽取卡片并根据卡片的内容(地点、时间)提问:Where did you go on your holiday?其他同学根据卡片上的内容回答:I went to ....
(2) 然后其他同学自由抽取卡片根据内容(交通方式或者动词短语)用动作或模拟声音表达出来并体问:How did you go there?或What did you do there?其他学生根据动作猜短语并回答。
(3)小组内部每人轮流抽卡片并体问。
教师请一名学生说出曾经去过的地方和所乘做的交通工具,学生两人一组进行调查。教师可请几名学生汇报调查结果。
设计思路:通过前面的小组活动充分为学生搭建了语言交流的平台,这一环节教师可以放手让学生自主操练,使学生积极运用所学英语进行交流,加强合作式学习,共同完成学习任务。
Step5 :Homework
1. 听音朗读对话内容并背诵、默写四会句子。
2.调查其他朋友的假期旅游情况,下节课汇报交流。
设计思路:通过课内外相结合的方式,让学生学习英语的兴趣不仅停留在课堂上,而且能延伸到课外。这一开放性的作业设计,引导学生养成课外自主学习英语的习惯,锻炼学生在生活中运用英语的能力。
六、板书设计My holiday
How did you go there? I went by train.
英语优秀课件【篇7】
本课的内容是小学新起点英语二年级上册第三单元Lesson13。通过本课学习使学生能够在涉及的情景条件下能够听懂会说出与公园有关的单词和句型。本课的学习,我以“任务型”教学为纲领,结合“TPR”教学法,通过听,说,读,唱等一系列教学活动,培养学生的学习兴趣,鼓励同学们大胆运用英语参与实践及时予以表扬和鼓励使他们获得学习英语的成就感和喜悦感。
二年级的学生在此时对英语学习已经有了初步的认识,模仿能力比一年级强了,口腔肌肉不在那么僵硬了。有了对英语学习的感觉和浓厚的兴趣。他们渴望上英语课,渴望获得更多的锻炼机会。因此采用听,说,读,唱等一系列教学活动,倡导学生体验参与。从而达到培养学生综合语言运用能力的目的。
(1)Parks这一课内容贴近学生生活实际,富有趣味性,我在教学时就注重学生学习兴趣培养,以不同的方式限度地激发学生的学习动机。
(2)为学生创设学习情境,注重培养学生语言运用能力,突出语言的实践性和交际性,同时突出语言的真实性和实用性。
(3)注重教材的灵活性和可操作性,以满足不同层次学生的需求。并为学生进一步学习或终身学习奠定基础。
根据教材在本课的教学,我以“任务型”教学为纲领,结合“TPR”教学法,通过听,说,读,唱等一系列教学活动,培养学生的.学习兴趣,鼓励同学们大胆运用英语参与实践并及时予以表扬和鼓励使他们获得学习英语的成就感和喜悦感。
本着以题材为纲,功能、结构、运用任务为目的,着重培养学生运用英语的能力。教学中体现学用结合,学以致用的原则,通过听听做做,唱唱玩玩等方式,让学生尽可能多地“习得”英语,帮助学生从不自觉,无意识地“习得”英语逐步到自觉,有意识地“学习”英语,为学生创造一个在听懂与会说之间,在看懂与会读之间,在会读与能写之间的语言自我发展过程。
结合本课内容,根据《英语课程目标》提出基础教育阶段英语课程的总体目标是培养学生综合语言运用能力,结合这一目标要求,以及本册书的特点现将本课教学目标设计如下:
1知识目标:能够听懂并说出与公园有关的自然景物的单词及表达某地有什么的句型。
2能力目标:让学生能初步运用所学知识进行交流,培养学生的口语交际能力。
3情感目标:(1)进一步提高对英语的学习热情,增强学习兴趣。
(2)培养学生积极主动地参与课堂活动,大胆开口,主动模仿。
(3)通过本课的学习培养学生欣赏美的能力,热爱大自然,保护我们的生活环境。
教学重点
1、词汇:park hill lake tree bridge flower grass
2、句型:There is … in the park.
教学难点
1、单词bridge的正确发音。
2、对某地有某物的表达:There is … in the park.
教法、学法
为使学生在教学过程中积极参与到教学活动中,我在设计课堂活动时,让学生尽可能多的时间开口说英语,练习与运用刚学到的知识并把学到的单词编成琅琅上口的小Chant,充分调动学生的学习主动性。运用多媒体技术,把动感带进课堂,使原来比较枯燥的知识变得生动,集视觉,听觉,语音,情景于一身,使原来比较枯燥的知识变得生动,从而改进教学环境,让学生在声、文、图、象的新情境中去学习巩固本课知识,从而提高教学效率。
教学流程
教学目标的确立,教学学法的设计,最终要在教学程序中体现。因此合理安排教学程序是教学成功的关键之一,结合学生的认知状况,我打算用以下几个教学环节来完成本课的教学:
一、问候语
Hello boys and girls!
How are you today?
Nice to meet you!
设计意图:上课伊始通过师生问候既为学生营造轻松的学习氛围,又吸引了学生的注意力,也给学生创造了开口大声说英语的机会。
二、热身环节sing a song 《 》
设计意图:通过歌曲调动了学生全面参与到教师组织的活动当中,成为学习的主人,学生在热身这一环节中放松了紧张的心情,以更加自信的状态学习英语。
三、复习环节
通过游戏让学生来复习单词:tall short thin pretty ugly
设计意图;通过教师做动作让学生来猜单词,然后让学生来拼单词这一游戏来达到复习单词的目的,使原本枯燥的复习变得生动有趣,并在复习过程中给予适当的奖励,调动学习情绪和学生的学习积极性、主动性。
四、新授环节
1、导入: Look(大屏出示图) Oh, What are beautiful place! There are parks ! OK ,Today we will learn Unit3 Parks.
设计意图;通过出示一些公园的图片,引出本节课的话题,使学生有一种身临其境的感觉,让学更加直观的学习。
2、新授:
(1.)Let `s go to the park, Now what can you see in the park?(看大屏)what’this ? 学习单词flower tree hill lake bridge grass 及句型There is … in the park.
设计意图:通过课件来学习单词便于学生掌握所学内容,通过个别读、齐读、小组读等多种方式帮助学生巩固单词,并及时把新学到的单词放在句型中操练,使学生学习起来轻松、自如,从而提高学习英语的自信心。
五、巩固训练:
1、Let’s chant!
hill hill 小山高又高
tree tree 大树绿又绿
lake lake 湖水清又清
flower flower 花儿真美丽
grass grass 草地做游戏
设计意图:通过歌谣形式来帮助学生复习巩固本堂课所学的新单词,提高学生的学习兴趣,让学生带着非常轻松、愉快的心境实现了对语言知识的运用。
2.通过图片来练习句型 :
There is … in the park.
( flower tree hill lake bridge grass)
设计意图:通过这样的操练目的是为学生创设一个自我表现的空间,让他们能够学以致用,有一种学习英语的成就感和自信心。同时也是为了深化新知,发展学生用英语思考的能力,培养学生的综合语言运用能力。
六、作业
七、结束语
So much for today!
Everyone bye bye!
效果预测
我力求在轻松愉快的气氛中完成本课教学,使学生在课堂上学习热情高涨,通过TPR、游戏、歌谣、等各种活动使学生学会本课所要掌握的知识,让学生在动中学、玩中练,使学生真正成为课堂活动中的主人。我有信心相信我能很好的完成本次教学任务,达到预定的教学目标和要求。
英语优秀课件【篇8】
一、教学目标:
1、知识目标
(1)能够听、说、认读五个有关水果的单词:apple,orange,banana, grape,pear,并能正确运用;注意单词banana、grape的复数形式。
(2)能够运用句型What is this/that? It is a/an…进行对话,注意单词在名词前a/an的变化。
2、技能目标
(1)通过学习单词,培养学生听说读的能力
(2)通过创设情景,综合运用所学语言进行交流,培养学生在实际生活中综合运用语言的交际能力和对语言的应变能力。
3、情感目标
让每一个学生都能积极主动参与教学活动,发挥学生主观能动性,从而使他们更加热爱英语学习,增强学习英语的信心。
二、教学重点难点
(1)重点:学习单词apple、 pear 、banana 、orange 、grape 的正确读音以及句型What is this/that? It is a/an…的学习。注意单词在名词前a/an的变化和单词的复数形式。
(2)难点:注意单词在名词前a/an的变化和单词banana、grape的复数形式;能正确运用句型What is this/that? It is a/an…在日常生活中进行对话。
三、教法、学法:
情景教学法、游戏法、活动教学法、小组合作法
四、教具准备:
单词卡片,多媒体课件。
五、教学过程
1、复习旧知:利用带有颜色单词的卡片,进行抽查和全班齐读形式让学生回忆 red、yellow、orange等单词。
2、导入新课:大屏幕出示所要学习的水果的谜语,要求学生猜谜语。“同学们喜欢猜谜语吗?老师这里有几个谜语,想让同学们猜猜,快看大屏幕:红红脸,圆又圆,咬一口,脆又甜。”(剩下的4种水果也用猜谜形式引出) “同学们真聪明,那同学们想不想知道这些水果用英语怎么说呢? 好,今天我们就一起来学习吧。”
3、呈现新课:
(1)把新单词板书在黑板上,逐个跟读、拼读。首先是全班读,接着是男生女生轮流读、最后是通过小组间竞赛读和开火车读的形式巩固单词读音。强调banana 、grape的复数形式是bananas和grapes(通过在大屏幕出示one banana,two bananas,they are grapes的图画,这样再来教学这两个单词的复数形式。)
4、大屏幕出示What is this/that? It is a/an…的对话语音,老师及时在黑板上板书新句型What is this/that? It is a/an…。让学生把刚学的单词运用起来,(如:老师手拿苹果卡片,问:What is this?生答: It is an apple.)强调apple、 orange的首字母是元音字母而且发音是元音开头,所以单词前必须是an(如:an apple、an orange),而pear 、banana 、grape是辅音字母开头,所以单词前是a(如a pear)。再通过师生、生生互动交流进行对话练习,首先是全班跟读,接着是师问生答和生问师答互动读,最后是同桌之间到小组之间的生生问答,达到巩固且能掌握并熟练运用。
5、巩固练习
(1)游戏“水果蹲”:老师说明游戏规则,先在小组内进行;再邀请5位同学上台,分别以刚学习水果单词命名,进行“水果蹲”游戏。如“apple蹲apple蹲,apple蹲完 pear 蹲”
(2)游戏“猜水果”:老师说明游戏规则,一名同学说出要猜水果的特征(一定要用英文说出该水果的颜色),另一位同学要用英文回答是什么水果,回答正确后刚刚的两位同学要用What is this/that? It is a/an…进行对话。先在小组内进行;在邀请一对同学上台进行游戏。如“A:这个水果是圆圆的,颜色是red。B:apple。A:What is this?B:It is an apple.”
(3)大屏幕出示刚刚学习的水果单词和句子,学生跟读两遍。
六、总结
今天我们一起学习了新的单词apple、 pear 、banana 、orange 、grape和他们的复数形式以及新的句型What is this/that? It is a/an…和单词在名词前a/an的变化,课下同学们要多读并多用学过的单词句子与同学们交流哦。
七、布置作业
完成课后练习,回家后把今天所学的单词和句子和自己的父母说说。
英语优秀课件【篇9】
一、精心设计听前活动,引入听力情境,激发学生听的兴趣。
听前活动是听力教学的暖身活动,在听前学生先阅读听力材料,激发学生听的兴趣,集中听的注意力,同时扫除即将听到的语言材料中的难点,以便顺利地进入下一阶段的活动。
精心设计听力课的导入是上好听力课的前提。设计导入活动时,教师要以听力材料的内容着手,特别关注学生的兴趣。
(1)利用图片和多媒体课件导入。
在学生正式听录音之前,为了让学生能尽快地进入听的状态,初步感受听力的主题。教师可以利用图片和多媒体课件等教学辅助材料来刺激学生的视觉。激发他们对由画面内容引起的猜测、联想等一系列的思维活动。通过教师层层有启发性的提问,鼓励学生积极思维,勇于表达。教师还可组织学生就画面内容展开讨论。在讨论过程中学生的信息可以得到互补。如教师要求学生听一个主题为 “Rules around us”时,听前活动就可设计为:
Task One: Talk about the signs:
教师出示各种在不同场合可以见到的标志如“禁止吸烟”、“不准入内”、“严禁跳水”、“不准停车”等标志,提问学生:
1. Where can you see these signs?
2. Do you know what these signs mean?
3. What must we do or mustn’t do when we see these signs?
通过对这些图片的讨论,学生对与主题有关的重要语言结构和内容作好了充分的准备。
Task Two: Talk about the places:
画面出现学生生活中每天都经历的场景。如学校食堂、图书馆、马路车站、居住小区等,引导学生继续思考讨论。
what are the things you must do or you mustn’t do in these places?
听前活动的设计既激活了学生的背景知识,学生在Think and share的过程中,思维能力和口语表达能力也得到相应的发展和提高,更重要的是听前活动的开展为听时环节的顺利开展无论在学生的心理上,还是语言知识上都作好了充分的准备。又如在为学生引入 “famous persons”这一主题时,教师也可以利用图片或画面显示学生非常熟悉和崇拜的人物如歌星、影星、运动明星等。让学生通过讨论的基础上,聚焦某一人物。比如要让学生听一段介绍有关篮球明星姚明的文章。教师可先让学生观看一段篮球比赛的画面。然后教师可提问 “Do you like watching/playing basketball?” “Who do you think of when you watch basketball match?” “Do you know something about Yao Ming?” “Do you want to know more about him?” 在画面的帮助下,教师设计有启发、有层次的问题使学生渐渐进入听力的主题。
(2)利用学生背景知识导入。
学生进入课堂时,都是有备而来的。他自身已有的知识水平、生活经验、兴趣爱好等都对课堂教学产生积极的影响。教师要努力激活学生的背景知识,使学生凭借已有的知识和经验来获取更新的知识,更多的经验。还是以“Rules around us”为例,听前教师以学生非常熟悉的班级公约说起,要求学生讨论已有的班规。或调整或修改或补充。使学生明白作为班级的一分子,每个人都有责任、有义务遵守各项班级制度。继而由此话题展开讨论Are there any rules around you? What are they? 此时学生会把自己所知的东西毫无保留地说出来。同时他们更渴望从课堂中获得更多。学生的背景知识被激活,学习的欲望也就因此而被点燃。教师要趁机组织好下面的新授环节,使课堂教学环环相扣、内容层层递进。
(3) 通过表演导入
学生生性活泼好动,有非常强的表现欲。教师要积极创设情景,努力为学生创造机会。如在让学生听 “seeing a doctor”这一主题时,听前活动就可以设计让学生表演各种不同的病状,如头痛,牙疼,胃痛等。当表演的学生通过不同的表情,不同的动作表现出各种病症时,其他同学会被表演学生的滑稽像所逗乐,同时教师通过提问“What’s wrong with him?”学生就复习整理了一些常见的'表示病症的词汇,如toothache ,sore throat, headache等。学生也会自然而然地想到生病了要去看医生,需要打针、吃药。或者同学病了,我们要多关心他,要给他一些建议,或者他生病了,我也要多加注意等一系列问题的思考。所以,这一活动的设计为下面听力活动的开展作好了语言和内容方面的准备。学生在进入听时活动环节中就会少遇一些障碍,多一份自信。
(4) 通过游戏引入
英语听力材料中经常会出现数字表示不同意思的情况。如数字表示日期、表示数量、表示价格、表示时间等。学生在听的过程中往往会反应不过来。如果平时缺乏针对性的训练,学生在听到数字时常有措手不及的感觉,影响听力理解的效果。所以如果教师在让学生完成听力任务时出现较多用数字表达意思的情况,教师就应在听前活动中设计热身练习。这里可以通过做不同的游戏来刺激学生对数字的反应。如训练学生对数字表示时间的反应时,教师就可准备一个钟面,组织学生进行竞赛,看谁说得又快又准。也可在黑板上画几个钟面,教师报出时间,让学生在钟面上画出相应的时间。教师还 组织类似智力抢答的游戏。如教师说“It’s half past eight, but Tom’s watch is five minutes fast/slow. What time is it by Tom’s watch? 或 “It’s half past eight. The class will be over in ten minutes. What time is it now?”教师设计多种情况让学生积极操练有关时间的加减换算,激发学生的兴趣,训练了学生对数字的敏感性,反应的灵活性。从而缓解了学生在听到数字时紧张、焦虑的心理。
二、合理安排教学活动,精心设计听力练习,使学生积极参与听时活动。
听中活动的设计主要是培养学生听力理解能力。通过听不同形式的材料来培养学生获取事实、信息的能力。在完成听力任务的过程中养成听的习惯,积累听的方法,锻炼听的心理,完善听的技巧,从而逐步提高听的能力。听时活动的设计一定要围绕主题设计循序渐进的,形式多样的活动来激发学生的参与意识。让学生在完成任务的过程中获得一份成功的体验。
在听“Rules around us”时,教师就可以设计如下几种活动让学生在听时完成任务。
Task One: Listen to two students talking about signs. Number the signs that are talking about。(磁带录音)(图片插入)
A: Look at these signs what do you think they mean?
B: Well, this one means don’t throw rubbish on the ground. I think they use it in parks. A: What do you think this one means?
B: I think that’s to stop people throwing things out of windows. You sometimes see it on housing estates.
教师指导学生边听边为表示该标志的图片编上序号。当这一任务完成之后,教师可利用现有的图片向学生提问 “what does this sign mean?” 也可以与学生一起做快速反应练习。即教师说出某一标志的意思,要学生快速指出是哪一图片。如“which sign means no passing? Which sign means you don’t throw the rubbish on the ground.等。在对话材料中还出现哪里能见到这些标志,因此教师可让学生再听一遍录音。当然在听之前一定要给予学生明确的指令,以便让学生在听的过程中有意注意关键的内容。如第一遍学生有意注意每一标志的具体意思,而第二遍则更注意这些标志出现的地方。在第二遍听完之后,教师就可以利用图片口头提问“Where can you find this sign?”.总之,教师要事先对学生所要听的材料做好充分的准备。了解材料中的难点是什么? 重点是什么?根据材料还能设计什么活动?使得每一份材料都能得到充分的使用。
Task Two: Two students are talking about some places. Listen to their dialogue and fill in the blanks. .(磁带录音)
A: What are some of the regulations on the underground?
B: Well, I know you’re not allowed to eat or drink on the underground.
A: Yes. That’s right. They have that sign which says you mustn’t eat or drink.
B: Oh, and I know another one. You should let people get off the train before you get on. A: Let people get off the train before you get on. That’s a good idea.
听完对话以后,教师等待学生完成练习。
You mustn’t ____________ or_______________. You should let people _____________before you get on. 校对完学生的练习之后,教师更应启发学生谈论更多乘地铁需要遵守的规则。教师可以说 “we mustn’t ear or drink. And we should let people get off before we get on when we take an underground train. Then what else must or mustn’t be done on underground? 教师鼓励学生说出更多乘地铁需要注意的地方。这一活动是让学生用英语的思维关注生活。教师还可以提供更多的场所供学生在课余讨论。为调节课堂气氛教师还可组织猜一猜活动。如这里教师可把活动设计为:one says people must or must not do in a certain place and the others guess what place he/she is talking about.
Task Three: Eight students in the picture are breaking library rules. Listen to the librarian talking about the rules and number the students who are breaking rules. .(磁带录音)(图片插入)
(1) Oh, I can see students cutting something out of one of the books. That’s very bad. We have a rule against that.
(2)what’s that students doing with a bag in the library? Bags aren’t allowed.
(3) Is that student playing cards over there? That’s against the rules. The library is a place for reading and studying---not for playing cards.
这一练习因为有图片的辅助,因而不难完成任务。重要的还是如何运用现成的材料继续开展积极的活动。如根据图片教师可以提问 “what is he/she doing? What should he/she do or not do? 如果条件允许的话,教师也有、可以播放一段事先拍摄的关于人们违规现象的录象,要求学生指出Who is breaking the rule? What should he/he do ?这样的活动既让学生在现实的情景中操练运用了语言,又让学生在行为习惯的养成方面受到良好的教育。
Task Four: An English teacher has decided to introduce some new rules in her class. Listen and write down the new rules. .(磁带录音)
If Mrs Li arrives late for class,_____________________________________________
Students who get an A for a test______________________________________________
Students who make no grammar mistakes in a composition_________________________
Students who arrive late for class_____________________________________________
Students who forget to do homework__________________________________________
//Well, everyone, I’ve decided to introduce some new class rules. Firstly, I’m sorry I’ve arrived late so often this term. If I arrive late again, there’ll be no homework that day. Is that fair? Now, I’ve decided to give a special reward to students who get an A for a test .anyone who gets an A on a test will get a piece of cake. And I want to see some more improvement in your composition too, so anyone who gives in a composition with no grammar mistakes will get two chocolates. I see that some of you are still arriving late for class. In future, anyone who arrives late for class will have to sing a song to the class. So if you don’t want to sing, don’t be late. And I don’t want anyone to forget their homework. In future, anyone who forgets to do their homework will have to learn a poem??
上述材料是一位英语教师对他课堂的新规定。听完之后学生不禁会羡慕别人有这么开明,民主的英语教师。 所以作为教师,我们要善于捕捉学生微妙的心里想法和心理变化,及时调整我们的教育教学策略。 如听了上述材料,作为英语教师对改进自己的课堂纪律和要求无动于衷的话,学生肯定会大失所望的。 因而,教师就应该因势诱导学生一起讨论制订更完善、更民主、更具人情味的英语课堂学习纪律。这一活动的开展不仅会激发学生英语学习的兴趣,更会使学生在英语课堂上规范自己随意的行为。对学生整个的学习过程会产生积极的影响。
总之,听时活动的设计一定要根据材料的内容结合学生的语言实际、认知能力、年龄特点设计由易及难,由单项到综合的活动,在一环扣一环的环节设计中让学生一步一步完成任务。其次,在学生完成任务的过程中,教师要明确自己的角色,教师决不是录音设备的操纵者,而是学生的帮助者。教师要通过提问、观察等多种途径了解学生在听的过程中注意力是否集中?情绪是否焦虑?信息接受是否困难?任务安排难易是否得当?教师要及时发现学生在听的过程中的出现的问题并及时地给予学生必要的支持和帮助。如某一单词或句子结构、某一语法现象、某一文化差异等对学生的理解造成障碍,教师要调整策略。是应该停下来讲解,还是放慢听的速度或增加听的次数。听的过程中加强师生之间的互动使听的过程更流畅,任务的完成更有效。学生获取信息、处理信息的能力更强。同时,教师还要注意在学生任务的过程中加强听能技巧的指导。教师要指导学生在听时先抓住关键,即主要大意。再听细节。让学生每听一遍都有新的任务,每听一遍都有新的收获。
英语教学课件精品
为了让您阅读更加愉快,编辑特别修改了这篇"英语教学课件"。根据教学规定,老师在上课前必须准备好教案和课件,这可不是随便一搞就行的。教案和课件是打造高效课堂不可或缺的要素。非常欢迎您的阅读,希望您会喜欢它!
英语教学课件 篇1
随着基础英语课程改革的不断深人,人们越来越认识到广大教师在课程改革中至关重要的作用以及担负的神圣使命。教师对于新课程的重视是实施新课程的前提和基础,教师对新课程的重视度将最终决定着新课程实施是否成功,以及素质教育推进的深度 。
当然,备课不等同于写教案,备课是教师教会学生如何学习、如何思索、逐渐成长的过程,而教案只是教学提要,是教师在上课前准备的教学方案。备课还包括教案之外的教师通过自己的日常生活感受、知识储备以及积累的教学经验对课堂做出的准备。万变不离其宗,任何备课模式都离不开以提高教学质量为前提,在备课时,教师应明确教学目标、优化教学设计、活用教学方法、适用教学手段、精炼教学语言、精心设计问题等多种方法多方面进行有效备课。同时,各教师之间备课要做到资源共享,组织教师开展集体研读大纲和教材、分析学情、制定学科教学计划、分解备课任务、审定备课提纲、反馈教学实践信息等系列活动。
课堂上教师采用什么教学方法,学生就往往采用相应的学习方法,它直接影响着的学生的学习效果。为此,教师在课堂教学上应努力以灵活多样的教学方法,精心设计教学过程中的各个环节,围绕学生能力素质的发展进行教学。可采用“知识技能,学习能力,学习态度”来作为确定学习状态的特征变量,从而为促进学习能力素质的全面发展服务。由于教学大纲要求的教学内容本身就是根据知识技能、顺序、结构和学生的初始能力的特点做出安排的,所以可以直接拿来使用,在此基础上,按照知识技能的相对完整性,可将教学知识技能发展序列分成几个教学环节。一般来说,除了第一节课以外,每一课教师所要进行教学的内容不外乎三个部分:①复习已教过的语言材料;②教学新的语言项目如词汇、语音、语法和句型等;④进行各种形式的听、说、读、写训练活动。在每一个步骤当中,教师的作用都有所不同,如采用口、笔头练习、测试、听写、提问等复习方式,利用实物、图片、借助动作、猜迷、接龙式提问、简笔画等介绍新的语言项目;通过分排或分行、两入、小组等进行操练;通过做游戏、扮演角色等方式提高运用语言能力;充分利用和“复习要点”,练习册中的练习,口、笔头练习等加强学习运用的能力,以加深印象,巩固记忆。教师要在教学中自始至终观察全班学生的反应,要随时根据情况变换自己的角色,保证所教的内容大家都能接受,达到完成课堂的整体教学任务。教学方法得当,学生则学得轻松有趣,学得灵活,学得好;教学不得当,学生则学得吃力,学得枯燥,甚至厌学,最终导致弃学。
评价不是对结果简单的肯定与否定,而是对学生思维的点拨。同时改进教学评价体系,在批改作业的基础上进一步拓展和延伸。英语新课程的评价采用形成性评价与终结性评价相结合的方式,即关注学生学习的结果,又关注学习的过程.使对学习过程和对学习结果的评价达到和谐统一。形成性评价是对学生日常学习过程中的表现、所取得的成绩以及所反映出来的情感、态度、策略等方面的发展做出评价。它可以使学生从被动地接受评价转变成为评价的主体和积极参与者。其他的学生、教师和家长也可以共同参与评价,实现评价主体的多元化。终结性评价是检测学生综合语言运用能力和反映教学效果的重要途径,它以考察学生综合语言运用能力为目标。可以采取口试、听力考试和笔试等形式,全面地、科学地考察学生在经过一段时间学习后所具有的语言水平。
更新关于课程实施和学生学习的观念和认识语言学习的体验性、实践性特征决定了语言学习过程的重要性。不仅语言运用能力的培养,而且有效的学习策略、积极的情感态度和正确的价值观的形成只有通过学生主动参与大量语言实践活动才能得以实现。更新教师角色,教师不能停留于单纯的知识传授者的角色,而要成为教学的组织者和参与者。它要求教师将教学内容加上既有可操作性又与学生的兴趣和实际生活紧密联系的语言学习任务,并创设真实的语言学习情景,通过广泛的师生互动、生生互动。
课后,教师要主动地进行该课的自我反思,在备课的过程中对学生的哪些问题进行更深化,如对动词的理解,学生的各种感官调动,反思找出在课堂设计和课堂控制等方面的不足,并认真反思本课的教学目标是否达到,学生在这堂课中是否得到了应有的知识摄取。在反思的过程中要全面细致,做好书面记录和总结,对课堂设计的活动获得的效果进行认真的分析。课后,教师可以通过找个别同学谈话的方式了解学生对课堂的满意程度,也需要以作业的方式对学生的学习效果有一定的检测了解,这样可以让教师了解学生对知识的获取情况,以便及时进行教学方法方面的调整。
英语教学课件 篇2
学年康县第一期英语教学培训课程xxxx--xxxx 康县大南峪学校英语教师张瑛xxxx年xx月xx—xx日为期2天的英语培训已落下帷幕,在这紧张、充实而又快乐的日子里,我感受到了很多,也学到了很多。这次培训使我受益匪浅,虽然时间很短,但是培训的内容给了我教学上很大的帮助,听了来自挪威的阿斯媂老师的理论指导,也观看了一些教学实例,亲身体验了一些活动,让理论联系了实际,使得我更深刻、更透彻的领会了老师所讲的内容。以下是我的一些心得体会:
本课时Lets learn 部分学习 white, black, brown, pink, orange等颜色单词。热身、复习环节,主要复习所学的各种问候语和颜色单词。呈现新课时,教师接着第一环节中猜颜色的游戏,有意在最后出示一个学生没学过的颜色,从而引出新颜色单词的教学。教学新知时,教师让学生拿出蜡笔和水彩笔,学习black, brown, pink, orange。再利用颜色卡片,教师带读单词,同时要提示 white, black, brown等的发音。BINGO游戏可复习所学的全部颜色单词。在学生基本掌握新单词之后,教师可以让学生动手用所学颜色画把雨伞或做个陀螺。最后,教师让学生将所做的物品转动起来,说说所看到的颜色。通过此种活动形式,教师可充分发挥学生的能力,做事情、说英语。
英语教学课件 篇3
一、教学设计:
(2)教学向导:
语言目标:Do you want to go to a movie? Yes ,do.
What kind of movies do you like?
I like action movies. Because they are exciting.
what与like的特殊疑问句;
并列连词and,but。
学习策略与技巧:应用讨论的方法,激活学生推理与判断的能力,培养学生的综合分析能力。
情感培养:通过谈论不同类别的影片,使他们学会用funny、scary等不同的形容词来谈论影片,同时鼓励学生观察生活。
词汇储备:action movie,comedy,thriller,documentary,exciting,scary,sad。
二、教学思路:
先从学生喜欢的movie谈起,呈现comedy,thriller等新单词。通过会话,听力等任务型教学方式不断突出主题词汇。2a,2b,2c展开对话,循环练习。给出3a,3b及周末活动的调查任务,让学生综合创新。通过任务型阅读,任务型调查,实现语用能力的自我评价。
三、教学重难点:
(1)重点词汇及句型“Do you want to……?”Yes/No。
(2)并列连词and , but的运用及各词由单数变复数的规律。
四、教学方式:
听歌曲,看剪辑,任务型活动,2组对话,讨论及任务型调查。
教学过程:
Step 1、Lead in:Draw some pictures of football,basketball. T:Do you want to play football?S:YesI do.T:Do you want to go to a movie?S:Yes,I some movie pictures to the students。 Letthem discuss together. And teach the new words.
Step 2Task 1,Talk about the movies. T:Do you want to go to a movie?S:Yes,I do. T:What kind of movies do you like? Do you like comedies?S:Yes,I do./No,I don’t.
First, teacher gives an example. Then the class ask and answer. Choose 2 or 3 pairs to act them out.
Step 3、Task 2,Listening.
Let the students read 2a,then listen to the tape.
Ask some questions about listening.
T:Does Sally like action movies?S:No.
T:What kind of movies does Sally like?S:documentaries.
T:Does Ben like thrillers?S:No,they are scary.
Step 4、Task 3,discussion;like and dislike,using and used,but. Let the students discuss,and finish 3a and 3b and check the answers. Then tell them to read together,in groups or in pairs.
Step 5、Make a survey:What kind of movies do you like?Ask group mates what kind of movies they want to see on weekends. Tell them to talk about each other,and then ask the grouper to give a report.
英语教学课件 篇4
活动目标:
1.教幼儿能听懂并说出眼睛、鼻子、嘴巴的英文名称(eye. Mouse. Mouth)
2.通过各种游戏活动,培养幼儿学习英语的兴趣。
3.通过各种游戏练习,使幼儿了解各器官的作用和功能。
1.字卡:eye眼睛 nose(nauz)鼻子 mouth嘴巴
活动过程:
1.听录音,和老师一起做“五官操”,以及激发幼儿的学习热情,并让幼儿接触“eye, mose, mouth”的发音。
(师):我们每个人都有一张“Face”,在我们的”face”上长有器官,谁能告诉我这些器官的名称,小朋友边说老师边在黑板上画五官,并用英语说:eye two
eyes nose mouth。最后添上头发,耳朵画成一个调度小男孩。幼儿练习“eye mouse mouth”时按五官的上下顺序,同时注意幼儿发音是否 规范。
方法:
师:touch your eyes, one 、two、three,
幼:(手指眼睛)here 、here 、here,
师:touch your nose, one 、two 、three,
幼(手指鼻子)here 、here、 here,
师:touth your mouth, one、 two、three.
幼:(手指嘴边)here、 here 、here。
4.活动延伸:
方法:小朋友每三人一组,给缺少五官的脸谱添画eye nose mouth在添画时告诉大家你画的是什么。
英语教学课件 篇5
标点符号很重要,组成文章不可少,该用哪种小符号,都要认真来思考。
意思说完用逗号,话说完了用句号,喜怒哀乐感叹号,提出问题用问号,
并列词语用顿号,并列分句用分号,提示下文用冒号,对话引用加引号,
注释进层破折号,书文名称书名号,意思省略省略号,表示停顿用顿号。
1、一句话说完,画个小圆圆(。句号)。
2、中间有停顿,小圆点带尖(,逗号)。
3、并排语气词,点个瓜子点(、顿号)。
4、并排分句间,逗号顶圆点(;分号)。
5、引用原话前,上下两圆点(:冒号)。
6、疑问或发问,耳下坠耳环(?问号)。
7、命令或感叹,滴水下屋檐(!感叹号)。
8、引用特殊词,蝌蚪上下翻(“”引号)。
9、文中要解释,月牙分两边(()括号)。
10、转折或注解,直线画后边(——破折号)。
11、意思没表完,六点紧相连(……省略号)。
12、报刊或书名,括号带双尖(《》书名号)。
13、重点词语句,字下加黑点(.着重号)。
14、专用名称下,横(浪)在下边(—— ﹏专用号)。
15、两数或名词,横线连两边(-连接号)。
16、人、地、文名中,黑点居中间(.间隔号)。
1、问号
第一注意选择问,全句末尾才用问。第二注意倒装问,全句末尾也用问。
第三注意特指问,每句末尾都用问。第四注意无疑问,陈述语气不用问。
2、感叹号
关键注意倒装叹,全句末尾才用叹。
3、顿号
大并套小并,大并逗,小并顿。 并列谓和并列补,中间不要去打顿。
集合词语连得紧,中间不要插进顿。 概数约数不确切,中间也别带上顿。
4、分号
分句内部有了逗,分句之间才用分。
5、冒号
提示下文用冒号,总结上文要带冒。
6、引号
引用之语未独立,标点符号引号外。引用之语能独立,标点符号引号里。
7、括号
注释局部紧贴着,注释整体隔开着。
英语教学课件 篇6
一、教材内容分析:
1本单元重点学习围绕食物展开的单词及功能性句子。本课时主要学习一些有关食物的单词:tomato ,tofu,potato,fish,green beans, eggplant和句型What would you like for lunch? l dlike…其中有些单词和句型在四年级上册已经学过,也可以说本单元是四年级上册第五单元的延续。
2.学习有关食物的词汇及如何用英语谈论自己最喜欢的食物,A部分侧重学习有关食物的单词以及一天三餐的食谱。B部分则是谈论自己最喜欢的食物以及原因 C部分是通过制作最喜欢的食物广告活动,逐渐把所学知识内化为自己的能力。
二、教学目标:
What would you like for lunch today? I’d like …
2. 知识目标:认读Let’s learn 的单词和句子,并掌握四会单词;了解good to know等部分的内容。
3.情感目标:了解中国表示美好愿望的传统美食,并介绍其他国家的代表性食物,开拓学生的视野
重点:掌握有关食物单词:tomato ,tofu,potato, eggplant,greenbeans
难点:掌握较多的食物单词,设计又去、符合学生生活实际的情景,激发学生的`兴趣。调动学生的积极性,达到教学目标。
(1) Greetings.
(2)Let’s sing and chant.《What Would You Like》播放《PEP小学英语》四年级上第五单元歌曲,学生跟录音唱。
(1)Do you like vegetables?I like vegetables very much .After a while,I’ll introduce some vegetables and meat for you! Oh, look, I have a riddles .(出示Let’s start部分的谜语。)
Riddle1:It’s red and round. It grow on the ground. It looks like an apple, but it isn’t an apple.What’s it?(tomato.) Riddle2: It’s brown. French fries are made of them. What is it ?(potato)
(3)利用实物教授单词:eggplant,green beans,cabbage,fish , tofu, cabbage.注意纠正cabbage和tofu的读音。
(4) 教授单词pork , mutton。
(5)Group work.
以小组为单位,利用食物卡片,模拟餐厅里吃饭的场景,学生在小组内练习句型What would you like for lunch?及巩固新单词。
(1)、Make the summary.
把学生分成4人一组,调查组内成员一日三餐情况,调查结束后,请学生进行口头汇报。
(1)写本课时的四会单词三遍。
(2)做本部分的活动手册配套练习。
Unit 3 What’s your favourite food?
单词:Park tofu mutton tomato fish patato eggplant
What do you have for lunch today?
I have eggplant and tomatoes .
I have onions and green beans.
英语教学课件 篇7
一、设计理念:
1、教材分析:
我所设计的内容是EEC教材,初三英语上册第六单元第一课。本单元的中心话题是“结识新朋友,不忘老朋友;要和老朋友保持联系”。所以在新课的导入和语言实践活动中,始终在都在围绕着朋友这个话题。最终目的是通过听、说训练,增进应答、反馈和表述的能力。
2、学情分析:
本节课的授课对象是初三的学生。大多数学生已经能够用英语表述自己的想法,但一部分学生比教害羞,上课时不爱发言,同时班级有一部分学生英语的基础比较薄弱。针对这种情况,在教学过程中开发课程资源,拓展教学渠道,利用多媒体教学,创设情景,激发兴趣,调动学生的学习热情,使不同的学生在课上都有所得。
二、教学目标
1、知识与技能:掌握本节课的生词及交际功能;提高学生的听、说能力。
2、过程与方法:教师引导和学生探究。
3、情感态度与价值观:要珍惜友谊,记得和老朋友保持联系。
三、重点、难点:
本节课的教学重点是熟练的掌握生词及短语的用法,培养学生听、说的能力。本节课的教学难点是听过对话后,能够抓住关键信息,并自由的交流或介绍一些朋友的情况。
四、教法与学法:
1、教学方法:
(1)以合作式学习及探究式学习为中心。通过丰富多彩的教学情景,不同的教学活动,使学生感知、体验、实践、参与。
(2)任务型教学。教学过程中,让学生通过完成任务而参与学习过程,而让学生形成运用英语的能力。
2、学法指导:
(1)提高学生自学、探究和合作学习的能力,側重听、说学习策略及语言技能的指导。课堂上要把掌握知识,形成技能,发展能力与培养学生个性健康发展有机结合起来,体现人文主义的教育,引导学生要会选择朋友,珍惜友谊,树立正确的世界观、人生观和价值观。
(2)注重过程评价。在评价中注重培养和激发学生学习语言应用的能力。用恰当的、合理的、充满激情的评价语言进行师生或生生评价,从而调动学生的积极性,培养学生学习的自信心,为学生指明努力方向。
3、教具:多媒体。
五、教学过程:
(一)导入 以 “趣”为切入点。
孔子说过,知之者不如好之者,好之者不如乐之者。当一个人对事物感兴趣时,他的大脑就会兴奋起来。亲切的问候后,学生看两张图片,一棵树和一片森林,问一问学生更喜欢哪一张及其原因。使学生联想到,一人不能独立生存在这个世界上,人人需要朋友。那什么才是朋友呢?通过师生间轻松的交流,使学生既初步了解本单元的话题,又顺利的进入了第一课的学习。
(二)热身活动,在探究中激活学生的思维。
谈论图片:教材在热身活动中,提供了三幅图片。为了增强学生参与意识,吸引学生的注意力,我把三幅图片扫描后,设置在了不同的幻灯片上。这一环节主要是在不同的情景中处理生词,了解图片内容,了解刘畅与他朋友的成长经历,为下一步听,克服障碍。
(三)语言应用,引导质疑,反馈听力能力。
经过热身活动,将教材的第二部分听力,作为了课堂上的反馈环节。首先是听录音,回答两个简单的问题,从整体上去理解听力材料;而后,再听对话,根据对话内容选出最佳答案完成各句,培养学生从听力材料中获取信息的能力,这里说明一下,教材在设置问题时,是分成两部分,比较分散,所以依据中考的题型,我对原有的教材内容的进行了改编;再听第三遍,根据所听内容写出所缺的单词,提高学生听音写词的能力。在大量的听的输入基础之上,让学生进行自读,领会对话的内容。最后小组活动,完成一个表格。这个表格的设计,主要是帮助学生巩固三个交际功能,同时提高他们的收集信息的能力。
(四)综合运用语言,生生互动探讨和体验。
通过了解刘畅和苏珊的老朋友,学生已能够熟练的表达自己和朋友间的故事。所以给学生提供充分的展示空间。通过小组表演对话,同学互访或亲自给朋友设计明信片并寄语的形式来表达自己的想法。对所学的内容进行延伸与拓展,使学生在活动中体验合作成功的快乐。
(五)自我评价和合作评价,增强参与意识。
评价可以调整学生的学习策略,增强学生的学习能力。因此在课的最后,向学生提供了一个评价表格。使学生及时的进行自我反思。
(六)作业的布置:写一篇作文,探讨一下,是否应该结交朋友。在语言的学习过程中,听和读是领会吸收的过程,说和写是表达和应用的过程,通过写,使学生的语言实践能力得到巩固和发展。
六、板书设计:
Unit 6 Silver and Gold Leon 1
Language to know:
A:sb mi sb
B:sb should do ---
C:Iwill do that.
英语教学课件 篇8
本课时Lets learn 部分学习 white, black, brown, pink, orange等颜色单词。热身、复习环节,主要复习所学的各种问候语和颜色单词。呈现新课时,教师接着第一环节中猜颜色的游戏,有意在最后出示一个学生没学过的颜色,从而引出新颜色单词的教学。教学新知时,教师让学生拿出蜡笔和水彩笔,学习black, brown, pink, orange。再利用颜色卡片,教师带读单词,同时要提示 white, black, brown等的发音。BINGO游戏可复习所学的全部颜色单词。在学生基本掌握新单词之后,教师可以让学生动手用所学颜色画把雨伞或做个陀螺。最后,教师让学生将所做的物品转动起来,说说所看到的颜色。通过此种活动形式,教师可充分发挥学生的能力,做事情、说英语。
英语音标课件分享
相信大家都看过很多范文,优秀的范文可以让我们积累相关的知识,阅读范文可以让我们学会将想要表达的传达给他人。对于一些人来说,多看一些范文能增进知识,那么,优秀范文的优秀模板有哪些呢?下面是由小编为大家整理的“英语音标课件分享”,希望能对您有所帮助,请收藏。
英语音标课件 篇1
英语音标教学课件
英语作为一门国际语言,对于许多人来说,学习其语音是必不可少的,因此,英语音标教学既是英语教育的重要组成部分,同时也是英语学习者必须掌握的知识点之一。为此,针对英语音标教学的课件设计就显得尤为重要,下面将介绍如何设计一份有效的英语音标教学课件。
一、选材要点
在设计英语音标教学课件时,选材是相当关键的一环。首先需要考虑教学对象的年龄、英语基础、学习目的等因素。对于小学生和初学者而言,可从英语字母的发音入手,引导学生逐步认识英语音标的基本概念,并结合丰富多彩的图片和动画进行生动有趣的展示和解释。对于高年级学生或成年人,可以通过一些实用的口语和听力练习案例,加深其对英语发音的理解和应用技巧。
二、教学模式要点
英语音标教学的模式分为2种:一是在教师引导下掌握音标,二是通过学生自我探索,逐步掌握音标。对于初学者,第一种方式更为适合,在教师讲授的同时,进行互动练习和巩固,促使学生快速掌握英语音标的基础知识。对于高年级或进一步学习英语的学生,可采用第二种方式,通过提供英文单词或短语,并让学生根据音标的掌握,自行发音练习,以此加深对英语音标的理解。
三、多媒体应用要点
在现代教学中,多媒体技术具有重要的应用价值。在英语音标教学中,多媒体技术可以通过动画、声音、图片等形式帮助学生更好地理解和掌握英语音标的发音规律,加深学生记忆和理解,从而提高学习效果。
四、知识延伸要点
在音标教学的过程中,不仅可以学习和掌握英语音标的基础发音规律,还可以通过各种对话和语境中的应用,了解英语音标在实际口语交流中的应用方式。让学生将学到的音标技巧应用于口语培训中,不断提高英语口语表达水平。
五、教学效果评估要点
在英语音标教学的教学过程中,我们需要根据学生的学习进度和口语表达能力等因素,对教学效果进行评估。可通过评分或口语测试等方式,判断学生是否掌握了音标的相关知识和技巧,从而对教学进度和教学方式进行相应的调整。
总之,为了让英语学习者更好地掌握英语音标技巧,教学者需要在设计时注重选材、教学模式、多媒体应用和知识延伸,使学生在轻松愉快的学习氛围中,逐步领悟和掌握英语音标的发音规律,为日后的英语口语表达打下坚实的基础。
英语音标课件 篇2
英语音标教学课件
一、前言
英语是世界通用语言,其发音清晰、准确是全球人士必备技能。语音学是语言学的一个分支学科,它通过对语音音素的研究,说明语言的声音系统及其规律性,并设计了一套行之有效的音标来表示语音音素。 近年来,许多学生在学习英语时,语音的正确性开始逐渐被重视。而对于英语发音、语音规则和音标知识的学习和掌握,是英语教学中不可忽视的重要一环。本课件旨在提供系统、全面、易学易懂的英语音标教学内容,帮助学生快速地掌握英语音标和发音规则,提高英语语音水平。
二、主题一:“英语音标概述”
在本主题下,通过对音标的定义、分类、分析以及其在英语学习中的重要性进行阐述。如何快速掌握英语音标内容和技巧,从而使学生了解到音标是英语语音学习的重要前提。
三、主题二:“元音音标及其发音规则”
在本主题下,针对元音音标进行阐述,深入介绍元音音标的发音规则,并结合实例进行讲解,引导学生正确掌握元音音标的发音规则。
四、主题三:“辅音音标及其发音规则”
在本主题下,对辅音音标进行阐述,详细介绍英语辅音音标的发音规则,在注重语音规则的前提下,建议提供西语、法语等外语辅助学习。例如,对于一些辅音音标的发音,西班牙语和法语发音习惯较为接近,可以帮助学生更好地掌握发音规则。
五、主题四:“语音重读及节奏感训练”
在本主题下,对英语的重读和节奏进行讲解、如何准确地读出英语的各种节奏和韵律。这一主题的实践性较强,推荐采用反复朗读、口头模仿等实际练习方式。
六、结语
本课件将英语音标教学内容系统化、立体化,提供了学生学习英语音标及发音规则的简明易懂指南。同样,我们建议教师在教学中通过配套教材、练习册等教学资料帮助学生,更好的落实语音学习的效果,减少学生口语习得的难度,培养良好的英语口语表达能力。同时,我们呼吁学生们始终保持学习英语的热情,不断完善自己的语音水平,为提高英语学习付出不懈的努力和坚持不懈的付出。
英语音标课件 篇3
英语音标教学课件
随着全球化的不断深入,英语成为了全球通用的语言,因此学好英语变得越来越重要。而英语音标是英语学习的重要环节,也是建立语音基础的关键。本文将探讨英语音标教学课件的编写和应用,帮助学生更好地掌握英语音标知识。
一、英语音标的介绍
英语音标是一个标记英语语音的符号系统。它由40个音标字母组成,分为元音和辅音两类。英语音标可以帮助学生准确地发音,并且更容易理解和掌握英语语音系统,从而提高听说能力和语言交际能力。
在选择英语音标教学课件时,教师应该注重几个方面:
1、与学生的年龄和水平相适应
2、能够直观地呈现英语音标符号和发音规则
3、能够让学生通过互动练习与运用巩固所学知识
二、英语音标教学课件的设计
1、界面设计
课件的界面设计应该简洁、明了,色彩搭配以及字体选择要合理,以便吸引学生的注意力。界面要体现学科性和趣味性。
2、课件内容
(1)英语音标的基本介绍
应包括音标的定义、历史,各类英语音标的分类等。
(2)单个音标的学习
介绍音标符号及其发音,重点强调摸清发音位置和发音方式。
(3)音标的连读
介绍和讲解英语中的连读,如元音和辅音的连读,辅音和辅音的连读等。
(4)不同音标之间的区别
介绍各音标间的区别,包括元音和辅音,不同的音标读音时要注意的区别。
3、课后练习
课件中应包含一些与学过的内容有关的互动练习,通过练习可以帮助学生巩固所学知识,提高学生的理解和记忆能力。
三、英语音标教学应用
英语音标教学课件的应用可以帮助教师更好地将语音知识传递给学生,同时可以提高学生的学习兴趣,并且通过练习理解和掌握英语音标的正确发音方法。
在教学中,教师可以根据学生的实际水平,选取不同难度的教材和课件,并且在课堂中加入互动环节,让学生在学过的内容上进行联系,增加课堂的趣味性。同时可以引导学生实践英语音标和语音知识,如朗读练习、美式英语音准测试等。这些实践活动可以促进学生语音能力的发展,增强英语学习的信心和兴趣。
总之,英语音标教学课件的编写和应用是英语教育中的重要内容,可以帮助学生掌握和运用英语语音知识,同时也可以提高教学效果和学习效果。
英语音标课件 篇4
英语音标教学课件
一、前言
英语是一门国际性语言,在全球范围内被广泛使用。因此,学好英语已成为许多人的追求目标,而英语音标是英语学习中不可或缺的一部分。正确掌握英语音标的发音规律,不仅能提高口语水平,还能更好地理解和发音英语单词。本课件致力于帮助学生快速、准确且有趣地学习英语音标。
二、教学目标
1. 学习掌握英语音标的基本构成和发音规律;
2. 熟悉英语26个字母的音标发音规律,能正确拼读单词;
3. 能准确区分英语元音和辅音的音标,发音达到口语交流的要求。
三、教学内容
本课件主要分为三大部分:音标简介、音标分析和音标练习。
1. 音标简介
音标指的是声音的标志符号,包括元音和辅音两种。元音是指发音时声道通畅,没有过多的嘴唇、舌头和牙齿等阻碍,舌位和口位变化较小的音;辅音是指发音时发声器官有一定的阻碍或摩擦,舌位和口位有一定的变化的音。音标的发音规律是通过字母符号来表示语音的声音成分。
2. 音标分析
本部分是针对英语语音中的26个字母的音标发音规律进行分析,通过图文并茂的形式进行讲解。其中,元音和辅音分别进行了详细的解析,学生可通过动态图表对各个单词的单词元音和辅音进行练习。
3. 音标练习
在学习完音标分析后,本部分将提供包括单词发音、听音辨字、语音纠错等多个环节的音标练习。通过大量的练习,提高学生的英语口语水平,并且在练习中锻炼学生的语感和口形。
四、教学方法
本课件主要采用基于英语音标的视听互动教学,重点突出语音教学和口语训练,通过多种教学辅助手段实现丰富多彩的课堂体验。
1. 个性化听力训练。学生根据自己的听力难点,进行音标语音对比拼读训练,提高英语音频率,达到听力训练的目的。
2. 互动基础课。引导学生对英语音标的掌握,逐步提高他们的语感和口形,使学生能够流利、自然而准确地发音。
3. 视频讲解配合练习。利用教育视频配合学生石墨文档进行练习,对因学生理解或语言组织有障碍的音标或单词进行详细图文讲解,解决学生自身的困惑。
五、教学展望
音标是英语学习中重要的基础和核心内容,透彻掌握英语音标发音规律,不仅能提高英语口语水平,还能更好地理解和发音英语单词。本教材将在教学策略的独具特殊的互动跟踪方式下,促使学生在学习过程中获得信息并应用它们。这将能够更好地满足学生的个性化需求,也将会在教学过程中获得高效的反馈,从而提高学生的学习兴趣和学习效果。
英语音标课件 篇5
英语音标教学课件
随着英语的普及和使用的范围变得更加广泛,在现代社会中,作为一种全球通用语言,英语就像氧气一样存在着。因此,学习英语的重要性就凸显出来了。在英语学习中,英语音标就是一个非常重要的组成部分,因为它可以帮助我们准确地发音,无论是听力还是口语训练都离不开英语音标。
为了更加有效地教授英语音标,我们需要有一套专门的英语音标教学课件,这样才能使学员更加深入地学习,更加轻松地理解和掌握英语音标的知识。
本次英语音标教学的主题是“入门级英语音标教学课件”,在这门课程中,我们将以“音符,音形,音典”为主要参照点,让学员更好地了解英语音标的概念、发音规则,并能够较为准确地发出英语单词和短语的正确发音。
本课程主要包括以下三个方面的内容:
一、音符
对于初学者来说,最重要的是先学习英语音标的发音标记,因此在课件的第一部分,我们将详细介绍英语音标的30个发音标记,帮助学员逐步掌握这些音符的基本知识和发音规则。
二、音形
学了音符以后,就需要学习如何将这些音符组合成为单词和短语。在课件的第二部分,我们将通过多种形式,如图片、音频、视频等,让学员学习如何将音符进行组合,以识别和记住单词和短语的正确读音。同时,在练习单词和短语发音的过程中,我们也会针对常见的发音错误进行讲解和纠正。
三、音典
最后,在课件的第三部分,我们将介绍如何使用英语发音字典,并让学员亲自体验这个过程。我们会详细介绍英语发音字典的使用方法,让学员学会如何在字典中查找单词,了解单词的读音,并进行练习。通过这样的学习过程,学员可以更好地掌握英语发音和英语语言的应用。
通过以上三个方面的详细介绍和讲解,本课件不仅可以帮助学员建立起英语音标的概念,更加关注英语音标的实际应用,使学员能够从中获得更多更广泛的发音知识。通过本课件的学习,学员可以逐步掌握英语发音的技巧,不断提高自己的发音水平,帮他们更好地应对在英语学习和实际应用中遇到的挑战。同时,本课件也可以作为英语教学中的一个有力辅助工具,帮助老师更好地教授英语语音发音,提高课堂教学效果。
总之,英语音标教学课件是一种非常实用和有力的英语教学工具,不仅能够帮助学员掌握发音规则和技巧,还能够提高教学效果和教学质量。对于初学者来说,本课件的学习将是一个非常有价值和有效的过程,帮助他们更快地进入英语学习的世界,掌握更多更实用的英语知识。
英语音标课件 篇6
主题:如何有效教授英语音标
导语:英语音标是学习英语语音的基础,掌握好英语音标,有利于更好的发音和交流。对于英语教师来说,如何有效教授英语音标也是一个不可忽视的问题。本文将从以下几个方面来探讨如何有效教授英语音标。
一、对于不同级别的学生要采用不同的教学方法。
对于初学者,建议教师采用基础的发音教学方法,如:先教授元音和辅音发音,慢慢引导学生正确发音,渐进式地教授音标。对于进阶的学生,教师可以采用更高级的教学方法,如:介绍单词中的词缀和词根,通过词缀和词根认识一些不常见的发音规则,提高学生的语音熟练度。
二、使用趣味教具、多媒体辅助教学。
音标的教学应该尽量丰富多彩,应该利用多种教学方式来吸引学生的注意力,提高学生的学习兴趣和积极性,让学生在愉快的氛围中学习音标。比如:可以使用一些形象鲜明的教具,如卡片、表情包等。同时,也可以使用多媒体辅助教学,如幻灯片、视频等,来模拟真实的语音场景,让学生更好地理解和掌握音标。
三、注重语音训练,进行反复模仿练习。
学生掌握了音标的正确发音后,就需要进一步加强语音训练,进行反复模仿练习。因为语音训练是掌握英语音标的关键,只有经过反复练习,才能真正掌握好音标,减少发音错误。在具体教学中,教师可以通过一些语音训练和练习的游戏来帮助学生加强语音训练,如音标一笔画、语音练习地图等。
四、形成好的学习习惯,进行反馈和复习。
为了让学生更好地掌握英语音标,教师还需要帮助学生形成好的学习习惯,如每天进行一定量的语音训练、复习和巩固音标知识,定期进行自我检测和反馈。同时教师要重视反馈,了解学生的学习情况,并为学生提供帮助和指导。最后,要让学生知道学习英语音标是一个不断学习的过程,不要放弃,勇于尝试,相信自己一定能掌握好英语音标。
结语:英语音标教学不仅需要掌握好教学方法,还需要教师具有耐心和毅力,学生也要有积极性和持续学习的信心。希望本文能够为英语教师的音标教学提供一些思路和启示,让更多的学生能够受益。
英语音标课件 篇7
英语音标教学课件
近年来,随着全球化的进程加速和国际交流的日益密切,英语成为一种必备的国际语言。然而,英语的语音系统对很多母语非英语的人来说是一大难题,导致他们在日常交流和英语考试中常常出现语音误差。因此,英语音标教学显得尤为重要。本课件就是为了向大家介绍英语音标教学的相关内容,旨在帮助大家更好地掌握英语语音知识,提高英语口语和听力水平。
一、教学背景
英语会被更多人使用和接触,随之而来就是国际化的英语教育需求。而语音是英语学习的一个很重要的方面,它直接影响英语学习者的口语能力和理解能力,因此,掌握英语语音规律和音标知识对学习者来说非常必要。
二、教学目标
1.掌握基本的英语语音知识,包括发音规律、音位和音标等。
2.提高学习者的口语表达能力和听力水平,让他们可以更准确、自然地表达和理解英语。
三、教学内容
1.音位和音标
音位是指声音的最小单位,而音标则是用来记录或表示不同音位的符号。在英语语音中,有20个辅音音位和3个元音音位。此外,还有一些特殊符号,如重音、音调符号等。这些符号有助于学习者更好地掌握英语语音。
2.基本的发音规律
在英语语音中,不同音位之间有着很多不同的发音规律,如连读、重音、浊音变清音等。这些规律对于准确地掌握英语语音非常重要。
3.音标练习
为了帮助学习者更好地掌握英语音标,我们将提供大量的音标练习,并通过练习课堂互动的方式来检查学习者的掌握情况。
四、教学方法
1.针对不同的学习者,我们将采用不同的教学方法。对于初学者,我们将采取幻灯片教学、音频教学和示范教学等方式,帮助学习者了解音位和音标的基本知识,并进行基本的发音练习。对于较高水平的学习者,我们将采用案例分析、听力训练和口语表达练习等方式,更好地帮助他们掌握英语语音知识。
2.课堂互动是我们教学中非常重要的一环。在课堂上,我们将通过小组活动、听力测试和互动问答等方式来检查学习者的掌握情况,并提供详细的回馈和建议。
五、教学评估
在教学过程中,我们将不断进行教学评估。针对学习者的不同水平,我们将提供不同难度的练习题,并通过听力测试、口语表达练习和教学作业等方式来检查他们的掌握情况。同时,我们也将不断调整教学方法和内容,以确保教学效果最佳。
六、教学总结
通过本课件的学习,相信学习者可以更好地掌握英语语音知识,提高英语口语表达和听力水平。我们希望每一位学习者都能够认真学习和积极参与本课件的教学,实现自己的语言目标。
英语音标课件 篇8
英语音标教学课件
随着英语越来越普及,学习英语的人也越来越多。而对于大部分英语学习者而言,英语音标一直是一个难以逾越的坎儿。因此,我们的教学课件应该把重点放在如何帮助学生正确地理解和掌握英语音标。
首先,在课件中需要有一个简明易懂的介绍英语音标的部分,其中包括26个英文字母的音标,并对每个音标进行示范和解释,特别是一些容易混淆的音标,比如/i:/和/ɪ/,/ʌ/和/ə/等等。这些示范可以通过录音或者视频等多种形式展现。同时,对于那些刚接触英语音标的学生,我们可以提供一些音标和汉语拼音进行对照学习,帮助学生快速掌握音标的发音规律。
其次,在课件中应该分阶段、分难度地进行讲解。英语音标的初步了解是相对容易的,但掌握分类、使用则需要花费很多功夫。在课件的设计中,可以分为三个阶段:入门、进阶、高级。在入门阶段中,可以设计一些学生较为熟悉的单词,如“big”、“cat”等来讲解音标的发音,重点在模仿和跟着样板读,以更好地巩固音标的发音。在进阶阶段中,可以引导学生进行一些练习,比如体操性质的发音练习或者一些词汇的朗读练习,以帮助学生掌握音标发音的基本技巧。在高级阶段中,可以加入一些语音特点和习惯用法等内容,让学生更好地了解并运用英语音标。
最后,在课件的设计上,应该融入趣味性的元素。学习应该是一种享受,而非枯燥的任务。设计一些有趣的练习、测验等,比如“音标趣味拼图”、“错音谜语”等,以帮助学生提高英语音标的学习兴趣。此外,我们还可以通过录制一些有声有色的音标故事、打趣、笑话等,来吸引学生的眼球和注意力。
总之,英语音标教学课件的设计需要注重基础知识的讲解,分阶段、分难度地教授,以及趣味性的因素。只有同时满足这些要点,才能让学生更好地掌握英语音标的发音规律。
英语学习课件十五篇
我们在上学时也会去读一些范文,这些优秀的范文能我们学到很多的东西,通过阅读范文我们可以学会如何去记录重要的事情。对于一些人来说,多看一些范文能增进知识,写优秀范文需要包括呢些方面呢?下面是小编帮大家编辑的《英语学习课件十五篇》,供大家参考,希望能帮助到有需要的朋友。
英语学习课件 篇1
活动目标:
1、初步学习歌曲《Ten Little Indian Children》,能大声地用英语来演唱。
2、复习双语单词one——ten,会与数字1——10相对应。
3、通过音乐游戏复习第5—7册英语句子提高幼儿学习双语的兴趣。
4、培养幼儿感受音乐,热爱大自然的美好情感。
教学重难点:
1、认识单词one—ten,会与数字1—10相对应。
2、学习新的乐曲《Ten Little Indian Children》,初步掌握歌词与旋律。
活动准备:
1、印有英语单词one——ten的车票两套。
2、情景布置图及汽车座位上粘上数字1——10两排。
3、画有印第安小朋友的图片若干。
5、幼儿人手一个小背包,包内放有英语句子纸条两份。
6、幼儿水笔人手一份,教师事先在十个小指上画有简单的脸谱。
up2; 以旅游售票的游戏导入,复习数字1—10的英语单词。(播放背景音乐)
T:小朋友,今天天气真好,让我带你们去旅游吧!Let’s go!
T:瞧,孩子们!车站到了,请你们去售票员阿姨那买票,然后根据你的车票上车找相应的座位号,赶快行动吧!
T:小朋友都找到座位了。OK!我现在要来核对一下你的车票是否和你所坐的座位号相符合,请你用响亮的声音从1—10的顺序报出你的车票号码。Do you understand?OK! You pleas!
(幼儿用响亮的声音报出车票号码,教师根据幼儿所报号码进行核对,并纠正个别幼儿的发音。)
T:OK! Very good. 经过核对,你们的车票与座位号都相吻合。请小朋友保管好你们的票,把它放在口袋里,放好了吗?车要开了。(播放音乐,做简单律动。)
二、基础部分:
up2; 引导幼儿认识、理解歌词,初步熟悉歌曲旋律。
1、以游戏性的方式引出主题。
T:小朋友快看,我们到印第安了。瞧,那边还有许多Indian Children 在迎接我们呢。快打个招呼吧!Hello, Indian Children.
2、初步熟悉歌词。
T:小朋友们我们下车了。让我们来数一数这里有几个Indian Children.
T:OK!Ten Indian Children. 现在请你们来看一下我拍的照片,好吗?(边出示图片边请幼儿说出照片上有几个小孩)
非常棒,Indian Children都在夸你们呢,老师告诉你们‘一个小孩’是用英语one little来表示的,跟老师说……
T:老师知道你们的英语学得非常棒,请你们把旁边的中英文短句贴放在相应的照片下。(将幼儿分为两组进行匹配)
英语学习课件 篇2
目标:
1、过活动,教幼儿认识汉字“手”和“脚”,了解其字型结构,学习用“手”和“脚”两字组词。
2、学习hand和foot的正确发音,理解其中文含义。
3、教育幼儿爱护自己的手和脚。
准备:
录音机、磁带、电视机、影碟机,“手”“脚”图片及汉字,英文hand和foot,幼儿人手一套身体躯干卡片。
过程:
一、学生共唱英文之歌《a、b、c》入教室。
二、游戏“听指令做动作”。
三、游戏“听一听,猜一猜”。幼儿猜猜这是身体哪部分发出的声音。
四、出示“手”“脚”图片,提问:
(1)小朋友的手和脚会做些什么?
(2)幼儿自由发言
(3)小结:手和脚的用处大,我们一定要爱护自己的手和脚,注意保持它们的清洁。
五、认识汉字“手”和“脚”
(1)看一看,汉字“手”和“脚”在字形结构上有什么不一样?
(2)“手”字组词。
(3)幼儿跟教师认读手。
(4)“脚”字组词。
(5)幼儿跟教师认读脚。
六、学习hand和foot的正确发音。
(1)老师认读出手的英文名字hand,幼儿想想和谁的英文发音有点相同。
(2)分“hand”和“head”。
(3)学习foot的正确发音。
七、集体游戏:“捉迷藏”。
八、个别游戏“1,2,3,4,5,6,7”。
九、 游戏“拼图”
根据老师的指令拼出小男孩的手,脚,头。
十集体舞蹈“幸福拍手歌”
幼儿变跳边随教师出教室。
英语学习课件 篇3
大班英语(学习单词)
(一)活动目标:
学习正确读准、认识单词daddy、mommy、grandpa、grandma,并了解其含义。
(二)活动准备:
flash card:daddy、mommy。
(三)活动过程:
1. say hello(打招呼):
师:今天我们班上来了好多客人,小朋友们应该和客人说什么呀?(教师做hello动作提醒幼儿)
师:我们一起唱一首好听的英文歌送给大家好吗?
师幼共唱《hello song》。
2. warm up(热身运动):
肢体动作:stand up, sit down, run, jump, turn around……
3. teaching(教学):
①师:do you want to know what’s behind me?你想知道谁在我后面吗?(想)可是啊,它要求小朋友数到3才肯出来呢!我们一起来好吗?show me your hands. one, two, three. 咦,它还是不肯出来,we try to again.我们再来一次。(师互动幼儿举出手指数one, two, three)
②(出示flash card:daddy)who is he?他是谁呢?(幼儿说说)he is my daddy!他是我的爸爸。(幼儿学念:daddy)
(出示flash card:mommy)who is she?她是谁呢?(幼儿说说)she is my mommy.她是我的妈妈。(幼儿学念:mommy)
我们来和daddy, mommy打个招呼吧。say: hello, daddy! hello mommy!
③ ki ing game:依次请幼儿说:hello daddy/mommy.
4. jumping game:
①以唱歌《where’s my daddy/mommy?》的形式请两位幼儿分别扮作daddy 和mommy。
②教师说明游戏规则。
③教师指挥游戏:教师随机喊daddy或mommy,两名幼儿尝试游戏。
④教师互动其他幼儿喊daddy或mommy,参与游戏幼儿进行jumping game.
5. say good bye(说再见)。
英语学习课件 篇4
幼儿园小班英语教案:学习字母RST
学习字母RST单词raittartea
rstraitstartea
活动目标:
1、通过游戏活动,引导幼儿的学习字母rst的正确读音,初步了解单词raitstartea的含义,发音基本准确。
2、鼓励幼儿大胆表演歌曲whatwouldyoulike
3、培养幼儿对英语活动的兴趣。
活动准备:
rst字母卡,raitstartea的图片cd。
活动过程:
一、问候
t:goodmorning,everybody
二、新授
1、出示字母图片让幼儿猜
t:look,whatisit
2、幼儿猜出或猜不出后,就完整出示卡片,并教会幼儿正确读音。
t:ok,itsr
游戏:将字母卡rst依序贴在白板上,老师带读数次,再调换字母卡的顺序观察幼儿是否能认识正确的字母。
3、教会正确读音后可以配合动作加深幼儿记忆
ok,letsdotogether
(如此类推,教授rst)
4、情景表演(老师带兔子、星星的图片出现)
t:o,whoiscoming
t:o,lookat冯老师,whatsinhishands
5、游戏iamhome(听音乐随便叫某个幼儿的名字,由吴老师做暗号,听到暗号后停下来做动作rr(发音)rait)如此类推
t:ok,nowletsplaytogether
(时间长就直接到goodbyesony)
三、复习歌曲whatwouldyoulike
ok,nowlistentotheradio
四、goodbyesony
英语学习课件 篇5
①学会观察生活和搜集资料,培养口语交际的能力。
②把自己想说的话写下来,做到语句通顺。
③自主发现词语的构词特点,通过观察图画与词语,初步了解十二生肖这一传统文化。
④运用熟字加偏旁的方法,认识“搞、稿、编”等9个字。
⑤能主动参与展示活动,乐于展示自己的学习收获和才能,并善于与别人交流。
课件或投影(“日积月累”中的词语),十二生肖邮票挂图。
内容:
同学们将近期了解到的祖国传统文化以新闻发布的形式向大家作个汇报。
规则:
a.按小组选一名“新闻发言人”,“发言人”先要全面了解小组内各位同学搜集到的不同的传统文化,再加以归纳向大家作具体介绍。
b.“新闻发言人”在介绍的过程中要接受班内“记者”们的提问。
奖励办法:
凡是让大家有耳目一新之感的发言均可奖励一把“闪光的金钥匙”。
①组内交流,让全组同学充分了解各自搜集的资料。
①各小组依次进行介绍“发言人”介绍的时候,本组的同学可以补充,其他小组的同学可以提问。
②所有同学根据发言情况对各小组的表现进行评估。
选择自己最感兴趣的一种传统文化讲给家里的人听。
英语学习课件 篇6
一、 目标:
1. 通过玩玩、找找、发现自己身体能动的部位,对自己的身体感兴趣。
2. 愿意和老师一起说说自己的体验和感受。
二、 重点与难点:
1. 重点:发现自己身体能动的部位。
2. 难点:对自己的身体感兴趣。
三、 材料与环境创设:
幼儿人手一份活动器具,教师用的一张放大的纸宝宝。
四、 活动流程:
尝试发现 找身体会动的部位及相关英语单词 游戏活 动 延伸活动
1. 尝试发现
1) 今天,老师在活动室里放了好多的活动器具,请孩子们看看都有些什么呀?请每个孩子拿一样你喜欢的器具玩,玩的时候你要仔细地看看,你身体的什么地方动了?
2) 提问:你玩了什么你身体的什么地方动了?
2. 找身体会动的部位
1) 我发现你们的手和脚会动,其实身体上还有许多地方也在动。老师为你们准备了一位纸宝宝,并教相对应的英语单词 2) 请你们把身体上会动的地方用英语告诉大家吧
孩子们讲出会动的部位老师在放大的纸宝宝上记录并相应让孩子们动动该部位。
3. 游戏:动一动
1) 纸宝宝要和你们来玩一个动一动的游戏。
2) 老师点到纸宝宝什么部位,你就说出对应英语单词并动什么部位。 3) 今天,你们发现人身上许多部位都会动,就是因为这些部位会动,我们人的身体就很灵活,样样事情都会做。
4. 延伸活动:
身体外面可以动,那么身体里面部位会动吗?请孩子们去教爸爸妈妈或者看看书,用你们的心、眼睛慢慢地去发现,看谁发现的小秘密多,把你们的发现记下来。
英语学习课件 篇7
使学生理解百分数的意义;能够正确的读写百分数、运用百分数解决简单的实际问题。
问题解决与数学思考 使学生经历收集、分析、处理信息的过程,培养学生分析、比较、抽象、概括的能力和与人交流合作的能力。
使学生感受百分数在实际生活中的广泛应用,同时结合相关信息对学生进行思想教育。
重点 百分数的意义和写法。
师:同学们,课前教师让大家收集生活中的百分数,收集到了吗?在哪儿收集的?容易找吗?这说明了什么?
既然百分数这么有用,这节课我们就来学习百分数好吗?你想学习有关百分数的哪些知识?
你认为哪杯糖水更甜?
学生争论后得出不好判断的结论。
老师给出三杯糖水中糖的含量:7克、13克、9克。问:这下能判断吗?还需要什么条件?
再给出糖水的重量:20克、50克、25克。问:这下能判断吗?看什么?
根据学生的回答板书:
师:百分数表示的是两个数量之间的倍数关系,是一个分率,后面不能带单位名称,所以百分数又叫百分率或百分比。(板书)
2、百分数的写法:
师:百分数通常不写成分数形式,而在原来的分子后面加上百分号“%”来表示。(板书)师示范写35%。
请一位学生板演26%、36%,其他学生在本上写。
①两个小圆圈要写的小一点。②斜线的倾斜程度。
3、由刚才的不好判断,到现在的一目了然,是谁帮了我们的忙?大家在课前已经收集了许多生活中的百分数,你现在能说说这些百分数的具体含义吗?好,下面我们就来交流一下:四人小组交流,说说你收集的百分数,表示什么意思?
(全班交流)谁愿意向大家展示你收集的百分数?说说它的意义。
4、老师也收集了一些百分数,想不想看?
(1)我国的耕地面积占世界耕地面积的7%;
(2)我国人口占世界人口的22%;
(3)在北京奥运会上,我国体育健儿共获得51枚金牌,占金牌总数的16.9%;
(4)我国发射人造卫星的成功率是100%。
这些百分数都表示什么意义,你知道吗?
看了这些信息,你想说什么?
2、学生汇报:
学生可能回答: ①分子 ②分母 ③读法 ④意义等的不同。
课件出示:
下面哪个分数可以用百分数来表示?哪个不能?说说为什么?
一堆煤 吨,运走了它的 。
百分数是分数吗?分母是100的分数是百分数吗?
得出结论:分数即可以表示两个数之间的倍数关系,也可以表示一个具体的数量,百分数只能表示两个数之间的倍数关系。百分数是特殊的分数。
拓展应用 1、百分数在我们的生活中无处不在,成语里也有百分数。
总 结 1、这节课你对自己的表现满意吗?用一个百分数表示你的满意程度。
2、对教师满意吗?也用一个百分数表示。
3、最后,教师送给同学们一句名言,与大家共勉。
英语学习课件 篇8
活动目标:
1、通过利用各种游戏活动让幼儿反复听、说、读、练,在游戏活动中学习并掌握英语字母:“V”、英语单词:“Van”的正确发音及译义,理解短语:“playagame.”的实际译义
2、激发幼儿用英语进行对话的欲望
活动准备:
准备手偶DooDoo、CoCo等手偶,卡片、V字母卡各一张、录音机及《阳光幼儿英语》音乐磁带
活动过程
1、活动开始,师幼例行问候,引起幼儿英语活动的兴趣,使幼儿由安静状态转入活动状态。
T:“Goodmorningchildren!”
C:“Goodmorningmelody!”
2、复习、检查上节课所学内容,奖励有进步的幼儿,并介绍本节课将要学习内容的重点
3、教授新字母及新单词:“V”“Van”
(1)教师利用字母娃娃来做客的游戏教授字母“V”的正确发音
(2)教师利用DooDoo手偶要去逛动物园需要汽车来引出英语单词Van,并教授其的正确发音及译义,通过让幼儿进行反复练习及强化,逐渐掌握单词lion的正确发音及译义.
(3)利用模仿游戏:《看谁说得快又对》巩固练习
4、律动教学,教授幼儿短语“playagame.”的实际译义。
5、教师小结,叮嘱幼儿:“回家要看VCD,回家要听录音机,回家要当Melody!”
英语学习课件 篇9
通过本次学习,我对核心素养有了新的认识和体会。学校和教师的三大核心任务:价值引领、思维启迪、品格塑造。素养是教化、体验的结果,素养靠训练和实践而习得,涉及能力和品格。
传统课程目标的3个维度是,知识与能力、过程与方法、情感态度价值观。然而,许多学校更关注对学生“知识与能力”和“过程与方法”的培养,“情感态度价值观”最容易被忽视。但是,从人的成长与发展来看,学校应注重学生的价值判断和价值选择。因此,基于学生发展核心素养培养的课程目标,是对人的成长在课程设计与实施目标方面“三位一体”的回归。究竟什么是学生发展核心素养?我认为,是能成全生命、成就生命、促进生命成长发展,并且可持续能深化的素养,如有责任能担当、有判断会选择、有理解会反思……学生发展核心素养是学科核心素养的上位概念,是指导学科一切教学活动的按钮,也是转化为学生基本素质的关键所在。学生发展核心素养是一切教育活动使“人成为人”、使人的素养成为“人的素质”的关键“酵母”。我们关注学科核心素养,就是要通过教学活动有效地将其转化为学生的基本素质。
随着时代的发展,教育改革的更新,《新课程》的深入学习,“自主、探究、合作”学习成为学生学习方式的主要特征,这就要求教育上学生由被动接受知识向主动探索知识。由学会知识向学会学习、学会合作、学会生存转变,使其适应社会发展的需要。所以,教师必须注重学生学习方法的研究,培养学生自主学习的能力,使学生素质得到全面主动的发展,使学生真正成为学习的主人。因此,教学中应注重学生自主学习能力的培养。我们小学课堂上主要要提升的学生的语言能力和合作能力。
语言能力的培养需要老师们对语言进行建构与运用,这就需要我们教师根据教材进行单元统整与内容整合。单元单元统整与内容整合就是围绕核心,设计任务;围绕目标,逐步递进;围绕话题,整合内容。在不同主题的语言教学中逐步引导、延伸,使学生的思维被不断激发,语言的输出得到更大强度的锻炼。学生在潜移默化中,学生接触并学习到了学科教学中所提倡的中文美德,也由此体现了学科素养的价值型态,培养了学生的价值观。
合作能力则需要在教学的各个环节进行渗透和运用。如在练习和展示环节,就需要孩子们小组或俩俩合作公共完成,在合作过程中他们可以交换思想和语言知识,可以共同努力完成任务,从而可以体会到团结的力量和1+1>2的知识蓬勃迸发的力量,更能从别人那里获取自己所缺乏的知识和能力,进而更好的提升自己。
小学英语新版教材中蕴含着知识性、思想性、教育性很强的内容,我们要善于发掘这些素材,挖掘教材的思想内涵,结合学生实际,采用灵活多样的方法对学生进行思维品质的培养,让他们的思维具有独创性与批判性。如我们在英语中经常教授孩子要学会对帮助你的人表达谢意,那么表达谢意的情况有哪些?如何适度的表达我们的感情?我们亲人和好朋友之间要不要及时表达我们的谢意?再生活中诸多感情的适度表达形式有哪些?我们要如何去做或把握?等等,这些思想教育的渗透就是对孩子情感目标的培养,是培养一个国际通用人的必备之路。同时通过我们的交流、分享,孩子的独创性思维也得到了很好的培养。在比如,在具体描述一个人生气的状态时,老师可以首先提问学生平常生气时会怎么做,然后讲做这些事可能会出现的后果,可能会对你自己、他人及社会造成什么样的影响,这就会培养学生的批判性思维能力。然后,教师可以引导学生思考应该怎样发泄情绪,学生可能会想到去倾诉、跑步、踢球等健康的解决方式,这样学生内心世界的东西、生活的东西、品格的东西,行为的东西全都融合到了语言教学的课堂中,这才是真正素养的培养。
学生核心素养的培养需要我们所有一线老师长期、坚持的努力和引导,我们在前进的路上一往无前!
英语学习课件 篇10
主题背景下的英语活动:学习用品
要求:
1、通过情景游戏“Shopping ”、“School”复习一些学习用品单词:pencil、ruler、rubber、sharpener等;
2、听懂并理解老师的一些简单英语指令,乐于模仿;
3、通过情景模拟激发幼儿上小学的愿望;
准备:
1、铅笔盒、书包人手一份;铅笔、卷笔刀、尺若干;
2、情景设置:文具超市、小学
过程:
一 Warm Up:
* Dialogue:Hi,how are you today?(Fine,Happy)
How many days are there in a week?
What day is today?
二 情景游戏“Shopping”
1、复习单个单词
*(出示书包)Oh,nothing!What shall I prepare?(pencil……)
*Look,there is a stationary super-market!Who wants to be the shopman?(师与幼儿示范,提示幼儿递东西时要说出单词)
*OK,now let`s play。(请二名幼儿做shopman)
2、在单词前加修饰词,师辅助提示“What shape is it?”,“What color is it?”
What did you buy?
二 情景游戏“School”
1、Song:“Go to school”
Let’s go to school, OK? (引发幼儿进入游戏情景)
2、模拟小学生上课:打铃上课,起立—坐下
(1) Listening game:
Please put your bag on the chair。
Please open/close your pencil-box 。
Please take out/put in your pencil-box。/pencil、rubber、ruler、sharpener
Who wants to be the little teacher?
(2)尝试用“because…”回答问题
What do you like?Why?
(3)Class is over。Stand up ,good-bye everyone!
三 结束:Song:“Butterfly”飞回教室。
英语学习课件 篇11
一、教学目标:
1)学习理解运用句型:Is it a ….?
Yes , it is . / No , it isn’t .
2)复习运用单词:cucumbercarrottomatopotatoeggplantpumkin
3)听懂并理解老师的一些简单英语指令,乐于模仿。
4)通过游戏激发幼儿学习英语的兴趣,培养其学习英语的积极态度。
二、教学准备:cucumbercarrottomatopotatoeggplantpumkin 食物各一个及红领巾一条。
三、教学过程:
一)Greeting ---------sing a song 《Twickltwickllittlestar 》
二) review vegetable words :
T : What’s this ?
S :It is a cuaumber
T What’s this ?
S :It is a tomato
T : What’s this ?
S :It is a potato
T : What’s this ?
S :It is a carrot
T : What’s this ?
S :It is apumkin
T : What’s this ?
S :It is an eggplant
三)learn sentences:Is it a …? Yes , it is . / No , it isn’t .
T :Is it a cucumber ?
T and s : Yes , it is .
T :Is it a carrot ?
S : Yes , it is .
T :Is it atomato?
S : Yes , it is .
T :Is it a potato ?
S : Yes , it is .
T :Is it pumkin?
S : Yes , it is .
T :Is it a carrot ?
S : No, it isn’t .
T :Is it a pumkin?
S : No, it isn’t .
T :Is it a tomato ?
S : No, it isn’t .
T :Is it a potato?
S : No, it isn’t .
四 在游戏中学习运用句型
游戏1:分组比赛“cat and dong ”game .(规则:由老师提问句型:Is it a ….? 由孩子进行回答; Yes , it is . / No , it isn’t .
游戏2:猜谜游戏(上台来的小朋友将红领巾蒙住眼睛,通过触摸食物,回答句型:Yes , it is . / No , it isn’t .由下面的小朋友提问句型:Is it a ….?
五 Sing a song 《Goodbye song 》结束本次活动。
教学反思:
本次活动主要是学习运用句型:“Is it a ….? Yes , it is . / No , it isn’t .? ”:首先,出示蔬菜的实物让幼儿直接理解掌握相关的单词,通过触摸实物的方式,为幼儿学习运用句型做好铺垫。在学习句型环节,通过两个游戏,让孩子们在“玩中学,学中玩 ”;
游戏一、分组比赛,“Cat and dog ”,由老师提问题“Is it a …?”孩子们运用句型“ Yes , it is . / No , it isn’t .进行回答,接着老师跟孩子再互换角色;
游戏二、用红领巾蒙住眼睛,通过触摸实物,运用句型“Is it a ….?”;孩子们对“猜谜”游戏兴趣很高,个个都争先恐后的举手要求参与,但毕竟课堂的时间有限,所以老师这一次只能请到少部分的孩子上台来参与游戏,没能请到的孩子,可以在自由活动时间到“英语角”天地,继续玩此游戏。
看着孩子们那份意犹未尽表情,我知道今天的课孩子们学的是非常的开心,老师我也就更开心了,因为老师的辛苦付出没有白费,孩子有进步,就是我最大的愿望。
英语学习课件 篇12
教学目标:
1.学生自主学习生字,自主正音,积累叠词。使学生充分认识时间一去不复返的特点,激发爱惜时间的情感。
2.落实学生正确、流利地朗读课文。
3.引导学生从课题想开去,整体把握全文内容,初步理解文中含义深刻的句子,写好感悟,为第二课时的深入学习做好准备。
教学重点: 读通、读顺课文,初步理解含义深刻的句子。
教学准备: 搜集有关时间的名言警句,阅读朱自清的资料。
2.交流有关时间的名言警句,说说自己的感受。
1.90多年前,有一位年轻的作家也和你们有着一样的感怀,于是他写了一篇文章,题目是“匆匆”。
2.教师板书课题,强调“匆”与“勿”的字形区别。
4.冬去春来,季节是匆匆的;踏上行程,脚步是匆匆的;斗转星移,岁月是匆匆的。那这篇《匆匆》是哪位作家所写呢?
5.出示朱自清的资料,用一分钟记忆。
1.导入:朱自清匆匆的一生只走过短暂的50年,现在就让我们走进他的这篇《匆匆》。
2.明确初读要求:读准字音,读通句子,读不好的地方反复读一读,全文只读一遍。
4.哪些句子需要找出来大家读?
A.2段中的句子,理解“头涔涔、泪潸潸”,什么叫“不禁头涔涔而泪潸潸”——理解后朗读句子。
B.3段中的句子,理解“挪移”,谁在挪移?书写“挪”字。
C.4段中的句子,理解“蒸融”,什么被蒸融呢?书写“蒸”,强调注意的笔画。
2.有谁知道本文的体裁是什么?介绍散文的突出特点——形散而神不散。
3.写于90年前的这篇散文,六年级的你们谁有好方法能读懂它?学生推荐学习方法。
4.教师小结:品味情感,领悟道理,并且板书“品情、悟理”。
1.教师推荐“品读助手”
①找出描写时间匆匆流逝的词、句,仔细读一读。
②从这些词句中你品味出了什么?在书上批注。
③把你的感受与同学们交流、分享,用朗读展示。
2.指名读,教师补充:品味的内容可以是作者的情感,悟出的道理,也可以是你发现的文章的表达方法、写作方法、修辞手法,可以把你的感受批注在书上,也可以凝练成词语、短语写在黑板上。
3.学生自学标画。
4.看板书小结。
五、作业:
1.书写生字、新词,把你优美的朗读让家人或同学欣赏。
2.背会一句有关时间的名言警句,作为你的座右铭。
英语学习课件 篇13
教材分析:
本文以简炼的语言,形象地描绘了一幅夏日雷雨图。全文按雷雨前、雷雨中、雷雨后的顺序,清晰地展开描写。三部分特征鲜明,写景细致逼真,引人入胜。激发了学生对大自然的深刻体验,培养学生观察生活,热爱自然的热情。
设计理念:
雷雨对于学生来说并不陌生,他们都有着一定的生活体验。因此,在教学时,从学生的生活入手、从他们的已有经验入手,激发他们学习的兴趣。在学习雷雨前的段落时,先让学生充分地接触文本,在读的基础上谈感受,学生的感受会更多。整堂课力求引导学生在体验、观察、阅读中感悟课文的内容,激发学生观察生活的兴趣,热爱自然的热情。
学情介绍:
对二年级的学生来说雷雨并不陌生,但学生对感受雷雨前、雷雨中、雷雨后的景象不够深,需要老师指导观察体会。从二年级学生的心理特点和学习特点出发,结合教材的内容,我觉得教学的重点是让学生通过各种形式的朗读来体会雷雨前和雷雨后的不同景象。教学的难点在感悟雷雨前后景物的变化。
教学目标:
1、会认“压、乱、垂、虹”4个生字。
2、默读课文,能边读边想像。有感情地朗读课文,通过声音表现雷雨前的景象。
3、有留心观察天气的兴趣。
教学难点:让学生联系生活实际,感知并有感情地朗读雷雨前、雷雨中和雷雨后的描写。
有位老兄脾气大, 爱发怒的就数他,
发起怒来大声吼, 伴着成串的泪珠下。
2、今天我们一起学习18课雷雨。板书课题,齐读。
(一)一读:请打开书第80页,听课文录音朗读,把容易读错的字词做上记号。
(二) 二读:用自己喜欢的方式读课文。读准字音,读通句子。在每个自然段前标上序号。
师:刚才小朋友们都读得非常认真,谁来当当小老师带着大家读一读这四个生字。
小老师带读(提示垂是翘舌音)――同桌检查读(请同桌互相检查着读一读,比比谁读得好)
师:现在,让这些生字宝宝去掉拼音帽,你还能认识吗?(课件出示去掉拼音的生字,学生开火车读)
师:生字宝宝想妈妈了,请你把它们送回家吧。在课文中画出带有生字的句子读一读。
师:找出来了吗?老师也找出来了,同学们来读一读吧。(出示句子的幻灯片)
1.满天的乌云,黑沉沉地压下来。
2.忽然一阵大风,吹得树枝乱摆。
3.一只蜘蛛从网上垂下来,逃走了。
4.一条彩虹挂在天空。
(三)三读,检查了解朗读情况。
(1)、默读课文,边读边想课文哪几个自然段写雷雨前的景象,哪几个自然段写雷雨中的景象,哪几个自然段写雷雨后的景象?
(2)、交流。
三、研读课文,感悟雷雨前、雷雨中、雷雨后的景象。
现在就让我们走近这场雷雨,感受大自然的神奇吧!
(一)雷雨在来临前总会发出一些特殊的信号,告诉大家雷雨马上就要来了。读读课文的1、2、3自然段,用铅笔画出作者在这三段里写了什么?
师:(出示图乌云图)(1)“满天的乌云,黑沉沉地压下来。树上的叶子一动不动,蝉一声也不叫。”
1、指名读:
3、师:“压”字是什么意思?(逼近)能用你的动作来表示吗?
4、师:当黑沉沉的乌云越来越多,越来越厚,越来越重,不断地向我们逼近,你感觉怎么样?
5、师:这时候,连爱动的树叶,爱唱歌的蝉都和大家一样。不动也不叫。
(2)“忽然一阵大风,吹得树枝乱摆。一只蜘蛛从网上垂下来,逃走了”
过度:我们再来读读第三自然段,看看雷雨前还有什么现象?
2、角色扮演,体会“乱摆”:
师:如果你就是这大风中的小树,你会怎样?同学们,怎样是“乱摆”?你们能做出乱摆的动作吗?(看来这阵风真的很大啊!)
“一只蜘蛛从网上垂下来,逃走了。”大风真的刮过来了。这可吓坏了……小蜘蛛。
这只正在悠闲织网的蜘蛛他的表现是……
师:你觉得哪个字用的好,为什么?(“垂”字用的好,形象写出了蜘蛛随着蜘蛛网往下落的情景,让人感觉到风特别大,连蜘蛛都害怕)
(3)“闪电越来越亮,雷声越来越响。”
师: 谁能学着课文里的样子用“越来越”造句子。
师:雷雨前的空气真闷呀!(板:闷)一场大雨就要下来了,让我们一起把这种感觉读出来吧。
(二)感受4-6雷雨中的情景。
师:雨下得真大。谁想读读第四自然段。让大家好像看到了这么大的雨?
(4)“哗,哗,哗,雨下起来了。”
师:告诉大家一个秘密,只要读好三个字,就能读好这句话。(点出“哗,哗,哗”)还可以怎么读?(哗,哗,哗)说明什么?(雨大、还很急)谁再来读。
(5)“雨越下越大。往窗外望去,树哇,房子啊,都看不清了。”
师:(引读)是啊!雨越下越大。(看到什么了?)树哇,房子啊,都看不清了。
看着窗外雨在哗哗地下着。我也想跟你们一起读一读这第五自然段。
(6)“渐渐地,渐渐地,雷声小了,雨声也小了。”
师:再看,渐渐地,渐渐地,雷声小了,雨声也小了。
师:雷声雨声是一下子变小的吗?(生:不是的,是慢慢地)哪个词告诉我们了。(渐渐地就是慢慢地意思)
师:1.雨很快就停了,雷雨后的景色是什么样的呢?你们赶快看课文,默读7 8自然段雷雨后的景象。
师:现在我们一起来看看雷雨后的情景吧。(课件出播放雷雨后的情景)看了这段画面,这时你最想说什么?
师:是啊,我们仿佛感觉到了雨后的清新、美丽。你能把这两段美美地读出来吗?(指名读,齐读,试背)
小结:雨过天晴,呼吸着清新的空气,欣赏着美丽的彩虹,耳边传来声声蛙鸣,这是一幅多么美丽的图画呀。(板书:美)
齐读课文:
请同学们用不同的语调分别读好这个三个部分,用心感悟雷雨前后的不同景象。
今天这节课我们欣赏了雷雨前、中、后的不同景象,感受到了它们不同的特点,多神奇的大自然呀,小朋友们,只要你们细心观察,一定还会发现更美丽、更神奇的景象。把观察到的记录下来,写成观察日记吧。
板书设计:
前 1-3 乌云、叶子、蝉、
18、雷雨 大风、树枝、蜘蛛、
英语学习课件 篇14
1、能在游戏活动中大胆表现自我并初步使用基本礼貌用语进行对话;
2. 能在玩中学会新授知识并根据示范领会教师意图;
T(教师): Hello! Good morning,boys and girls.
2.根据幼儿做出的反应继续引导:
3.跟我做律动《hello, hello, how are you》
1、引导幼儿学习小鸟 bird,猫 cat, 小兔子rabbit
此环节教师拿一袋子,里面装有图片,请幼儿来摸,并告诉大家,自己拿出的是什么图片。
神秘的包,会给幼儿带来很强的好奇感,目的能激发幼儿活动的兴趣。引出三种动物bird、dog、rabbit.
T(教师): 今天还有三位小朋友来到我们班做客呢,看看他们是谁呢?逐一引出三种动物bird、dog、rabbit.(新授过程中注意引导幼儿发音)
4.出示三张图片,引导幼儿观察,猜猜他们的家在哪里?
T(教师): 孩子们,小动物要回家了,我们把它们送回家吧,NOW READ AFTER ME. BYE BYE ,bird/ cat /rabbit
K(孩子):BYE BYE ,bird/ cat /rabbit
孩子们,小动物回家了,我们也得回家了,我们一起说:bye-bye。
幼儿在教师引导下搭上火车有序的离开教室。
英语学习课件 篇15
教学目标:
1、启发并勉励孩子在体会不一样类型Music的前提上勇敢地显现出自个儿觉得的善与恶的形象。
3、启发孩子体会英文教学带来的快乐。
教学预备:
展示小兔子的头部装饰,Whoisit?今日我们便来做rabbit做游戏,(孩子与幼儿教师一块儿带头部装饰)
Whoareyou?
Wearerabbits。(Music……):今日我们又要来做游戏啦,Areyouhappy?
(It’scarrot……gogogo——carrotcarroteateateat。
It’sgrass……gogogo——grassgrasseateateat。
That’smushroom……——mushroommushroomeateateat
(凝重地Music……)guessguess,Whowillcoming?
Look,Whoiscoming?
It’saWOLF。
改正孩子对新单词的发音。
Wolf长得怎样?是怎样走路的?
孩子跟着Music学wolf。Wolfwolf大灰狼……
(愉悦地Music……)rabbitrabbitjumpjumpjump。……
(凝重地Music……)Whoiscoming?Wolf,wolfiscoming。……Rabbit,wearegohome!……Wolf
小学英语课件集合
在开课前,教师必须准备好教案课件,通常,老师都会尽心尽责地亲自设计。学生的反应则可以协助教师恰当地掌握教学节奏。今天,栏目小编为大家梳理了一些关于"小学英语课件"的相关信息,别忘了收藏我们的网站,随时获取我们的最新动态和消息!
小学英语课件 篇1
学情分析
学生年龄都在九到十岁左右,生性活泼好动,想象能力丰富,对游戏竞赛.唱歌都非常感兴趣。学生学习英语半年多了,大家都能说简单的日常交际用语。如何让他们学习英语有信心,感兴趣是我们教学的重点。课堂以跨越式模式为主,注重培养学生的英语学习兴趣,鼓励他们大胆说,努力听。
教材分析:在上册书Unit2中我们已经学过句型:Where is...?在巩固此句型的基础上,学习一些新词和短语。
教学内容:Part A Let's talk
教学目标:
1、知识目标
The pupils can read and say these new words and new sentences:Where is my car?On the desk. In the toy box. Under the chair.
2、能力目标
1)PPT提供一定主题内容的图片,培养学生在key points辅助下进行口语表达的能力。
2)通过自主说.两两对话.小组活动等形式,培养和提高学生口语交际能力和运用英语进行思维的能力。
3、情感目标
1)通过本节课的学习,学生能够互相团结协作,共同完成学习任。在学习中培养孩子们的相互协作意识。
2)养成独立思考.自主学习的学习习惯。
教学重点:The pupils can read and say these new words and new sentences.
教学难点:The pupils can use the sentences correctly in the life.
教学理念:
1、以跨越式教学理念为基础,体现教师主导.学生主体的教学思想。
2、利用多媒体服务于教学,为教学创设理想的英语学习环境。
3、倡导俩俩对话为主.师生对华为辅的交际模式,提高学生的语言应用能力。
4、本节课主要通过图片展示.师生练习.俩俩对话.儿歌欣赏等方式培养学生学习英语的兴趣。
教学理念:跨越式教学理念
教学资源
1、录音
2、多媒体
3、教学卡片。
教学策略
以教师为主导,学生为主体。运用多媒体与卡片有效结合,激励学生的英语学习兴趣。
一、Warm—up/ Revision
1. Chant:Where is your hand?Here it is.
2. Revise the old words:car,box,plane.
Ask:What ’s this?Do you like?
二、Presentation
1、师生示范The teacher puts the car,doll,plane in the toy box.
T:What’s this?Ss:It’s a box.
T:Yes,it’s a box.It’s a toy box.
Then the teacher points at the car,doll,plane and says:They are toys. Help the pupils read “ toy box.”
2、The teacher puts the car in the toy box,on the toy box,under the toy box. Then teach these phases.
3、Teach in,on,under. Pay an attention to the sound of under.
4、Listen to the tape and read the dialogue.
5、Practise the dialogue in pairs like this:Where is my pencil?It’s in your pencil—case.
6、Game:Listen and act
T:Act a ball in a toy box. Act a plane on a toy box.
Act a car under a toy box .
7、 Do and Say . Two pupils in a group.
A:Where is my ———?
B:It’s in/ on/ under———.
三、拓展听读。
使用拓展材料中的Dialogue1. 2. 3. 4. 6。根据时间的安排与学生的理解情况至少听两个对话。
小学英语课件 篇2
网络**
在听做、听唱、玩演和视听等丰富多彩的活动中,激发小学生学习英语的兴趣是新课程标准设定的小学英语教学的主要目标之一。为此,项目组整理了“小学英语教学活动设计”。在这个板块中,我们围绕着新课程标准中语言知识(二级)中的21个功能和话题,整理了《中小学外语教学》(小学版)及《中小学外语教学》(中学版)中教师设计的活动目的明确、可操作性强、贴近小学生的学习与生活且有利于学生学习英语知识和发展语言技能的课堂教学活动(活动形式包括玩游戏、唱歌曲、诵歌谣、讲故事、演短剧和做事情等),让学生在愉悦的合作式的学习氛围中学习英语和运用英语。
time
1[活动名称]现在几点了?
【活动类型】diy
【活动目的】通过在图中标注时间,复习和巩固时间表达法,并进一步引导学生在游戏活动中运用表示时间的句型。
【语言项目】what time is it? it’s …
【适合水平】小学低年级
【活动方式】双人小组活动、全班活动
【活动准备】大白纸、颜料或水彩笔等
第一步:老师出示四个没有时针和分针的钟。
step2:教师根据各图旁标注的时间分别给每个钟面画上时间。
step3:教师呈现句型“what time is it?it’s …”供学生在活动中运用。
step4:小组活动
1) 学生根据自己的喜好设定时间和设计时钟模型
1234
2)学生根据所填的时间,运用教师呈现的句型进行对话。
step5:小组与全班活动。学生两人一组,将时钟图粘贴在黑板上或通过投影仪向全班同学展示。然后根据时钟的时间表演对话。
2.【活动名称】what time is it?
【活动类型】diy
【活动目的】巩固所学的时间表达法,并引导学生设计类似的游戏,在游戏活动中进一步巩固表示时间的单词和句型。
【语言项目】what time is it? it’s …
is it … o’clock? yes. /no.
【适合水平】小学低年级
【活动方式】小组活动、大班活动
【活动准备】教师预先设计用两只手表示时间的手势
【活动步骤】step1:教师用双手代表时针和分针,摆出若干组表示整点的时间,并提问学生:what time is it?
step2:教师呈现句型:is it … o’clock?
第三步:老师用双手抽出时间,让学生用句型回答问题。
step4:小组活动。一个学生用双手抽出一定的时间让其他小组成员猜猜。
step5:小组与全班活动。每组派学生将自己设计的表示时间的手势展示给全班,并用句型“what time is it? / is it … o’clock?”表演对话。
3.【活动名称】what time is it now? it’s …
【活动类型】game
【活动目的】在学生喜爱的活动中创设信息差,引导学生学习和巩固时间的表达法,并渗透有关“时差”的常识。
【语言项目】what time is it now? it’s …
【适合水平】小学中、低年级
【活动方式】双人小组活动、全班活动
【活动步骤】step1:发给学生画有“钟面”的图,并让学生听录音;听录音,画出具体的时间(即在钟面上画出时针和分针的确切位置)。
第二步:教师向学生简要介绍时差反应的知识,然后要求学生快速回答。例如:
it’s nine fifteen in the morning in china. what time is it now in london?
第三步:学生学习以下诗句:
tick-tick-tick,
what time is it?
1, 2, 3. it’s three o’clock.
time for tea?
no, it’s not.
tick-tick-tick,
what time is it?
1, 2, 3, 4. it’s four o’clock.
time for tea?
the tea is hot.
step4:教师教给学生两则有关时间的谚语,并让学生课下收集更多的关于时间的谚语。例如:
never too old to learn.(活到老学到老。)no man can call back yesterday.
(时光不可倒流。)
4[活动名称]制定时间表
【活动类型】discussion
【活动目的】通过小组讨论,制定秋游计划,以此展示学生的知识与能力,并在制定计划及汇报的过程中,让学生体会学习英语的乐趣,建立用英语交流的信心。
【语言项目】when will you get up/go to the park/have lunch/go home/…?
we will … (do sth.) at ... (a certain time)
【适合水平】小学高年级
【活动方式】四人小组活动、全班活动
【活动准备】提供与秋游相关的短语
【活动步骤】step1:教师创设以下情景:我班将组织一次秋游活动,时间是下周五,地点是紫马岭公园,请每个小组制定一份计划,安排好具体时间和活动内容。
教师写出部分相关的单词和词组供学生选用(如get up, go to the park, have lunch, go home, play games, canoe, play cards/soccer/barbecue/frisbee, do a puzzle, have a match),并鼓励学生增加更多新内容。
step2:小组活动。以3-4名学生为一组,使用以下句型讨论并制定计划:
when shall we...? we shall ... at...
ok. i agree with you. that’s a good idea.
i don’t think so. …
step3:小组汇报。老师让3-4个小组到讲台上来。小组成员解释了部分计划。
step4:小组互访。为了制定最佳计划,让团队中的每个成员去其他小组面试,并在面试中使用以下句型:
when will you...? i will... at...
what about you? i don’t think so. it’s a good idea.
... 第五步:下课后,每各小组都要完善小组制定的计划,并在第二天的课堂上互相交流。
5.【活动名称】时空隧道
【活动类型】do a survey
[目的]扩大学生的知识面,使他们理解时差的概念;学习现在进行时
【语言项目】what’s the time in new york? / what are they doing? / they are…
【适合水平】小学高年级
【活动方式】4-6人小组活动
【活动准备】时钟,世界地图
【活动步骤】第1步:老师布置任务:根据时差知识完成下表:
step2:各小组利用网络或图书馆资料了解全球各地时差,并根据各地时差推测当地人们正在干什么,同时完成**。
(1)学生在教师引导下核对**,教师评价各组的完成情况。
小学英语课件 篇3
小学英语教学活动案例1
活动名称:快乐换换换
适用范围:小学中低年级
活动目标:
1.学习和巩固室内动物名称:dog, cat, rabbit, monkey, bear, lion, elephant, giraffe, tiger, deer, fish, turtle等。
2培养学生的听力和快速思维能力,调动学生参与活动的积极性。
活动要求:学生已经听懂了一些动物名称的单词。
活动材料:动物**,一些动物名字的单词卡片。
活动步骤:
1老师介绍活动内容:让我们一起做一个有趣的交流活动,看看哪些学生反应快。为了玩这个游戏,我们必须先学习一些新单词。
2.教师展示动物**,并向学生提问:what's this?,学生到曾经学习过的动物就会说:
it's a rabbit / cat ...。当学生遇到学生没有学会的单词时,老师引导学生大声朗读。教师每呈现一种动物**,就把该动物对应的英文单词卡片展示在**旁边,并带领学生反复朗读。
让学生看到动物,会说单词,看到单词就知道是什么动物。
3.教师找10至12名学生到教师前面来,给每个学生发一张动物单词卡片,让这些学生站成一个圈,教师宣布游戏开始。
4.教师可以逐个快速地念出单词,然后教师说:rabbit and cat,持有这两张卡片的学生就要跳到圈的中间来交换卡片,其他所有的学生说:change。
然后这两名学生退回到队伍中。如果拿牌的学生不站起来,他将被罚在圆圈中间表演动物在卡片上的动作或模仿动物的声音。然后老师会换其他人继续游戏。
5.在进行两轮之后,教师可找一名学生到教师前面代替教师来下命令。
这项活动有利于学生语言能力的培养,主要体现在一下几个方面:1
1)可反复训练所学单词。
2) 巩固和加深对所学单词的记忆,培养学生的听力和快速思维能力,调动学生参与活动的记极性。
3)这项活动将枯燥的单词记忆融入到有趣的游戏活动中,学生不仅巩固了对刚刚学习的大单词的记忆,更感受到了学习英语的乐趣。
4)在活动的最后部分,中学生可以代替老师在教师前下达命令。 这种做法有利于培养学生的口语能力。然而,由于课堂时间有限,不可能为所有学生提供这样的机会。教师可以对这个活动稍作改变,即可让学生在训练听的能力的同时又训练说的能力。
比如:当教师说:rabbit and cat,持有这两张卡片的学生就要跳到圈的中间来交换卡片,并大声说出:
i'm a rabbit / cat.。这样学生说的能力就得到了培养。
5)这项活动趣味性强,操作性强,同时学生也可以比较全面地的参与。
小学英语教学活动案例2
活动名称:欢乐的身体
适用范围:小学中低年级
活动目标:
1.学习和巩固身体部位名称:head, neck, shoulder, arm, leg, foot, hand, toe, knee, eye, ear, nose, mouth。
2学会用一些简单的形容词来形容身体部位:长,短,大,**全部,等等。
三。培养学生的听说能力,初步培养学生的写作能力。
活动要求:学生已经学会了一些形容词,可以用来描述形状。
活动材料:身体部位**、蜡笔、实物投影仪
活动步骤:
1老师向学生介绍活动内容:今天我们要把我们最喜欢的人物画在一起。现在老师将在黑板上为你画一个字。我一换图纸就给你介绍。谁是我最喜欢的角色。
教师在黑板上画加菲猫(或其他**人物),边画边讲解:this is his head. it's big.
this is his arm. it's short...。让学生跟著老师朗读句子并进行推测。
2.教师画完后,告诉学生:this is garfield, my favorite cartoon character.。然后指着图画上的各个部位向学生呈现新单词,在身体部位的旁边标出对应的身体部位名称,并让学生进行跟读。
三。教师会快速地展示身体各部位的**,让学生快速说出身体各部位的名称。然后,老师带领学生唱身体部位的歌曲,唱歌做动作,用手指指着相应的身体部位
head and shoulders, knees and toes, knees and toes, knees and toes,
head and shoulders, knees and toes, knees and toes, eyes, ears, mouth and nose.
4.在学生对所学的身体部位名称熟悉了之后,教师给学生布置任务,让学生画一个机器人或自己喜欢的**人物或动物,画完后,与同桌进行交流,介绍自己画出的人物或动物形象身体各部位的名称。
5.随后教师鼓励学生自己设计一个**人物形象,画完之后仿照黑板上或书上的英文单词,用英语为自己设计的形象标出其身体部位的名称。
6.让学生利用实物投影仪在全班展示自己创作的**人物形象,并用课上学到的单词和表达方式进行描述和介绍,最后由全班学生评选出最佳创意奖,最佳绘画奖,最佳口语奖等奖项。
这项活动有利于学生语言能力的培养,主要体现在一下几个方面:1
1)表达和描述身体部位。
2) 通过完成任务,达到熟练的课堂听说单词和句型,初步培养学生的写作能力。
2.在讲授人体部位的英语名称时,我们要做的不仅仅是让学生记住那些身体部位的英文名称,而是要让学生能够在现实的生活中得到运用。因此,这个活动的设计首先是以学生的真实兴趣为出发点,机器人、加菲猫、蜡笔小新等都是学生喜欢的**形象,让学生自己动手画出喜爱的**形象,符合了学生“愿学、乐学”的原则。在熟练的说话和唱歌的基础上,让学生阅读,然后过渡到模仿写作,为下一阶段的学生学习打下良好的基础。
同时,在完成这项活动的过程中,为每个学生创造了一个充分展示才华的机会,有利于增强学生的自信心。
小学英语课件 篇4
Unit5 B Let’s talk部分是学生在前一课已经学会询问衣服价格、能购买衣服的基础上,来学习购买鞋子的一个语言情节。整个语言情节中,需要学生新学的内容是会询问鞋子尺码和价格,以及在言语交际中学会建立良好的人际关系。
首先,我要说的是教学目标:
能够听、说、认、读四句句型:
① A pair of sth for sb ② What size?
③ How much are they? ④ We’ll take them.
要达到以上知识技能目标,需要通过创设生活模拟情境,让学生在情境中交际,在整个学习过程中学生经历探究、猜测、朗读,这也是本课所追求的过程目标。
本课的情感目标是要体验以得体的方式与别人进行交际。
我设计这堂课的理念是:
第一、采用任务型教学,面向全体学生开展交际活动,在活动中习得语言。
第二、分散难点,把各新学内容巧妙地设计在循序渐进的过程中,努力使学生学得轻松愉快。
■为了有一个真实的学习情境,我把教室布置成一个超市,“超市”有三个柜台组成,柜台上放置大小不同的鞋子和衣服,而且每个柜台间的鞋子、衣服价格不等。
整个教学过程是这样的:
warm-up部分,
首先是复习单词,把柜台上的一双“凉鞋”隐蔽起来,对学生说:“Can you guess ,which shoes in it ?”学生自然会用上节前课所学的四个单词来猜测,等学生把四个单词都猜一遍后,再揭开谜底。这种游戏重复几次。兴趣高昂的猜测过程,就是复习四个单词的过程。
其次是复习“Can I help you ?”、“A pair of … ”这两个句型。让学生用这两句对话完成给自己购买鞋子的任务。
Presentation部分。
这一环节,我设计的大致流程是:在热身中引出学习“A pair of sth for sb ”,接着学“What size?” “ How much are they ?”,再学说“ We’ll take them.” “How about this pair?”, “Are they all right ?”三个句型。应该说这个流程分散了学习难点,有利于学生体验成功,增强学习主动性。
●在热身部分的对话句式训练后,教师与某学生组成一对“顾客”参与其中,当“营业员”向教师提问“Can I help you ?”教师的回答是“A pair of sneakers for my student .”并配以动作演示,把买到的鞋子递给学生,让学生在教师的`演示中,感悟到这个句型的意思。
之后,要求学生三人组成一组,分别当营业员和顾客。操练“Can I help you ?”、“A pair of sneakers for sb .”的对话句型,这里的sb可以说成父母或兄弟姐妹。因为课文中说的是妈妈给儿子买鞋,但,一般学生在平时还不需要说“给儿子买鞋子”。所以,我想创造性地使用教材。让学生说是给“父母或兄弟姐妹”买鞋,这样,更切合学生生活的实际需要。
●教师激励学生:“In the shoes supermarket ,you can buy any shoes you like 。But you must speak in English。”同时播放课文录像,让学生在课的一开始就对课文有一个整体的感知。
播放录像后,提出要求:“If you speak well,and the shoes is for you !”激发学生学习兴趣。随后,教师拿一双鞋子,以营业员的口气提问:“What size ? ”让学生在教师引导下,根据鞋上的标码回答。当学生能正确回答,也能感知到意思后,教师再与几位学生循环对话示范,规范学生语音。之后组织同座位的学生互问互答。
对“What size ? ”提问和回答的操练后,用同样方法学会 “How much are they ?”,并能正确回答。
“What size ? ” “How much are they ?”这两个句型是本课学习重点,单独组成一个环节进行教学是我设计这堂课的基本策略之一。
●为巩固这二句重点句型,引入一个游戏。先播放电视中“我猜、我猜、我猜猜猜”的一个片段,用学生喜欢的电视节目来激发学习兴趣,“Wow How funny 。Let’s do it 。”让一个学生上台找到适合自己型号的鞋子,找到后用 “What size?”,“How much are they?”向其他学生提问,其他学生要根据所提的不同问题猜是多少码或多少钱。临时教会学生用too up or too down 来评价猜得是高还是低。要求学生轮流上台参与,以使每位学生都有机会提问和回答。
●这篇课文中,除此之外,还要学会 “We’ll take them。”以及“How about this pair?”,“Are they all right ?”我的教学策略是组织学生边听课文录音,边看录像。听数遍后,让学生听录音的跟读、师问生答的引读,在多种形式的语言感知过程中,让学生自我质疑,又结合录像画面,重点揣摩,逐步领悟这三句句式的意思。如“We’ll take them。”这句话,就结合录像中“妈妈要求营业员把鞋子包装起来”的画面,明白它的意思是“我们就买这双吧”。通过朗读、观察、推测,自我解决疑问是英语新课标提倡的学习策略。也是我设计本课的基本策略之二。
听录音跟读后,学生分成合作小组自由读熟课文,在小组内要相互倾听与帮助,教师参与其中作个别辅导。指名检查熟读情况,了解学生实际水平,特别是发音正确与否,根据学生掌握情况随时生成新的指导方式。
Practice部分
让所学知识有所用,是任务型英语教学的基本要求。最后的操练部分设计了在整个模拟的超市中,用英语去购买便宜的商品。设计买便宜商品的目的是训练学生用得体的方式与多个柜台进行交际,询问价格,保证全体学生有多次口语训练的机会,又渗透购买物品要进行比较的生活素质。
具体学习过程是这样的:
学生可以排着队伍唱着上节课学的歌《The Coat in the Window》,走进模拟超市。几位学生可自己主动到柜台前当“营业员”,其他每个学生都用新学的句式到各柜台前买鞋,比较各柜台上鞋子的价格后,再把便宜的买下。整个过程中可以是自己买给自己,更提倡几人组成一组,用“A pair of sth for sb”的句型买给对方。在购物中还需要用前课学的“It’s too expensive ”句式来拒绝高价商品,从而达到单元整体巩固的目的。
●购买后,让每个学生去调查身边四位同学各自购买的商品价格各是多少,这又是一次英语口语交际的机会,在调查过程中完成“Group work”部分的表格,也自然把“写”的训练融入了英语课中。
■各位老师,我设计的课,始终注意激发学生学习兴趣,在猜中复习、在游戏中强化、在活动中操练,在表达中激励,听、说、读、写、演交替进行。
正确处理教师主导作用,保证学生主体地位,突出学生个性,实施差异教学。
全课学习过程流畅,使众多学习内容化为简单,一步一个脚印,应该说学习目标的达成度会是很高的。
小学英语课件 篇5
我是今天的最后一位选手28号。请允许我最后一次和大家一起分享自己对这套人教版教材的教学思路和感想。这是一篇关于介绍家庭成员的阅读课I Love My Family,如图(课件)我的说课分为五个部分,说教材、说教法、说学法、说教学过程、说反思和评价。今天我以一年四季为背景来分别介绍。
一、说教材
1、教学内容
基于学情: 作为五年级上册的学生对英语阅读课并不陌生,也掌握一定的词、句、段、章的知识积累和阅读能力。但作为阅读初学者,教师应侧重于具有针对性的阅读方法的指导、阅读能力的培养、语用意识的提高。
基于教材:本教材是人教(新版)内容,学生之前对What’s your (his her) name? Who’s he? This is my father. He is a doctor.内容都有涉及,但仅限于单句的问答。因此,语言知识的整合,综合运用这些单句来进行语言交际是本节课关键。
基于单元:本单元涉及的是关于职业的内容,主要涉及的知识内容有This is my father, he is a teacher.的自我介绍;What’s he? He is a doctor的职业问答;Who’s he ?He is my uncle的人称问答。能力要求有人称代词的熟练使用,以及能熟练介绍关于辈分、职业、愿望的自我介绍。
基于本课:作为第一课时,从文本材料的要求just speak的提示来看,应该是整体理解和把握阅读文本,将支离破碎的知识点进行整合,开展阅读,从而达到语用。所以对辈分、职业等知识的展开和具体学习会在之后的课时中进行。所以教师在本节课中侧重对阅读能力的培养。
基于以上四点,我设计的理念是授之以鱼不如授之以渔。因此不仅提高给学生知识性指导,更注重的培养学生朗读文本、阅读文本、领会文本的语篇意识和运用文本的语用能力。
2、教学目标
基础教育阶段英语课程的任务是激发和培养学生学习英语的兴趣,使学生树立自信心,养成良好的学习习惯和形成有效的学习策略。我将教学目标确定为:
(1)知识目标:
A. 能够听、说、读、用句型:This is my mother . She is a tailor.
B.能够听、说、读定语短语和介词搭配:
in Class Two, Grade Five. On the left. On the right in the middle.
C.能够正确意会、朗读Here’s a picture of my family. We look like each other. We’re twin brothers
(2)能力目标:
A.听: 能学会正确、仔细聆听文本、教师、同伴的回答,模仿并纠错。
能听懂、交流What’s your name? What’s he? Who’s she?相关信息
B.说:能学会大胆说、大声说、大方说。
能在实际中学会简单介绍自己和家人的年龄、辈分、职业等。
C.读:能认真模仿、正确朗读文本材料,掌握一定的朗读技巧。
能正确朗读本节课的文本材料,配上语气、语调、态势语等。
D.写:模仿范文,开展初步写作。书写清楚,字迹工整。
能根据教师提供的书写范本,进行独立的写作训练。
(3)情感、策略、文化等有关目标:
A.情感目标:注重培养爱家、爱家人的家庭意识。
B.策略目标:认知策略 、阅读策略、交际策略 、语用策略
3、教学重点
能够听、说、读、用句型:This is my mother . She is a tailor.并在交际中加以替换。
4、教学难点
A.能够听、说、读定语短语和介词搭配: in Class Two, Grade Five. On the left. On the right in the middle.
B. 能够正确意会、朗读Here’s a picture of my family. We look like each other. We’re twin brothers
二、说教法
《新课程》要求教师从学生的学习兴趣、生活经验和认知水平出发,倡导体验、实践、参与、合作与交流的学习方式和任务型的教学途径,发展学生的综合语言运用能力。教师是教法的执行者,但无论教法如何新颖、独特,都应该考虑学生的兴趣、学情、能力、差异等方面,以生为本。
1、任务型教学法:学生通过为Lin找家人、为Tom找家人、圈划判断、仿写等任务的完成来达到层次递进的学习目的。
2、情境教学法:创设为Lin找自己的家人、参观Tom的家、介绍自己的家的一系列以家为主的真实情境,到最后爱家的情感抒发,水到渠成。
3、交际教学法:学生之间、师生之间无时无处不体现交际教学法。
4、多媒体辅助教学法:利用多媒体的直观教学来辅助教学。
5、活动探究法:以学生为主体,以活动为载体,在系列活动中,培养学生独立的自学能力、思维能力、活动组织能力、自我探究能力。
6、合作学习法:组织学生进行小组讨论,促使学生在学习中自我发现问题和解决问题,培养学生的团结协作的精神。
7、分层教学法:不同学情、不同程度的学生设计不同的问题,提出不同的要求,完成不同的作业。对不同层次的学生提出不同程度的要求和目标。
教法的原则:全体学生为主体、有效活动为载体(达到学生综合能力培养为目标)
三、说学法
《新课标》指出教学主要目的是使学生掌握一定的英语基础知识和听、说、读、写技能,使语言学习的过程成为学生形成积极的情感态度、主动思维和大胆实践、提高跨文化意识和形成自主学习能力的过程。教师的教法以培养学生的学法为主,学生的学法又要求教师及时调整教法。
1、自主探究法:在自己的语言基础上进行积极主动的思考,从而养成自主学习能力。
2、旁知学习法:通过观察教师、模仿同伴、跟读录音等借助一些学习资源进行学习。
3、分析归纳法:将自主学习和旁知学习的内容进行加工、整合,形成自己的知识体系和学习方式。
4、合作学习法: 和同伴取长补短、互相帮助、互相学习。
学法的养成原则:循序渐进、关注细节、恩威并重(达到学生独立学习能力养成为目标)
四、说教学过程
1、教学准备
简笔画、课件、录音、作业纸、学生照片
2、教学步骤
(1)快速热身,直切主题(教学in Class One, Grade Five)
【设计意图】心理学研究表明学生注意力是细致观察, 良好记忆, 正确思维的重要条件。热身复习环节应充分吸引学生的眼球,让学生快速投入到本节课英语学习的氛围中。
我采用了激情三部曲:第一步:快问快答,知识梳理:What’s your name? What’s his name? What’s her name? Who’s he? Who’s she?为下面的学习做好充分的准备。第二步:激情激趣,知识整合:在黑板上简笔画了一幅Lin画进行介绍:Her name is Lin. She’s ten. She’s from China. She’s a student in Class One, Grade Five (板书中突出大写、介词等细节知识),板书简单清楚的板眼了自我介绍的四个内容。第三部:轻松介绍,知识运用:在清晰的示范、幽默的简笔画中学生自我介绍name, age, nationality, job,在轻松自然中复习旧知的同时,学习了新知in Class One, Grade Five,可谓一举两得。
(2)情境创设,呈现操练
【设计意图】所谓:“知之者不如好之者,好之者不如乐之者”,可见兴趣是学习的原动力。激发兴趣,自然从学生的真实生活出发,创设他们喜欢熟悉的情境,并能在任务型的驱动下大胆探究、主动学习。具体设计如下:
A、任务之一:为Lin 找爸妈:(教学Here’s a picture of my family)
【设计意图】以任务型教学的方式,激发孩子的好奇心,在完成任务的过程中自然习得语言。
(简笔画中补充lin 的眼泪)Lin can’t find her father and mother. Can you help her? Who’s her father and mother?出示三张不同的照片,展示出三个不同的短语:Here is a picture of black family. Here is a picture of white family. Here is a picture of yellow family.在为Lin找爸妈的任务中,不同家庭照片的出示,自然引出了Here’s a picture of my family。孩子们在观察和说的过程中表达Here is Lin’s father and mother.
B.任务之二:描述lin’s family(教学This is my mother. She is a teacher. on the left ight in the middle)
【设计意图】继续开展任务型教学,帮助Lin找到了家人之后,请为她介绍一下她的家人。在此环节中包含有重点句型的学习、难点内容的突破、语音问题的初探。使活动具有有效性、实效性、多功能性。
(简笔画中的Lin又恢复了笑脸)Lin’s happy. Lin has a happy family, She loves her family.
(出示照片)教师引导:Who’s she ? ——This is my mother
What’s she ? She can teach——She is a teacher.
Where’s she? ——She is on the left
同此,请学生来说出This is my mother. She is a teacher . She is on the left.
This is me. I’m a student in Class One, Grade Five. I’m in the middle.
This is my father. He is a doctor. He is on the right.
开展自主探究式学习,巩固语音:egg——leg——left——on the left
night——light——right——on the right
miss——mid——middle——in the middle(提示in on)
出示课题:I Love My Family.
(3)直击语篇、阅读指导
A、读前铺垫、总体把握:教学twin, Here’s a picture of my family. We look like each other.
【设计意图】通常自己在教学中会布置读前预习的作业。本节课通过读前的默读、朗读、记标记等方式的阅读指导,让学生在和老师共同阅读之前自己自主学习,寻找关键点,总体把握文本。既而培养学生独立阅读的能力,本环节属于范读环节。
a.默读画圈:根据Lin的幸福家庭,自然引出了Tom的幸福家庭。要求学生默读短文,并划出Tom’s family member. 并回答How many people are the in there in Tom’s family?
b.朗读划线: What’s Tom’s father? This is my father. He is a teacher.
What’s Tom’s mother? This is my mother. She is a tailor.
教师指导:She can make the clothes. She is a tailor.(教读单词)
B、读中指导、环环相扣
【设计意图】读中的指导应该是对文本的深挖细掘,在教师的指导下,开展有针对性、具体化、目标性的阅读指导,不仅让学生掌握一定的阅读技巧,也是对文本细化的过程。读中环节是阅读最重要的部分,属于精读环节。
a.听力回答:listen and answer the question(作业纸)
My name is Tom. I’m ten. I’m a student in Class Two, Grade Five.
Her name is Mary. She’s nine. She is a student in Class One , Grade Three.
b.阅读回答: Who’s the boy on the right?
He’s my twin brother. We look like each other.(引导意会)
c.听力模仿:听的过程中,教师引导学生用红笔记录朗读符号,并模仿。
d.合作学习:pair work(同桌互相学习,以此互相帮助和纠正朗读中存在的问题)
C、读后操练、加强巩固
【设计意图】在对文本范读和精读之后,对文本材料的表面意思有了一定的认识和理解。读后环节是文本材料的升华,是对文本的再理解、再梳理、再学习的环节。
a.根据课文判断
1. This is Tom’s father. He is from China. ( )
2. This is Tom’s mother. She is a tailor. ( )
3. Tom and Mary are twins. ( )
4. Tom has a happy family. ( )
b.齐读短文,注意模仿语气、语调,关注朗读技巧。
C. talk about Tom’s family. Tom has a family.
(4)、学以致用,巩固拓展
【设计意图】任何语言的学习归根结底都是语言的运用,也就是学生语用能力的养成。在对文本材料的学习之后,会让学生进行一定的仿写,这符合《新课标》二级要求:即五年级学生应开展初步的写作。自己在教学中每个单元也会让学生进行主题写作。写作的方式为模仿写作,写作的层次是先口头、再填空式书写、最后家庭作业中的发散性写作。
A、口头模仿:拿出照片,进行小组合作group work。
Tom has a happy family. He loves his family. Do you love your family?
: I Love My Family.
Here is a picture of my family. My name is . I’m . I’m a student of Class Grade .This is my . He is a . This is my She is . I have a family. We love each other.
B、书面练笔:通过口头模仿的基础,在范文的指导下开展书面小练笔(作业纸)
C、情感渗透:无论家庭贫富、父母如何,应该爱自己的父母、爱自己的家人、爱自己家的情感目标应该是渗透到教学的每一部分中。
(5)个性作业,自主学习。(作业纸)
【设计意图】作业设计面向全体同学,对全体学生提出该年段、学段的基础性要求。同时注重学生的个体差异,以此激发学生的学习兴趣和培养学生的自主学习能力。因此,针对五年级学生素质的差异,我进行了分层训练,这样做既可以使全体学生掌握基础知识,又可以使学有余力的学生有所提高。
Homework: Choose As I Like.
A、(必做)Listen, imitate and read. 听读短文,并大声模仿,直至流利朗读。
B、(必做) Write your own composition, use the picture of your family.
参考文本,完成作文,并贴上照片。
C、(选做)Write Mike’s composition, use the picture of his family.
根据文本,请为我朋友写上他的家庭介绍,附上照片。
作业设计的宗旨:
a.面向全体:基础性知识的作业要做到人人会、人人做的要求。
b.自主选择:不同学生可以选做不同的作业,一定程度上发展各个层次的学生。
c.检查评价:作业有做有批有订正,这样作业才真正达到复习和巩固的效果。
小学英语课件 篇6
一、教材分析
1、教学内容
本单元围绕去商场买包,要求学生掌握heavy,light,broken,pockets等词,并能熟练运用It’s /It’got…句型利用所学到的形容词对看到的事物进行描述。
2、教学目标
新英语课程标准指出,基础教育阶段英语课程的总体目标是培养学生的综合语言运用能力。而综合语言运用能力又以学生语言技能,语言知识,情感态度,学习策略和文化意识五个方面的综合素养为基础。
基于以上认识,由于英语听的重要性。我们将目标定为以下几点:
(1)能力目标:能够根据听到的内容,对所描述的事物做出判断。
(2)知识目标:能够听、说、认、读本课的重点单词:heavy,light,broken,pocket。掌握句型It’s nice。 It’s got two pockets。
(3)情感、策略、文化等有关目标:通过本课听的学习,使学生有兴趣听、说英语、描述图片,主动与他人交流。能够互相描述事物进行英语表达。
3、重难点
依据以上对教学内容和教学目标的分析以及小学生的认知规律和英汉语言差异,我们认为能够认真的听,并通过听进行思考,学习本课的句型及单词是本课的重点。
4、教学方法
根据以上对教材的分析,我采用情景法、直观演示法、全身反映法等教学方法。坚持以话题为中心,以任务型活动来安排本单元教学。由听做说开始,创设语言氛围,激发学生的学习兴趣,使学生在复习旧知识的同时能够掌握并应用新知识。
二、教学过程
基于对学生进行倾听习惯的培养,我们设计了以下过程。
1、边听边做,激发学生学习兴趣。
兴趣是学好语言的关键,激发学生学习英语的兴趣是小学阶段英语教学的一项重要任务。为了能调动学生学习的积极性,促使学生积极主动地学习,我首先要求学生听并和我一起做动作和说单词,这样激发了学生的学习兴趣,也集中了学生的注意力。同时对所学过的形容词进行了很好的复习,对后面的环节的练习做了很好的铺垫。
2、学生为主体,活动中渗透听。
(1)学生的兴趣集中了,马上出示图片要求学生通过听、看来猜事物。在激发学生的兴趣的同时将新单词heavy,light引入。并进行教授。先让学生听然后进行模仿单词及句子。This green bag is heavy。 This red bag is light。
(2)创设真实的语言情境:出示我的包,告诉学生老师即将在假期去西安看朋友,当拿出包时,做出发现包破时的惊讶表情,学生在轻松的氛围中,进入今天的主题“买包”。此时教授新内容department store。
(3)进入商场,进行选包复习并学习It’s… It’s got…句型。在此过程中学生要听教师问问题并进行回答才能说出重点句子。这也是对学生听的训练。
(4)当选包结束,我选择了一个认为很好的包,教授句型It’ll be easy for me 。I’ll take it。我认为这两个句型的出现比较自然,而且以这样的方式呈现让学生较为容易掌握这两个句型。
(5)此时,进入课文的学习,在课文的学习中,我用了三个步骤进行学习。第一,让学生听课文进行回答问题。让学生初步对课文内容进行了解。第二,让学生听录音进行跟读。让学生在前一基础上进行跟读,培养学生读的能力。第三,让学生听录音并合书进行课文填空,这增大了难度,对学生的要求更高一些,不仅要求学生能懂,并能够让学生对所学的内容进行理解及记忆
本单元围绕去商场买包,要求学生掌握heavy,light,broken,pockets等词,并能熟练运用It’s /It’got…句型利用所学到的形容词对看到的事物进行描述。
这一方式也很好的检测了学生对课文内容的理解。将“听、说、理解”做到了很好的整合。
3、巩固知识,进行拓展
出示几张图片,我先进行描述让学生进行猜测,不仅培养了学生听的习惯,同时训练学生用英语进行思维。让学生做pair work的练习,很好的锻炼了倾听他人表达的习惯,同时也能够说英语进行交流。提高了语言运用的实效性。
4、结束
布置英语家庭作业,要求学生做练习册的看图写句子的题。
三、学法指导
在本课中,利用多媒体课件,依据英语教学的直观性、趣味性、实践性原则,主要以听来贯穿整节课,坚持“词不离句,句不离章”的教学原则,使学生积极参与到教学活动中,形成自主学习的能力。
本节课也有很多的不足之处:比如,告诉学生暑假我要去西安看朋友,但是自己却拿了一个很小的包来。课件中出现的旅行箱。对学生的评价不足等,希望各位老师多提出宝贵意见及建议。谢谢!
小学英语课件 篇7
1、模拟交际情境。
情境表演最能满足学生的表现欲。为了表演成功,学生往往会积极而精心地设计表演内容,而在这一过程中,学习内容已嵌入学生的脑子里。例如学习了见面打招呼、互相介绍的句子后,引导学生模拟真实的生活情境,在课堂上表现出来,从Hello!Nice to meet you!到Goodbye!See you!从姓名What’s your name?到年龄How old are you?亦或其它的问题,老师都可以引导学生按照预定的.目标进行情境表演。
2、创设生活情境。
人如果脱离了生活就学不会语言,学汉语如此,学英语也是如此。如果教师把课堂变成一个浓缩的社会,让课堂活起来,让学生在生活情景中学英语,在体验中学英语,在实践中学英语,学生就会学得主动、生动、快乐。如在教学牛津小学英语4B《Buying fruit》这一单元时,我把众多的水果带入课堂开始卖水果,而且当你学会了买卖还可以获得一些水果奖励。小组自由买卖水果中,同学们激情高涨,思维一下就被激发出来,香蕉、苹果、草莓、梨等单词学得真快,连一些语句“Can I help you?”/I’d like some……/How many kilos?/……kilos,please等也学得特别快,进而从生疏到熟练,学生学得特别带劲
情境表演时除了真人表演的对话,还可以让学生利用玩具、木偶等自己喜欢的物品来表演木偶戏,这样效果会更好。因为充当配音小演员及造型可爱的小玩具同样是孩子们喜欢的事物,孩子们在说说笑笑、玩玩跳跳中既感受到轻松愉快,又达到了“动手又动脑”的目的。
3、借助媒体情境。
媒体教学生动形象,特别音形色感强烈。例如教科书上安排了许多动物的单词,教学中除了看xxx片、动物玩具教单词外,还可利用媒体创设情境进行教学,效果特别好。如在教学dog,cat等单词时,可以设计成一个有趣的故事,随着“汪汪”的叫声,欢快地跳出“dog”,小狗高兴地出去游玩,找到好朋友小猫“cat”。学生通过看看、听听、说说、想想,思维被激发,既学会了英语单词,又听到了故事,学生学习的兴趣大增。
小学英语课件 篇8
一、说教材
1.教学内容
本节课是新起点英语一年级上册第一课时包括6个单词dog,cat,chicken,duck,bird,rabbit和句型What’s this ? It’s a ……。的学习。
2.教学目标
知识目标:能够听、说、读单词dog,cat,chicken,duck,bird,rabbit并能用动作来表示这些小动物;能进行简单的句型问答What’s this ? It’s a ……。
能力目标:在日常生活中,能用英语It’s a .... 介绍小动物。
情感目标:通过这节课的学习,培养学生热爱小动物,保护大自然的情感。
教学重点:听、说、读单词dog,cat,chicken,duck,bird,rabbit。
教学难点:在日常生活中的实际运用。
二、说教学方法
根据本套教材的特点,一年级学生的年龄特点及本课教学的`需要,我采用直观教学法、主观演示法、个人小组练习法、全身反应法等教学方法。坚持创设学习英语的环境氛围,激发学生的学习兴趣,调动学生的学习积极性,安排本课时的教学。
三、说学法
在本课教授中我坚持以课标为指导,以活动的方式游戏为辅助,坚持“词不离句”的教学原则,使学生运用观察法,模仿法、练习法、游戏法对本课的新知识进行学习。
四、说教学过程
1. 热身 以出现单词卡片孩子们说歌谣的形式来复习前几节课的知识。
2. 导入 以五个主线人物和我的宠物来贯穿单词和句型的学习,让孩子们注意听和看出现的单词卡片,记住谁的宠物是什么动物。
3. 新授部分 本课共6个单词,我主要让孩子们三三两两练习读,增强孩子们的学习自信心,其中穿插句型What’s this ? It’s a ……, 老师通过动作让孩子试着说一说。在巩固练习时,采用两个游戏来检验孩子们对单词和句型的掌握情况, 一个是看图片说句子,如果我说的动物和图片上的动物一样,那么就和我一起说,反之则作相应的反应Ah oh.;另一个是我扔玩具扔到谁的面前,大家一起问他问题What’s this ? 他来试着回答 It’s a ……。
小学英语课件 篇9
说教材
我说课的内容是小学快乐英语第二册第三单元13课。本课是交际训练课,我注重围绕“访客迎课”这一中心内容,采用多样化的教学手段将听,说,玩,演,唱溶于一体,激发同学学习英语的兴趣和愿望,使同学通过合作学习体验荣誉感和成绩感,树立自信心,培养同学一定的语感和良好的语音语调基础,发展语言技能,从而初步形成用英语进行简单日常交际的能力,为进一步学习打下基础。
教学目标
1、正确使用“May I come in? Come in please.” 这些日常用语。
2、能够听懂,会说并认读 apple、 banana 、pear 三个单词。
3、学会有礼貌的访客迎客,掌握基本的会客方法。
教学重点
正确使用“May I come in? Come in please.” 这些日常用语以和会用“Have a …”表达款待客人的心情。
教学用具
录音机、水果、手偶、装有梨的盒子。
教法和学法
(一)小组学习法
针对本课内容我把全班同学分成三个小组,课堂各项活动,均以小组活动为主线,结对或全班活动为辅,同学互相交流,切磋,一起完成任务。在合作中感受学英语的乐趣,也通过小组成员之间“荣辱与共”的关系而形成一起学习的环境。
(二)情景教学法
我将教学建立在满足同学心理需要的基础上 ,使教学活动带有浓厚的情感色彩。在单词和句型教学中,采用简笔画、手偶、实物等调动同学的多种感官,拓宽同学学习渠道,改进同学学习方式,提高教学效果。
本课的说课稿我是这样设计的:
一、 热身
(1)师生问候,亲切交流。(教师以朋友的语气与同学交流,不但消除同学的紧张情绪,而且把同学带进了轻松与悦的情绪中,同时锻炼了同学英语口语交际能力)。
(2)唱英语歌曲 (活泼欢快的歌曲,吸引了同学的注意力,稳定了同学的情趣,活跃了课堂气愤。同时有利于建立民主、和谐的师生关系。)
二、复习导入
1、 教师模仿兔子,让同学猜。然后让同学Do it like this.达到复习动物类单词的目的。
(这一环节复习尽量发挥同学的眼、口、手、脑、耳多种器官并用动身。)
2 、板书课题
三、讲授新知
学习Look Listen and Say
1、教师简笔画出示苹果,学习apple这一单词。
(这局部内容我主要采取简笔画教学手段,初步让同学形象感知,既形象又直观。)
2、教师出示香蕉实物并说:“It’s a banana.” Who can draw it? Who can color it? 同学画完后,并涂色。学习banana这一单词。
3、教师拿出装有梨的盒子,让同学猜。学习pear这一单词。(我采用教师领读、指生读、男生齐读、女生齐读、全班齐读的方式学习单词。)
4、誊写单词。(适量的书写为同学正确、流利书写单词和句子打下扎实的基础。)
5、同学听音跟读。(巩固所学的知识,提高同学听说能力,使同学发音规范,语调自然。)
6 、Dran and color.(通过这一环节提高同学的审美意识,同时又为Play a game.和 Let’s act.做好铺垫。)
7、 Let’s play a game.(将所学知识融入活动中,即使同学得到放松又活跃了课堂气氛。)
学习Learn to say
这局部内容分以下几步:
1、教师出示手偶,扮演对话,让同学理解句子的含义。
2、教师板书句子并学习。
3、同学听音跟读。(Learn to say .)
(这局部的操练为下局部的提高练习打下基础,让口语暂落后的同学也有表示的机会,增强同学说英语的信心,激发他们学英语的兴趣。)
学习Let’s act.
1、教师与一名同学扮演对话,引出Have a big banana.
2、教师将香蕉扒好皮,示意让同学品尝。让其他同学理解句子的含义。
3、教师领读句子。
4、小组练习。(自主操练,发挥了同学的自主性,让他们品尝到创新的喜悦,从而增强了学习的自信心,提高了口头表达的能力。 )
5、 Let’s talk one by one.
6、听音跟读。
四 听力练习。(我采用了听力练习册的题作为本课的巩固练习。)
五、总结评价
(通过同学自身总结,自我评价更有益于同学自我认识,有利于同学反思和调控自身的学习过程。)
六、课后作业
1、与你的好朋友扮演会客内容的对话。并在实际生活中加以运用。
2、誊写三个水果类单词。
小学英语课件 篇10
随着课改的逐渐深入,说课已成为考核教师教学能力的重要方式和提高教师教学水平的重要途径越来越受到普遍重视。那么如何正确认识说课,在我们的教学实践中说课究竟有什么作用,如何掌握初中英语中的说课,是许多教师特别是青年教师亟待了解的。
一、正确认识说课
说课,就是教师在总结自己教学实践经验的基础上,从教学理论的高度,依照教学大纲要求,结合教学内容、学生基本状况和现有教学条件等实际情况,对自己的备课思路、课堂教学设计进行系统阐述。但是必须注意说课不同于一般意义上的备课说课并不是读教案。
说课的过程是教师对教学理论再学习并用于指导新的教学实践的过程,是教师对教学大纲进一步深化认识理解的过程,是教师将自己的教学经验条理化并升华到理性认识的过程。说课的效果,是教师综合教学能力和业务素质的体现。
二、说课的作用
1、说课具有提高教学效率的作用。说课的过程能使教师做到备课、授课思路清楚,步骤清晰,重点突出,方法得当。
2、说课是检验教师综合能力和业务素质的重要手段。通过说课可及时发现教师运用教育理论是否正确、采用教学方法是否得当、分析理解教材是否准确,从而判定该教师是否胜任所承担的教学工作。目前很多地方教学比赛,大多将说课作为一个重要方式。说课具有提高教师整体水平的作用。因此,说课可用来指导和检验备课的科学性和时效性,可用于进行教师个人的教学经验总结,还可用来作为考核教师教学水平和理论水平的手段。
三、怎样说课
I、说教材
1.简要分析本课内容在整个单元和整个教材体系中甚至在英语素质教育教学中的重要地位和作用。
2.确定教学目标及其依据,根据单元教学的目的和要求(对语音、词汇、日常交际用语、语法等方面的不同程度的要求),结合学生的实际水平,确定贯穿单元教学的总目标和本课的具体目标。目标包括:
1)知识目标:
a.语言知识目标;
b.文化知识目标;
2)能力目标:
a.语言能力目标;
b.智力发展目标,如训练学生的逻辑思维和快速反应能力等;
3)德育(情感情意)目标。
3.确定重点、难点和关键点及其依据
重点、难点和关键点分别是什么,并写出确立该重点、难点和关键点的理论依据,说明为什么该重点是本课教学的最主要部分或最重要内容,为什么该难点在本课教学中是学生最难理解和最容易出现错误的部分(有时重点和难点相同),为什么该关键点对本课教学的成败起决定性的作用。
II、说教法
以哪种教学方法为主,哪几种方法为辅,采用什么教学手段实现教学目标,采用这些教学方法和手段的理论依据是什么,并说明这些教学方法在本课教学中的具体操作方法,贯彻什么教学原则,采用什么教学模式,作必要的解释和说明。如果有独特的教学思想和教学特色,可单独说明。
III、说学法
结合教学内容,说出在本课教学过程中,指导学生学习使用或学会使用什么学习方法,如五官并用、强化记忆、比较归纳、分析概括规律、循环记忆、分类记忆、联想记忆、发现学习、心口一致等等。要说明结合本课教学培养学生哪种学习能力,如观察力、记忆力、想像力、注意力、创造力、思维能力、反应能力、自学能力等。说学法可以与说教法结合。
IV、说教学程序
简要说出各个教学步骤的具体教学环节名称及相关教学内容、步骤、教学活动组织和安排;即在哪个教学环节教哪个(些)知识点,提出哪些问题,做哪些练习(教什么),组织哪些课堂教学活动,采用什么教学方法(怎么教)等等。在叙述教学程序时,要按照教学步骤说清各个教学环节的具体活动,包括讲授的知识内容、练习、小结、反馈、矫正及作业布置等安排。要说明如何通过教学突出重点,突破难点,抓好关键。说教学程序要求既有具体步骤的安排,又要有针对性的教法理论阐述。必要时说出各步骤的时间安排。
V、说板书设计
板书设计要求语言精练,说明板书的整体布局即可。用多媒体展示板书内容。
Ⅵ.说课注意事项
(一)语言表达:
1.简明扼要,用词准确得体,长短句搭配;
2.尽量避免使用抽象、笼统、缺乏可操作性和可监测性的一般性用语;
3.避免多次使用同一种结构或词语表达;
4.可适当使用具有口语特征的语言,避免“背书”的嫌疑;
5.语调、语速应有变化。
(二)多媒体演示
1.将教案主要内容与本课的电子课件有关内容相结合;
2.简明实用,千万不要过于花哨;
3.演示操作应熟练。
(三)体态语言
1.表情以微笑为主,兼顾严肃、幽默;
2.站位应和听众、屏幕形成一定角度,主要面对听众,有时兼顾屏幕或评委;
3.眼神应和不同位置的听众交流;
4.身体笔直,配合一定的手部和头部动作,大方潇洒。
总而言之,说课就是教师在教学实践经验基础上,依照教学大纲要求、教材内容、学生基本状况和现有教学条件,从教学理论的高度,对自己的备课思路、课堂教学设计进行全面、综合、具体和有条理的阐述。要通过说课明确本课的教学目的和要求,分析本课的重点和难点,分析教学主体的客观情况,并对如何安排教学内容、如何驾驭教学过程、如何掌握教学节奏、自己所选择的教学方法和手段以及预期效果加以具体的论述和说明。
因此,教师尤其是青年教师,要尽快掌握说课这项教学基本功,将自己的教学实践活动上升到教学理论上来认识,与教学大纲密切结合起来,迅速提高自己的教育教学理论水平和业务水平,成长为教育领域的栋梁。
小学英语课件 篇11
一、谈话引入
1、 铺垫,知识回忆
想一想,到现在你学会了哪些英语知识?说说看,比一比谁学到的多?
2、 激趣,字母游戏:创设情境,发现问题
大家学会的可真不少!今天,我们就应用所学会的一些字母做一个游戏,你们喜欢吗?
老师给每个同学发一张卡片,上面有一些字母,下面同学们仔细听,把老师读到的字母划掉,看看你发现了什么?每个小组第一桌的同学到前边来做,看哪组分高。
师读:C、D、I、J、K、M、N、Q、S、U、V、X、Y
Now, tell me please. What do you find?
生:单词flag, go, zoo, bag, pen.
师:OK! You are very clever.
完成的同学得一朵小红花。
师:这里有一个单词同学们没有找到,那就是我们今天学习的weather.
( 游戏能为小学生的英语学习带来快乐,使枯燥、机械的句型操练变得生动,活泼,因此,在教学过程中,应恰当的把游戏引入课堂,寓教于乐。)
二、利用多媒体学习新单词
1、 练习生词的读音
课前让学生查找与天气有关的'单词,学生通过搜索资料提高搜索信息的能力,培养学生探究能力,然后进行六个单词的重点学习,在听完磁带后,找学生读单词,纠正他们的发音。
( 利用电教多媒体能使课堂更加生动,直观,图文并茂,使学生能够在轻松愉快的气氛中学习。)
2、 交际英语
运用What’ the weather like? 就图片上的天气进行提问。
( 英语要作为交际工具来教,也要作为交际工具来学,做到学用统一。)
3、 图片与句子相连接,学生走到微机前进行连接。
三、争做小小天气预告员
就各地区的天气进行预告。
( 爱好是的老师,而爱好来自好奇,来自体验,提供实践机会,让他们参与表演,这既符合儿童好动、表现欲强的年龄特点,同时也会进一步加强对所学知识的把握。)
四、学唱歌曲
1、 运用肢体语言教学生词snoring, bumps his head,确信学生理解歌曲的意思。
( 肢体语言,可使学生在语言和动作、表情间建立直接的联系,从而获得形象的感知,能收到良好的效果。)
2、 建立超连接,运用新标准动画光盘教唱歌曲,在演唱中配以相应的动作,然后小组间展开竞赛,看哪个小组唱得,为唱得的学生发小红花,并鼓励他们把新学的歌曲唱给爸爸妈妈听。)
( 小学生性格天真活泼,特殊喜欢唱歌,在演唱中配以相应的动作会更引起他们的参与和投入,在英语歌曲中学新词,既减轻了学生的心理负担,又能在轻松愉快的气氛中学到新知识。)
五、总结升华
以沙尘暴为例对学生进行爱护四周环境的思想教育,让我们的天空更蓝。
六、课堂小结
在活动中复习巩固了所学知识,把握了如何问答天气,以及在愉快的气氛中学会了一首英文歌曲,增强了学英语的自信。
高一英语课件
必看的“高一英语课件”精选文章即刻推荐。教案课件是老师在课堂上非常重要的课件,因此就需要我们老师写好属于自己教学课件。老师上课时要依据教案课件来实施。若您想再次查看此页记得立即收藏方便查找!
高一英语课件【篇1】
新课标高一英语Unit 1 Friendship教案
Unit 1 Friendship
(1) 课题:Friendship (2) 教材分析与学生分析: 本单元的中心话题是“友谊”,几乎所有的内容都是围绕这一中心话题展开的。Warming Up部分以调查问卷的形式引导学生了解日常生活中朋友之间发生的真实问题以及解决这些问题的方法;Pre-Reading部分的几个问题启发学生对“友谊”和“朋友”进行思考,使学生明确不仅人与人之间可以做朋友,日记也可以成为人们的朋友;Reading部分Anne’s Best Friend以日记形式讲述了犹太女孩安妮的故事;Comprehending部分通过连句、多项选择和问答形式帮助学生对课文内容、细节进行更深入的理解; Using about Language 部分教学本课重点词汇和重点语法项目。 (3) 课时安排:The first period: Speaking: Warming Up and Pre-Reading The second period: Reading
The third period: Grammar
The forth Period:Listening
The fifth period: Writing
(4)教学目标: ① 知识与技能:Talk about friends and friendship; Practise talking about agreement and disagreement, giving advice and making decisions; Use direct speech and indirect speech; Learn to write an essay to express and support an opinion.
② 过程与方法:本单元在读前阶段就提出问题,让学生思考是不是只有人与人之间才能交朋友,然后在阅读中通过安妮的日记向学生说明我们也可以与动物及无生命的日记交朋友。在深刻理解、充分训练的基础上,可以再引导学生深入讨论几个与本单元话题有关的问题:1.描述朋友; 2. 结交网友;3. 观点交流;4. 善不善交朋友; 5. 朋友的重要性。 ③ 情感态度与价值观:学完本单元后要求学生进行自我评价,主要评价自己在本单元中的学习情况。对书中的'内容是否感兴趣,有哪些收获,解决了什么问题。使学生加深对友谊、友情的理解,以及如何正确交友,处理朋友之间发生的问题等。 (5) 教学重点和难点:
词汇:add point upset ignore calm concern cheat share reason list series crazy nature purpose dare thunder entirely power according trust suffer advice situation communicate habit
短语: add up calm down have got to be concerned about go through hide away set down on purpose in order to face to face according to get along with fall in love join in
重点语法项目: 直接引语和间接引语的互相转换
难点:Understand the real meaning of friends and friendship;
Discuss the answers to the questions (Reading);
How to teach the Ss to master the usage of Direct Speech and Indirect
Speech(Statement and Questions).
(6) 教学策略: Discussion, Student-centered vocabulary, learning, listening, pair work, teach grammar in real situation (7) 教学煤体设计: A projector and a tape recorder. (8) 教学过程:详见以下分课时教学设计。 (9) 课堂练习与课外作业设计: 穿插于分课时教学设计中
(10)教学反思或值得改进的地方: 见每个课时最后部分。
Period One:Speaking (Warming Up and Pre-Reading)
Aims
Talk about friends and friendship.
Practise talking about agreement and disagreement.
Step I Revision
Ask some of the students to read his / her composition for the class, describing one of the problems between friends and how it is solved. Then give some comments.
T: Now, let's check up your homework for last class. I'd like some of you to read his / her composition for the class, describe one of the problems between friends and how it is solved.
Step II Warming up
T: / think most of us have some good friends. Do you know why people make friends with one another?
Step III Talking(WB P41)
First get the students to listen to what a Canadian say about making friends. Then ask them to discuss the two questions.
T: Now we're going to listen to what Leslie Clark, a Canadian has got to say about making friends. After listening, please talk about the two questions in groups of 4. Try to use the following expressions.
1 Do you agree with her? 找教案
2 What do you think of people from foreign countries?
Agreement Disagreement
I think so, I don't think so.
I agree. I don't agree
That's correct. Of course not.
That's exactly my opinion. I'm afraid not.
You're quite right. I don't think you are right.
Step IV Speaking(B P6)
First, get the students to think of four situations among friends in groups of 4 and design a questionnaire to find out what kind of friends their classmates are. Second, try it out on their own group, checking the questionnaire through and adding up their score and see how many points they can get. Ask them to fill in the form prepared before class. Show the instructions and decide what kind of friends their classmates are. Third, ask each student to stand up and walk around the classroom to make a survey on four of other classmates. Show the instructions and decide what kind of friends other classmates are. They can share your questionnaire with one or two other groups and try each other's questionnaires.
At last, show the instructions to help your classmates to know how to improve his or her skills of making good friends with others if necessary.
T: Friends come in many flavors. There are best friends, school friends, fair-weather friends, forever friends and many more. Do you want to know what kind of friends your classmates are? Now let's make a survey. First, please think of four situations among friends and design a questionnaire to find out what kind of friends your classmates are.
1. Your friend borrowed 100 Yuan from you last week and hasn't returned it. You will
A. ask him / her to pay back as soon as possible; or you'll end the friendship.
B. ask him / her to pay back if he / she has.
C. tell him / her not to return it.
2. Your friend said your bad words behind you. You will
A. ask him / her to say sorry to you , or you'll stop your friendship.
B. excuse him / her and forget it.
C. ask others to tell him / her that he/she is wrong.
3. You promised to meet your friend at five o'clock but your parents ask you to do homework at home. You will
A. tell him your parents ask you to do homework at home.
B. tell him / her a lie that you are ill.
C. say sorry to him / her and plan to meet him / her another time.
4. You borrowed a bike from your friend, but you had it stolen. You will
A. buy a new one which is the same as his / hers.
B. just tell him / her you had it stolen.
C. say sorry to him/her and buy him/her an old one
After they finish choosing the answers, show the scoring sheet on the screen.
Instructions:
2-5 A fair-weather friend 找教案
Only like them when they are happy and popular. If they are feeling down, or if they are having a problem, you don't want to spend time or talk with them. You don't help your friends when they have problems. You are always thinking about yourself.
You should care more about your friends. If you continue to be self-centered and don't consider others' feelings, you won't make more friends and keep friendship for long.
6-11 A school friend
You see each other in school. You just study and play with them together in school. You may not know everything about each other. You take things smoothly. You seldom hurt your friends with your benefit considered. You'd better add more affection to your friends. Friendship is about feelings and we must give as much as we take.
12-17 A best friend
You do everything together with your friends: study, read, watch TV, surf the Internet, play sports and listen to music. If either one has a problem, the other is there to help. You know your friends very well. You understand and yield to each other. You help with each other and improve together. You have a lot of common benefit. Your friendship is good to both of you. You are mutually beneficial.
18-21 Forever friend
You will always listen to your friends and try to help them, even if you disagree or if you are having a problem. Whenever they have any difficulty, you'll try your best to do what you can to help them without hesitation. You devote yourself to your best friends. You are willing to lose what you have, even your life.
课后反思:本课教学设计容量和密度较大,但难度适中,大部分学生都能接受。体现全面照顾大部分学生的教学理念。注意培养学生开口说英语的的信心。
The second period: Reading
Aims:
1. to master the new words and some useful expressions.
2. to understand the text and finish the exercises in Comprehending.
Step 1. Looking and guessing
Work in pairs. Look at the pictures and the heading and guess what the text might be about.
1). Imagine what it might be like if you had to stay in your bedroom for a whole year. You could not leave it even to go to the WC or to get a cup of tea. How would you feel?
2). What would you choose if you are only allowed to have five things with you in the hiding place because there is very little room?
Step 2
Reading to summarise the main idea of each paragraph.
Skim the text and summarise the main idea of each paragraph in one sentence.
Step 3 Language points
1. add (to) v. 1) to put together with something else so as to increase the number, size, or importance; 2) to join (numbers or amounts ) so as to find the total.
eg: The fire is going out; will you add some wood?
The snowstorm added to our difficulties.
Add up these figures for me, please.
2. ignore v. to take no notice of; refuse to pay attention to
eg: His letters were ignored.
Even the best of men ignored that simple rule.
My advice was completely ignored.
3. concern v. 使担心;使不安 (+about/for); 涉及,关系到;影响到
eg: The boy's poor health concerned his parents.
He is concerned for her safety.
The news concerns your brother.
He was very concerned about her. 4. loose adj. not firmly or tightly fixed. She wore loose garments in the summer.
I have got a loose tooth. Some loose pages fell out of the book.
5. purpose n. [C] an intention or plan; a person’s reason for an action. What is the purpose of his visit?
The purpose of a trap is to catch and hold animals.
Did you come to London to see your family, or for business purpose?
6. series n. (of) a group of things of the same kind or related in some way, coming one after another or in order.
Then began a series of wet days that spoiled our vacation.
This publishing firm is planning a new series of school textbooks.
They carried out a series of experiments to test the new drug.
7. cheat. 1) v. to behave in a dishonest way in order to win an advantage;
2) n. a person who cheats; dishonest persons
They cheated the old woman of her house and money.
The salesman cheated me into buying a fake.
He never cheated in exams.
I see you drop that card, you cheat!
I never thought that Sam is a cheat.
8. share 1) vt.&vi. (inwith amount etween) to have, use or take part in something with others or among a group.
2) n. (inof) the part belongs to, owed to or done by a particular person.
The money was shared out between them.
Sam and I share a room.
We shared in his joy.
They always share their happiness and sorrow.
I have done my share of the work.
9. crazy adj. 1) mad ; foolish 2) [+about] wildly excited; very interested
You're crazy to go out in this stormy weather.
John's crazy about that girl.
She is just crazy about dancing.
10. dare v.& v.aux.. 1) + to do; 2) + v
to be brave enough or rude enough (to do sth. dangerous, difficult or unpleasant).
How dare you accuse me of lying!
How dare you ask me such a question?
My younger sister dare not go out alone.
He did not dare to leave his car there.
11. trust 1) n. [U] (in) form believe in the honesty, goodness or worth etc, of someone or something
2) v. to believe in the honesty and worth of someone or something; have confidence in
I have no trust in him.
I don’t place any trust in the government’s promises.
Why do you trust a guy like him?
I trust your wife will soon get well.
12. suffer v. (for) to experience pain, difficulty or loss
I cannot suffer such rudeness.
He suffered from poverty all his life.
My father suffers from high blood pressure.
They suffered a great deal in those days.
13. advice n. [U] opinion given to someone about what they should do in a particular situation 找教案
→v. advise to give advice to
I want your advice, sir. I don't know what to do.
I asked the doctor for her advice.
I f you take my advice, you won’t tell anyone about this.
He gave them some good sound advice.
14. communicate v. 1) (to) to make (opinions, feelings, information etc. ) known or understood by others. e.g. by speech, writing or body movements;
2) (with) to share or exchange opinions, feelings, information etc.
Our teacher communicates his idea very clearly.
He had no way to communicate with his brother.
Did she communicate my wishes to you?
We learn a language in order to communicate.
Deaf people use sign language to communicate.
15. calm 1) adj. free from excitement, nervous activity or strong feelings; quiet
2) n. [U] peace and quiet
3) v. to make calm
You must try to be calm.
The high wind passed and the sea was calm again.
The police chief advised his men to stay keep calm and not lose their tempers.
There was a calm on the sea.
She calmed the baby by giving him some milk.
We calmed the old lady down.
Useful expressions:
1. add up to join (numbers or amounts ) so as to find the total.
Add up 3, 4 and 5 and you'll get 12.
Add up your score and see how many points you can get.
If we add these marks up, we'll get a total of 90.
2. calm down
to make or become calm
Calm down, sir. What's the trouble?
Just calm down, there’s nothing to worry about!
We tried to calm him down, but he keep shouting.
3. be concerned about with
to worry or interest
My parents are concerned about my studies.
Don’t concern yourself about with other people’s affairs.
She’s concerned about his son’s future.
4. go through
1) to suffer or experience; 2) to look at or examine carefully;
3) to pass through or be accepted
The country has gone through too many wars.
The new law did not go through.
Let’s go through it again, this time with the music.
5. set down
1) to make a written record of; write down 2) put down
I have set down everything that happened.
I will set down the story as it was told to me.
Please set me down at the next corner.
6. a series of + pl. & n 做主语时,谓语动词用单数
一连串的,一系列的,连续的
There has been a series of car accidents at the crossing.
These days I have read a series of articles on reading.
A series of TV play is on Channel 1 these days.
7. on purpose
intentionally; with a particular stated intention
He did it on purpose.
“I am sorry I stepped on your toe; it was an accident.” “It wasn’t! You do it on purpose.”
I came here on purpose to see you.
8. according to
as stated by sb. or sth.
They divided themselves into three groups according to age.
Please arrange the books according to size.
According to the Bible, Adam was the first man.
According to her, grandfather called at noon.
9. fall in love
begin to be in love (with sb.)
They fell in love at once; it was love at first sight.
What will he do if his daughter falls in love with a poor man?
They fell in love with each other for years.
10. join in
to take part in (an activity)
They are going to join in the singing.
She started dancing and we all joined in.
Would you like to join in my birthday party?
课后反思:本节课分层教学,在阅读课文,理解课文的基础上进行课文知识点的细致处理。需要改进的地方:单词短语部分讲解过多,占了很多时间,可以将其改为课后练习的形式。在以后的教学中要注意改进。
Period 3: Grammar
Step I Revision
Check students' homework.
Step II Word study
This part is a consolidation of the words learnt in this unit. Ask the students to do the exercise independently.
T: Now please open your books and turn to Page 4. First let's learn about language. Use the word they've learnt in this unit to fill in the blanks. Complete the sentences with suitable words in correct forms.
Step III Preparation
Get a pair of students to stand up and act as Anne and Kitty. It's time for the teacher to be the interpreter between them. Encourage both sides to give different sentences, including statements and questions.
Step IV Grammar
The students will learn the use of Direct Speech and Indirect Speech (statements and questions). First try to make clear to the students what direct and indirect speech is, with the help of the practice in Step III. Then give them some examples. At last get them to summarize the rules of Direct Speech and Indirect Speech (statements and questions).
T: In this part, we are to learn the use of Direct Speech and Indirect Speech (statements and questions). When do we use Direct Speech and when do we use Indirect Speech?
Step V Practice
For Ex 1, get the students to look at the sentences carefully in pairs in order to find out the difference between direct speech and indirect speech. Guide the students to find out the changes in pronoun forms, word order, adverbials and so on, especially the verb tenses, the underline parts. Ask the students to pay attention to the reporting clause.
For Ex 2, ask the students to do it by themselves, then check.
Step VI Homework
1. Practice of WB (P42.1 &P 43.2)
2. Ask the students to think out different ways to solve the problems about making friends, preparing the materials about the debate. Get the students to know the problem was that Anne had made a friend in the hiding place the son of another family hiding with them, but her father was not happy about this. The topic is: how do you help to solve the problem between Anne and her father. Do you agree with Anne or her father? Use specific reasons to support your solutions.
课后反思:本节课是语法课,能以学生为主体,通过指导学生观察、体验探究、合作等积极主动的学习方式,发现语言的规律并运用到各种语言实践活动中。做到精讲多练,使学生掌握直接引语和间接引语(祈使句和疑问句)的相互转化。
Period 4: Listening
Step I Revision
After checking the WB Exx, the teacher asks the students to read the letter on Page 6 first, and then ask them to discuss what was upsetting Lisa.
T: Here is a letter written to Miss Wang of radio by Lisa. Read the letter, please. Try to find out what was upsetting her with your partners, using the indirect speech.
S: Lisa made a friend with a boy in her class. But her classmates said they fell in love. Lisa said she didn't want to end the friendship. Lisa asked what she should do.
Step II Listening (Using language) The students will hear what Miss Wang says, then ask the students to answer the questions, using the indirect speech. At last, get them to spell out the words and fill in the blanks.
T: OK, we've already known the Lisa's problems on making friends. Miss Wang has suggested some possible solutions. Please look at page 6. We 're going to listen to what Miss Wang says, and then answer the questions of Ex 2. Go through the questions quickly.
Write down the key words as quickly as possible.
Listen again and check the answers with the whole class.
T: Now let's listen to it again and try to spell out the words and fill in the blanks.
Step III Listening (WB P41)
The students will hear a passage about Anne's best friend, her diary Kitty. They are asked to complete the passage according to the tape.
T: In the following part, we are going to listen to a passage about Anne's diary. Listen to the tape carefully and fill in the blanks.
Listen to it again and check the answers with the whole class.
Step IV Listening Task(WB P43)
The task can be divided into three parts. First, the students will hear a story about an argument between Anne and her father about her boyfriend. After listening, they just write down their different thoughts. Then they can have a debate to find out a better solution to solve Anne and her father's problem. The activity should be prepared carefully beforehand. During the class, the two teams just do the final preparations.
StepV Assignment
1. Today we have learnt how to solve the problems on making friends. For the homework, describe one of the problems between friends and how it is solved.
2. What does cool mean?
What do you think should do with your friends?
课后反思:本节是听力课,从帮助学生形成有效学习策略的角度出发,培养学生如何去获取信息,处理信息的能力。通过训练逐步提高学生的听力能力。
Period 5: WRITING
Step I Revision
Check the homework, asking them to read out their ideas for the class.
T: Let's check the homework. I'd like some of you to read out their ideas.
For the class. Volunteer!
Step II Warming up
T: Have you ever read The 21st Century ?
S: Yes, I have. It's a popular paper among teenagers in China.
T: If you have any problem, you can write to the editor and ask for advice. Here is a letter from a student.
Step lII Writing (B P7)
This part asks the students to write their advice to Xiao Dong as an editor. First, let the students to discuss how to write a letter to offer some advice with their partners. Second, teacher shows the instructions on how to write a proposal letter on the screen. Third, ask the students to read the letter on Page 7. Ask them to discuss what Xiao Dong's problem is and what is the solution they can offer in groups of 4, with the help of the points given on the books. Fourth, give them ten minutes to write the letter. At last, ask some of the students to read their letters for the class while the teacher gives some comments.
T: Today we're going to write your advice to Xiao Dong as an editor. Do you know how to write a proposal letter? Now, let's have a discussion on it with your partners. Students are talking about how to write a proposal letter.
T: Who'd like to answer this question?
S: The problem should be presented first. Then we must analyze the reasons to cause the problem. Proposing the solution must be the main, which should be well explained.
T: Exactly. The discussion of the solution itself, based on the analysis of the problem, is the core of a proposal. I'll give you some instructions about how to write the body part of a proposal letter as follows.
T: AH right, let's read the letter on Page 7. And try to find out what Xiao Dong's problem is and what is the solution they can offer in groups of 4, with the help of the points given on the books.
The students are discussing Xiao Dong's letter.
T: OK, who can tell me what Xiao Dong's problem is?
S: He is not very good at communicating with people. He wants to know how to make friends with others.
T: Quite right. Now please write your advice to Xiao Dong as an editor with the help of the points given on the books. I'll ask some of the students to read their letters
for the class in ten minutes. The students are writing the letters.
T: Have you finished? I'll ask some of the students to read their letters for the class.
高一英语课件【篇2】
Unit 9 Technology单元测试题
第一部分:听力(共两节,满分30分)
第一节(共5小题;每小题1.5分,满分7.5分)
请听下面5段对话,选出最佳选项。
1. Where are the two speakers?
A. On the way to the cinema.
B. In a car. C. On a train.
2. Why does the man want to ring up Mr Li?
A. He wants Mr Li to return his car.
B. He wants Mr Li to pick up his son.
C. He wants Mr Li to repair his car.
3. What can we know from the conversation?
A. James is wearing long hair.
B. The woman recognized James at once.
C. The woman didn’t recognize James at the beginning.
4. Where does the conversation take place?
A. At a shop. B. At school. C. In a hospital.
5. How many people are there in the man’s city?
A. 7, 789, 000. B. 778,900. C. 77,789,000.
第二节(共15小题;每小题1.5分,满分22.5分)
请听下面5段对话或独白,选出最佳选项。
请听第6段材料,回答第6、7题。
6. What does the woman want to do?
A. Buy a new car. B. Sell her old car.
C. Repair her old car.
7. What’s the possible relationship between the two speakers?
A. Husband and wife. B. Friends.
C. Workmates.
请听第7段材料,回答第8至10题。
8. What is the man?
A. A taxi driver. B. A doctor. C. A teacher.
9. Where are the two speakers?
A. In an office. B. In the street. C. In a hospital.
10. What does the man help the woman do?
A. Find a doctor. B. Carry her bag.
C. Call a taxi.
请听第8段材料,回答第11至13题。
11. Where does the conversation take place?
A. At home. B. On the way home.
C. On the way to the cinema.
12. What will the two speakers do first after supper this evening?
A. Buy something in the shop. B. See a film.
C. Have a walk in the shops and stores.
13. Why do the two speakers want to walk around the shops and stores?
A. They want to relax.
B. They want to buy something.
C. They want to meet their friends.
请听第9段材料,回答第14至16题。
14. What did the man buy for his wife?
A. A new dress. B. A nice skirt.
C. A pair of glasses.
15. Where is Mary’s?
A. In front of the speakers’ company.
B. Behind the speakers’ company.
C. Beside the speakers’ school.
16. What’s the possible relationship between the two speakers?
A. Classmates. B. Workmates. C. Neighbours.
请听第10段材料,回答第17至20题。
17. How many brothers and sisters did Ford have?
A. 6. B. 5. C. 7.
18. How much could Ford earn every week when he was young?
A. 2.5 dollars. B. 5 dollars. C. 3.5 dollars.
19. What did Ford do in 1893?
A. He invented the first car. B. He made a wood horse.
C. He bought a strong horse.
20. Which of the following words can’t be used to describe Ford?
A. Lazy. B. Able. C. Strong.
第二部分:英语知识运用(共两节,满分45分)
第一节:单项填空(共15小题;每小题1分,满分15分)
从A、B、C、D四个选项中,选出可以填入空白处的最佳选项。
21. -Well, when can I come for my bike?
-It ______ be ready in half an hour.
A. must B. should C. can D. might
22. -Thanks for ______ me of the meeting this morning.
-You’re welcome.
A. advising B. suggesting
C. reminding D. telling
23. I can’t move into my new house as it ______.
A. was painted B. is painting
C. is painted D. is being painted
24. Unfortunately, our plan ______ as my parents had expected.
A. broke down B. broke out
C. broke away D. broke up
25. -Will you go travelling this weekend?
-______.
A. More or less B. No wonder
C. That depends D. With pleasure
26. She stood up and walked to the teachers’ office, ______ what the head teacher would say to her.
A. to wonder B. wondering
C. wondered D. to be wondered
27. -What shall we do tonight?
-It’s up to you - ______ you want.
A. any B. whatever C. whichever D. either
28. Bill ______ the business when his father retired.
A. took over B. took down
C. took on D. took for
29. ______ he arrives before I get back, please ask him to wait.
A. Unless B. Because C. In case D. Even if
30. I suppose few tasks _____ more patience than fishing.
A. ask for B. call for
C. care for D. look for
31. Preparations ______ for the conference and everything will be ready soon.
A. were made B. are made
C. have made D. are being made
32. The American boy found it very difficult to ______the rules in the school in China.
A. obey B. break C. defeat D. touch
33. The money he spent during the trip ______ more than 50 dollars.
A. added to B. added up to
C. added up D. was added to
34. He ______ tell his mother what had happened to his father.
A. dares not B. dare to not
C. dared not to D. dared not
35. At last they succeeded ______ the serious forest fire themselves.
A. to put out B. in putting out
C. to put down D. in putting down
第二节:完形填空(共20小题;每小题1.5分,满分30分)
阅读下面短文,掌握其大意,然后从36-55各题所给的四个选项(A、B、C和D)中,选出最佳选项。
Sometime in the future, the familiar early-morning newspaper on the front porch(门廊) will disappear. And instead of 36 your newspaper, it will read to you. You’ll get up and 37 the computer newspaper just like switching on the TV. An electronic 38 will distribute(发送) stories about the 39 events, guided by a program that selects the type of 40 you want. You will even get to 41 the kind of voice you want to hear. Want 42 information on the brief story? A simple touch makes the entire text 43. Save it in your own personal 44 if you like. These are among the predictions from communications experts working 45 the newspapers of the future. Pictured as part of broader home-based media and entertainment systems, computer 46 would unite print and broadcast reporting, 47 news and analysis with video images of news events.
Most of the 48 is available(可用的) now, but convincing(说服) more people that they don’t need paper to read a newspaper is the 49 step. But resistance(反对) to computer newspapers may be stronger from within journalism. Since it is such a cultural 50, it may be that present generation of journalists and publishers will have to die off 51 the next generation realizes that the newspaper industry is 52 a newspaper industry. Technology is making the 53 of traditional newspapers unavoidable.
Despite technology advances, it could take decades to 54 newsprint with computer screens. It might take 30 to 40 years to 55 the changeover because people need to buy computers and because newspapers have established financial interests in the paper industry.
36. A. seeing B. watching C. reading D. looking
37. A. make up B. turn on C. pick up D. turn over
38. A. voice B. picture C. book D. company
39. A. newest B. nearest C. last D. latest
40. A. resource B. style C. news D. TV
41. A. choose B. make C. pretend D. add
42. A. any B. more C. some D. little
43. A. print B. copy C. appear D. broadcast
44. A. library B. computer C. shelf D. house
45. A. in B. off C. up D. on
46. A. experts B. newspapers C. screens D. magazines
47. A. offering B. sending C. removing D. reminding
48. A. events B. wonders C. information D. technology
49. A. useful B. past C. next D. useless
50. A. move B. change C. choice D. work
51. A. till B. after C. before D. once
52. A. forever B. still C. no more D. no longer
53. A. end B. start C. survival D. birth
54. A. admit B. create C. relate D. replace
55. A. begin B. prepare C. complete D. stop
第三部分:阅读理解(共10小题;每小题2分,满分20分)
阅读下列短文,从每题所给的四个选项(A、B、C和D)中,选出最佳选项。
A
Growing numbers of people are becoming addicted to (上瘾) text messaging, a German doctor warned recently.
Psychotherapist(采用精神疗法的医生) Andreas Herter estimated that there were some 380,000 sufferers in Germany. Herter based his prediction on the growing number of manic mobile phone users among patients arriving at his Hanover clinic for addiction treatment.
“Text message addiction is a real and serious illness because it causes mental and financial damage,” said Herter. “The problem leads to depression and personality disorders, not to mention skyrocketing phone bills.”
For example, a teenage boy spent 8,900 euros (US,000) texting people he didn’t even know and a married couple could only communicate by text message, even when they were sitting side by side.
56. The passage is mainly to tell us ______.
A. why people like text messaging
B. text messaging has many advantages
C. overusing text message does great harm
D. text messaging does no good
57. Herter thinks text message addiction is ______.
A. acceptable B. easy to deal with
C. worrying D. unreasonable
58. The examples given in the last paragraph are used to show ______.
A. sending text message is their only hobby
B. they care about nothing else but text message
C. text message addiction is a serious disease
D. they are very rich
B
A proud US father has named his son after a computer software term(术语).
Jon Blake Cusack, from Mocjogam, told the local newspaper the US traditional way of adding “Junior” or “II” after a boy’s name was too common.
So, when his son was born last week, he decided on the name Jon Blake Cusack 2.0, as if he were a software upgrade(升级版).
Mr Cusack admitted that it took months to persuade his wife, Jamie, to accept the idea.
Mrs Cusack said she asked several friends whether they can accept this name or not.
All the men, she said, felt the name was “cool”. However, her women friends did not think so. “I think the women will end up liking it,” she said.
Mr Cusack told the local newspaper he got the idea from a film called The Legend of 1900, in which an abandoned (被抛弃的) baby is given the name 1900 to remember the year of its birth.
“I thought that if they can do it, why can’t we?” he said.
After little Jon Version 2.0 was born, Mr Cusack even sent a celebratory e-mail to the family and friends designed to look as though he and his wife had created new software.
“I wrote things like ‘there are a lot of new features(特点) from Version 1.0 with additional(其他的) features from Jamie’,” he said. And he is already planning for his son’s future. “If he has a child, he could name it 3.0,” he said.
59. From the passage we know that “Jon Blake Cusack 2.0” ______.
A. shows the traditional way of American baby naming
B. is also the name of a computer software
C. has the same meaning as “Jon Blake Cusack Junior”
D. tells something about the hope the father places on his baby
60. According to Jamie, who disliked the name?
A. All her friends. B. Her women friends.
C. Her men friends. D. Nobody.
61. What do the names of “1900” and “Jon Version 2.0” have in common?
A. They’re both uncommon.
B. They’re both connected with computer.
C. They both tell about the births.
D. They’re to be equally popular.
62. What does “Version 1.0” refer to in the last paragraph?
A. A computer software. B. Mr Cusack.
C. Mr Cusack and his wife.
D. Mr Cusack’s grandson.
C
Not very long ago, the computer was a strange machine. Not many people understood it. Not many people said yes to it. Today much of that is changing. The first computer system was introduced for use in business in the mid-1950s. Since then, the number of computer systems used in business, government offices, and institutions has grown rapidly. In 1975, about 250, 000 systems were in use in the United States. This figure is growing by tens of thousands every year.
The computer is an important factor in our lives. Each year we use computer more and more to help us to collect data and to provide us with information. At one time people thought computers were only useful to banks, department stores and governments. But today the rapidly increasing number of computers are used for many other purposes. Have you ever stopped to think how you are affected(影响) by a computer? The clothes you wear were probably made with the help of a computer. The newspaper you read could have been edited and typed by a computer. Even radio programmes are often prepared by computers.
Computers today are playing important roles in education, transportation and medicine. They are used to predict the weather, to examine the ocean, and to develop defense systems. They are being used by businesses, governments and institutions. There is no doubt that their uses will become a greater part of our lives.
The influence(影响) of the computer is great. The list of its uses could go on and on. Computers now affect millions of people in countless ways every day.
63. Before the l950s the computer was _______.
A. widely used B. no use at all
C. not understood by many people D. liked by people
64. The writer thinks our lives are affected by computers, but we _______.
A. don’t quite notice it B. have known it clearly
C. don’t want to know about it
D. don’t like it
65. Although the first computer system was only introduced in the mid-l950s, computers now affect millions of people in countless ways every day. This means the
writer _______.
A. doesn’t like computers B. likes computers
C. thinks computers have developed rapidly
D. thinks we can’t live without computers
第四部分: 写作(共两节, 满分25分)
第一节:短文改错(共10小题;每小题1分,满分10分)
Before he was a teacher, Bob told me that what he 66. ____________
would like to do a lawyer when he was at school! 67. ____________
He worked very hard at his lessons and try to 68. ____________
enter into a famous university, but something unhappy 69. ____________
happened in his family, which made necessary for him 70. ____________
to work for a life. As a young man, he had been a 71. ____________
bus driver, a dustman and a salesman. But he spent his 72. ____________
spare times studying and finally became a college 73. ____________
teacher. “Young people,” he often said, “full of wishes 74. ____________
and hopes after they step into the society.” 75. ____________
第二节:书面表达(满分15分)
根据下列内容, 用英语写一篇题为 Life in the future的短文。
1. 人们可能到月球和其他星球上度假;
2. 科学家可能在海底生活;
3. 每家都有可视电话;
4. 孩子们可在家通过电视和广播接受教育;
5. 机器人为你做家务。
要求:1. 词数:100左右; 2. 可适当增加细节,使行文连贯。
责任编辑:李芳芳
高一英语课件【篇3】
Aims & Demands: Talk about science and technology
Describe things and how they work
Express agreement and disagreement
Focus: How to express disagreement and agreement
Methods: Communication and Discussion
Teaching steps
Step I Revision
Review some important phrases in unit 8.
Step II word study
1 read the new words and expression in unit 9
2 additional explanations
① dis- 前缀。表示“否定;相反;除去”等意思
eg: like ------ dislike agree-----disagree
able ------ disable appear----disappear
honest ----dishonest
② depend v 依赖; 依靠
eg: Good health depends on good food, exercise and enough sleep.
He is a man to be depended on. 他是一个值得信赖的人
The price depends on the quality. 价格依质量而定
It all depends. 这也难说;看情况而定
③ throughout prep 遍及,贯穿 adv到处,处处
※ 表示空间和时间的贯穿,且强调整体、全部。语气很强。
eg: News spread throughout the country.
He worked throughout the whole night.
She watched the film and cried throughout.
④ add v 增加
add to sth. 增加某物
eg: The bad weather added to our difficulties.
add sth. to sth. 把某物加入某物
eg: Please add some salt to the soup.
add up to 总计,达到
eg: The expense add up to 100dollars.
Step III Warming-up
1.Bring a toothpick and a plastic bag to the class. Draw a sock on the blackboard .ask the Ss to discuss the function of the 3 things.
2. Explain the “talk box” and ask the Ss to make some words.
3. Discuss the “True or False”.
Step IV Listening
1.Ask the Ss to close the books and listen to the tape paragraph by paragraph.
2. Ask the Ss to guess the things and discuss the functions after listening.
3. As with the listening material, do some exercises .Ask one students to describe one thing, and let the others to guess what it is.
Step V Speaking
1 divide the whole class into 4 groups .One group acts as Jane. One acts Jane’s father, and one acts Jane’s best friend. One acts as Jane’s mother.
2 Discuss with the group members, and then explain the reasons. Debate with other groups openly.
3 find the best debaters and the best groups.
Step VI Homework
1. Remember all the new words and expressions in unit 9.
2. Do the workbook P134 vocabulary 1---3
3. Preview the reading part.
高一英语课件【篇4】
一、学习目标:
1.抓住关键句,理解“雅舍”之“陋”以及雅舍之“雅”。
2.理解文句,体会作者的人生旨趣,培养学生乐观、积极的心态。
3.欣赏本文生动、诙谐的语言风格。
1.导入新课:(板书:陋室--雅舍)投影1:《陋室铭》齐读。刘禹锡说:斯是陋室,惟吾德馨。陋室因主人旷达、乐观的人生态度而高雅之气弥漫其中。一千多年后,梁实秋写了散文《雅舍》,那么,这“雅舍”又如何呢?现在,我们就来共同学习欣赏梁实秋的《雅舍》。
《雅舍》全文之精髓便着一“雅”字上,如此“雅致”之文又岂可不读?我们不妨请几位同学来为大家读读。这么有味道的文章,我也忍不住读上两段。
(学生个别朗读1、2、3段,老师范读4、5两段,全班一起读6、7段)
2.正音,出示几个难理解的词语解释(投影3),帮助学生读懂课文内容。
3.此文既题为“雅舍”,则作者写作重点自为“雅舍”,那么大家能否快速浏览第一段,找出一句最能体现“雅舍”特点的语句来?(学生读读,找找,划划)
明确:纵然不能蔽风雨,“雅舍”还是自有它的个性。有个性就可爱,这“个性”两字足以概括雅舍的特点,因而这两字也就成了全文的文眼所在。
3.既然“雅舍”的可爱之处在于它有个性,那么“雅舍”到底具有怎样的个性呢?
提示:综观全文,我们可以发现一个极其有趣的现象,文中所有出现的“雅舍”两字上都标有引号,大家有没有思考过:这引号是否和“雅舍”的个性有关?“雅舍”到底是“雅”还是“陋”呢?
请大家跳读全文,品味雅舍之独特个性。找找雅舍之“陋”与雅舍之“雅”分别体现在哪里?请同学找找体现“雅舍”之陋及“雅舍”之“雅”的语句,并作简要的概括。
小结:这不就是一栋典型的陋室吗?这样一个居所究竟“雅”在何处呢?
(1) 若说地点荒凉,则月明之夕,或风雨之夜,亦常有客到,大抵好友不嫌路远,路远乃见情谊。(第2段)
(到如此荒凉之所访友的必是主人的知己,俗话说“人以群分”,这梁实秋乃是典型的文人,这客想必定是雅客,如此一群雅人点缀此居所,何陋之有呢?)
(2) “雅舍”最宜月夜--地势较高,得月较先……此时尤为幽绝。
(面对月夜幽绝之景、细雨生趣之情,我们油然想到的是……这样的情景不就只能用一个字来概括吗?雅)
(4)“雅舍”所有,毫无新奇,但一物一事之安排布置俱不从俗。(第5段)
(好一句不复他求,好一句俱不从俗,屋内陈设简朴却脱俗,而这简朴陈设的内涵便是梁实秋思想情趣之雅,如此雅人才能欣赏雅舍,才能以雅舍命名之。)
小结:可见“雅舍”之“雅”体现在自然风光之雅、陈设脱俗之雅,更体现在主人思想情趣之雅上。
(三)深入思考,体会本文中所蕴藏的作者的人生旨趣。
思考:如此“个性”突出的陋室,作者身居于此却处之泰然,更欣欣然命名为“雅舍”,这其中表现了作者怎样的人生旨趣?我们不妨通过几个难句的理解来体会这种旨趣。
出示(投影5):
(1) 到四川来,觉得此地人建造房屋最是经济。
--经济便体现在砖柱、木头架子、竹蓖墙、泥灰以及孤零零、瘦骨嶙峋、单薄、可怜等词语中,从中我们可以体会到作者的无奈之情。
(2) ……现在住了两个多月,我的'好感油然而生。
--无奈的自嘲式幽默便体现在这里,其实也是一种苦中作乐。
(3) ……我则久而安之。
--坡度甚大,每日由书房走到饭厅是上坡,饭后鼓腹而出是下坡。逼真细腻地再现了房子的简陋和不方便,但作者却以近似于赞美的笔调描绘它,幽默自嘲,别有味道。
(4) 比鼠子更骚扰的是蚊子。……在雅舍则格外猖獗……但是我仍安之。
--对现实不满、无奈,但能安然对待,一种豁达心胸也油然突现了。
(5)……试问还有什么法子?洋鬼子住到“雅舍”里,不也是“没有法子”?
--没有直接表示对战争、对生活的不满,转而欣赏清风明月,这便是随遇而安的超脱了。
(6)我此刻卜居雅舍,雅舍即似我家。其实似家似寄,我亦分辨不清。
--梁实秋却能从苦难中寻觅诗意,安然视“雅舍”为家,可见雅舍对于梁实秋已经超出了一种物质的寄托,已然成为了他心灵的家园,精神的依附。这里,梁实秋身上那种豁达平和、苦中作乐、随遇而安的心态体现得非常突出。
(提示:抗战次年,即1938年,梁实秋先生被迫内迁重庆,在那他购平房一栋,命曰雅舍,这一住便是整整八年)
点拨:本文命名为“雅舍”,实际上是记述半山腰的一间陋室。明明是“陋”,却偏要称“雅”,其间自然存在着作者对所处战争年代的无奈,对自己生活环境的自嘲、自讽,但更多得表现了作者随遇而安、豁达乐观、苦中作乐的生活态度。
《雅舍》之所以动人,还因其行文的幽默诙谐。这种语言风格体现在那些文字上?请大家找一找,读一读。
点拨:本文语言风格无外乎典雅清朗而又富于幽默感。文笔轻松洒脱,或自嘲自解,或正话反说,或文白相间,或巧用典故。文中第4段堪称经典。(稍加分析,集体朗读)
据说《雅舍小品》这部散文集至今已经重版了五次,可见其受欢迎的程度。通过这节课的学习、欣赏、品味,我相信《雅舍》这篇散文已经给同学们留下了深刻的印象,同时,老师也希望作者豁达乐观、苦中作乐的生活态度会对同学们今后的人生产生积极的影响。
现在,请同学们自由朗读全文,再次品味文中语言的风格、作者的人生旨趣。
为自己的居室、宿舍取一能够体现其独特个性的“雅”名。
高一英语课件【篇5】
作者:贺 莉
Teaching plan for SB1A Unit 9 Technology
Teaching goals: Talk about science and technology
Describe things and how they work
Express agreement and disagreement
Use the present Continuous Passive Voice
Talk about the advantages and disadvantages of modern technology
Write a letter to Q12 about love and friendship
Time arrangement:
Period 1 Warming up, listening, speaking
Period 2 Pre-reading, reading, post-reading
Period 3 Intensive reading
Period 4 Language study
Period 5 Integrating skills
Period 6 Workbook (Talking and Reading)
Period 7 Test
Period one ( listening and speaking )
Warming up
Step I Brainstorming about Technology
1. Is technology important to us? What will you think of when talking about technology?
2. What qualities shall we have if we want to have advanced technology?
( to be creative , good at solving problems and thinking in new ways )
Step II Activity
( Bring the items of a toothpick, plastic bag and left-handed glove if possible)
(Hold a competition of creativity among groups of students if necessary)
1. Students work in groups to solve the problems
2. Compare different solutions and talk about creativity.
Listening
Step I Introduction
1. Describe an everyday object for Ss to guess. (color/ size/ shape/ use etc.)
Step II listening
1. First-listening: what is being described?
2. Second-listening: what can the things be used for?
3. Discussion in pairs: what are the new uses for the objects in addition to the “normal” uses?
Step III A riddle-guessing competition
1. Read the instruction and the guided questions
2 Do a demonstration with a student.
Teacher: You seem to have something in your pocket. What does it look like?
Student: It looks like … ….
T: What is it made of ?
S: It’s made of …….
T: What is it used for ?
S: … … …
3 Ss practice in pairs
4 Competition--- Who can guess it ?
One student thinks of or hides an object in his pocket, while the rest raise questions to guess what it is.
Speaking
Step I Brainstorming
1. Present the situation
2. Brainstorming about the advantages and disadvantages about cellphones
Step II Expressions of agreement and disagreement
Teach new expressions
1) Absolutely= Definitely= Exactly
2) It depends.
3) That’s a good point.
4) That’s worth thinking about.
Step III Activity
1. Ss works in groups and prepare a role play.
2. Ss present their dialogues.
3. Debate: Players from different groups debate the advantages and disadvantages of a cellphone.
Homework: 1. Listening : Workbook P133 Listening Ex 1&2
2. Speaking: Interview your parents the way of life 30 years ago ( Were there telephones , TVs or computers ? )
3. Thinking : P60 Ex 3 Design your cellphone--- to be creative!
Period Two ( extensive reading )
Revision
Check the listening homework on page 133.
Pre-reading
Step I Discussion (Question 2 of Pre-reading )
1. Check the speaking homework of interview
How did people live 30 years ago?
What did people do at night without electricity?
How have inventions and new technology changed our way of life?
2. Talk about the title---Life on the go
Life on the go refers to a fast-paced lifestyle where people are always on the go---rushing from one place to another, doing many things at once, and using cellphones, computers, etc.
Reading
Step I Presentation
1. Talk about the cellphone and present the new vocabulary.
( Ask Ss to bring cellphones of different brands to class if possible)
Questions: What functions does a cellphone have?
What features does your cellphone have? etc.
Vocabulary: function, feature, image, an electronic calendar, remind ,appointment
2. The top question:
Why are cellphones so popular with teenagers according to the passage?
Step II Reading
1. Skimming for the top question.
2. Some T or F statements to check the general understanding of the passage.
3. Scanning for the main idea of each paragraph, comparing general statement and specific statement. ( Post-reading Ex 2 on Page 60 )
Step III Activity
1. Discussion in pairs ( Post-reading Ex 1 on Page 60 ).
2. Design your own cellphone in groups.
Homework: 1. Read the text after the tape, marking the difficulties.
2. Reading comprehension: WB page 136.
Period Three ( intensive reading )
Revision
Revise the text .
Language points
Vocabulary
1. depend v. dependent adj. independent adj.
1) That depends. = It depends. = I’m not completely sure.
2) depend on 依赖,信任,取决于
e.g. His family depends on him.
We’re depending on you to finish the job by Friday.
Happiness often depends on your attitude to life.
2. add v.
1) 增加, 相加, 补充说
e.g. Add a few more names to the list.
If you add 5 and 3 you get 8.
I should like to add that we are pleased with the result.
2) add to = to increase something
e.g. The rise in electricity costs has added to our difficulties.
3) add up to = amount to
e.g. These numbers add up to 100.
3. remind v.
remind sb to do sth.
of sth.
that –clause
e.g. Remind me to write to Dave.
This hotel reminds me of the one we stayed in last year.
She reminded me that Sue was in Paris.
4. touch n.
get in touch with sb. lose touch with sb.
stay in touch with be in touch with
keep in touch with be out of touch with
5. call v.
call for = to demand sth. , to collect sb.
call at some place = visit some place
call on sb. = to visit sb., to ask sb. to do sth.
call in = to ask sb. to come in{
e.g. Students are calling for more spare time and less homework.
I'll call for you at 8 o'clock.
I think we'd better call in a doctor.
I called on my uncle while I was in London.
6. case n.
in case in this case
in case of + n./pron in any case
in case --clause in no case = never
e.g. The meeting will be put off in case it rains.
In case he arrives before I get back, please ask him to wait.
In case of fire, ring the bell.
I don't think I need any money, but I'll bring some in case.
In no case should we give up dreaming about a better future.
7. need n.
[U] 缺乏; 需要
[C] 需要得东西; 必需品
in need of sth.
no need for sth.
e.g. There’s a growing need for new housing in big cities.
She didn’t earn enough money to satisfy all her needs.
We’re collecting money for children in need.
Please come to me if ever you’re in need of help.
There’s no need for you to say sorry to me.
Sentence patterns
1. Cellphones make it possible for us to talk to anyone from anywhere.
e.g. I think it necessary for her to stay in touch with her parents .
He found it possible for them to improve the working condition.
Our school makes it a rule for us to have an English Corner every Friday.
2. We have a need to stay in touch with friends no matter where we are or what we are doing.
e.g. Nobody believed him no matter what he said.
No matter where he goes, the thief can’t escape being caught.
She always goes swimming no matter how cold it is.
3. She says that her cellphone helps her do whatever she wants to do.
e.g. Whatever you do, wherever you go, I’ll be right here waiting for you.
She always goes swimming, however cold it is.
Homework: 1. WB page 134-135 Vocabulary Ex1,2,3&4
Period Four ( Language study )
Word study
Step I Page 61 Match the words with their meaning
Step II Check the homework on page 134-135.
Step III Reading for meaning ---guessing the words from the clues.
Page 63 Tips Are you a smart reader?
Grammar
The passive voice (3) --- The Present Continuous Passive Voice
Step I Study the examples
am/ is/ are + being + done
Step II Practice ( page 61 )
Step III Activity
Two students put on a performance of “双簧”.
The door is being pushed open slowly and quietly. A chair is being taken into the room and put at the desk. A piece of paper is being taken out of his pocket. The chair is being cleaned. Now he is sitting down. And some books are being moved to the side of the desk. The schoolbag is being opened, and an English book is being taken out…….
Homework: 1. WB page 136 Grammar 1&2
Period Five ( integrating skills )
Reading
Step I Reading
What is the computer Q12 like ?
How does it control human beings?
What other suggestions will you make to solve the problem?
What will the earth be like if Q12 understands love and friendship?
Step II Language points
1 take over 接管
e.g. The company has been taken over by a American firm.
Sarah will take over my job when I leave.
2 break down (机器)不运转;失败;
break up 结束; (关系)破裂
e.g. The car broke down on the motorway.
The peace talks between the two countries have broken down
The meeting broke up after only half an hour.
Their relationship wasn’t working, so they decided to break up.
3 come up with = to think of or suggest an idea 想出办法,提出建议
e.g. He couldn’t come up with an answer.
How have you come up with such a good idea?
4 success in manage to do sth.
sucessful in
succeed in doing sth. fail to do sth.
e.g. We had no success in finding a new flat.
Jane finally succeeded in passing the her driving test.
Writing
Step I Study the outline of the letter
Step II Students have a discussion in pairs.
Step III Ask a student to give a sample letter orally.
Homework: 1. write a letter to Q12
Period Six ( WB talking and reading )
Talking
WB page 134 Talk about modern technology.
Step I Read the situation
Step II Activity
Ss work in groups
First list the advantages and disadvantages of the inventions of cellphones, robots and computers.
Then Ss have a debate in groups.
Step III Debate
Have 3 debates between groups.
( There are speakers representing each group, and the rest are judges)
Reading
WB page 136 Reading Future travel: teleportation
Step I Fast reading and skimming
What does teleportation mean?
Step II Scanning
How is teleportation different from normal transportation?
Why is it so difficult to teleport human beings?
Step III Reading for words
Match the words with the best strategy on page 137.
Step IV Activity
Discussion : Will teleportation be realized?
Think of more impossible things that may be possible in the future.
高一英语课件【篇6】
基本知识
1 单词和词组:
although waste a waste of believe necessary
go up bring down
passenger record keep a record at one time
make a plan for greatly
correct form
repair complete
information improve decision make a decision
thanks to
Jenny
title CAAC aeroplane
summary take up
2 日常交际用语:
In my opinion,we should…
What‘s your opinion?
I believe we should…
I don’t think it‘s necessary to buy…
We must decide…
I hope we can make a decision.
3 语法:
学习现在完成时的被动语态。
知识点精析与应用
1.单词和词组
(1)waste v.-make no use of;use without a good purpose 浪费
n.-wasting or being wasted 浪费
e.g.①We mustn’t waste any more time.我们千万别再浪费时间了。
②That would be a waste of money.那会浪费钱的。
③What a waste of energy!多么浪费精力!
note:“在…方面(浪费)”应用on或in doing sth.
Dont‘t waste time and money on the house (in building the house)
also:waste adj.-no longer of use 费的,无法利用的
e.g.When the waste water from factories is made clean and reused,a lot of money is saved.(当来自工厂的废水被净化后,重新利用,很多钱就会省下。)
(2)believe v.-fell sure of the truth of sth.;that sb.is telling the truth;be of the opinion(that)。相信(事物的真实性,人的诚实)认为(可与宾语从句连用)。
e.g.①I believe we should buy the smaller one.(我认为我们应买小的。)
②They believed him to be honest.(他们相信他很诚实。)
=They believed that he was honest.
③Will they be ready tomorrow?Yes,I believe so.
(No,I believe not.)
他们明天会准备好吗?是的,我相信的。(不,我相信不会。)
④I believe her.(=I believe what she said)(我相信她说的话是真的。)
also meaning:believe in sb.-trust sb.信任某人
believe in sth.-feel sure of the existence of(相信…存在)
e.g.①The teacher believe in us.(老师认为我们可靠,值得信任。)
②They believe in God.(他们信上帝。)
note:believe与believe in的区别
1)believe in是“信仰,信任”
e.g.He believes in communism.他信仰共产主义。
2)believe sb.是“相信某人说的话是真的”即某一次性具体的判断,而believe in sb.指较长时间觉得某人可靠,值得信任。
e.g.①I believe him.我相信他说的话。(=I believe what he says in true.)
②I believe in him.(=I believe that he is a good and honest man.)
(3)complete v.-finish;bring to an end;make perfect完成,使完善
e.g.①The first and last sentences have already been completed to help you.(第一句和最后一句为了帮助你已经写完.)
②The railway is not completed yet.铁路尚未完工。
note:complete与finish的异同点
1)这两个动词都有“完成”的含义,在许多情况下可换用。
e.g.①Have you completed(finished)your work yet?你的工作完成了吗?
②The house will soon be completed(finished).这房子不久就要完工。
2)finish是一般用语,通常用于完成日常活动,而complete是较正式的用词,常用于完成预定的任务、工程、建设等。
e.g.①Have you finished the book?这本书你看完了吗?
一般不说:Have you completed the book?
②We can complete our task on time.
一般不说:We can finish our task on time.
3)finish还可用作不及物动词而complete不能。
e.g.①I’ve nearly finished.我快完成了。(=I‘m nearly finished)
②He didn’t finish in time.他没有及时完成。
also:complete adj.-having all its parts;whole完全的,整个的
finished 完成的,结束的
e.g.①This is a complete edition of Shakespeare‘s plays.(这是莎士比亚戏剧的全集。)
②When will the book be complete?(这项工作将于何时完成?)
(4)information n.(u.)-sth.told;news or knowledge given消息、情报
e.g.①I’ve got the information for all the computers now.(现在我已有所有这些计算机的消息。)
That‘s a useful piece of information.(那是一则有用的情报(消息)。)
note: information与news的区别
1)information作“消息”、“情报”之意是一个用得比较广泛的词,指通过观察、学习、阅读、调查和交谈所获得的消息、情报乃至资料和知识等。它侧重于内容。它是不可数名词,只有单数形式。
e.g.①Please give me some informaation about trains to London.(请提供给我一些去伦敦的火车的情况。)
②I heard some pieces of information this morning.(今天早上我听到几则消息。)
2)news是“消息”、“新闻”最单纯和最一般的用语,主要侧重于“新”。它是指事件等发生后不久的消息。尤指广播、电视、报刊等新闻媒介所报道的重大“消息”和“新闻”,是不可数名词,只有单数形式。
e.g.①There is a piece of interesting news in the newspaper.(报上有一则有趣的新闻。)
②What good news it is!(多好的消息啊!)
(5)go up-rise 上升
e.g.①I believe prices might go up next week.(我认为下周的价格可能上涨。)
②New buildings are going up everywhere.(新楼房到处在建立起来。)
③Production keeps going up.(生产正在不断上升。)
(6)at one time-during a period of past过去有段时间
e.g.①At one time,there were long queues of people waiting outside the CAAC booking office.(曾有一度在中国民航售票处有排长队的人们在等候售票。)
②At one time I used to go mountain-climbing every summer.(有一段时期,每年夏天我便去爬山。)
other phrase:
at a time 有一次;一次;在某个时刻
at no time 在任何时候都不;决不
at other times在另外一些场合中
at the same time 同时,一齐
at that time 在那时
at times 有时,不时
知识点测试
一.
( )(1)He went on______us______it in a different way.
ing,how to do B.to show,what to do ing,to do D.to show,how to do
( )(2)What_________he sent out!
A.an important information B.important imformations C.an important piece of information D.an important piece imformation
( )(3)Don’t make any noise.He is thinking of __________next.
A.how to do B.doing what
C.what to do D.to do that
( )(4)“Do you think Mr Brown is quite pleased with his new job?”
“I______.”
A.think not B.don‘t think it
C.don’t think that D.don‘t think so
( )(5)Each believed_______he knew just__________the beast looked like.
A.that,what B.that,that
C.what,what D.what,that
( )(6)It is necessary______me______my studies before a new term.
A.for,to make a plan forB.of,making a plan for
C.for,to make a plan ofD.of,making a plan of
( )(7)How long did they________out the maths problem?
A.spend to work B.take working
C.spend working D.take to work
( )(8)Is_________necessay to complete the design before Friday?
A.this B.that C.it D.he
( )(9)The Smiths usually eat at home,but______ they eat at a nearby restaurant.
A.some times B.at times C.at one time D.at that time
( )(10)Most of the students’ time is spent____________ studies.
A.to do B.doing C.on D.for
( )(11)Mr Wang kept___all his old students, though he had retired(退休).
A.a record B.the record
C.a record from D.a record of
( )(12)Is this village_________you visited last autumn?
A.where B.that C.one D.the one
( )(13)I really don‘t know______.
A.which topic to choose B.what to choose topic
C.which to choose topic D.what topic choosing
( )(14)The teacher get someone_______her.
A.help B.to help C.helped D.helping
( )(15)_______your help,we have_______.
A.Thanks to,finished B.Thanks to,completed
C.Thank for,finished D.Thank for,completed
( )(16)When and where to build the new factory__________yet.
A.is not decided B.are not decided
C.has not decided D.have not decided
( )(17)You can’t_________till tomorrow morning af-ter the blood examination.
A.not noly eat but also drink B.either eat or drink
C.neither eat nor drink D.both eat and drink
( )(18)I thought you______like something to read,so I‘ve brought you some storbooks.
A.may B.must C.might uld
( )(19)He hasn’t been able to lose his weight, _______he has done much exercise.
A.although B.but C.though D.as though
( )(20)I‘m sure the prices of grain will__________down.
A.bring B.be brought C.be dropped D.be cut
二.语法练习
( )(1)My parents__________invited to the party.
A.both have been B.have both been
C.have been both D.had been both
( )(2)You can see the house________for years.
A.isn’t painted B.hasn‘t painted
C.hasn’t been painted D.hadn‘t painted
( )(3)Some new oilfields(油田)________since 1976.
A.were opened up B.has opened up
C.have been opened up D.had been opened up
( )(4)“Why does Lingling look so unhappy?”
“She has_______by her classmates.”
A.laughed B.laughed at
C.been laughed D.been laughed at
( )(5)This is a photo of the power station that___________in my home town.
A.has set up B.has been set up
C.was set up D.is set up
( )(6)Great changes__________in the city,and a lot of factories___________.
A.have been taken place,have been set up
B.have taken place,have been set up
C.have taken place,have set up
D.were taken place,were set up
( )(7)The police found that the house_________and a lot of thins_______.
A.has broken into,has been stolen
B.had broken into,had been stolen
C.has been broken into,stolen
D.had been broken into,stolen
( )(8)When the firemen arrived,the fire________put out.
A.has B.had C.was D.had been
( )(9)All the sewing machines(缝纫机)__________sold out before we arrived.
A.have B.have been C.had been D.had
( )(10)Some of the chapters(章、节)____________by many scientists.
A.have been widely read B.have been read wide
C.have dipped into D.have looked through
答案
一. (1)-(5)D C C D A (6)-(10)A C C B C
(11)-(15)D D A B A (16)-(20)A B C C B
二. (1)-(5)B C C D B (6)-(10)B D D C A
英语动物课件十二篇
在校园里,我们阅读过许多范文,一篇好的范文会让我们学到东西,阅读范文可以让我们更容易渡过独处的时间。阅读范文还能够让自己加深对写作的了解,那么,您看过哪些值得借鉴的教师相关优秀范文吗?以下是小编为大家收集的“英语动物课件十二篇”仅供参考,希望能为您提供参考!
英语动物课件 篇1
一、活动目标:
1、通过故事来让幼儿了解动物脚的作用。并且知道各有各的本领,不能自以为是,骄傲自满。
2、巩固复习英语单词,并且能运用到故事中。
3、丰富和认字“锋利”“濮”“肉垫、”“语重心长”。
二、活动准备:
背景图、小动物、认字卡片、录音机、磁带、图画纸蜡笔。
三、活动过程:导入活动
1.复习双语儿歌《拍拍手》。
朋友见面招招手,Hello!Hello!
欢迎朋友拍拍手。Welcome!Welcome!
谢谢谢谢握握手,Thankyou!Thankyou!
再见!再见!摆摆手!Goodbye!Goodbye!
2.游戏《猜猜这是谁的脚?》
(1)在黑板上出示动物图片,(每张图片遮住身体,直露出脚,分别是鸡、鸭、猫、马)
(2)请小朋友仔细观察、根据脚的特点说图片上的动物是谁?(请小朋友猜一猜)
(3)最后打开遮住的图片,全体幼儿做口语练习。Goodmorning!chick!Goodmorning!Duck!Goodmorning!Cat!Goodmorning!Horse!
四、基本部分
1.今天这几只小动物真高兴、它们要给小朋友讲一个故事《动物的脚》。
2.提问:鸡、鸭、猫、马它们在吵什么呀?
幼儿:(幼儿自由讨论)
师:让幼儿回答(A)都夸自己脚的本领大!它们互不相让,吵了个面红耳赤。(B)chick说自己的脚有什么本领?
(C)dcck说自己的脚的本领大?
(D)cat说自己的脚有什么本领?
(E)Horse说自己的脚有什么本领?
这时Cattle说走来语重心长的说:“什么”?它们听了以后都怎么样?请两个小朋友来完整地把各自的本领讲述一遍,(边讲述边表演加深印象)
师小结:对了小动物的脚各有各的长处,如:鸡的脚有锋利的爪子能用脚刨土。鸭的脚肉连着叫濮可以用脚当作船划,非常省力。猫说:有毛绒绒的毛摸上去很光滑脚趾和脚掌下有一块肉垫。马说:可以拉车运东西。你们都有自己的长处,都有自己的短处。我们应该友好相处,大家成为朋友互相帮忙。
师:Yes or no
幼:答yes
3.认字(继续讲述一遍故事)(听录音)
4.你们还了解哪些动物的脚的本领吗?(如大象的脚大而有力能运木头)
讨论(自由讨论)
集中:幼儿自由发言
小结:对了小动物脚各有各的本领,不能自以为是,互相帮助,成为朋友,生活会变的更美好!
五.结束部分
延伸:对了还有其他小朋友没有听过我们《动物的脚》的故事。我们来把他画下来,把他们各自的本领讲给小朋友听好吗?好areyouready?ok!
幼儿画画,放一些轻音乐(可以让家长和孩子互动帮忙合作绘画,边讲故事边画画)
英语动物课件 篇2
活动目标:
1、初步学习单词:孔雀peacock、乌龟Turtle,并复习有关动物的单词。
2、能够大胆积极地回答问题,进一步激发幼儿参与英语活动的积极性。
3、复习已经学过的单词,并且用游戏的形式进行巩固练习。
4、培养幼儿对于英语的兴趣,让幼儿乐意参与英语活动。
活动准备:
1、PPT、单词卡片。
2、幼儿已学过一些动物的单词。
活动过程:
一、 日常用语对话
小朋友,今天杨老师要带来了一位小客人,待会小朋友见到小客人以后要有礼貌哦!
Mickey与集体说话
M:Hello!My name is mickey.Good morning everyone!
幼儿:Good morning Mickey!
Mickey个别交流
M:how are you ?
幼:I am fine. /just so so .
小结:与mickey一起说说“hello” 打招呼儿歌。
二、运用直观材料,复习旧单词。
出示动物园幻灯片,让幼儿用英语说出小动物的名字。
1、 师:昨天mickey去了一个好玩的地方,他拍了一些照片想和我们小朋友一起分享,我们一起去看看好吗?Are you ready?
师:Ok,let’s go
2、师:oh!Where is this?奥!这是哪里?
幼儿:动物园(zoo)
师:What did you see?你看到了什么动物呀?并做做动作。(兔子、老虎、狗、大象、蝴蝶)
小结:真聪明,一下子就能说出这些动物的名称跟着杨老师一起来念念。
三、学习单词:孔雀peacock、乌龟Turtle
1、学习单词:孔雀peacock
师:现在杨老师要考考你们,有个谜语给你们猜猜。“头上戴王冠,尾巴别花扇,一旦打开,人人喜欢。”幼儿猜,最后有教师出示课件揭示谜底。教幼儿学念孔雀peacock,并引导幼儿模仿孔雀peacock的特征。
2、学习单词:乌龟Turtle
师:Look ,who is coming ?你们看,还有谁来了?
幼儿与乌龟打招呼,学念乌龟Turtle。
四、游戏加深对单词的记忆。
“学样”师学蝴蝶、小白兔、老虎、狗、孔雀、乌龟,让幼儿根据动作说出相应的英语单词。(请幼儿上来“学样”,激发幼儿学习兴趣,此游戏可反复进行。)
五、结束活动。
师:玩的很开心来,我们和mickey一起唱、一起跳吧。
英语动物课件 篇3
幼儿园大班英语教案
一、活动目标
1、让幼儿认识农场里的不同小动物。
2、培养幼儿爱护小动物的情感。
3、能够说出几种动物的名称。
二、活动准备
1、磁带、配套光盘
2、大苹果、西瓜、饼干、梨头饰若干、图片等。
三、活动过程
(一)Greeting :
情景表演引出课题。
(二)Story time:
1、运用故事展开知识点,学习cow pig turkey chick等。
2、通过提问的形式回顾知识。
3、让幼儿和小动物游戏来巩固知识。
4、采用游戏来复习所学,运用机器人的游戏提高了幼儿的学习兴趣。
5、出示百宝盒让幼儿取出所学卡片复习巩固。
(三)Ending :
教师放大屏幕与幼儿一起复习所学。
四、活动结束
英语动物课件 篇4
教具准备:
1 教师准备动物玩具 rabbit, panda, monkey, dog, duck 等放置于一个篮子中。
2 教师准备有关动物图片和卡片。
3 教师准备Let's talk部分和有关动物的教学课件。
4 教师准备教材录音带。
教学过程:
1 热身、复习 (Warm-up/Revision)
(1)教师播放 Recycle 1----Let's sing 的录音,师生共同演唱歌曲 How Are You?, 并伴有打节拍等动作。
(2)学生口语表演。教师给学生3分钟左右的时间, 让学生根据所学内容自编会话。(若课上没有准备的时间,教师可留口头家庭作业,让学生头一天准备。)在学生准备完毕后进行课上表演。会话内容为所学知识的总和,也可鼓励学生将课外知识引入。以下提供两个简单的会话内容:
a. ----Good afternoon, Fang Fang.
----Good afternoon, Lan Lan.
----Lan Lan, this is Dong Dong. He is new.
----Hi, Dong Dong. Nice to meet you.
----Nice to meet you, too.
b. ----Hello, Bai Ling. How are you?
---- Hi, I'm fine, thank you. And you?
----Very well, thank you.
(3)教师播放 Recycle 1---- chant and find! 的录音,师生同说此段内容。
(4)游戏:SHOW ME YOUR… 【学生使用自己准备好的文具实物】
教师先示范说单词,如pencil ,教师说Show me your pencils. 学生出示铅笔,又快又正确的同学为小组赢得一分。用同样的方法找学生说其它文具单词的口令,继续游戏。(注意:教师应参加学生的游戏,与学生一起展示文具。)
2 呈现新课 (Presentation)
(1)教师举起自己的钢笔说:Look!I have a pen. 请学生用Look!I have a … 的句型再次复习文具。
(2)教师拿出准备好的篮子,篮子中有rabbit, panda, monkey, dog, duck 等动物玩具。教师将篮子举起,兴奋地说:Look! Wow! I have so many animals. I love animals. 教师拿起 panda 说:Look! I have a panda. 教师教授新单词 panda ,a panda ,I have a panda.
(3)用同样的方法讲授新单词rabbit, monkey, dog, duck 等。学习单词时,让学生手举玩具与老师一起说。其中以 rabbit, monkey为主。在说新单词时教师鼓励学生用完整句表述,如:I have a panda/ monkey.
(这些单词本课时只要求学生能听懂,会说。 认读则放在第二课时。)
(4)再次认读单词。教师用动物的图片制成教学课件。教师点击鼠标,每点击鼠标一次,屏幕上出现一个图案和相应单词。教师让学生按图案认读单词rabbit, monkey, dog, duck, panda, cat 。第七次点击鼠标时,前六幅图案同时出现并闪动,一两秒钟后屏幕出现 animals 一词。此时教师说单词 Rabbit, monkey, dog, duck, panda, cat , they are animals. They are in the zoo. 教师说到 zoo 时,再次点击鼠标,屏幕上出现动物园的图案和单词。
在开始呈现独个动物图片时,教师可让学生猜猜看,根据学生猜的情况教师适时带领学生用感叹语 Wow! Cool! Great! Super! 。比如学生猜的是小兔子时,屏幕上出现的也是一只可爱的小兔子,教师感叹道:Wow! Look! It's a rabbit. 另外,学生在第二和第三单元接触过 Wow! Great! 两个感叹语,当看到可爱或夸张的图片时也会情不自禁的感叹。 教师可因势利导的再教两个有关赞美的感叹语 Cool! 和 Super! 告诉学生时下中文最 时髦的说法“好酷啊!”中的“酷”既是英文的Cool! 一词的译音。而“Super! ”可翻 译成“好极了!”“棒极了!”等等。
(5)教师播放Let's talk/ A部分的课件。播放之前提出要求:
你能听到或看到几种动物?How many animals?
你会说其中的哪种动物? Can you say in English?
你能说说其中还有你会的内容吗?Anything else?
(6)再次观看,让学生试着跟说。
(7)播放教学录音,学生模仿录音说对话。注意模仿语音正确、语调自然。
3 趣味操练 (Practice)
(1)教师让学生手拿自己的玩具,两至四人一组练习说 Look!I have a rabbit / dog …
(2)教师让学生将玩具交换,并把自己新得到的玩具随意展示给某个同学看,或教师指定一名学生将新玩具展示给其他同学看。边展示边说:Look!I have a rabbit / dog … ,听者用感叹词Wow! Cool! Great! Super! 做出反应,并发出这种动物的声音。教师还可以发挥学生表演才能,比一比,看谁模仿的动物叫声及形体特征最逼真。
(3)让学生打开书40页,教师带读书上 Let's play 部分的象声词 Woof! Woof! Mew! Mew! Quack! Quack! , 随后教师让学生两人一组,按照课本中所呈现的方式,扮演小动物,进行练习。最后找同学上台前表演此部分内容。
4 课堂评价 (Assessment)
做活动手册本单元第一部分的练习,方法和步骤同以前。
5 扩展性活动(Add-activities)
谁最像?
教师请学生上台模仿小动物的声音或动作,如果叫Mew! Mew! 其他学生马上说出单词:Cat! Cat! 有小猫玩具的同学,手举实物说句子Look! I have a cat! 其他学生运用所学的感叹语发出Wow!/Cool!/Super!/Great! 然后教师再请另外的学生上台来模仿小狗,小鸭的叫声,其他同学配合表演。最后,评出谁模仿得最逼真生动,教师奖励动物图片,以提高学生的积极性。
板书设计:
英语动物课件 篇5
目标:
1.引导幼儿能熟练地运用“I like…….”的句型。
2.鼓励幼儿学会用迁移的方法,可以比较灵活的回答提问。
3.幼儿能够融入到英语游戏之中,并能配合教师积极参与到英语活动之中。
4.幼儿能够感受到英语学习的快乐。
准备:小猫、小狗、小猴、小鸭头饰若干,旅游旗帜一面,野餐食物若干。
过程:
一、师生相互问好
T:Good morning, Girls and boys.
C: Good morning, Miss xiong .
T: How are you today ?
C: I am fine.
二、New lesson
1、教师出示旅游旗帜,开始自我介绍:
T: I am a rabbit,nice to meet you !
C: Nice to meet you too.
T:It’s sunny day ,I’m very happy, Are you happy?
C: I am happy.
T:I will take you out in the open air,It’s very funny,Are you ready?
C: Yes.
T:Let’s go . C:Go go go!
2、带小朋友爬山涉水(设置好的障碍),在走的途中引导幼儿说:“This is a hole”.“This is a hill”.可提问:“Do you like climbing hills? 幼儿回答:Yes,I do .爬上涉水后便来到了一遍美丽的草地上,T:These flowers are very beaufiful.,I like red flowers and yellow flowers…….What flowers do you like ?C:I like …….(引导幼儿说完整的一句)
3、T:We’re very hungry,after long walk,Are you hungry?
C:Yes.
T:There’re many delicacy food in the grass.You must find these food first and than you can eat.
4、教师给幼儿交代清楚寻找食物的要求,幼儿寻找食物。
5、幼儿把寻找的事物带到教师面前,教师问问题:
T:What do you like?
Monkey、Duck、Cat、Rabbit分别回答:I like banana./I like small fish. /I like fish./I like carrot.
6、Let’s play a game.进一步巩固“I like …….”句型。
T:Let’s hand in hand ,make a circle ,Play a game“Ai mi ma mo”.Ok?
C:Ok!
三、结束部分。
1、跟音乐一起跳舞狂欢。
2、T:Are you tired ? C:Yes .
T:Time is up ,we must go home .Byebye. C:Byebye.
英语动物课件 篇6
活动目标:
1、初步学习句子How are you ?—fine, thank you
2、学会表达礼貌用语,做个懂事的小朋友
3、在游戏环节中巩固所学内容并培养孩子的英语学习兴趣。
4、幼儿能够感受到英语学习的快乐。
5、在奇妙的游戏中体验英语学习的乐趣。
活动准备:
布绒玩具小猫和小狗各一个
小猫和小狗的头饰
活动过程:
Step1:Greeting
T:Hello boys and girls 。
C:Hello miss su
T:nice to meet you!
C:Nice to meet you too!
Step2:Warm up
T:Uncle ,uncle very very cool…………..
C: Uncle ,uncle very very cool…………..
Step3:New lesson
教师出示单词进行复习单词。
T:教师出示猫和狗的玩具
T:hello everyone!
C:hi cat ,hello dog
T:good,listen carefully !
T:当我们遇见别人的时候要和他们问好,应该怎么说呢?(你好吗?别人是怎么回答你的呢?我很好,谢谢!对了,别人会说)这是有礼貌的好孩子。
T:这些话用英语怎么说呢?How are you !
C:How are you ?
T:ok ,then you shoud answer "fine thank you !"
C:fine thank you !
T:good,I will ask you ,"how are you ?"and you answer me ,fine thank you !ok ?
T:How are you!
C:fine thank you !
Step4:game :角色扮演
Tercher shows the models of dog and cat!
T:hello everyone
C:hi cat hi dog
T:good listen carefully when the cat and the dog meet ,they will greet to each other
Ok ,I need two kids to act as the cat and the dog
Who wants to try ?
(当小猫和小狗相遇的时候,他们相互问候。需要两个孩子分别扮演猫和狗,教师请幼儿戴上头饰进行情景表演。)
T:are you ready
C:yes
Players :How are you!
—fine thank you !引导幼儿相互问好!重复玩机次游戏,方法同上。
Step5:game sing a song How are you!
请幼儿先跟着老师学唱歌曲。
游戏规则:教室带着小朋友一起唱问候歌并请小朋友在唱的同时找到自己的好朋友拥抱并握握手。
请小朋友把这首歌曲唱给好朋友听。
活动延伸:
引导幼儿平时上课前用所学的礼貌用语和老师打招呼。
英语动物课件 篇7
教学目标:
1、 进一步巩固表示动物类单词,使学生通过学唱歌曲、做手影来调动复习兴趣。
2、 要求学生能熟练听说、认读单词 monkey, dog, duck, panda, cat, rabbit ,能跟唱歌曲《Old MacDonald》。
教材分析:
本课时的Let's make 部分是通过做手影动物,进一步调动学习兴趣,检测学生用所学语言独立做事的能力。同时培养他们动手动脑能力和创造力。
Let's sing 部分是通过演唱歌曲,让学生复习和巩固所学动物的词汇。
设计说明:
在 Let's sing 部分的歌曲中,有一些单词的发音较难如:here, there, everywhere, with ,教师可让学生通过跟唱的方法熟悉发音。另外,教师还应适当讲解歌词的含义,辅助学生理解和记忆。在学生初步掌握书上的一段歌词后,教师可指导学生将歌词稍作改动,增加几段歌词,进一步运用动物类单词演唱歌曲。ducks 改为cats, dogs , quack, quack 改为 mew, mew, woof, woof 。
Let's make 部分,教师可将学生带到室外,在阳光下做手影动物。在教师简单讲解、学生亲自实践中发散思维、努力创新,使学生既动手来又动脑。最后,教师可组织“巧手大赛”,让学生展示自我的同时相互学习、彼此交流,但要注意比赛期间的英文使用率。
教学重点:
运用所学语言(动物类单词)做事情的能力。如:表达所有或所见动物的名称,演唱含有动物类单词的歌曲等。
教学难点:歌词中部分单词的发音 here, there, everywhere, with 。
教具准备:
1、教师准备教材配套的录音带。
2、教师准备 ducks, cats, dogs的头饰。
3、教师准备一幅关于老麦当劳农场的画,农场中的动物不画进去,而是另外画在纸上并剪出形状。
4、教师准备所学动物类单词卡片和图片。
教学过程:
1、热身、复习 (Warm-up/Revision)
(1)师生共唱英文歌曲《Head Shoulders Knees and Toes》 《How are you?》
(2)学生展示英语口语对话。
(3)游戏:Do it quickly! (快速做一做)
首先,用单词卡和图片练习所学动物类单词。学生边读老师边把卡片和图片贴在黑板上或墙壁上。之后,将全班分为三、四队,每次按顺序每队出一名选手。教师给学生下指令Run to the cat. ,各队的选手要快速跑到cat 的图片或卡片处,用手取下图片或卡片。哪组学生得到图片或卡片就为他们对得一分。随后,教师再用本单元第二课时的指令 Act like a cat/ a duck/ a panda/…. 等,让学生边模仿边走到卡片或图片处取下。
2、呈现新课 (Presentation)
(1)教师将准备好的老麦当劳农场的图片贴在黑板上,指着图中的老麦当劳对学生说:Look, this is Old MacDonald. This is a farm. This is Old MacDonald's farm. 之后,教师带读Old MacDonald 和 farm 两个单词。 告诉学生farm 是农场,Old MacDonald是人名。检查学生认读情况,适当纠正发音,此时的准确认读有利于后面歌词的跟读。
(2)教师播放歌曲Old MacDonald ,询问学生听到些什么?(学生能听出的歌词不在乎多少,在于听力的训练。)表扬听对、敢说单词的学生。
(3)教师带读歌词中的重点词句。
Old MacDonald had a farm. On that farm he had some ducks. Old MacDonald had a farm on that farm he had some ducks. 教师边带读边把几只鸭子的图贴到农场的不同地方。用中文解释到:老麦当劳有个农场,农场中有ducks ,这里嘎嘎叫,那里也嘎嘎叫,到处都是嘎嘎的叫声。引出 Here a quack, there a quack, everywhere a quack quack. 。重点带读here, there, everywhere, with 。
(4)教师手打节拍,再次带读歌词。
(5)让学生听 Let's sing 部分的录音,学生跟着试唱。由于这首歌的歌词较复杂,让学生多听几遍多跟唱几遍。教师还可以逐句教唱。
3、趣味操练 (Practice)
(1)教师拿出准备好的 ducks, cats, dogs 的头饰。在学生初步掌握书上的一段歌词后,指导学生将歌词稍作改动,增加几段歌词,进一步运用动物类单词演唱歌曲。ducks 改为cats, dogs ,quack, quack 改为 mew, mew, woof, woof 。
(2)师生共同演唱改编后的歌词。
(3)由于歌词较难,在连唱几段歌词时,教师可以自己领唱或找能力强的学生领唱前两行,从第三行起集体齐唱。用此方法降低难度,调动唱歌兴趣。
(4)做 Let's make 部分的活动。教师可将学生带到室外,在阳光下做手影动物。
a. 教师简单讲解活动内容和具体手势。找一面阳光能照得到的白墙,用两只手做不同动物的影子。
b. 学生亲自实践。除了学过的动物单词,学生还可做其它东西的影子,并及时告诉这种东西的英文名称。从中发散思维、努力创新,使学生既动手来又动脑。
c. 教师组织"巧手大赛",让学生展示自我的同时相互学习、彼此交流,但要注意比赛期间的英文使用率。学生可用: Look, I have …的句子表述。做得好的同学教师应该给予表扬和奖励。
如果室外没条件,教师可打开投影机,照射在一面白墙上和学生一起活动。
4、课堂评价 (Assessment)
做活动手册本单元第3部分的练习,方法和步骤同以前。
5、扩展性活动(Add-activities)
游戏1:Silent Speech
告诉学生教师将换一种方法说句子------唇说,既说句子的时候不发出声音。学生看教师的口形,猜教师"说"的内容。说的句子为本单元所学内容例如: I have a duck. I have a rabbit….
游戏2:Cards game
把所学动物类单词卡放在一边,图片放在另一边,学生两人一组做游戏。每次每人抽单词卡和图卡各一张,如单词卡和图卡为同一单词为胜利。最后比一比,谁手中的卡多,谁为胜利者。
英语动物课件 篇8
【设计思路】
这几天,我们正进行着有关“春天”的活动。今天的这个活动就是围绕“春天的动物”中冬眠的小动物进行的。孩子一开始就非常喜欢小动物,加上我们为孩子设计了“春天来了,冬眠的动物醒来啦!”这个版面(可以自由拉动墙壁上的小动物)因此他们对冬眠的小动物有了更大的兴趣。午睡时,叶晨小朋友问起了 “小猪冬眠吗?”户外活动时王宇劼问起了“小蜗牛冬眠吗?”孩子们从家里收集了许多资料,有的带来了从网上下载的资料,有的带来了毛绒玩具,还有的带来了有关冬眠动物的故事……因此,我设计了本次游戏活动,目的让幼儿了解更多的有关冬眠的动物。
【活动目标】
1、通过游戏,了解哪些动物是冬眠的。
2、尝试在游戏中说说英语,体验游戏的快乐。
活动准备:幻灯片、冬眠动物版面、动物头饰、春天歌曲
【活动过程】
一、说说最近我们忙着做件什么事情?(寻找哪些是冬眠的小动物)说说你找到的冬眠的小动物有哪些?
二、观看幻灯,师生讨论
讨论幻灯片中的小动物是否冬眠(其中有争议的地方可让幼儿问问客人老师或在“小问号”内记录)
三、游戏《Wake up!冬眠的动物醒来啦!》
1、个别游戏
玩法:幼儿对纸袋里的小动物说些有关春天的话,然后把冬眠的小动物拉出来。
2、集体游戏
玩法:幼儿做冬眠的小动物,教师做叫醒小动物的人。听到“冬天来了,许多小动物开始冬眠啦!”幼儿做睡觉状。听到“春天来了,冬眠的动物醒来了。小青蛙,Wake up!Wake up!”小青蛙就做醒过来的样子。然后再去把其它冬眠的动物叫醒。直至所有的小动物都醒过来。
规则:冬眠的动物听到“wake up!wake up!”才可醒来。叫醒小动物的人要说一些有关春天的话。
英语动物课件 篇9
名称:动物夏令营(Animals Summer Camp)
目标:
1、引导幼儿能熟练地运用“I like…….”的句型。
2、鼓励幼儿学会用迁移的方法,可以比较灵活的回答提问。
准备:小猫、小狗、小猴、小鸭头饰若干,旅游旗帜一面,野餐食物若干。
过程:
一、师生相互问好
T:Good morning, Girls and boys.
C: Good morning, Miss xiong .
T: How are you today ?
C: I am fine.
二、New lesson
1、教师出示旅游旗帜,开始自我介绍:
T: I am a rabbit,nice to meet you !
C: Nice to meet you too.
T:It’s sunny day ,I’m very happy, Are you happy?
C: I am happy.
T:I will take you out in the open air,It’s very funny,Are you ready?
C: Yes.
T:Let’s go . C:Go go go!
2、带小朋友爬山涉水(设置好的障碍),在走的途中引导幼儿说:“This is a hole”.“This is a hill”.可提问:“Do you like climbing hills? 幼儿回答:Yes,I do .爬上涉水后便来到了一遍美丽的草地上,T:These flowers are very beaufiful.,I like red flowers and yellow flowers…….What flowers do you like ?C:I like …….(引导幼儿说完整的一句)
3、T:We’re very hungry,after long walk,Are you hungry?
C:Yes.
T:There’re many delicacy food in the grass.You must find these food first and than you can eat.
4、教师给幼儿交代清楚寻找食物的要求,幼儿寻找食物。
5、幼儿把寻找的事物带到教师面前,教师问问题:
T:What do you like?
Monkey、Duck、Cat、Rabbit分别回答:I like banana./I like small fish. /I like fish./I like carrot.
6、Let’s play a game.进一步巩固“I like …….”句型。
T:Let’s hand in hand ,make a circle ,Play a game“Ai mi ma mo”.Ok?
C:Ok!
三、结束部分。
1、跟音乐一起跳舞狂欢。
2、T:Are you tired ? C:Yes .
T:Time is up ,we must go home .Byebye. C:Byebye.
英语动物课件 篇10
活动目的及要求:复习动物单词
活动目标:
1、能用英语日常用语互动并积极地参与游戏中。
2、能边做动作边说出英语单词:sheep,pig,bee,bird,dog,cat,horse,rabbit,chick,duck
活动准备:英语卡片、英语律动碟片,百宝馕
活动过程:
一、问候
师:Goodafternoon,students?(Goodafternoon,teather.)
二、律动
师:Letsdoawarmup,Ok?(Ok.)
做英语韵律操(由做的好的学生带领做)
三、游戏
师:Letsplayagame,ok
1、通过集体游戏Turnaround,复习英语单词sheep,pig,bee,bird,dog,cat,horse,rabbit,chick,duck
玩法:师:Turnaround
(1)试两遍,幼儿熟悉游戏。
(2)游戏中,谁第一个说出单词,给予礼物以激发幼儿兴趣。
2、通过游戏百宝馕,引导幼儿复习英语单词sheep,pig,bee,bird,dog,cat,horse,rabbit,chick,duck妈咪爱婴网-幼儿园教案频道
(1)先后假装让2位幼儿偷看百宝馕中的物品,并作嘘动作,幼儿开口之前口说:不许说,作出神秘状
(2)让第三位幼儿取出卡片并说出单词,请其他幼儿判断。
(3)也可以请幼儿表演,其他幼儿猜单词,请取卡片的幼儿判断。
英语动物课件 篇11
教学内容:
教学目标:
1. Master the new words : jump, walk, swim, dance, run
2. Can you jump/ swim? Yes, I can.
3. I can dance?
教学目标的检测途径 1.老师说,学生做动作。或者学生说,另一学生做动作进行检验。2.打乱新单词、图片顺序,学生自由认读。
重点难点:
Teaching importance: New words learning.
Teaching difficulty : use the structures to ask and answer
突破教学难点的方法 1.用动作引导单词的记忆。2.通过歌谣,边说边做。
教具准备:
课件
教学过程:
一、Warm-up
1. Oral English
---Good morning! / afternoon!
---Good morning! / afternoon!
---How are you?
---I’m find.
--- What day is it today? -
-- It’s Monday.
---What’s the weather like today?
---It’s rain.
2.Say the rhyme : An elephant can walk, walk, walk, walk?
二、新课呈现(Presentation)
1.T: What can elephant do?
S: Elephant.
T: Yes, the elephant can walk. Today, Miss Liu will take you to the zoo, to see some animals and learn what can they do?
2.Show out a picture of elephant
T : What’s this? S: ?
T: What can it do?
T: It’s can walk. Elicit : walk Walk, walk, an elephant can walk. ( do action)
T: Can you walk?
S: Yes, I can. Repeat:walk Say the rhyme again : An elephant can walk, walk, walk, walk?A frog can jump, jump, jump, jump,?
3.Practice A: Can you walk? ( one ask the next, little train)
4. Elicit: Jump Repeat:jump
5. the same way to learn swim, run.
6. ask a student to sing a song and do action
One two, one, two, It’s a fish。
To sing a song and do action
One two, one, two, It’s a fish
T: ( when the student do action) Look, she can dance. Elicit: Dance,ask some students come to the board to dance.
7. play a game touching game
8. play an acting game teacher say teacher act ---- ---- they act
三、巩固和延伸(Consolidation and extension)
Come to the board to ask their friends: Can you ?? Yes, I can. No.----
they say Play a game like this
I can jump. I can jump, I can swim. I can jump, I can swim, I can walk. ? ?
T:Let’s listen to the tape and read after it.Ss listen to the tape and read after it
四、作业布置
Listen to the tape and read after it.
Teach parents to do actions with you.
板书设计:
jump, walk, swim, dance, run
Can you jump/ swim?
Yes, I can. I can dance?(图片)
英语动物课件 篇12
教学目标:
1、能听说、认读本课所学的常见的动物单词 rabbit, monkey, dog, duck, panda, cat 。
2、能用英文介绍这些动物。
3、能听懂一些简单的指示语,并能按照指令模仿动物做出相应的动作。
教学重点:进一步学习常见的几种动物的单词 monkey, dog, duck, panda, cat, rabbit。
教学难点:panda, cat, rabbit 三个单词中的字母 a 都含有相同的音[? ] ,提示学生找共同点,使学生简单了解一些语音知识。
教具准备:
1、教师准备 monkey, dog, duck, panda, cat, rabbit 的图片和相应的单词卡片。
2、教师准备 monkey, dog, duck, panda, cat, rabbit 的面具或头饰。
3、教师准备与教材相配套的教学录音带。
4、教师准备Let's talk/ A 部分对话中人物的面具。
教学过程:
1、热身、复习 (Warm-up/Revision)
(1)Oral practice学生口语会话展示。教师可提示学生适时加入新句型: I have a ….
(2)然学生带上面具表演第一课时 Let's talk/ A 部分的对话。
(3)"猜猜看"游戏。
教师用简笔画的方法在黑板上画某种动物身体的某个部位,边画边问:What is it? 如:教师在黑板上画猴子的头、耳朵后问: What is it? 学生随意想象,猜图说:A panda? A monkey? … 教师再继续画一两笔,让学生接着猜,并以小组为单位讨论,最后由一名学生代表说出一个答案。教师将图画完,带领学生一起说: Look! It's a … 猜对的小组赢得一分。
2、呈现新课 (Presentation)
(1)继续调动学生学习兴趣,接着刚才的游戏猜谜。教师将所学的动物单词 monkey, dog, duck, panda, cat, rabbit 的图片提前贴在一块小黑板上,或提前贴在教室的黑板上,并在每幅动物图案上用纸张或其它物品遮盖好,只露动物的尾巴,让学生猜猜看 What is it? ,导入单词的学习。
(2)学生根据动物的尾巴猜谜,并七嘴八舌的讨论。
(3)教师将遮盖物取下,学生自然的发出感叹 Wow! Great! 随后教师请学生读单词。(学生在第一课时已经初步学习了单词)此时教师不要急于纠正学生发音,而让学生相互说说、评评,让学生间相互纠正单词的发音。
(4)教师出示单词卡片,请学生将单词读出后将卡片贴在黑板上,并要求贴在相对应的图片底下。使单词的音、形、译三者相结合。
(5)教师请五名"小老师"到讲台前带读单词,既是对能力强学生的表彰也是多方面调动学习兴趣的体现。让每名"小老师"带读一个单词。
(6)打开书41页,全体学生听录音跟读单词。要求每读一个单词,手指一个单词。跟读单词时力求模仿录音中的语音语调。
(7)将学生分为六个小组,让能力强的学生或自愿申报担任组长工作,带领小组组员继续学习单词,巩固认读情况 monkey, dog, duck, panda, cat, rabbit 。小组活动时应有评比,评比各组活动情况,如:学习氛围,小组纪律状况,有无大声喊叫现象,有无打闹现象等。教师还可为各小组命名,组名为新单词内容 monkey, dog, duck, panda, cat, rabbit 。
(8)小组反馈。让小组组员齐读单词,也可每人读一个单词,检查单词掌握情况。教师可继续评比,方法为:读对一个单词加一分。
(9)总结小组分数。
3、趣味操练 (Practice)
(1)游戏:小组对抗赛
a. 按六个小组monkey, dog, duck, panda, cat, rabbit 开展对抗比赛,各小组挑选一名组员上讲台前抽取单词卡片,大声认读,本组的其他组员快速做出此种动物的动作或模仿声音,正确的加分。以此类推,直到六个小组都轮流过一次。
b. 各小组间自由挑选组员,按自己的意愿说本课单词,但只张嘴不出声音,要求对方猜出单词是什么。例:monkey小组挑选dog小组的一名组员并不出声音的说单词panda ,dog小组的组员要按照口形猜出单词,猜对的加分。以此类推,各组间自由考察,相互提问。
c. 总结各小组分数,为第一名小组发奖。
(2)Let's do
a. 教师播放 Let's do 部分的录音,学生边听边说边做此部分的活动。做动作时可加上动物的叫声。
b. 教师使用Let's do 部分的动作图卡,让学生看图说图卡上画的是什么动物做的动作。
c. 学生再次听录音,能力强的学生说出指令内容,同时请几个学生上台前表演动作。
(3)游戏:
教师将monkey, dog, duck, panda, cat, rabbit 的面具或头饰拿出,选六名学生到讲台前,请他们紧闭双眼,教师给它们戴上面具后学生睁开双眼。底下的学生直呼其中一人的名字,并用动作告诉她/他面具是什么动物,由带面具的学生猜,猜对为胜,直到六名学生都知道自己的面具是什么动物。根据时间决定游戏次数。
4、课堂评价 (Assessment)
做活动手册本单元第2部分的练习,方法和步骤同以前。
5、扩展性活动(Add-activities)
游戏1:
I'm lucky today!
教师将学生带到室外,按学生人数分成大组,每组约10人,围成大圈坐在地下。给每组学生一套面具monkey, dog, duck, panda, cat, rabbit ,让一名学生手拿面具,随音乐走动,当音乐停止时将其中一个面具放在一名同学身后,大家一起喊:1 2 3 (One, two, three),谁的身后有面具谁就是"幸运星","幸运星"要戴上面具大声说:I'm lucky! Look! I have a … 。音乐再次响起,游戏继续进行。
游戏2:
教师将面具发给学生,让学生戴上面具,扮演小动物参加运动会入场式。底下的同学要一同介绍参加入场式的成员 This is Panda. This is Cat. This is Duck. …
教后反思:panda,cat,rabbit三个单词都有/a/音,可进行归纳。听了艳艳老师的课后,可借鉴的好点子有:
1.monkey king, I like …
2.Hello, I’m a cat.表演,可以将以前学过的语言运用起来,可以滚雪球的方式越滚越大。